MBA - 317 15 - Financial and Management Accounting PDF
MBA - 317 15 - Financial and Management Accounting PDF
MBA - 317 15 - Financial and Management Accounting PDF
All rights reserved. No part of this publication which is material protected by this copyright notice
may be reproduced or transmitted or utilized or stored in any form or by any means now known or
hereinafter invented, electronic, digital or mechanical, including photocopying, scanning, recording
or by any information storage or retrieval system, without prior written permission from the Alagappa
University, Karaikudi, Tamil Nadu.
Information contained in this book has been published by VIKAS® Publishing House Pvt. Ltd. and has
been obtained by its Authors from sources believed to be reliable and are correct to the best of their
knowledge. However, the Alagappa University, Publisher and its Authors shall in no event be liable for
any errors, omissions or damages arising out of use of this information and specifically disclaim any
implied warranties or merchantability or fitness for any particular use.
Work Order No. AU/DDE/DE1-238/Preparation and Printing of Course Materials/2018 Dated 30.08.2018 Copies - 500
SYLLABI-BOOK MAPPING TABLE
Financial and Management Accounting
Self-Instructional
Material
Meaning, Scope and Usage
of Accounting
BLOCK - I
BASICS OF FINANCIAL AND MANAGEMENT
ACCOUNTING NOTES
1.0 INTRODUCTION
Accounting has rightly been termed as the language of the business. The basic
function of a language is to serve as a means of communication. Accounting
also serves this function. It communicates the result of business operations
to various parties who have some stake in the business, viz., the proprietor,
creditors, investors, Government and other agencies. Though accounting is
generally associated with business but it is not only business which makes use
of accounting. Persons like housewives, Government and other individuals
also make use of accounting. For example, a housewife has to keep a record
of the money received and spent by her during a particular period. She can
record here receipts of money on one page of her “household diary”, while
payments for different items such as milk, food, clothing, house, education,
etc., on some other page or pages of her diary in a chronological order. Such
a record will help her in knowing about:
(i) The sources from which she received cash and the purposes for which
it was utilised.
Self-Instructional
Material 1
Meaning, Scope and Usage (ii) Whether her receipts are more than her payments or vice versa?
of Accounting
(iii) The balance of cash in hand or deficit, if any, at the end of a period.
In case the housewife records her transactions regularly, she can
NOTES collect valuable information about the nature of her receipts and payments.
For example, she can find out the total amount spent by her during a period
(say, a year) on different items, say milk, food, education, entertainment,
etc. Similarly, she can find the sources of her receipts such as salary of her
husband, rent from property, cash gifts from her near relations, etc. Thus, at
the end of a period (say, a year) she can see for herself about her financial
position, i.e., what she owns and what she owes. This will help her in planning
her future income and expenses (or making out a budget) to a great extent.
The need for accounting is all the more greater for a person who
is running a business. He knows: (i) What he owns? (ii) What he owes?
(iii) Whether he has earned a profit or suffered a loss on account of running
a business? (iv) What is his financial position, i.e., whether he will be in a
position to meet all his commitments in the near future or he is in the process
of becoming a bankrupt.
1.1 OBJECTIVES
After going through this unit, you will be able to:
• Appreciate the need of accounting
• Explain the meaning of accounting
• Discuss accounting for historical and managerial function
• Identify the objectives of accounting
• Explain the relationship of accounting with other disciplines
• Explain the different types of accounting
• Differentiate between management accounting and financial accounting
Self-Instructional
2 Material
Accounting is primarily concerned with designing the systems for Meaning, Scope and Usage
of Accounting
recording, classifying and summarizing the recorded data and interpreting
them for internal and external endusers. Accountants often direct and
review the work of the book-keepers. The larger the firm, the greater is the
responsibility of the accountant. The work of an accountant in the beginning NOTES
may include some book-keeping. An accountant is required to have a much
higher level of knowledge, conceptual understanding and analytical skill
than what is required for a book-keeper.
Difference between Book-keeping and Accounting
The difference between book-keeping and accounting can be well understood
with the help of the following example:
If A sells goods to B on credit, the only fundamental principle involved
is of “dual aspect” and to give a true picture of the transaction, both the
aspects must be considered. On the one hand, A has lost one asset, i.e., good
and on the other hand, he has obtained another asset, i.e., a “debt due from
B”. The book-keeper should debit B’s account in A’s books and credit the
sales account. However, if at the end of a year, A has got some stock of goods
with him, they should be properly valued in order to ascertain the true profit
of the business. The principle to be followed in valuing the stock and many
adjustment that will have to be made before the books of account can be
closed and true profit or loss can be ascertained, are all matters of accounting.
Thus, book-keeping is more of a routine work and a book-keeper, if instructed
properly, can record the routine transactions quite efficiently even if he does
not know much of accounting principles.
Is Accounting a ‘Science’ or an ‘Art’?
Any organized knowledge based on certain basic principles is a ‘science’.
Accounting is also a science. It is a organized knowledge based on scientific
principles which have been developed as result of study and experience. Of
course, accounting cannot be termed as a “perfect science” like Physics or
Chemistry where experiments can be carried and perfect conclusions can be
drawn. It is a social science depending much on human behaviour and other
social and economic factors. Thus, perfect conclusions cannot be drawn.
Some people, therefore, though not very correctly, do not take accounting
as a science.
Art is the technique which helps us in achieving our desired objective.
Accounting is definitely an art. The American Institute of Certified Public
Accountants also defines accounting as “the art of recording, classifying and
summarizing the financial transactions”. Accounting helps in achieving our
desired objective of maintaining proper accounts, i.e., to know the profitability
and the financial position of the business, by maintaining proper accounts.
Self-Instructional
Material 3
Meaning, Scope and Usage Accounting and Accountancy
of Accounting
Honestly speaking, in today’s world, there is not much difference between
accounting and accountancy. The terms have become pretty much
NOTES interchangeable. Accounting is traditionally one of the three principles
of accountancy (the others were bookkeeping and auditing), which was
the application of reading and maintaining the financial records of said
company. Traditionally, accountancy is the parent term for the entire field
and accounting was a specific duty of an accountant. Accountancy is referred
to as the actual process of communicating information about the financial
state of a company to its shareholders, usually in the form of financial
statements, which show the assets and resources under the company’s control
in monetary terms.
1.2.1 Definitions and Functions of Accounting
From the above discussion it is clear that over a period of time the concept of
accounting and the role of accountant has undergone a revolutionary change.
The change is particularly noticeable during the last fifty years.
Earlier, accounting was considered simply as a process of recording
business transactions and the role of accountant as that of record-keeper.
However, accounting is now considered to be a tool of management providing
vital information concerning the organisation’s future. Accounting today is
thus more of an information system rather than a mere recording system.
It will be useful here to give in a chronological order the definitions
given by some of the well established accounting bodies which show how
the concept of accounting has undergone a change over a period of time.
In 1941, the American Institute of Certified Public Accountants
(AICPA) defined accounting as follows:
“Accounting is the art of recording, classifying and summarizing in
significant manner and in terms of money, transactions and events which are,
in part, at least of a financial character and interpreting the results thereof”.
In 1966, the American Accounting Association (AAA) defined
accounting as follows:
“Accounting is the process of identifying, measuring and communicating
economic information to permit informed judgements and decisions by users
of the information”.
In 1970, the Accounting Principles Board (APB) of the American
Institute of Certified Public Accountants (AICPA) enumerated the functions
of accounting as follows:
“The function of accounting is to provide quantitative information,
primarily of financial nature, about economic entities, that is needed to be
useful in making economic decisions”.
Self-Instructional
4 Material
Thus, accounting may be defined as the process of recording, Meaning, Scope and Usage
of Accounting
classifying, summarizing, analysing and interpreting the financial transactions
and communicating the results thereof to the persons interested in such
information.
NOTES
An analysis of the definition brings out the following functions of
accounting:
Recording: This is the basic function of accounting. It is essentially
1.
concerned with not only ensuring that all business transactions of
financial character are, in fact, recorded but also that they are recorded
in an orderly manner. Recording is done in the book “Journal”. This
book may be further sub-divided into various subsidiary books such as
Cash Journal (for recording cash transactions), Purchases Journal (for
recording credit purchase of goods), Sales Journal (for recording credit
sales of goods), etc. The number of subsidiary books to be maintained
will be according to the nature and size of the business.
Classifying: Classification is concerned with the systematic analysis
2.
of the recorded data, with a view to group transactions or entries of
one nature at one place. The work of classification is done in the book
termed as “Ledger”. This book contains on different pages individual
account heads under which all financial transactions of similar nature
are collected. For example, there may be separate account heads for
Travelling Expenses, Printing and Stationery, Advertising etc. All
expenses under these heads after being recorded in the Journal will be
classified under separate heads in the Ledger. This will help in finding
out the total expenditure incurred under each of the above heads.
Summarizing: This involves presenting the classified data in a
3.
manner which is understandable and useful to the internal as well as
external end-users of accounting statements. This process leads to the
preparation of the following statements:
(i) Trial Balance (ii) Income Statement (iii) Balance Sheet.
4. Dealing with Financial Transactions: Accounting records only those
transactions and events in terms of money which are of a financial
character. Transactions which are not of a financial character are not
recorded in the books of account. For example, if a company has got
a team of dedicated and trusted employees, it is of great use to the
business but since it is not of a financial character and capable of being
expressed in terms of money, it will not be recorded in the books of
the business.
Analysing and Interpreting: The recorded financial data is analysed
5.
and interpreted in a manner that the end-users can make a meaningful
judgement about the financial condition and profitability of the business
Self-Instructional
Material 5
Meaning, Scope and Usage operations. The data is also used for preparing the future plan and
of Accounting
framing of policies for executing such plans.
A distinction here can be made between the two terms—‘Analysis’ and
‘Interpretation’. The term ‘Analysis’ means methodical classification
NOTES
of the data given in the financial statements. The figures given in the
financial statements will not help one unless they are put in a simplified
form. For example, all items relating to ‘Current Assets’ are put at one
place while all items relating to ‘Current Liabilities’ are put at another
place. The term ‘Interpretation’ means explaining the meaning and
significance of the data so simplified.
However, both ‘Analysis’ and ‘Interpretation’ are complementary to
each other. Interpretation requires Analysis, while Analysis is useless
without Interpretation.
Communicating: The accounting information after being meaningfully
6.
analysed and interpreted has to be communicated in a proper form and
manner to the proper person. This is done through preparation and
distribution of accounting reports, which include besides the usual
income statement and the balance sheet, additional information in the
form of accounting ratios, graphs, diagrams, funds flow statements,
cash flow statements etc. The initiative, imagination and innovative
ability of the accountant are put to test in this process.
1.2.2 Accounting for Historical and Managerial Functions
Historical functioning of accounting involves keeping the accurate records
of all the past transactions made in the business. This type of functioning of
accounting includes:
· Recording the financial transactions and maintain a journal to keep
them all.
· It is important to classify and separate the records and the ledger.
· Preparation of brief summary takes place for the quick reviews.
· This type of accounting gives the net result other than just keeping the
records.
· Preparation of balance sheet takes place to determine the financial
position of the business.
· The analyzed data and records are then used for the other purposes.
· The last step is to communicate the obtained financial information to
the interested sectors, for instance, owners, suppliers, government,
researchers etc.
Self-Instructional
6 Material
Managerial Functions Meaning, Scope and Usage
of Accounting
In an organization, the management committee looks for all kind of the
decision making. To ensure that the decisions are smooth and beneficial for
everyone, they do an evaluation of the past records provided by accounting. NOTES
These are managerial functions. The five managerial functions of accounting
are:
· Formation of plans in addition to controlling the financial policies.
· Besides that, a budget is prepared to estimate the total expenditure for
the future activities.
· Also, cost control is made possible by comparing the cost with the
efficiency of the work.
· The accounting also provides the necessary information during the
evaluation of employee’s performance.
· To check for frauds and errors is what the workability of the whole
procedure depends.
1.2.3 Various Users of Accounting Information
Accounting is of primary importance to the proprietors and the managers.
However, other persons such as creditors, prospective investors, employees,
etc., are also interested in the accounting information.
Proprietors: A business is done with the objective of making profit.
1.
Its profitability and financial soundness are, therefore, matters of prime
importance to the proprietors who have invested their money in the
business.
Managers: In a sole proprietary business, usually the proprietor is the
2.
manager. In case of a partnership business either some or all the partners
participate in the management of the business. They, therefore, act
both as managers as well as owners. In case of joint stock companies,
the relationship between ownership and management becomes all the
more remote. In most cases the shareholders act merely as rentiers of
capital and the management of the company passes into the hands of
professional managers. The accounting disclosures greatly help them
in knowing about what has happened and what should be done to
improve the profitability and financial position of the enterprise in the
period to come.
Creditors: Creditors are the persons who have extended credit to the
3.
company. They are also interested in the financial statements because
these will help them in ascertaining whether the enterprise will be in a
position to meet its commitment towards them both regarding payment
of interest and principal.
Self-Instructional
Material 7
Meaning, Scope and Usage Prospective Investors: A person who is contemplating an investment in
4.
of Accounting
a business will like to know about its profitability and financial position.
A study of the financial statements will help him in this respect.
NOTES Government: The Government is interested in the financial statements
5.
of business enterprise on account of taxation, labour and corporate
laws. If necessary, the Government may ask its officials to examine
the accounting records of a business.
Employees: The employees are interested in the financial statements
6.
on account of various profit sharing and bonus schemes. Their interest
may further increase in case they purchase shares of the companies in
which they are employed.
7. Citizen: An ordinary citizen may be interested in the accounting records
of the institutions with which he comes in contact in his daily life,
e.g., bank, temple, public utilities such as gas, transport and electricity
companies. In a broader sense, he is also interested in the accounts of
a government company, a public utility concern etc., as a voter and a
tax-payer.
1.8 SUMMARY
• Accounting has rightly been termed as the language of the business. The
basic function of a language is to serve as a means of communication.
Accounting also serves this function. It communicates the result of
business operations to various parties who have some stake in the
business, viz., the proprietor, creditors, investors, Government and
other agencies.
• Some people take book-keeping and accounting as synonymous
terms, but they are different from each other. Book-keeping is mainly
concerned with recording of financial data relating to the business
operations in a significant and orderly manner.
• Any organized knowledge based on certain basic principles is a
‘science’. Accounting is also a science. It is an organized knowledge
based on scientific principles which have been developed as result of
study and experience.
• Accounting is of primary importance to the proprietors and the
managers. However, other persons such as creditors, prospective
investors, employees, etc., are also interested in the accounting
information.
• Accounting is closely related with other disciplines. It is, therefore,
necessary for the accountant to have a working knowledge of these
disciplines for effective performance of his job.
• The Accountants are the persons who practice the art of accounting.
The Accounting System and the Accountants who maintain it, provide
useful services to the Society. The Accountants can broadly be classified
into two categories.
1. Accountants in Public Practice
2. Accountants in Employment.
• In order to satisfy the needs of different people interested in the
accounting information, different branches of accounting have
Self-Instructional
Material 17
Meaning, Scope and Usage developed. They can broadly be classified into two categories:
of Accounting
Financial accounting and management accounting..
• Financial accounting and management accounting are closely
NOTES interrelated since management accounting is to a large extent
rearrangement of the data provided by financial accounting. Moreover,
all accounting is financial in the sense that all accounting systems are
in monetary terms and management is responsible for the contents of
the financial accounting statements.
Self-Instructional
18 Material
Meaning, Scope and Usage
1.11 FURTHER READINGS of Accounting
Self-Instructional
Material 19
Accounting Concepts,
Accounting Standards and
Accounting Books UNIT 2 ACCOUNTING CONCEPTS,
ACCOUNTING STANDARDS
NOTES
AND ACCOUNTING BOOKS
Structure
2.0 Introduction
2.1 Objectives
2.2 Meaning and Types of Accounting Concepts
2.3 Accounting Conventions and Their Types
2.4 Accounting Principles
2.5 Accounting Standards
2.5.1 Introduction to Accounting Standards Issued by ICAI
2.6 Systems of Book-Keeping and Accounting
2.6.1 Accounting Equation
2.6.2 Double Entry System and Single Entry System
2.7 Accounting Books: Journals and Ledgers
2.7.1 Journals
2.7.2 Ledger
2.8 Subsidiary Books
2.9 Answers to Check Your Progress Questions
2.10 Summary
2.11 Key Words
2.12 Self Assessment Questions and Exercises
2.13 Further Readings
2.0 INTRODUCTION
It has already been stated in Unit 1 that accounting is the language of business
through which normally a business house communicates with the outside
world. In order to make this language intelligible and commonly understood
by all, it is necessary that it should be based on certain uniform scientifically
laid down standards. These standards are termed as accounting principles.
Accounting principles1 may be defined as those rules of action adopted
by the accountants universally while recording accounting transaction. “They
are a body of doctrines commonly associated with the theory and procedures
of accounting, serving as an explanation of current practices and as a guide
for selection of conventions or procedures where alternatives exist”. These
principles can be classified into two categories: (i) Accounting Concepts2
and (ii) Accounting Conventions
1
. also termed as ‘Accounting Standards’.
2
. also termed as ‘Accounting Postulates’.
Self-Instructional
20 Material
In this unit, we will discuss not only allowing concepts and conventions Accounting Concepts,
Accounting Standards and
but also accounting standards, systems of book keeping and different Accounting Books
accounting books.
Self-Instructional
Material 21
Accounting Concepts, It should be noted that the ‘going concern concept’ does not imply
Accounting Standards and
Accounting Books permanent continuance of the enterprise. It rather presumes that the enterprise
will continue in operation long enough to charge against income, the cost of
fixed assets over their useful lives, to amortise over appropriate period other
NOTES costs which have been deferred under the actual or matching concept, to pay
liabilities when they become due and to meet the contractual commitments.
Moreover, the concept applies to the business as a whole. When an enterprise
liquidates a branch or one segment of its operations, the ability of the
enterprise to continue as a going concern is normally not impaired.
The enterprise will not be considered as a going concern when it has
gone into liquidation or it has become insolvent. Of course, the receiver or
the liquidator may endeavour to carry on business operations for some period
pending arrangement with the creditors or the final buyer for the sale of the
business as a going concern, the going concern status of the concern will
stand terminated from the date of his appointment or will be at least regarded
as suspended, pending the results of his efforts.
3. Money Measurement Concept: Accounting records only monetary
transactions. Events or transactions which cannot be expressed in money do
not find place in the books of accounts though they may be very useful for the
business. For example, if a business has got a team of dedicated and trusted
employees, it is definitely an asset to the business but since their monetary
measurement is not possible, they are not shown in the books of the business.
Measurement of business event in money helps in understanding
the state of affairs of the business in a much better way. For example, if a
business owns `10,000 of cash, 600 kg of raw materials, two trucks, 1,000
square feet of building space etc., these amounts cannot be added together
to produce a meaningful total of what the business owns. However, if these
items are expressed in monetary terms such as `10,000 of cash, `12,000 of
raw materials, `2,00,000 of trucks and `50,000 of building, all such items
can be added and much more intelligible and precise estimate about the assets
of the business will be available.
4. Cost Concept: The concept is closely related to going concern concept.
According to this concept:
(a) an asset is ordinarily entered in the accounting records at the price
paid to acquire it, and
(b) this cost is the basis for all subsequent accounting for the assets.
If a business buys a plot of land for `50,000, the asset would be
recorded in the books at `50,000 even if its market value at that time happens
to be `60,000. In case a year later the market value of this assets comes
down to `40,000, it will ordinarily continue to be shown at `50,000 and not
at `40,000.
Self-Instructional
22 Material
The cost concept does not mean that the asset will always be shown at Accounting Concepts,
Accounting Standards and
cost. It has also been stated above that cost becomes the basis for all future Accounting Books
accounting for the asset. It means that asset is recorded at cost at the time of
its purchase, but it may systematically be reduced in its value by charging
depreciation. NOTES
Cost concept has the advantage of bringing objectivity in the
preparation and presentation of financial statements. In the absence of this
concept the figures shown in the accounting records would have depended
on the subjective views of a person. However, on account of continued
inflationary tendencies the preparation of financial statements on the basis
of historical costs, has become largely irrelevant for judging the financial
position of the business. This is the reason for the growing importance of
inflation accounting.
5. Dual Aspect Concept: This is the basic concept of accounting. According
to this concept every business transaction has a dual effect. For example,
if A starts a business with a capital of `10,000, there are two aspects of the
transaction. On the one hand, the business has asset of `10,000 while on the
other hand the business has to pay to the proprietor a sum of `10,000 which
is taken as proprietor’s capital. This expression can be shown in the form of
following equation:
Capital (Equities) = Cash (Assets)
10,000 = 10,000
The term ‘assets’ denotes the resources owned by a business while the
term “Equities” denotes the claims of various parties against the assets. As
we have learned before, equities are of two types. They are: owners’ equity
and outsiders’ equity. Owners’ equity (or capital) is the claim of owners
against the assets of the business while outsiders’ equity (for liabilities) is the
claim of outside parties, such as creditors, debenture-holders etc., against the
assets of the business. Since all assets of the business are claimed by some
one (either owners or outsiders), the total of assets will be equal to total of
liabilities, Thus:
Equities = Assets
or Liabilities + Capital = Assets
In the example given above, if the business purchases furniture worth
`5,000 out of the money provided by A, the situation will be as follows:
Equities = Assets
Capital `10,000 = Cash `5,000 + Furniture `5,000
Subsequently, if the business borrows `30,000 from a bank, the new
position would be as follows:
Equities = Assets
Self-Instructional
Material 23
Accounting Concepts, Capital `10,000 + Bank Loan `30,000 = Cash `35,000 + Furniture `5,000
Accounting Standards and
Accounting Books The term ‘accounting equation’ is also used to denote the relationship
of equities to assets. The equation can be technically stated as “for each debit,
there is an equivalent credit”. As a matter of fact the entire system of double
NOTES
entry book-keeping is based on this concept.
6. Accounting Period Concept: According to this concept, the life of the
business is divided into appropriate segments for studying the results shown
by the business after each segment. This is because though the life of the
business is considered to be indefinite (according to going concern concept),
the measurement of income and studying the financial position of the business
after a very long period would not be helpful in taking proper corrective
steps at the appropriate time. It is, therefore, absolutely necessary that after
each segment or time interval the businessman must ‘stop’ and ‘see back’,
how things are going. In accounting such a segment or time interval is called
‘accounting period’. It is usually of a year.
At the end of each accounting period an Income Statement and a
Balance Sheet are prepared. The Income Statement discloses the profit or
loss made by the business during the accounting period while the Balance
Sheet depicts the financial position of the business as on the last day of the
accounting period. While preparing these statements a proper distinction has
to be made between capital and revenue expenditure.
7. Periodic Matching of Costs and Revenue Concept: This is based on the
accounting period concept. The paramount objective of running a business is
to earn profit. In order to ascertain the profit made by the business during a
period, it is necessary that ‘revenues’ of the period should be matched with
the costs (expenses) of the period. The term matching, means appropriate
association of related revenues and expenses. In other words, income made by
the business during a period can be measured only when the revenue earned
during a period is compared with the expenditure incurred for earning that
revenue. The question when the payment was received or made is ‘irrelevant’.
For example, if a salesman is paid commission in January, 2011, for sales
made by him in December, 2010, the commission paid to the salesman in
January, 2011 should be taken as the cost for sales made by him in December,
2010. This means that revenues of December, 2010 (i.e., sales) should be
matched with the costs incurred for earning that revenue (i.e., salesman’s
commission) in December, 2010 (though paid in January, 2011). On account
of this concept, adjustments are made for all outstanding expenses, accrued
incomes, prepaid expenses and unearned incomes, etc., while preparing the
final accounts at the end of the accounting period.
8. Realisation Concept: According to this concept revenue is recognised
when a sale is made. Sale is considered to be made at the point when the
property in goods passes to the buyer and he becomes legally liable to pay.
Self-Instructional This can be well understood with the help of the following example:
24 Material
A places an order with B for supply of certain goods yet to be Accounting Concepts,
Accounting Standards and
manufactured. On receipt of order, B purchases raw materials, employs Accounting Books
workers, produces the goods and delivers them to A. A makes payment on
receipt of goods. In this case the sale will be presumed to have been made
not at the time of receipt of the order for the goods but at the time when NOTES
goods are delivered to A.
However, there are certain exceptions to this concept:
(i) In case of hire purchase the ownership of the goods passes to the
buyer only when the last instalment is paid, but sales are presumed to
have been made to the extent of instalments received and instalments
outstanding (i.e. instalments due but not received).
(ii) In case of contracts accounts, though the contractor is liable to pay only
when the whole contract is completed as per terms of the contract, the
profit is calculated on the basis of work certified year after year as per
certain accepted accounting norms.
Self-Instructional
32 Material
IAS 27. Consolidated and Separate Financial Statements. Accounting Concepts,
Accounting Standards and
IAS 28. Investments in Associates. Accounting Books
Self-Instructional
Material 37
Accounting Concepts, 4. Scope of Accounting Standards
Accounting Standards and
Accounting Books
(1) Efforts will be made to issue Accounting Standards which are in
conformity with the provisions of the applicable laws, customs, usages
NOTES and business environment in India. However, if a particular Accounting
Standard is found to be not in conformity with law, the provisions of
the said law will prevail and the financial statements should be prepared
in conformity with such law.
(2) The Accounting Standards by their very nature cannot and do not
override the local regulations which govern the preparation and
presentation of financial statements in the country. However, the
ICAI will determine the extent of disclosure to be made in financial
statements and the auditor’s report thereon. Such disclosure may be
by way of appropriate notes explaining the treatment of particular
items. Such explanatory notes will be only in the nature of clarification
and therefore need not be treated as adverse comments on the related
financial statements.
(3) The Accounting Standards are intended to apply only to items which are
material. Any limitations with regard to the applicability of a specific
Accounting Standard will be made clear by the ICAI from time to time.
The date from which a particular Standard will come into effect, as well
as the class of enterprises to which it will apply, will also be specified
by the ICAI. However, no standard will have retroactive application
unless otherwise stated.
5. Procedure for Issuing an Accounting Standard
Broadly, the following procedure is adopted for formulating Accounting
Standards:
(1) The ASB determines the broad areas in which Accounting Standards
need to be formulated and the priority in regard to the selection thereof.
(2) In the preparation of Accounting Standards, the ASB will be assisted
by Study Groups constituted to consider specific subjects. In the formation of
Study Groups, provision will be made for wide participation by the members
of the Institute and others.
(3) The draft of the proposed standard will normally include the
following:
(a) Objective of the Standard
(b) Scope of the Standard
(c) Definitions of the terms used in the Standard
(d) Recognition and measurements principles, wherever applicable
(e) Presentation and disclosure requirements.
Self-Instructional
38 Material
(4) The ASB will consider the preliminary draft prepared by the Study Accounting Concepts,
Accounting Standards and
Group and if any revision of the draft is required on the basis of deliberations, Accounting Books
the ASB will make the same or refer the same to the Study Group.
(5) The ASB will circulate the draft of the Accounting Standard to the
NOTES
Council members of the ICAI and the following specified bodies for their
comments:
(i) Department of Company Affairs (DCA)
(ii) Comptroller and Auditor General of India (C&AG)
(iii) Central Board of Direct Taxes (CBDT)
(iv) The Institute of Cost Accountants of India (ICAI)
(v) The Institute of Company Secretaries of India (ICSI)
(vi) Associated Chambers of Commerce and Industry (ASSOCHAM),
Confederation of Indian Industry (CII) and Federation of Indian
Chambers of Commerce and Industry (FICCI)
(vii) Reserve Bank of India (RBI)
(viii) Securities and Exchange Board of India (SEBI)
(ix) Standing Conference of Public Enterprises (SCOPE)
(x) Indian Banks’ Association (IBA)
(xi) Any other body considered relevant by the ASB keeping in view
the nature of the Accounting Standard.
(6) The ASB will hold a meeting with the representatives of specified
bodies to ascertain their views on the draft of the proposed Accounting
Standard. On the basis of comments received and discussion with the
representatives of specified bodies, the ASB will finalise the Exposure Draft
of the proposed Accounting Standard.
(7) The Exposure Draft of the proposed Standard will be issued for
comments by the members of the Institute and the public. The Exposure
Draft will specifically be sent to specified bodies (as listed above), stock
exchanges, and other interest groups, as appropriate.
(8) After taking into consideration the comments received, the draft
of the proposed Standard will be finalised by the ASB and submitted to the
Council of the ICAI.
(9) The Council of the ICAI will consider the final draft of the proposed
Standard, and if found necessary, modify the same in consultation with the
ASB. The Accounting Standard on the relevant subject will then be issued
by the ICAI.
(10) For a substantive revision of an Accounting Standard, the
procedure followed for formulation of a new Accounting Standard, as detailed
above, will be followed.
(11) Subsequent to issuance of an Accounting Standard, some aspect(s)
may require revision which are not substantive in nature. For this purpose, the
Self-Instructional
Material 39
Accounting Concepts, ICAI may make limited revision to an Accounting Standard. The procedure
Accounting Standards and
Accounting Books followed for the limited revision will substantially be the same as that to be
followed for formulation of an Accounting Standard, ensuring that sufficient
opportunity is given to various interest groups and general public to react to
NOTES the proposal for limited revision.
6. Compliance with the Accounting Standards
(1) The Accounting Standards will be mandatory from the respective date(s)
mentioned in the Accounting Standard(s). The mandatory status of an
Accounting Standard implies that while discharging their attest functions,
it will be the duty of the members of the Institute to examine whether
the Accounting Standard is complied within the presentation of financial
statements covered by their audit. In the event of any deviation from the
Accounting Standard, it will be their duty to make adequate disclosures in
their audit reports so that the users of financial statements may be aware of
such deviation.
(2) Ensuring compliance with the Accounting Standards while preparing the
financial statements is the responsibility of the management of the enterprise.
Statutes governing certain enterprises require of the enterprises that the
financial statements should be prepared in compliance with the Accounting
Standards, e.g., the Companies Act, 2013 (section 129), and the Insurance
Regulatory and Development Authority (Preparation of Financial Statements
and Auditor’s Report of Insurance Companies) Regulations, 2000.
(3) Financial Statements cannot be described as complying with the
Accounting Standards unless they comply with all the requirements of each
applicable standard.
Issue of Accounting Standards: In all 32 accounting standards have been
issued out of which 1 has been withdrawn while 3 are only recommendatory.
The applicable of these standards is dependent on the size—Level I/II/III
company. The following table lists out the Accounting Standards and their
applicability.
Accounting Standards
No. Title Mandatory from ac- Applicability level of
counting period begin- enterprise
ning on or after
AS 1 Disclosure of Accounting Policies 1-4-1991 I, II, III
AS 2 (Revised) Valuation of lnventories 1-4-1999 I, II, III
AS 3 (Revised) Cash Flow Statements 1-4-2001 I
AS 4 (Revised) Contingencies and Events occurring 1-4-1995 I, II, III
after Balance Sheet Date
AS 5 (Revised) Net Profit or Loss Prior Period and 1-4-1996 I, II, III
Extraordinary Items and Changes in
Accounting Policies
AS 6 (Revised) Depreciation Accounting withdrawn 1-4-1995 I, II, III
w.e.f. 1st April 2017
Self-Instructional
40 Material
No. Title Mandatory from ac- Applicability level of Accounting Concepts,
counting period begin- enterprise Accounting Standards and
ning on or after
Accounting Books
AS 7 (Revised) Accounting for Construction 1-4-2003 I, II, III
Contracts
AS 8 Accounting for Research and 1-4-1991 Withdrawn NOTES
Developments (withdrawn w.e.f. 1-4-1991 I, II, III
1-4-2003)
AS 9 Revenue Recognition 1-4-1991 I, II, III
AS 10 Property, Plant & Equipment 1-4-1991 I, II, III
(changed from Accounting for Fixed
Assets)
AS 11 (Revised Accounting for the Effect of 1-4-2004 I, II, III
2003) Changes in Foreign Exchange Rates
AS 12 Accounting for Government Grants 1-4-1995 I, II, III
AS 13 Accounting for Investments* 1-4-1995 I, II, III
AS 14 Accounting for Amalgamations* 1-4-1994 I, II, III
AS 15 (Revised Employee Benefits 7-12-2006 I, II, III
2005)
AS 16 Borrowing Costs 1-4-2000 I. II, III
AS 17 Segment Reporting 1-4-2001 II, II, III (with
modifications)
AS 18 Related Party Disclosures 1-4-2001
AS 19 Leases 1-4-2001
AS 20 Earnings Per Share 1-4-2001
AS 21 Consolidated Financial Statements* 1-4-2001
AS 22 Accounting for Taxes on Income 1-4-2001 I, II, III
AS 23 Accounting for Investments in 1-4-2002 I
Associates
AS 24 Discounting Operations 1-4-2004 I
AS 25 Interim Financial Reporting 1-4-2004 I
AS 26 Intangible Assets 1-4-2003 I, II, III
AS 27 Financial Reporting of Interests in
Joint
Ventures 1-4-2002 I. II, III (with
clarifications)
AS 28 Impairment of Assets 1 -4-2004 I, II. III (with
modifications)
AS 29 Provisions, Contingent Liabilities 1-4-2004 I
and Contingent Assets*
AS 30 Financial Instruments: Recognition
and Measurement (recommendatory
w.e.f. 1-4-2009)
AS 31 Financial Instruments: Presentation
(recommendatory w.e.f. 1-4 2009)
AS 32 Financial Instruments: Disclosures
(recommendatory w.e.f. 1-4-2009)
Level I Company: Enterprises, which fall in any one or more of the following
categories, at any time during the accounting period, are classified as Level
I enterprises.
(i) Enterprises whose equity or debt securities are listed whether in India
or outside India.
Self-Instructional
Material 41
Accounting Concepts, (ii) Enterprises, which are in the process of listing their equity or debt
Accounting Standards and
Accounting Books securities as evidenced by the board of directors’ resolution in this
regard.
(iii) Banks including co-operative banks.
NOTES (iv) Financial Institutions
(v) Enterprises carrying on insurance business
(vi) All commercial, industrial and business reporting enterprises,
whose turnover (excluding other income) exceeds ` 50 crore in the
immediately preceding accounting year.
(vii) All commercial, industrial and business reporting enterprises having
borrowings, (including public deposits), in excess of ` 10 crore at
any time during the immediately preceding accounting year.
(viii) Holding and subsidiary enterprises of any one of the above at any
time during the accounting period.
Level II Company: Enterprises, which are, not Level I enterprises but fall
in any one or more of the following categories are classified as Level II
enterprises:
(i) All commercial, industrial and business reporting enterprises, whose
turnover (excluding other income) for the immediately preceding
accounting year exceeds ` 40 lakh, but does not exceed ` 50 crore.
Turnover does not include ‘other income’.
(ii) All commercial, industrial and business reporting enterprises having
borrowing, (including public deposits), in excess of ` one crore but not
in excess of ` 10 crore at any time during the immediately preceding
accounting year.
(iii) Holding and subsidiary enterprises of any one of the above.
Level III Company: Enterprises, which are not covered under Level I and
Level II are considered as Level III enterprises.
Applicability
Level II and Level III enterprises are considered as SMEs.
Level I enterprises are required to comply fully with all the accounting
standards.
No relaxation is given to Level II and Level III enterprises in respect of
recognition and measurement principles. Relaxations are provided with regard
to disclosure requirements. Accordingly, Level II and Level III enterprises are
fully exempted from certain accounting standards, which mainly lay down
disclosure requirements. In respect of certain other accounting standards,
which lay down recognition, measurement and disclosure requirements,
relaxations from certain disclosure requirements have been given.
In the following pages we are giving brief details of Accounting
Standards issued by ICAI.
Self-Instructional
42 Material
Accounting Concepts,
Accounting Standards and
Check Your Progress Accounting Books
Self-Instructional
44 Material
The result of applying the system of double entry system may be Accounting Concepts,
Accounting Standards and
summarised in the form of following rule: Accounting Books
“For every debit there must be equivalent credit and vice versa.”
The rules of Debit and Credit have been explained in the succeeding NOTES
chapter.
Illustration 2.1. Anil had the following transactions. Use accounting equation
to show their effect on his assets, liabilities and capital:
1. Started business with cash ` 5,000
2. Purchased goods on credit 400
3. Purchased goods for cash 100
4. Purchased furniture 50
5. Withdrew for personal use 70
6. Paid rent 20
7. Received Interest 10
8. Sold goods costing `50 on credit for 70
9. Paid to creditors 40
10. Paid for salaries 20
11. Further capital invested 1,000
12. Borrowed from P 1,000
Solution:
Accounting Equation: Assets = Liabilities + Capital
No. Transaction Assets = Liabilities + Capital
` ` `
1. Anil started business with cash `5,000 5,000 = 0 + 5,000
2. Purchased goods on credit for `400 400 = 400 + 0
New Equation 5,400 = 400 + 5,000
3. Purchase goods for cash `100 + 100
– 100 = 0 + 0
New Equation 5,400 = 400 + 5,000
4. Purchased furniture `50 + 50
– 50 = 0 + 0
New Equation 5,400 = 400 + 5,000
5. Withdrew for personal use `70 – 70 = 0 – 70
New Equation 5,330 = 400 + 4,930
6. Paid rent – 20 = 0 + – 20
New Equation 5,310 = 400 + 4,910
7. Received interest `10 + 10 = 0 + 10
New Equation 5,320 = 400 + 4,920
8. Sold goods consisting `50 on credit + 70
for `70
Self-Instructional
Material 45
Accounting Concepts, No. Transaction Assets = Liabilities + Capital
Accounting Standards and
Accounting Books – 50 = 0 + 20
New Equation 5,340 = 400 + 4,940
9. Paid to creditors `40 – 40 = – 40 + 0
NOTES New Equation 5,300 = 360 + 4,940
10. Paid for salaries `20 – 20 = 0 – – 20
New Equation 5,280 = 360 + 4,920
11. Further capital Invested 1,000 = 0 + 1,000
New Equation 6,280 = 360 + 5,920
12. Borrowed from P `1,000 1,000 = 1,000 + 0
New Equation 7,280 = 1,360 + 5,920
Self-Instructional
Material 47
Accounting Concepts,
Accounting Standards and 2.7 ACCOUNTING BOOKS: JOURNALS AND
Accounting Books
LEDGERS
NOTES It has been explained in Chapter 1, that Accounting is the art of recording,
classifying and summarising the financial transactions and interpreting the
results therefore. Thus, accounting cycle involves the following stages:
Recording of transactions: This is done in the book termed as
1.
‘Journal’.
Classifying the transactions: This is done in the book termed as
2.
‘Ledger’.
Summarising the transactions: This includes preparation of the trial
3.
balance, profit and loss account and balance sheet of the business.
Interpreting the results: This involves computation of various
4.
accounting ratios, etc., to know about the liquidity, solvency and
profitability of business. The recording of transactions in the Journal
is being explained in this chapter.
In this section, you will learn about journals and ledgers.
2.7.1 Journals
The Journal records all daily transactions of a business into the order in
which they occur. A Journal may, therefore, be defined as a book containing
a chronological record of transactions. It is the book in which the transactions
are recorded first of all under the double entry system. Thus, Journal is the
book of original record. A Journal does not replace but precedes the Ledger.
The process of recording transaction in a Journal, is termed as Journalising.
A proforma of journal is given as:
JOURNAL
Date: The date on which the transaction was entered is recorded here.
1.
Particulars: The two aspects of transaction are recorded in this
2.
column, i.e., the details regarding accounts which have to be debited
and credited.
L.F.: It means Ledger Folio. The transactions entered in the Journal
3.
are later on posted to the ledger. The relevant ledger folio is entered
here. Procedure regarding posting the transactions in the Ledger has
been explained in the next unit.
Debit: In this column, the amount to be debited is entered.
4.
Credit: In this column, the amount to be credited is shown.
5.
Self-Instructional
48 Material
Rules of Debit and Credit Accounting Concepts,
Accounting Standards and
Accounting Books
The transactions in the Journal are recorded on the basis of the rules of debit
and credit. For this purpose business transactions have been classified into
three categories: NOTES
(i) Transactions relating to persons.
(ii) Transactions relating to properties and assets.
(iii) Transactions relating to incomes and expenses.
On this basis, it becomes necessary for the business to keep an account of:
(i) Each person with whom it deals.
(ii) Each property or asset which the business owns.
(iii) Each item of income or expense.
The accounts falling under the first heading are called as ‘Personal
Accounts’. The accounts falling under the second heading are termed as
‘Real Accounts’. The accounts falling under the third heading are termed as
‘Nominal Accounts’. The classification of the accounts, as explained above,
can be put in the form of the following chart:
Each of the above categories of accounts and the relevant rule for ‘debit
and credit’ have been explained in detail in the following pages:
Personal accounts: Personal accounts include the accounts of persons
with whom the business deals. These accounts can be classified into the three
categories.
1. Natural Personal Accounts: The term ‘Natural Persons’ means
persons who are creation of God. For example, Mohan’s Account, Sohan’s
Account, Abha’s Account etc.
2. Artificial Personal Accounts: These accounts include accounts of
corporate bodies or institutions which are recognised as persons in business
dealings. For example, the account of a Limited Company, the account of
a Co-operative Society, the account of a Club, the account of Government,
the account of an Insurance Company etc.
3. Representative Personal Accounts: These are accounts which
represent a certain person or group of persons. For example, if the rent is
Self-Instructional
Material 49
Accounting Concepts, due to the landlord, an outstanding rent account will be opened in the books.
Accounting Standards and
Accounting Books Similarly, for salaries due to the employees (not paid), an outstanding salaries
account will be opened. The outstanding rent account represents the account
of the landlord to whom the rent is to be paid while the outstanding salaries
NOTES account represents the accounts of the persons to whom the salaries have to
be paid. All such accounts are, therefore, termed as ‘Representative Personal
Accounts’.
The rule is:
· Debit the Receiver
· Credit the Giver
For example, if cash has been paid to Ram, the account of Ram will
have to be debited. Similarly, if cash has been received from Keshav, the
account of Keshav will have to be credited.
Real accounts: Real accounts may be of the following types:
1. Tangible real accounts: Tangible Real Accounts are those which
relate to such things which can be touched, felt, measured etc. Examples of
such accounts are cash account, building account, furniture account, stock
account, etc. It should be noted that bank account is a personal account;
since it represents the account of the banking company—an artificial person.
2. Intangible real accounts: These accounts represent such things
which cannot be touched. Of course, they can be measured in terms of
money. For example, patents account, goodwill account, etc.
The rule is:
· Debit What Comes In
· Credit What Goes Out
For example, if building has been purchased for cash, building account
should be debited (since it is coming into the business) while cash account
should be credited (since cash is going out of the business). Similarly when
furniture in purchased for cash, furniture account should be debited while
the cash account should be credited.
Nominal accounts: These accounts are opened in the books to simply explain
the nature of the transactions. They do not really exist. For example, in a
business, salary is paid to the manager, rent is paid to the landlord, commission
is paid to the salesman—cash goes out of the business and it is something
real; while salary, rent or commission as such do not exist. The accounts of
these items are opened simply to explain how the cash has been spent. In the
absence of such information, it may be difficult for the person concerned to
explain how the cash at his disposal was utilised.
Nominal Accounts include accounts of all expenses, losses, incomes
and gains. The examples of such accounts are rent, rates lighting, insurance,
Self-Instructional dividends, loss by fire, etc.
50 Material
The rule is: Accounting Concepts,
Accounting Standards and
· Debit All Expenses and Losses Accounting Books
Illustration 2.2. From the following transactions find out the nature of
account and also state which account should be debited and which account
should be credited.
(a) Rent paid. (b) Salaries paid.
(c) Interest received. (d) Dividends received.
(e) Furniture purchased for cash. (f) Machinery sold.
(g) Outstanding for salaries. (h) Telephone charges paid.
(i) Paid to Suresh. (j) Received from Mohan (the proprietor).
(k) Lighting.
Solution:
Transaction Accounts involved Nature of Accounts Debit/Credit
(a) Rent paid Rent A/c Nominal A/c Debit
Cash A/c Real A/c Credit
(b) Salaries paid Salaries A/c Nominal A/c Debit
Cash A/c Real A/c Credit
(c) Interest received Cash A/c Real A/c Debit
Interest A/c Nominal A/c Credit
(d) Dividends received Cash A/c Real A/c Debit
Interest A/c Nominal A/c Credit
(e) Furniture purchased Furniture A/c Real A/c Debit
Cash A/c Real A/c Credit
(f) Machinery sold Cash A/c Real A/c Debit
Interest A/c Real A/c Credit
(g) Outstanding for salaries Salaries A/c Nominal A/c Debit
Outstanding Personal A/c Credit
Salaries A/c
(h) Telephone charges paid Telephone Charges A/c Nominal A/c Debit
Cash A/c Real A/c Credit
(i) Paid to Suresh Suresh Personal A/c Debit
Cash A/c Real A/c Credit
Self-Instructional
Material 51
Accounting Concepts, (j) Received from Mohan Cash A/c Real A/c Debit
Accounting Standards and (the proprietor)
Accounting Books
Capital A/c Personal A/c Credit
(k) Lighting Lighting A/c Nominal A/c Debit
Cash A/c Real A/c Credit
NOTES
The journalising of the various transactions is explained now with the
help of the following illustration:
Illustration 2.3. Ram starts a business with capital of `20,000 on January
1, 2011.
In this case there are two accounts involved. They are:
(i) The account of Ram (ii) Cash Account
Solution: 1. Ram is natural person and, therefore, his account is a Personal
Account. Cash Account is a tangible asset and, therefore, it is a Real Account.
As per the rules of Debit and Credit, applicable to Personal Accounts, Ram is
the giver and, therefore, his account, i.e., Capital Account should be credited.
Cash is coming in the business and, therefore, as per the rules applicable to
Real Accounts, it should be debited. The transaction will now be entered in
the Journal as follows:
JOURNAL
Date Particulars L.F. Debit Credit
` `
2011
Jan. 1 Cash Account Dr. 20,000
To Capital Account 20,000
(Being commencement of business)
Self-Instructional
Material 53
Accounting Concepts, The above classification of Goods Account can be shown in the form
Accounting Standards and
Accounting Books of the following chart:
GOODS ACCOUNT
NOTES
Self-Instructional
54 Material
Sl. No. Particulars L.F. Debit Credit Accounting Concepts,
Accounting Standards and
` `
Accounting Books
2. Cash A/c Dr. 800
Discount A/c Dr. 50
To Suresh 850
NOTES
(Being cash received from Suresh `800 and
discount allowed `50)
3. Cash A/c Dr. 2,000
Land A/c Dr. 4,000
Furniture A/c Dr. 1,000
Stock A/c Dr. 2,000
To Creditors 1,000
To Bank Overdraft 2,000
To Capital A/c 6,000
(Being commencement of business by Mohan
by taking over a running business)
Notes:
1. The total of payment due to Ram was `1,050. A payment of `1,000 has been made to him and
he allowed a discount of `50. This means by paying `1,000, a full credit for `1,050 has been
obtained. The account of Ram is a Personal Account, and therefore, it has been debited as he
is the receiver. The cash has gone out of the business and, therefore, Cash Account being a
Real Account, has been credited. Discount Account is a Nominal Account; getting discount
is a gain to the business and, therefore, it has been credited.
2. Suresh was to pay sum of `850. He paid `800 and he was allowed a discount of `50. It means
by paying `800 only, Suresh could get a full credit of `850. The Cash Account is a Real Account
and, therefore, it has been debited since cash is coming in. Discount Account is a Nominal
Account; it has been debited since it is a loss to the business. Suresh is the giver. His account
being a Personal Account, it has been credited by `850.
3. It is not necessary that a person should start business only with cash. He may bring the assets
into the business or he may purchase a running business. Mohan in the present case has
purchased the assets of some other business. The net assets (i.e. assets–liabilities taken over)
will be the capital of Mohan. The business is getting various assets and, therefore, the assets
accounts have been debited. The business creates certain liabilities in the form of creditors,
bank overdraft, and, therefore, these accounts have been credited. Mohan’s Account, i.e., his
Capital Account has been credited by the balance since it represents the capital brought in
by him.
Opening Entry
In case of a running business, the assets and liabilities appearing in the
previous year’s balance sheet will have to be brought forward to the current
year. This is done by means of a journal entry which is termed as “Opening
Entry”. All Assets Accounts are debited while all Liabilities Accounts are
credited. The excess of assets over liabilities is the proprietor’s capital and
is credited to his Capital Account. This will be clear with the help of the
following illustration:
Illustration 2.5. Pass the Opening Entry on January 1, 2016 on the basis of
the following information taken from the business of Mr. Sunil:
Self-Instructional
Material 55
Accounting Concepts, `
Accounting Standards and
Accounting Books (i) Cash in Hand 2,000
(ii) Sundry Debtors 6,000
NOTES (iii) Stock of Goods 4,000
(iv) Plant 5,000
(v) Land and Buildings 10,000
(vi) Sundry Creditors 10,000
Solution:
JOURNAL
Date Particulars L.F. ` `
2016 Cash A/c Dr. 2,000
Jan.1 Sundry Debtors A/c Dr. 6,000
Stock A/c Dr. 4,000
Plant A/c Dr. 5,000
Land & Buildings A/c Dr. 10,000
To Sundry Creditors 10,000
To Capital A/c (balancing figure) 17,000
(Being balances brought forward from the last year)
27,000 27,000
2.7.2 Ledger
It has already been explained in the previous unit that accounting involves
recording, classifying and summarising the financial transactions. Recording
is done in the Journal. This has already been explained in the preceding
Self-Instructional
58 Material
chapter. Classifying of the recorded transactions is done in the Ledger. This Accounting Concepts,
Accounting Standards and
is being explained in the present section. Accounting Books
Ledger is a book which contains various accounts. In other words,
Ledger is a set of accounts. It contains all accounts of the business enterprise
NOTES
whether Real, Nominal or Personal. It may be kept in any of the following
two forms:
(i) Bound Ledger (ii) Loose-leaf Ledger
It is common to keep the Ledger in the form of loose-leaf cards these
days. This helps in posting transactions particularly when mechanised system
of accounting is used.
Posting
The term “Posting” means transferring the debit and credit items from the
Journal to their respective accounts in the Ledger. It should be noted that the
exact names of accounts used in the Journal should be carried to the Ledger.
For example, if in the Journal, Expenses Account has been debited, it would
not be correct to debit the Office Expenses Account in the Ledger. Though,
in the Journal, it might have been indicated clearly in the narration that it is
an item of office expenses the correct course would have been to record the
amount to the Office Expenses Account in the Journal as well as in the Ledger.
Posting may be done at any time. However, it should be completed
before the financial statements are prepared. It is advisable to keep the more
active accounts posted to date. The examples of such accounts are the cash
account, personal accounts of various parties etc.
The posting may be done by the book-keeper from the Journal to the
Ledger by any of the following methods:
(i) He may take a particular side first. For example, he may take the debits
first and make the complete postings of all debits from the Journal to
the Ledger.
(ii) He may take a particular account and post all debits and credits relating
to that account appearing on one particular page of the Journal. He
may then take some other accounts and follow the same procedure.
(iii) He may complete postings of each journal entry before proceeding to
the next journal entry.
It is advisable to follow the last method. One should post each debit
and credit item as it appears in the Journal.
The Ledger Folio (L.F.) column in the Journal is used at the time when
debits and credits are posted to the Ledger. The page number of the Ledger
on which the posting has been done is mentioned in the L.F. column of the
Journal. Similarly, a folio column in the Ledger can also be kept where the
Self-Instructional
Material 59
Accounting Concepts, page from which posting has been done from the Journal may be mentioned.
Accounting Standards and
Accounting Books Thus, there are cross references in both the Journal and the Ledger.
A proper index should be maintained in the Ledger giving the names
of the accounts and the page numbers.
NOTES
Relationship between Journal and Ledger
Both Journal and Ledger are the most important books used under Double
Entry System of book-keeping. Their relationship can be expressed as follows:
(i) The transactions are recorded first of all in the Journal and then they are
posted to the Ledger. Thus, the Journal is the book of first or original
entry, while the Ledger is the book of second entry.
(ii) Journal records transactions in a chronological order, while the Ledger
records transactions in an analytical order.
(iii) Journal is more reliable as compared to the Ledger since it is the book
in which the entry is passed first of all.
(iv) The process of recording transactions is termed as “Journalising”
while the process of recording transactions in the Ledger is called as
“Posting”.
Rules Regarding Posting
The following rules should be observed while posting transactions in the
Ledger from the Journal:
(i) Separate accounts should be opened in the Ledger for posting
transactions relating to different accounts recorded in the Journal. For
example, separate accounts may be opened for sales, purchases, sales
returns, purchases returns, salaries, rent, cash, etc.
(ii) The concerned account which has been debited in the Journal should
also be debited in the Ledger. However, a reference should be made of
the other account which has been credited in the Journal. For example,
for salaries paid, the salaries account should be debited in the Ledger,
but reference should be given of the Cash Account which was has been
credited in the Journal.
(iii) The concerned account, which has been credited in the Journal should
also be credited in the Ledger, but reference should be given of the
account, which has been debited in the Journal. For example, for salaries
paid, Cash Account has been credited in the Journal. It will be credited
in the Ledger also, but reference will be given of the Salaries Account
in the Ledger.
Thus, it may be concluded that while making posting in the Ledger, the
concerned account which has been debited or credited in the Journal should
also be debited or credited in the Ledger, but reference has to be given of the
Self-Instructional
60 Material
other account which has been credited or debited in the Journal, as the case Accounting Concepts,
Accounting Standards and
may be. This will be clear with the following example. Accounting Books
Suppose, salaries of `10,000 have been paid is cash; the following
entry will be passed in the Journal:
NOTES
Salaries Account (i) Dr. 10,000
To Cash Account (ii) 10,000
In the Ledger two accounts will be opened, (i) Salaries Account, and
(ii) Cash Account. Since Salaries Account has been debited in the Journal,
it will also be debited in the Ledger. Similarly, Cash Account has been
credited in the Journal and, therefore, it will also be credited in the Ledger,
but reference will be given of the other account involved. Thus, the accounts
will appear as follows in the Ledger:
Dr. SALARIES ACCOUNT Cr.
` Particulars
Cash A/c (ii) 10,000
Particulars ` Particulars `
Salaries A/c (i) 10,000
Self-Instructional
Material 61
Accounting Concepts, Solution:
Accounting Standards and
Accounting Books JOURNAL
Ledger
CASH ACCOUNT
1 To Capital A/c 10,000 By Furniture A/c 4,000 6
By Mohan 1,000 8
CAPITAL ACCOUNT
FURNITURE ACCOUNT
PURCHASES ACCOUNT
3 To Mohan 2,000
MOHAN
Balancing of an Account
In business, there may be several transactions relating to one particular
account. In Journal, these transactions appear on different pages in a
chronological order while they appear in a classified form under that
particular account in the Ledger. At the end of a period (say, a month, a quarter
or a year), the businessman will be interested in knowing the position of a
particular account. This means, he should total the debits and credits of the
account separately and find out the net balance. This technique of finding out
the net balance of an account, after considering the totals of both debits and
credits appearing in the account is known as ‘Balancing the Account’. The
balance is put on the side of the account which is smaller and a reference
is given that it has been carried forward or carried down (c/f or c/d) to the
next period. On the other hand, in the next period, a reference is given that
the opening has been brought forward or brought down (b/f or b/d) from the
previous period. This will be clear with the help of the following illustration.
Self-Instructional
62 Material
Illustration 2.7. Journalize the following transactions, post them in the Accounting Concepts,
Accounting Standards and
Ledger and balance the accounts on 31st January. Accounting Books
1. Ram started business with a capital of `10,000.
2. He purchased goods from Mohan on credit `2,000. NOTES
3. He Paid cash to Mohan `1,000.
4. He sold goods to Suresh `2,000.
5. He received cash from Suresh `3,000.
6. He further purchased goods from Mohan `2,000.
7. He paid cash to Mohan `1,000.
8. He further sold goods to Suresh `2,000.
9. He received cash from Suresh `1,000.
Solution:
JOURNAL
Self-Instructional
Material 63
Accounting Concepts, Ledger
Accounting Standards and
Accounting Books Dr. CASH ACCOUNT Cr.
PURCHASES ACCOUNT
SURESH
SALES ACCOUNT
Self-Instructional
64 Material
debit side by `10,000. It will be, therefore, said that the Capital Account is Accounting Concepts,
Accounting Standards and
showing a credit balance of `10,000. Accounting Books
Self-Instructional
Material 65
Accounting Concepts,
Accounting Standards and
Accounting Books
NOTES
1. General Journal
It is also known as Journal Proper. It is meant for recording all such
transactions for which no special journal has been kept by the business. As a
matter of fact, it is meant for recording such transactions which do not occur
frequently in the business and, therefore, do not warrant setting up of special
journals. Examples of such transactions are as follows:
(i) Opening entries: When a new set of books is started, the old accounts
have to be brought forward in the beginning of the year from last year’s
books. The opening entry is meant for recording these transactions.
The entries are made from the balance sheet of the last year.
(ii) Closing entries: At the end of accounting year, the nominal accounts
are closed by transferring them to trading account or profit and loss
account. The entries passed for this purpose are termed as ‘Closing
Entries’.
(iii) Adjustment entries: At the end of the accounting year, adjustment
entries are to be passed for outstanding/prepaid expenses, accrued/
outstanding income etc. Entries for all these adjustment are passed in
the General Journal.
(iv) Transfer entries: Transfer entries are required for transferring one
account to the other. Entries for such transfer are passed in the General
Journal.
(v) Rectification entries: Rectification entries are passed for rectifying
the errors which might have been committed in the books of account.
For example, the account of Mohan might have been debited in place
of the account of Sohan. The necessary rectifying entry will be passed
in he General Journal.
(vi) Purchases of fixed assets: The entries for purchases of fixed assets
such as plant, machinery, furniture, etc., on credit are also passed in
this Journal.
Self-Instructional
66 Material
2. Special Journal Accounting Concepts,
Accounting Standards and
Accounting Books
The term ‘Special Journal’ means a Journal which is meant for a special
purpose. The following are the various types of Special Journals.
(i) Cash Journal: Cash Journal is meant for recording all cash NOTES
transactions. It may be further classified into Cash Receipts Journal
and Cash Payments Journal. Cash Receipts Journal records all cash
receipts while Cash Payments Journal records all cash payments.
(ii) Goods Journal: The Journal is meant for recording all transactions
relating to goods. It may, further, be classified into the following
categories:
(a) Purchases Journal: The Journal is meant for recording all credit
purchases of goods. Cash purchases are to be recorded in the Cash
Journal. Moreover, only purchases of goods is to be recorded in
this Journal. The term “goods” means articles purchased for resale.
(b) Sales Journal: The Journal is meant for recording all credit sales
of goods. Cash sales of the goods are to be recorded in the Cash
Journal.
(c) Purchases Returns Journal: It is meant for recording all returns
of goods purchased on credit. It is also known as Returns Outward
Journal.
(d) Sales Returns Journal: It is meant for recording all return of goods
sold on credit. It is also known as Returns Inward Journal.
(iii) Bills Journal: The Journal is meant for recording all bills of exchange
or promissory notes received or issued by the business. It can be
classified into two categories:
(a) Bills Receivable Journal: It is meant for recording all bills of
exchange or promissory notes received by the business from its
debtors.
(b) Bills Payable Journal: It is meant for recording all bills of
exchange or promissory notes issued by the business in favour
of its creditors.
In the following pages, we are explaining the method of recording
business transactions in each Journal and their posting into the ledger.
Cash Journal or Book
Cash Journal or Cash book is meant for recording all cash transactions. It is
a very important Journal of business on account of the following reasons:
(i) The number of cash transactions is quite large in every business. The
business has to pay for salaries, rent, lighting, insurance, purchase of
goods and it has to receive cash for sales of goods and capital assets.
Self-Instructional
Material 67
Accounting Concepts, (ii) The chances of fraud being committed regarding cash are higher as
Accounting Standards and
Accounting Books compared to other assets. A strict control is, therefore, required. A
properly maintained cash book helps in achieving this objective.
(iii) Cash is the nerve centre of the business. Timely payments to its creditors
NOTES
increases the reputation of the business. Similarly timely payments
from its debtors improves the financial position of the business.
The cash book can be of any of the following types:
(i) Simple Cash Book
(ii) Two-Columnar Cash Book
(iii) Three-Columnar Cash Book
(iv) Multi-Columnar Cash Book
(v) Cash Receipts Book
(vi) Cash Payments Book
(i) Simple (Single)-Columnar Cash Book
Simple Cash Book is like an ordinary cash account. Its proforma is given
below:
Dr. SIMPLE CASH BOOK Cr.
The recording of the transactions in the Simple Cash Book and their
posting in the Ledger can be understood with the help of the following
illustration:
Illustration 2.8. Record the following transactions in the Cash Book and
post them in the ledger:
Jan. 01 Opening Cash balance `5,000.
Jan. 04 Rent paid `2,000
Jan. 06 Interest received `3,000.
Jan. 15 Cash purchases `4,000.
Jan. 25 Cash sales `8,000.
Jan. 31 Salaries paid `2,000.
Self-Instructional
68 Material
Solution: Accounting Concepts,
Accounting Standards and
Accounting Books
NOTES
It should be noted that in the ledger no separate cash account will be opened.
The Cash Book functions both as a book as well as an account as shown in
the illustration above.
(ii) Two (Double)-Columnar Cash Book
Such a Cash Book has two columns: (i) Cash Column, and (ii) Discount
Column. Cash column is meant for recording cash receipts and payments
while discount column is meant for recording discount received and the
discount allowed. The discount column on the debit side represents the
discount allowed while discount column on the credit side represents the
discount received.
It should be noted that while the cash column of the cash book serves
both the functions of a book as well as an account but discount column does
not serve the function of a discount account. A separate discount account has
to be opened in the ledger in which total debits and credits from the Cash
Book are posted. Sometimes, two separate discount accounts are kept in the
ledger—one for discount allowed and the other for discount received.
Self-Instructional
Material 69
Accounting Concepts, Trade Discount and Cash Discount: The following are the points of
Accounting Standards and
Accounting Books distinction between trade discount and cash discount:
(i) Trade discount is a deduction granted by a supplier from the list price
NOTES of the goods due to large quantity of sales or business tradition. While
cash discount is allowed by the creditor to the debtor for either buying
in cash or for making payment before the stipulated period.
(ii) Trade discount is allowed on sale of goods while cash discount is
allowed on payment of money.
(iii) Trade discount is not recorded in the books of account. The goods are
recorded on the net price. While cash discount is shown in the books
of account.
(iv) Trade discount may vary with the quantity of goods purchased while
cash discount may vary with the time period.
The recording of transactions in a two columnar cash book will be clear with
the help of the following illustration:
Illustration 2.9. Record the following transactions in the Cash Book and
post them in the ledger:
1. Jan. 01 Cash balance `5,000.
2. Jan. 06 Sold goods to Mahesh `4,000.
3. Jan. 08 Purchased goods from Mukesh `3,000.
4. Jan. 15 Cash received from Mukesh `3,900 in full
satisfaction.
5. Jan. 20 Paid to Mukesh `2,830 in full satisfaction.
6. Jan. 25 Sold goods to Suresh `3,000.
7. Jan. 31 Received cash from Suresh `2,900 in full
satisfaction.
Solution:
Dr. CASH BOOK Cr.
Date Particulars L.F. Dis- Cash ` Date Particulars L.F. Dis- Cash
count count
(`) (`) (`)
Jan. 1 To Balance b/d 5,000 Jan. 20 By Mukesh 150 2,850
Jan. 25 To Mahesh 100 3,900 Jan. 31 By Balance c/d 8,950
Jan. 31 To Suresh 100 2,900
200 11,800 150 11,800
Self-Instructional
70 Material
Ledger Accounting Concepts,
Accounting Standards and
MAHESH Accounting Books
SURESH
Date Particulars ` Date Particulars `
Jan. 25 To Sales A/c 3,000 Jan. 31 By Cash 2,900
Jan. 31 By Discount 100
MUKESH
Date Particulars ` Date Particulars `
Jan. 20 To Cash 2,850 Jan. 8 By Purchases A/c 3,000
Jan. 20 To Discount 150
Notes:
1. Transactions 2 and 6 relate to credit sales of goods and, therefore, they have not been recorded
in the cash book. They will be recorded in the Sales Book and the posting will be done in the
personal account of Mahesh and Suresh from there as shown in the Ledger.
2. Transaction 3 relates to credit purchase of goods. It has, therefore, not been recorded in the
Cash Book. It will be recorded in the Purchases Book from where posting will be done in the
personal account of Mukesh as shown in the Ledger.
3. The total of the debit side of the discount column has been taken to the ‘Discount Allowed
Account’ in the ledger. The word ‘sundries’ has been put in the ‘particulars’ column. Any
person who is interested in knowing the person to whom the discount has been allowed can
find it out from the Cash Book.
4. The total of the discount column appearing on the credit side of the cash book has been
taken to ‘Discount Received Account’ in the ledger. The word ‘Sundries’ has been put in the
‘Particulars’ column. Any person who is interested in knowing the names of the persons form
whom the discount has been received can find it out from the cash book.
Self-Instructional
Material 71
Accounting Concepts, The proforma of such a Cash Book is as follows:
Accounting Standards and
Accounting Books Dt. Particulars L.F. Discount Cash Bank Dt. Particulars L.F. Discount Cash Bank
NOTES
Ledger
Dr. SALES ACCOUNTCr.
Self-Instructional
72 Material
SURESH Accounting Concepts,
Jan. 10 By Bank A/c 2,000 Accounting Standards and
By Discount A/c 100 Accounting Books
RENT ACCOUNT
Jan. 4 To Bank A/c 2,000 NOTES
MEHTA BROS
PURCHASES ACCOUNT
SALARIES ACCOUNT
Self-Instructional
Material 73
Accounting Concepts, Special points regarding cheques: A business may receive cheques
Accounting Standards and
Accounting Books from its customers or it can issue cheques in favour of its customers or other
creditors. Following are some special points which should be kept in view
while making accounting entries in the Cash Book regarding such cheques
NOTES received or issued.
1. Receipt of cheques: There can be two situations:
(A) A cheque may be received by the business and sent to the Bank the
same day for collection. In such a case, it will be better to put the
cheque received in the debit side of the bank column as soon as it is
received. For example, if on January 10, a cheque is received from A
for `10,000 and is sent to the Bank for collection on the same day, the
entry for receipt of the cheque will appear in the Cash Book as follows:
CASH BOOK (RECEIPTS SIDE)
(B) In case a cheque received from a party is sent to the Bank at a later
date, it will be better to take the cheque as receipt of cash when it is
received and deposit of cash in the bank when the cheque is sent for
collection to the Bank. For example, if on January 10, a cheque is
received from A for `10,000 and is sent to the Bank for collection on
January 14, the entries in the Cash Book will appear as follows:
Dr. CASH BOOK (CASH AND BANK COLUMNS) Cr.
Date Particulars L.F. Cash Bank Date Particulars L.F. Cash Bank
(`) (`) (`) (`)
Jan. 10 To A 10,000 Jan. 14 By Bank C 10,000
Jan. 14 To Cash C 10,000
Tutorial Note. In the absence of any specific instructions in the question, the students
should presume that the cheque received from a party was sent to the Bank the same day
for collection.
2. Endorsement of cheques received: A cheque received by the business
may not be sent by it to the Bank for collection, but may be endorsed by the
business in favour of a creditor of the business. In such a case, the cheque
received will be taken as a receipt of cash. Similarly, the cheque endorsed,
will be taken as payment of cash. For example, if on January 10, cheque was
received from A for `10,000 and it was endorsed on January 14 in favour
of B, a creditor of the business, the entries in the Cash Book will appear as
follows:
CASH BOOK (CASH COLUMN ONLY)
Date Particulars L.F. Amount Date Particulars L.F. Amount
Jan. 10 To A 10,000 Jan. 14 By B 10,000
Self-Instructional
74 Material
3. Dishonour of cheques: The term ‘dishonour of cheque’ means non-payment Accounting Concepts,
Accounting Standards and
of the cheque by the drawee Bank on its being presented for payment. There Accounting Books
can be two different situations.
(I) A cheque received by a business and sent to the Bank for collection
NOTES
may be dishonoured on presentation for payment. In such a case, the
party from whom the cheque was received should be debited while
the account of the Bank should be credited. For example, if a cheque
received from, ‘A’ for `10,000 on January 10, is dishonoured by his
bankers on presentation for payment on January 14, entries in the Cash
Book will appear as follows:
Dr. CASH BOOK (BANK COLUMN) Cr.
Date Particulars L.F. Amount Date Particulars L.F. Amount
Self-Instructional
76 Material
Solution: Accounting Concepts,
Accounting Standards and
Dr. CASH BOOK Cr. Accounting Books
Dt. Particulars L.F Dis. Bank Cash Dt. Particulars L.F. Dis. Bank Cash
(`)
(`) (`) (`) (`) (`) NOTES
2016 2016
Jul. 1 To Capital 9,000 Jul. 2 By Bank C 7,000
Jul. 2 To Cash C 7,000 Jul. 4 By Building 5,000
Jul. 18 To Bank C 100 Jul. 10 By Furniture 1,000
Jul. 20 To Sales 1,200 Jul. 15 By Purchases 800
Jul. 22 To Cash C 2,000 Jul. 18 By Cash C 100
Jul. 26 To Sales 1,500 Jul. 22 By Bank C 2,000
Jul. 31 To Suresh 30 1,480 Jul. 25 By Purchases 1,000
Jul. 27 By Insurance
Premium 100
Jul. 28 By Freight 50
Jul. 30 By Drawings 500
Jul. 31 By Electricity 90
Jul. 31 By Mahesh 20 1,080
Jul. 31 By Bal. c/d 3,400 160
30 11,980 10,300 20 11,980 10,300
Ledger
Dr. CAPITAL ACCOUNT Cr.
BUILDING ACCOUNT
July 4 To Bank 5,000
PURCHASES ACCOUNT
July 15 To Bank 800
July 25 To Cash 1,000
FREIGHT ACCOUNT
July 28 To Cash 50
ELECTRICITY ACCOUNT
July 31 To Cash 90
SALES ACCOUNT
July 20 By Cash 1,200
July 26 By Bank 1,500
FURNITURE ACCOUNT
July 10 To Bank 1,000
Self-Instructional
Material 77
Accounting Concepts, INSURANCE PREMIUM ACCOUNT
Accounting Standards and
Accounting Books July 27 To Bank 100
DRAWINGS ACCOUNT
NOTES July 30 To Bank 500
DISCOUNT ACCOUNT
July 31 To Sundries 35 July 31 By Sundries 20
Notes:
(i) Cash and Bank columns in the cash book serve the purpose of prime as well as final entries.
Hence, in the ledger no Cash and Bank Accounts have been opened.
(ii) Cash Account never shows a credit balance, since a person cannot spend more than what he
has. While, the Bank Account may show a credit balance, since a bank may permit a customer
to overdraw his account (i.e., withdraw more money than what he has in his account). In such
a case, it will be said that the customer has an overdraft with the Bank.
(iii) Postings to the Discount Account is done at the end of the period with Total Discount Received
and Total Discount Allowed.
Self-Instructional
78 Material
is appointed by the business to make payments of all such petty expenses. Accounting Concepts,
Accounting Standards and
He works under the supervision of the Chief Cashier, who advances money Accounting Books
in the beginning of every month/quarter to meet petty expenses. At the
end of the month/quarter, the Petty Cashier submits a statement of account
NOTES
of the expenses incurred by him during the month/quarter and gets a fresh
advance.
The Petty Cash Book is usually maintained on the basis of Imprest
System. According to this system, a fixed amount is advanced to the Petty
Cashier at the beginning of the period by the Chief Cashier. He submits his
accounts at the end of the period and the Chief Cashier after examining his
accounts gives him a fresh advance equivalent to the amount spent by him
during the period. Thus, in the beginning of the each period (month or quarter
as the case may be), the Petty Cashier has a fixed balance. The amount so
advanced to him is termed as “Imprest” or “Float”.
The recording of transactions in a Petty Cash Book will be clear with
the help of the following Illustration.
Illustration 2.12. Enter the following transactions in the Petty Cash Book
(maintained on Imprest system) for the month of January, 2015.
Jan. 01 Cash received from the Chief Cashier `200
Jan. 03 Typing paper `8, Postage `4
Jan. 06 Office cleaning `4
Jan. 08 Postage `2
Jan. 10 Cartage `2
Jan. 15 Postage `6
Jan. 18 Ink `3, Typing paper `10
Jan. 20 Typewriter ribbon `10
Jan. 22 Telephone charges `7
Jan. 24 Office cleaning `2
Jan. 25 Nailpolish `27
Jan. 27 Telegrams `25
Jan. 29 Typing paper `30
Self-Instructional
Material 79
Accounting Concepts,
Accounting Standards and
Accounting Books
NOTES
Self-Instructional
80 Material
Postings from the Petty Cash Book: Postings in the Ledger from the Accounting Concepts,
Accounting Standards and
Petty Cash Book is done at the end of the period, i.e., month or quarter as Accounting Books
the case may be. There are two alternative ways of making postings from
the Petty Cash Book.
NOTES
1. Petty Cash Book maintained as a Memorandum Book only: In such a case,
the total of the various expenses from the Petty Cash Book is debited, to the
concerned accounts at the end of the period and credit is given to the Cash
Account with the actual expenditure incurred. The amount advanced by the
Chief Cashier to the Petty Cashier is recorded by him as a memorandum by
way of a note in the Cash Book itself. This method is usually not followed.
2. Where Petty Cash Book is taken as a part of the Double Entry System:
This method is quite popular. The recording is done regarding the petty cash
transactions on the basis of the following entries:
(i) When money is advanced to the Petty Cashier:
Petty Cash Account Dr.
To Cash Account
(The Petty Cash Account is debited with the actual amount
of money advanced)
(ii) On submission of accounts by the Petty Cashier:
Expenses Accounts Dr.
To Petty Cash Account
(Each expense is to be debited separately with the expenditure incurred
during the period as shown by the Petty Cash Book.)
Thus, in the Ledger, there is a Petty Cash Account as well as separate
Expenses Accounts for each of the expenses.
Taking the figures as given in the preceding illustration, the various
ledger accounts, according to the second method, will appear as follows:
Dr. PETTY CASH ACCOUNT Cr.
Self-Instructional
Material 81
Accounting Concepts, STATIONERY ACCOUNT
Accounting Standards and
Accounting Books July 31 To Petty Cash A/c 61
POSTAL CHARGES ACCOUNT
July 31 To Petty Cash A/c 71
NOTES
CARTAGE ACCOUNT
July 31 To Petty Cash A/c 2
CLEANING ACCOUNT
July 31 To Petty Cash A/c 8
Purchases Journal
The Purchases Journal is meant for recording credit purchases of goods. It is
also known as the Purchases or Bought Day Book. It has columns for date of
purchase, invoice number, name of the party, ledger folio and the amount of
purchases. It should be noted that the book records only purchase of goods
on credit. Purchases of items other than goods on credit is recorded in the
General Journal. Similarly, cash purchases are recorded in the Cash Book.
Posting: The posting is done in the Personal Accounts daily from the
Purchases Book. At the end of a week/month, the total of the Purchases Book
is debited to the Purchases Account in the ledger.
The following illustration will make clear the recording of transactions
in the Purchases Journal and their subsequent posting in the ledger.
Illustration 2.13. Record the following transactions in the Purchases Journal
and post them in the Ledger.
2016
Jan. 01 Purchased from Ram & Co. on credit:
30 Heater rods @ `10
20 Philips Bulbs @ `20
Jan. 04 Purchased from Shyam & Co. on credit:
40 Heater rods @ `10
20 E.C.E. Bulbs @ `15
Jan. 08 Purchased from Bajaj & Co. on credit:
20 Electric Elements @ `40
3 Electric Mixers @ `100
Jan. 24 Purchased from K.C. & Co. on credit:
30 Electric Plugs @ `20
40 Table Fans @ `200
Self-Instructional
82 Material
Solution: Accounting Concepts,
Accounting Standards and
PURCHASES JOURNAL Accounting Books
Ledger
RAM & CO. (Folio 4)
Notes:
(i) Folio Nos. are all imaginary.
(ii) Purchases Account has been debited with the total purchases made during the month. This
has been done at the end of the month. A firm may make the posting in the Purchases Account
weekly also.
(iii) Posting is done in the Personal Accounts daily.
Sales Journal
The Journal is meant for recording all sales of goods on credit. This is also
known as Sales or Sold Day Book. It should be noted that Cash Sales are
Self-Instructional
Material 83
Accounting Concepts, recorded in the Cash Book while sales of articles other than goods on credit
Accounting Standards and
Accounting Books is to be recorded in the General Journal.
Posting is done in the Personal Accounts daily from the Sales Book.
NOTES They are debited with individual amounts. The Sales Account is credited
with the total sales made during the period (i.e., a week or month) at the
end of the period.
The recording of the transactions in the Sales Book and their posting
in the Ledger will be clear with the help of the following illustration.
Illustration 2.14. Record the following transactions in the Sales Day Book
and post them into the ledger.
2015
Jan. 01 Sold to Mukesh & Co.:
10 Heater Rods @ ` 20
10 Lamp Shades @ ` 30
Jan. 10 Sold to Suresh & Brothers:
10 Table Fans @ ` 250
20 Philips Tubelights @ ` 30
Jan. 25 Sold to Ramesh & Co.:
10 Electric Switches @ ` 50
20 E.C.E. Tubelights @ ` 30
Solution:
SALES JOURNAL
Sl. Invoice Particulars L.F. Amount (`) Amount
(`)
No. No.
Jan. 1 101 Mukesh & Co.: 4
10 Heater Rods @ `20 200
300 500
10 Lamp Shades @ `30
Jan.10 102 Suresh & Brothers: 6
10 Table Fans @ `250 2,500
20 Philips Tubelights @ `30 600 3,100
Jan. 25 103 Ramesh & Co.: 8
10 Electric Switches @ `50 500
600 1,100
20 E.C.E. Tubelights @ `30
Sales A/c Cr. 10 4,700
Ledger
MUKESH & CO. (Folio 4)
Self-Instructional
84 Material
SURESH & BROTHERS (Folio 6) Accounting Concepts,
Accounting Standards and
Jan. 10 To Sales 3,100 Accounting Books
Notes:
(i) Folio Nos., Invoice Nos. are all imaginary.
(ii) Posting is done in the Personal Accounts daily. The total sales are posted at the end of the
month (or week) on the credit side of the Sales Account, against the word ‘Sundries’. Any
person interested in finding out the names of the parties to whom the sales have been made
can do so by looking to the Sales Book.
The posting from the Sales Returns Journal will be done daily in the
personal accounts. For example, in the above case, the account of Ram &
Co. will be credited with a sum of `190 on Jan. 10. The total of the Sales
Returns Journal will be posted to the debit of Sales Returns Account at the
end of the period, say, a week or a month.
Credit Note: The customer who returns the goods, gets credit for the
value of the goods returned. A Credit Note is sent to him intimating that his
account has been credited with the value of the goods returned. The Note is
prepared in duplicate. Its Proforma is as under:
Self-Instructional
Material 85
Accounting Concepts, MAHESHWARI BROTHERS
Accounting Standards and
Accounting Books 3, Strand Road, Kolkata
No. 202 Date Jan. 10, 2016
To
NOTES Ram & Co.,
21, Shri Ram Road, Delhi.
Dear Sir,
We have credited your account in respect of the following goods returned by you:
` `
(i) 5 Electric Plugs @ `20 100
(ii) 3 Philips Tubelights @ `30 90 190
For Maheshwari Brothers
Sunil
Manager
Note No. ` `
Jan. 12 301 Shyam & Co.
3 Electric Rods @ `40 120
Jan. 21 302 Bajaj & Co.
3 Electric Mixers @ `300 900
Purchases Returns A/c Cr. 1,020
Note: The entries in the Personal Accounts are done daily from the Purchases Returns Book. They are
debited with the respective amounts. The total of the Purchases Returns Book is posted to the credit
of Purchases Returns Account at the end of the period, say, a week or a month, as the case may be.
Debit Note: When the goods are returned to the supplier, a debit note
is sent to him indicating that this account has been debited with the amount
mentioned in the Debit Note. Its proforma is given as under:
Self-Instructional
86 Material
MAHESHWARI BROTHERS
Accounting Concepts,
Accounting Standards and
3, Strand Road Kolkata Accounting Books
No. 301 Date Jan. 12, 2014
To
Shyam & Co. NOTES
3, Clive Road, Kolkata.
Dear Sir.
We have debited your account for the goods returned by us as under:
4 Electric Rods @ `30 `120
For Maheshwari Brothers
Sunil
Manager
Self-Instructional
Material 87
Accounting Concepts, 4. Accounting standards are rules according to which accounting
Accounting Standards and
Accounting Books statements have to be prepared. They can be termed as statements
of code of practice of the regulatory accounting bodies that are to be
observed in the preparation and presentation of financial statements.
NOTES
5. The accrual system of accounting is a system in which accounting
entries are made on the basis of amounts having become due for
payment or receipt.
6. According to Kohler, ‘it is a system of book-keeping in which as a
rule only records of cash and personal accounts are maintained, it is
always incomplete double entry, varying with circumstances.
7. The categories in which the business transactions are classified for the
purpose of recording in the journal are:
(i) Transactions relating to persons
(ii) Transaction relating to properties and assets
(iii) Transactions relating to incomes and expenses
8. Some examples of nominal accounts are rent, rates, lighting, insurance,
dividends, loss by fire, etc.
9. The process of recording transactions in the Ledger is called as
‘posting’.
10. Adjustment entries are entries which are passed at the end of the
accounting year, for outstanding/prepaid expenses, accrued/outstanding
income, etc. Entries for all these adjustments are passed in the General
Journal.
11. The Petty Cash Book is usually maintained on the basis of Imprest
System.
2.10 SUMMARY
• The term ‘concepts’ includes those basic assumptions or conditions
upon which the science of accounting is based.
• The following are the important accounting concepts: separate entity
concept, going concern concept, money measurement concept, cost
concept, dual aspect concept, accounting period concept, period
matching of cost and revenue concept and realization concept.
• The term ‘convention’ includes those customs or traditions which guide
the accountant while preparing the accounting statement.
• The following are the important accounting conventions: convention of
conservatism, convention of full disclosure, convention of consistency,
and convention of materiality.
• Accounting practices follow certain guidelines. The rules that govern
Self-Instructional how accountants measure progress and communicate financial
88 Material
information fall under the heading “Generally Accepted Accounting Accounting Concepts,
Accounting Standards and
Principles” (GAAP). GAAP comprises of conventions, rules and Accounting Books
procedures that constitute accepted accounting practices at any given
time.
NOTES
• Accounting standards are rules according to which accounting
statements have to be prepared. They can be termed as statements
of code of practice of the regulatory accounting bodies that are to be
observed in the preparation and presentation of financial statements.
• The objective of the IASC committee was ‘to formulate and publish
in the public interest standards to be observed in the presentation
of audited financial statements and to promote their world-wide
acceptance and observance.’
• Since 2001, the IASC was renamed as the International Accounting
Standard Board (IASB). The IASB has now taken over the work of
IASC. Its members (currently 15 full time members) are responsible for
the development and publication of IFRSs and approving interpretations
as developed by IFRIC.
• In order to bring uniformity in terminology, approach and presentation
of accounting results, the Institute of Chartered Accountants of India
established on 22nd April, 1977, an Accounting Standards Board
(ASB). The main function of the ASB is to formulate accounting
standards so that such standards will be established by the Council of
the Institute of Chartered Accountants.
• Book-keeping is the art of recording pecuniary or business transactions
in a regular and systematic manner. This recording of transactions may
be done according to any of the following two systems: single entry
system and double entry system.
• The Journal records all daily transactions of a business into the order
in which they occur. A Journal may, therefore, be defined as a book
containing a chronological record of transactions. It is the book in
which the transactions are recorded first of all under the double entry
system. Thus, Journal is the book of original record.
• Ledger is a book which contains various accounts. In other words,
Ledger is a set of accounts. It contains all accounts of the business
enterprise whether Real, Nominal or Personal.
• There are different subsidiary books which are used in accounting:
general journal and special journal like cash journal, goods journal
and bills journal.
Self-Instructional
90 Material
Jain, S.P. and Narang, K.L. 2001. Advanced Accountancy. New Delhi: Kalyani Accounting Concepts,
Accounting Standards and
Publishers. Accounting Books
Ahmed, N. 2008. Financial Accounting. New Delhi: Atlantic Publishers and
Distributors Pvt. Ltd.
NOTES
Self-Instructional
Material 91
Preparation of Trial Balance
and Final Accounts, and
Depreciation Accounting UNIT 3 PREPARATION OF
TRIAL BALANCE AND
NOTES
FINAL ACCOUNTS,
AND DEPRECIATION
ACCOUNTING
Structure
3.0 Introduction
3.1 Objectives
3.2 Preparation of Trial Balance
3.3 Preparation of Final Accounts
3.3.1 Trading Account
3.3.2 Profit and Loss Account
3.3.3 Preparation of Manufacturing Account
3.3.4 Balance Sheet
3.4 Errors and Rectification
3.5 Classification of Capital and Revenue
3.6 Fixed Assets Depreciation Accounting
3.6.1 Methods for Providing Depreciation
3.7 Answers to Check Your Progress Questions
3.8 Summary
3.9 Key Words
3.10 Self Assessment Questions and Exercises
3.11 Further Readings
3.0 INTRODUCTION
Up till, now we have learnt about the recording and posting of entries
in Journal and Ledger. But merely recoding and posting does not ensure
mathematical accuracy. This is why it is important to verify the entries at
the end of reporting periods. A Trial Balance is prepared periodically just
for this purpose. On the basis of this preparation, errors are identified, and
rectifications done. This then leads to the last stage of the accounting cycle
which is the preparation of final accounts. It determines the financial position
of the business. Under this it is compulsory to make trading account, the profit
and loss account and balance sheet. The term ‘final accounts’ includes the
trading account, the profit and loss account, and the balance sheet.
The Trading and Profit and Loss Account is a final summary of such
accounts which affect the profit or loss position of the business. In other
words, the account contains the items of Incomes and Expenses relating to a
Self-Instructional
92 Material
particular period. The account is prepared in two parts: (i) Trading Account, Preparation of Trial Balance
and Final Accounts, and
and (ii) Profit and Loss Account. The Balance Sheet shows the position of Depreciation Accounting
various accounts during the accounting period.
Related to these preparation of accounts, in this unit, we will also
NOTES
discuss accounting treatment of errors and rectification as well as concepts
of depreciation accounting, classification of capital and revenue assets, etc.
3.1 OBJECTIVES
After going through this unit, you will be able to:
• Describe the preparation of trial balance
• Discuss the preparation of final accounts
• Explain the accounting treatment of errors and rectification
• Examine the classification of capital and revenue
• Discuss the concept of depreciation accounting
Self-Instructional
Material 93
Preparation of Trial Balance prepare the financial statements as stated above to know the profit or
and Final Accounts, and
Depreciation Accounting loss made by the business during a particular period or its financial
position on a particular date.
Summarised ledger: It has already been stated that a Trial Balance
3.
NOTES
contains the ledger balances on a particular date. Thus, the entire
ledger is summarised in the form of a Trial Balance. The position of a
particular account can be judged simply by looking at the Trial Balance.
The Ledger may be seen only when details regarding the accounts are
required.
Methods of Preparation of a Trial Balance
A Trial Balance may be prepared according to any of the two methods:
1. Total Method: In case of this method after totaling each side of the
ledger account, the respective debit and credit totals of the ledger
accounts are transferred to the respective sides of the trial balance.
Thus, in case of this method, the trial balance can be prepared soon
after totaling various accounts and the time taken in balancing the
account is saved to that extent. This method is not generally followed
since it does not help in preparation of financial statements.
2. Balance Method: According to this method, every ledger account is
balanced and only the balance of the ledger account is carried forward
to the trial balance. This method is generally used since the preparation
of the financial statements where only balances are to be taken.
3. Total and Balance Method: This method combines the first two
methods explained above. In case of this method, the trial balance
contains both the totals of both sides of the respective accounts as well
as their final balances. This method has the advantage that it helps in
immediate location of a mistake incurred, if any in the balancing the
account. However, it has disadvantage of increasing the workload of
the staff.
Illustration 3.1. Prepare (a) ledger accounts and (b) the trial balance
according to (i) Total method (ii) Balance method and (iii) Total and balance
method on the basis of transactions.
Solution:
(a) Preparation of Ledger Accounts
Dr. CASH ACCOUNT Cr.
Date Particulars L.F. ` Date Particulars L.F. `
2016 2016
Jan. 1 To Balance b/d 8,000 Jan. 1 By Purchases A/c 3,800
Jan. 4 To Vijay 1,980 Jan. 8 By Plant A/c 300
Jan. 15 To Rahim 300 Jan. 20 By Salary A/c 2,000
Jan. 18 To Sales A/c 1,000 Jan. 21 By Anand 4,800
Jan. 26 To Interest A/c 200 Jan. 28 By Interest on
Self-Instructional
94 Material
Jan. 31 To Sales A/c 500 Loan A/c 500 Preparation of Trial Balance
Jan. 31 By Balance c/d 580 and Final Accounts, and
11,980 11,980 Depreciation Accounting
Feb. 1 To Balance b/d 580
BANK ACCOUNT
STOCK ACCOUNT
BUILDING ACCOUNT
VIJAY
ANIL
MADHU
CAPITAL ACCOUNT
PURCHASES ACCOUNT
DISCOUNT ACCOUNT
BHARAT
PLANT ACCOUNT
Self-Instructional
96 Material
Dr. MUKESH Cr. Preparation of Trial Balance
and Final Accounts, and
Date Particulars ` Date Particulars ` Depreciation Accounting
Jan. 31 To Balance c/d 5,000 Jan. 8 By Plant A/c 5,000
5,000 5,000
Feb. 1 By Balance b/d 5,000 NOTES
SALES ACCOUNT
SALARY ACCOUNT
DRAWINGS ACCOUNT
Self-Instructional
Material 97
Preparation of Trial Balance Particulars Debit (`) Credit (`)
and Final Accounts, and
Depreciation Accounting Building Account 10,000
Vijay 2,000 2,000
Anil 1,000
NOTES Madhu 2,000
Anand 5,000 5,000
Capital Account 55,000
Babu’s Loan Account 10,000
Purchases Account 9,000 200
Discount Account 20 400
Bharat 5,000
Plant Account 5,300
Interest on Loan Account 500
Mukesh 5,000
Sales Account 2,100
Rahim 600 600
Bad Debts Account 300
Salary Account 2,000
Drawings Account 200
Total 96,900 96,900
Self-Instructional
98 Material
(iii) Total and Balance Method Preparation of Trial Balance
and Final Accounts, and
TRIAL BALANCE Depreciation Accounting
(as on 31st January, 2016)
Self-Instructional
Material 99
Preparation of Trial Balance a loss during the period covered by the Trial Balance, (ii) Where does he
and Final Accounts, and
Depreciation Accounting stand now? In other words, what is his financial position?
The determination of the Profit or Loss is done by preparing a Trading
and Profit and Loss Account (or an Income Statement). While the financial
NOTES
position is judged by means of preparing a Balance Sheet of the business.
The two statements together, i.e., Income Statement and the Balance Sheet,
are termed as Final Accounts. As the term indicates, Final Accounts means
accounts which are prepared at the final stage to give the financial position
of the business.
Characteristics of Final Accounts
• It is the final process of accounting.
• It is prepared to show the final result of the company in a specific
period.
• It is the account, which is prepared at the end of the given year or period,
to see the profit and loss position as well as the financial position of a
going concern for the period given.
• It is also known as financial statement.
• It consists of trading account, profit and loss account and balance sheet.
• The trading account shows the gross profit or gross loss, net profit or
net loss is calculated from profit and loss account and balance sheet is
prepared to know the position of assets and liabilities.
• Profit and loss account shows the profitability achieved during the
accounting period and balance sheet reflects the composition of various
assets, liabilities, and shareholder’s equity on the accounting period.
Objectives of Final Accounts
The following are the main objectives of final accounts:
• To determine gross profit and net profit of the business during the year.
• To present the true financial position of the business on a given date.
• To make effective control on financial activities of the business.
• To make a summary presentation of all the financial transactions.
• To communicate the operating results and financial position of the
users.
• To help in making a different financial decision to the users of
accounting information.
Self-Instructional
100 Material
3.3.1 Trading Account Preparation of Trial Balance
and Final Accounts, and
Depreciation Accounting
Trading Account gives the overall result of trading, i.e., purchasing and selling
of goods. In other words, it explains whether purchasing of goods and selling
them has proved to be profitable for the business or not. It takes into account NOTES
on the one hand the cost of goods sold and on the other the value for which
they have been sold away. In case the sales value is higher than the cost of
goods sold, there will be a profit, while in a reverse case, there will be a
loss. The profit disclosed by the Trading Account is termed as Gross Profit,
similarly the loss disclosed by the Trading Account is termed as Gross Loss.
This will be clear with the help of the following illustration:
Illustration 3.2. The following figures have been taken from the Trial Balance
of a trader:
`
Purchases 30,000
Purchases Returns 5,000
Sales 40,000
Sales Returns 5,000
Calculate the amount of profit or loss made by the trader.
Solution:
The profit or loss made by the trader can be found out by comparing the cost
of goods sold with sales value. This has been done as follows:
Particulars Amount ` Amount `
Sales 40,000
Less Sales Returns 5,000 35,000
Purchases 30,000
Less Purchases Returns 5,000 25,000
Gross Profit 10,000
Solution:
Particulars Amount ` Amount `
Sales 60,000
Less: Sales Returns 10,000 50,000
Cost of goods sold:
Opening Stock 10,000
Add: Net Purchases (`40,000 – 5,000) 35,000
45,000
Less: Closing Stock 15,000 30,000
Gross Profit 20,000
Cost of goods sold calculated as above will then be compared with the
net sales to find out the amount of profit or loss made by the business. This
will be clear with the following Illustrations.
The term ‘merchandise’ is also used for the term ‘goods’.
Thus:
COST OF GOODS = COST OF MERCHANDISE
COST OF GOODS PURCHASED = COST OF MERCHANDISE
PURCHASED
COST OF GOODS SOLD = COST OF MERCHANDISE SOLD
Self-Instructional
102 Material
Illustration 3.4. Find out the cost of merchandise purchased, cost of Preparation of Trial Balance
and Final Accounts, and
merchandise sold, cost of merchandise unsold and Gross Profit from the Depreciation Accounting
following transactions:
`
Purchases (3,000 articles) 25,000 NOTES
Freight 1,000
Local Taxes 1,000
Salaries 2,500
Shop Rent 500
Godown Rent 500
Electrical Charges 600
Municipal Taxes 200
Stationery 250
Furniture (estimated life 5 years) 12,000
Sales (2,700 articles) 32,000
Solution:
Particulars Amount `
Cost of Merchandise purchased
This consists of:
Purchases 25,000
Freight 1,000
Local Taxes 1,000
27,000
Cost of Merchandise sold
Cost of 3,000 units of merchandise purchased 27,000
Cost of one unit of merchandise 9
Cost of 2,700 units of merchandise sold 24,300
Gross Profit
Sales of 2,700 units of merchandise 32,000
Less: Cost of merchandise sold 24,300
7,700
Cost of Merchandise unsold
300 units @ `9 per unit 2,700
Self-Instructional
Material 103
Preparation of Trial Balance
and Final Accounts, and Gross Profit = Sales – Cost of Goods Sold
Depreciation Accounting Cost of Goods Sold = Opening Stock + Purchases
+ Direct Expenses – Closing Stock
NOTES Therefore, Gross Profit = Sales – (Opening Stock + Purchases
+ Direct Expenses – Closing Stock)
Or Gross Profit = (Sales + Closing Stock ) – (Opening
Stock + Purchases + Direct Expenses)
The term “Direct Expenses” include those expenses which have been
incurred in purchasing the goods, bringing them to the business premises and
making them fit for sale. Examples of such expenses are carriage charges,
octroi, import duty, expenses for seasoning the goods, etc.
The Trading Account can be prepared in the following form on the
basis of equation given above.
TRADING ACCOUNT
Dr. for the period ending ... Cr.
Particulars Amount ` Particulars Amount `
To Opening Stock ...... By Sales ......
To Purchases ...... Less: Returns ...... ......
Less: Returns ...... ...... By Closing Stock ......
To Direct Expenses ...... By Gross Loss* ......
To Gross Profit* ...... ......
...... ......
*Only one figure will be there.
Illustration 3.5. Prepare the Trading Account of Mr. Ramesh for the year
ending 31st December, 2017 from the data as follows:
` `
Purchases 10,000 Wages 4,000
Purchases Returns 2,000 Carriage Charges 2,000
Sales 20,000 Stock on 1.1.2017 4,000
Sales Returns 5,000 Stock on 31.12.2017 6,000
Solution:
TRADING ACCOUNT
Dr. for the year ending 31-12-2017 Cr.
Particulars ` Particulars `
To Opening Stock 4,000 By Sales 20,000
To Purchases 10,000 Less: Sales
Less: Returns 2,000 8,000 Returns 5,000 15,000
To Wages 4,000 By Closing Stock 6,000
To Carriage Charges 2,000
To Gross Profit 3,000
21,000 21,000
Self-Instructional
104 Material
Important Points Regarding Trading Account Preparation of Trial Balance
and Final Accounts, and
Depreciation Accounting
1. Stock: The term ‘Stock’ includes goods lying unsold on a particular date.
The Stock may be of two types:
(i) Opening Stock (ii) Closing Stock NOTES
The term ‘Opening Stock’ means goods lying unsold with the
businessman in the beginning of the accounting year. This is shown on the
debit side of the Trading Account.
The term ‘Closing Stock’ includes goods lying unsold with the
businessman at the end of the accounting year. It should be noted that stock
at the end of the accounting year is taken after the books of accounts have
been closed. The following journal entry is passed in the Journal Proper to
record the amount of closing stock:
Closing Stock Account Dr.
To Trading Account
The amount of closing stock is shown on the credit side of the Trading
Account and as an asset in the Balance Sheet. This has been explained later.
The Closing Stock at the end of the accounting period will become the
Opening Stock for the next year. The Opening Stock is, therefore, shown on
the debit side of the Trial Balance.
The following equations can be derived for computation of stocks:
Opening Stock = Cost of Goods Sold + Closing Stock – Cost of
Purchases
Closing Stock = Opening stock + Cost of purchases – Cost of
Goods Sold
Taking the figures from Illustration 5.6 the two stocks can be
computed as under:
Opening Stock = Cost of Goods Sold + Closing stock – Cost of
purchases
= 12,000 + 6,000 – 14,000 = `4,000
Closing Stock = Opening stock + Cost of purchases – Cost of
Goods Sold
= 4,000 + 14,000 – 12,000 = `6,000
Valuation of Closing Stock: The closing stock is valued on the
basis of “cost or market price whichever is less” principle. It is, therefore,
very necessary that the cost of the goods lying unsold should be carefully
determined. The market value of such goods will also be found out on the
Balance Sheet date. The closing stock will be valued at the lower of the two
values. For example, if the goods lying unsold at the end of the accounting
period amount to `11,000, while their market price on the Balance Sheet
Self-Instructional
Material 105
Preparation of Trial Balance date amounts to `10,000, the closing stock will be valued at `10,000. This
and Final Accounts, and
Depreciation Accounting valuation is done because of the accounting convention of conservatism,
according to which expected losses are to be taken into account but not
expected profits.
NOTES
2. Purchases: The term “Purchases” includes both cash and credit purchases
of goods. The term “goods”, means items purchased for resale. Assets
purchased for permanent use in the business such as purchase of plant,
furniture, etc., are not included in the purchase of goods. Similarly, purchase
of articles such as stationery meant for using in the business will also not
be included in the item of purchases. In case a proprietor has himself used
certain goods for his personal purposes, the value of such goods at cost will
be deducted from the purchases and included in the drawings of the proprietor.
The journal entry in such a case would be as follows:
Drawings Account Dr.
To Purchases Account
Similarly, in case certain goods are given by way of free samples,
etc., the value of such goods should be charged to advertisement account
and deducted from purchases. The journal entry in such a case would be as
follows:
Advertisement Account Dr.
To Purchases Account
The amount of purchases will be the net purchases made by the
proprietor. The term ‘net purchases’ means total purchases of goods made by
the businessman less the goods that he has returned back to the suppliers. In
other words, purchases will be taken to the Trading Account after deducting
purchases returns from the gross purchases made during the accounting
period.
3. Sales: The term ‘Sales’ includes both cash and credit sales. Gross sales
will be shown in the inner column of the Trading Account out of which “sales
returns” will be deducted. The net sales will then be shown in the outer column
of the Trading Account. Proper care should be taken in recording sale of
those goods which have been sold at the end of the financial year but have
not yet been delivered. The sales value of such goods should be included in
the sales, but care should be taken that they are not included in the closing
stock at the end of the accounting period.
Sales have to be recorded at net realisable value excluding sales tax,
i.e., Sales excluding Sales Tax – Cost incurred necessarily to make the sale.
For example, an item can be sold for `50 plus sales tax at 10% after getting
it repaired at a cost of `5. The sales should be recorded at net relisable value,
i.e., `45.
Self-Instructional
106 Material
Sales of assets like plant and machinery, land and building or such other Preparation of Trial Balance
and Final Accounts, and
assets which were purchased for using in the business, and not for sale, should Depreciation Accounting
not be included in the figure of ‘sales’ to be taken to the Trading Account.
4. Wages: The amount of wages is taken as a direct expense and, therefore,
NOTES
is debited to the Trading Account. Difficulty arises in those cases when the
Trial Balance includes a single amount for “wages and salaries”. In such
a case, the amount is taken to the Trading Account. However, if the Trial
Balance shows “salaries and wages” the amount is taken to the Profit and
Loss Account. In actual practice such difficulties do not arise because the
businessman knows for which purpose he has incurred the expenditure by
way of wages or salaries. However, in an examination problem, it will be
useful for the students to follow the principle given above, i.e., “wages and
salaries” to be charged to Trading Account while “wages and salaries” to be
charged to the Profit and Loss Account. Wages paid for purchase of an asset
for long-term use in the business, i.e., wages paid for plant and machinery
or wages paid for construction of a building should not be charged to the
Wages Account. They should be charged to the concerned Asset Account.
5. Customs and Import Duty: In case the goods have been imported from
outside the country, customs and import duty may have to be paid. The amount
of such duty should be charged to the Trading Account.
6. Freight, Carriage and Cartage: Freight, Carriage and Cartage are
taken as direct expenses incurred on purchasing of the goods. They are,
therefore, taken to the debit side of the Trading Account. The terms “Freight
In”, “Cartage In” and “Carriage In” have also the same meaning. However,
“Cartage Out”, “Freight Out” and “Carriage Out” are taken to be the expenses
incurred on selling the goods. They are, therefore, charged to the Profit and
Loss Account. The term “Inward” is also used for the term “IN”. Similarly, the
term “Outward” is also used for the term “Out”. In other words, “Carriage” or
“Carriage Inward” or ‘‘Cariage In’’ are used as synonymous terms. Similarly,
‘‘Carriage Out’’ or ‘‘Carriage Outward’’ are also synonymous terms. The
same is true for other expenses like Freight or Cartage.
7. Royalty: Royalty is the amount paid to the owner for using his rights.
For example, the royalty is paid by a “Lessee” of a coalmine to its owner
for taking out the coal from the coalmine. Similarly, royalty is paid to the
owner of a patent for using his right. It is generally taken as a direct expense
and, therefore, is charged to the Trading Account. However, where royalty
is based on sales, for example, in case of the book publishing trade, it may
be charged to the Profit and Loss Account.
8. Gas, Electricity, Water, Fuel, etc. All these expenses are direct expenses
and, therefore, they are charged to the Trading Account.
9. Packing Materials: Packing Materials used for packing the goods
purchased for bringing them to the shop or convert them into a saleable state
Self-Instructional
Material 107
Preparation of Trial Balance are direct expenses and, therefore, they are charged to the Trading Account.
and Final Accounts, and
Depreciation Accounting However, packing expenses incurred for making the product look attractive or
packing expenses incurred after the product has been sold away are charged
to the Profit and Loss Account.
NOTES
Closing Entries
Closing Entries are entries passed at the end of the accounting year to close
different accounts. These entries are passed to close the accounts relating to
incomes, expenses, gains and losses. In other words, these entries are passed
to close the different accounts which pertain to Trading and Profit and Loss
Account. The accounts relating to assets and liabilities are not closed but
they are carried forward to the next year. Hence, no closing entries are to be
passed regarding those accounts which relate to the Balance Sheet.
The principle of passing closing entry is very simple. In case an account
shows a debit balance, it has to be credited in order to close it. For example,
if the Purchases Account is to be closed, the Purchases Account will have
to be credited so that it may be closed because it has a debit balance. The
Trading Account will have to be debited.
The closing entries are passed in the Journal Proper. The different
closing entries to be passed by the accountant for preparing a Trading Account
are being explained below:
(i) Trading Account Dr.
To Stock Account (Opening)
To Purchases Account
To Sales Returns Account
To Carriage Account
To Customs Duty Account
(ii) Sales Account Dr.
Purchases Returns Account Dr.
Stock Account (Closing) Dr.
To Trading Account
In case the total of the credit side of the Trading Account is greater than
the total of the debit side of the Trading Account, the difference is known as
Gross Profit. In a reverse case it will be a Gross Loss. Gross Profit or Gross
Loss disclosed by the Trading Account is transferred to the Profit and Loss
Account.
Importance of the Trading Account
Trading Account provides the following information to a businessman
regarding his business:
Self-Instructional
108 Material
1. Gross Profit disclosed by the Trading Account tells him the upper limit Preparation of Trial Balance
and Final Accounts, and
within which he should keep the operating expenses of the business Depreciation Accounting
besides saving something for himself. The cost of purchasing and the
price at which he can sell the goods are governed largely by market
factors over which he has no control. He can control only his operating NOTES
expenses. For example, if the cost of purchasing an article is `10 and
it can be sold in the market at `15 per unit, the gross margin available
on each article is `5. In case a businessman proposes to sell 1,000 units
of that article in a year, his gross profit or gross margin will be `5,000.
His other expenses should therefore be less than `5,000 so that he can
also save something for himself.
2. He can calculate his Gross Profit Ratio1 and compare his performance
year after year. A fall in the Gross Profit Ratio means increase in the
cost of purchasing the goods or decrease in the selling price of the
goods or both. In order to maintain at least same figure of gross profit
in absolute terms, he will have to push up the sales or make all out
efforts to obtain goods at cheaper prices. Thus, he can prevent at least
fall in the figure of his gross profit if he cannot bring any increase in
it.
3. Comparison of stock figures of one period from another will help him
in preventing unnecessary lock-up of funds in inventories.
4. In case of new products, the businessman can easily fix up the selling
price of the products by adding to the cost of purchases, the percentage
gross profit that he would like to maintain. For example, if the trader
has been so far maintaining a rate of gross profit of 20% on sales and
he introduces a new product in the market having a cost of `100, he
should fix the selling price at `125 in order to maintain the same rate
of gross profit (i.e., 20% on sales).
3.3.2 Profit and Loss Account
The Trading Account simply tells about the gross profit or loss made by
a businessman on purchasing and selling of goods. It does not take into
account the other operating expenses incurred by him during the course of
running the business. For example, he has to maintain an office for getting
orders and executing them, taking policy decisions and implementing them.
All such expenses are charged to the Profit and Loss Account. Besides this,
a businessman may have other sources of income. For example, he may
receive rent from some of his business properties. He may have invested
surplus funds of the business in some securities. He might be getting interest
or dividends from such investments. In order to ascertain the true profit or
loss which the business has made during a particular period, it is necessary
that all such expenses and incomes should be considered. Profit and Loss
1. Gross Profit ÷ Sales × 100 Self-Instructional
Material 109
Preparation of Trial Balance Account considers all such expenses and incomes and gives the net profit
and Final Accounts, and
Depreciation Accounting made or loss suffered by a business during a particular period. It is generally
prepared in the following form:
PROFIT AND LOSS ACCOUNT
NOTES
Dr. for the year ending..... Cr.
Particulars ` Particulars `
To Gross Loss b/d* ....... By Gross Profit b/d* ........
To Salaries ....... By Discount received ........
To Rent ........ By Net Loss transferred
To Commission ........ to Capital A/c* ........
To Advertisements ........
To Bad Debts ........
To Discount ........
To Net Profit Transferred
to Capital Account* ........
........ ........
Self-Instructional
Material 111
Preparation of Trial Balance 11. Depreciation: Depreciation denotes decrease in the value of an
and Final Accounts, and
Depreciation Accounting asset due to wear and tear, lapse of time, obsolescence, exhaustion
and accident. For example, a motor car purchased gets depreciated
on account of its constant use. A property purchased on lease for
NOTES `12,000 for a period of 12 years will depreciate at the rate of `1,000
per year. On account of new inventions, old assets become obsolete and
they have to be replaced. Mines etc. get exhausted after the minerals
are completely taken out of them. An asset may meet an accident and
may lose its value. It is necessary that depreciation on account of all
these factors is charged to the Profit and Loss Account to ascertain the
true profit or loss made by the business.
12. Discount: It is a reduction from a list price, quoted price or invoice
price. Discount may be of three types:
(a) Trade Discount: It is a reduction from the list price. It is a reduction
granted by a supplier from the list price of goods or services.
(b) Quantity Discount: It is similar to trade discount with the
difference that it is given in case of purchasing of goods in bulk
quantity.
(c) Cash Discount: It is a reduction granted by a supplier from the
invoice price in consideration of immediate payment or payment
within a stipulated period.
Thus, quantity discount is similar to trade discount. However, cash
discount is different from trade discount.
Distinction between trade discount and cash discount can be put as
follows:
(a) Meaning: A trade discount is a reduction granted by the supplier
from the list price on total amount of sales, while a cash discount
is a reduction for prompt payment or payment within a stipulated
time period.
(b) Objective: The objective of trade discount is to promote sales,
while the objective of cash discount is quick collection of
payment.
(c) Time: Trade discount is allowed at the time of purchasing of goods,
while cash discount is allowed at the time of making payment.
(d) Disclosure: Trade discount is shown as reduction in the invoice
itself, while cash discount is not shown in the invoice. Moreover,
trade discount account is not opened in the ledger, while cash
discount account is opened in the ledger.
(e) Variation: Trade discount may vary with the quantity of goods
purchased, while cash discount may vary with time period within
which payment is received.
Self-Instructional
112 Material
13. Manager’s Commissions: The manager of a firm may be given a Preparation of Trial Balance
and Final Accounts, and
certain percentage of net profit. This percentage of commission may Depreciation Accounting
be before or after charging of such commission. The computation of
commission can be understood with the following example.
NOTES
Example:
Net Profit before charging commision: `10,000.
Manager’s Commission 10% of Net Profit before charging his
commission.
The Manager’s Commission can be computed as under:
10
= `10,000 × 100 `1,000
However, if the manager’s commission is 10% of Net profit after
charging his commission, the amount of commission will be computed as
follows:
10
`10,000 × `909
= 100
This can be verified as under:
Net Profit before charging commission = `10,000
Less: Manager’s Commission = `909
Net Profit after charging commission = 9,091
Thus, manager’ commission of `909 is 10% of firm’s net profits after
charging commisson.
Accounting (Closing) Entries for Preparing Profit and Loss Account
The following journal entries will be passed in the Journal Proper for
preparing the Profit and Loss Account.
(i) For transfer of items of expenses, losses, etc., appearing on the debit
side of the Trial Balance
Profit and Loss Account Dr.
To Salaries
To Rent
To Commission
To Advertisements
To Bad Debts
To Discount
To Printing and Stationery
(ii) For transfer of items of incomes, gains, etc., appearing on the credit
side of the Trial Balance
Interest Account Dr.
Dividends Account Dr.
Discount Account Dr.
Self-Instructional
To Profit and Loss Account Material 113
Preparation of Trial Balance (iii) For transfer of net profit or net loss:
and Final Accounts, and
Depreciation Accounting In case the total of the credit side of the Profit and Loss Account is
greater than the debit side of the Profit and Loss Account, the difference is
termed as Net Profit. In a reverse case, it will be termed as Net Loss. The
NOTES
amount of Net Profit or Net Loss shown by the Profit and Loss Account will
be transferred to Capital Account in case of sole proprietary firm. In case
of a partnership firm, the amount of net profit or net loss will be transferred
to the Partners’ Capital Accounts in the agreed ratio. In the absence of any
agreement, the partners will share profits and losses equally.
For transfer of Profit
Profit and Loss Account Dr.
To Capital Account(s)
For transfer of Net Loss
Capital Account(s) Dr.
To Profit and Loss Account
Illustration 3.6. From the following balances, taken from the Trial Balance
of Shri Suresh, prepare a Trading and Profit and Loss Account for the year
ending 31st Dec., 2017:
Particulars Dr. ` Cr. `
Stock on 1.1.2017 2,000
Purchases and Sales 20,000 30,000
Returns 2,000 1,000
Carriage 1,000
Cartage 1,000
Rent 1,000
Interest Received 2,000
Salaries 2,000
General Expenses 1,000
Discount 500
Insurance 500
The Closing Stock on 31st December, 2017 is `5,000.
Solution:
TRADING AND PROFIT AND LOSS ACCOUNT
Dr. for the year ending 31st December, 2017 Cr.
Particulars ` Particulars `
To Opening Stock 2,000 BySales 30,000
To Purchases 20,000 Less: Returns 2,000 28,000
Less: Returns 1,000 19,000 By Closing Stock 5,000
To Carriage 1,000
To Cartage 1,000
To Gross Profit c/d 10,000
33,000 33,000
To Rent 1,000 By Gross Profit b/d 10,000
To Salaries 2,000 By Interest 2,000
To General Expenses 1,000 By Discount 500
To Discount 1,000
To Insurance 500
To Net Profit taken to Capital Account 8,000
Self-Instructional 12,500 12,500
114 Material
Importance of Profit and Loss Account Preparation of Trial Balance
and Final Accounts, and
Depreciation Accounting
The Profit and Loss Account provides information regarding the following
matters:
(i) Ascertainment of net profit (or loss): It provides information about NOTES
the net profit or net loss earned or suffered by the business during a
particular period. Thus, it is an index of the profitability or otherwise
of the business.
(ii) Comparative study: The Profit figure disclosed by the Profit and Loss
Account for a particular period can be compared with that of the other
period. Thus, it helps in ascertaining whether the business is being run
efficiently or not.
(iii) Controlling expenses: An analysis of the various expenses included
in the Profit and Loss Account and their comparison with the expenses
of the previous period or periods helps in taking steps for effective
control of the various expenses.
(iv) Providing for contingencies: Allocation of profit among the different
periods or setting aside a part of the profit for future contingencies can
be done.
(v) Prospective planning: On the basis for profit figures of the current
and the previous period estimates about the profit in the year to come
can be made. These projections will help the business in planning the
future course of action.
3.3.3 Preparation of Manufacturing Account
In the preceding pages, we have explained the preparation of the Trading
and Profit and Loss Account from the point of view of a trade, i.e., a person
who purchases and sells goods. However, a person may manufacture goods
by himself for selling them at a profit. In case of such a person, i.e., a
manufacturer, it will be necessary to ascertain the cost of manufacturing the
goods. In his case, therefore, the profit or loss made by him will be ascertained
by preparing the following three accounts:
(i) Manufacturing account: This account gives the cost of the goods
manufactured by a manufacturer during a particular period.
(ii) Trading account: This account gives information about the gross
profit or loss made by a manufacturer in selling the manufactured
goods. In case a manufacturer also functions as a trader, i.e., besides
manufacturing and selling goods of his own, he also purchases and
sells goods of others, he will be a manufacturer-cum-trader. In such
a case, his Trading Account will disclose not only the profit made by
him on selling his manufactured goods, but also the profit made by
him in selling the goods purchased by him from others.
Self-Instructional
Material 115
Preparation of Trial Balance (iii) Profit and Loss account: This account gives the overall profit or loss
and Final Accounts, and
Depreciation Accounting made or suffered by the manufacturer or manufacturer-cum-trader
during a particular period. The proforma of a Manufacturing Account
is given below:
NOTES MANUFACTURING ACCOUNT
Dr. for the year ending......... Cr.
Particulars ` Particulars `
To Work-in-process (Opening) ........ By Work-in-process (Closing) .......
To Raw Materials consumed: By Sale of Scrap .......
Opening Stock ........ By Cost of Production of
Add: Purchases of Raw Finished Goods during the
Materials ........ Period transferred to the ........
Less: Closing Stock of ........ Trading Account
Raw Materials ........ ........
To Direct or Productive wages ........
To Factory Overheads:
Power and Fuel ........
Repairs of Plant ........
Depreciation on Plant ....... ........
Factory Rent ........ ........ ........
The Gross Profit or Loss shown by the Trading Account will be taken
to the Profit and Loss Account which will be prepared in the usual way as
explained in the preceding pages.
Important Points Regarding Manufacturing Account
1. Stock: In case of a manufacturer, there can be stocks of three types:
(i) Stock of Raw Materials: It includes stock of raw materials or finished
components which might have been purchased by the manufacturer for
using them in the products manufactured by him but still lying unsold.
(ii) Stock of Work-in-process: This is also termed as stock of work-in-
progress. It includes goods in semi-finished form.
Self-Instructional
116 Material
(iii) Stock of Finished Goods: It includes stock of those goods which Preparation of Trial Balance
and Final Accounts, and
have been completely processed and are lying unsold at the end of a Depreciation Accounting
period with the manufacturer. It also includes stock of those finished
goods which might have been purchased by a manufacturer-cum-trader
from outside parties, but still lying unsold with him at the end of the NOTES
accounting period.
2. Raw Materials Consumed: It is customary to show in the
Manufacturing Account, the value of raw materials consumed for
manufacturing goods during a particular period. This is computed as
follows:
Opening Stock of Raw Materials .......
Add: Purchase of Raw Materials .......
.......
Less: Closing Stock of Raw Materials .......
Raw Materials Consumed
.......
For example, if the opening stock of raw materials is `5,000, purchases
of raw materials is `20,000 and closing stock of raw materials is `8,000, the
value of raw materials consumed will be calculated as follows:
` `
Opening Stock of Raw Materials 5,000
Add: Purchase of Raw Materials 20,000 25,000
Less: Closing Stock of Raw Materials 8,000
Raw Materials Consumed 17,000
Carriage Inwards, etc.: The expenses incurred for bringing the raw
3.
materials to the factory or the octroi or customs duty paid by the
manufacturer on the raw materials purchased or imported by him will
also be charged to Manufacturing Account.
Factory Overheads: The term ‘‘Overheads’’ includes indirect material,
4.
indirect labour and indirect expenses. The term ‘‘Factory Overheads’’,
therefore, stands for all factory indirect material, indirect labour, and
indirect expenses. For example, in case of a manufacturer of chairs, the
cost of timber purchased will be taken as raw materials. However, the
polishing material used by him will be taken as indirect material and
will be taken as an item of factory overheads. Similarly, the wages paid
to the carpenters who have been employed for making chairs will come
as cost of direct labour since they are actively engaged in manufacturing
the chairs. However, the salaries of the supervisor or the wages of the
gatekeeper will be taken as indirect labour cost and come in the definition
of factory overheads. Similarly, the carriage charges paid for bringing
the raw materials to the factory are considered to be direct charges since
they can directly be charged to the raw materials purchased. However,
the rent for the factory, depreciation of the factory machines, insurance
Self-Instructional
Material 117
Preparation of Trial Balance of the factory are all taken as indirect factory expenses and, therefore,
and Final Accounts, and
Depreciation Accounting covered under the category of factory overheads.
Cost of Production: The Manufacturing Account gives the cost of
5.
manufacturing the goods during a particular period. This is computed
NOTES
by deducting from the total of the debit side of the Manufacturing
Account, the total of the various items appearing on the credit side of the
Manufacturing Account as shown in the proforma of the Manufacturing
Account given earlier in the chapter.
Sale of Scrap: In manufacturing operations, certain scrap is
6.
unavoidable. It may or may not have any sales value. In order to
calculate the true cost of manufacturing the goods, it is necessary that
the money realised on account of sale of scrap (or realisable value of
the scrap in case it had not been sold) should be considered. The amount
of scrap is, therefore, credited to the Manufacturing Account.
Illustration 3.7. From the following details, prepare a Manufacturing and a
Trading Account for the year ending 31st December, 2017.
`
Stock on 1.1.2017:
Raw Materials 10,000
Work-in-Process 5,000
Finished Goods 20,000
Stock on 31.12.2017:
Raw Materials 5,000
Work-in-Process 15,000
Finished Goods 30,000
Purchase of Raw Materials 50,000
Direct Wages 10,000
Carriage Charges on purchase of raw materials 5,000
Factory Power 5,000
Depreciation on Factory Machines 5,000
Purchase of Finished Goods 30,000
Cartage paid on Finished Goods purchased 2,000
Solution:
MANUFACTURING ACCOUNT
for the year ending 31.12.2017
Particulars ` Particulars `
To Work-in-process on 1.1.2017 5,000 By Work-in-process
on 31.12.2017 15,000
To Raw Materials consumed By Cost of Production
transferred to Trading 70,000
Account
Stock on 1.1.2017 10,000
Add : Purchases 50,000
60,000
Self-Instructional
Less: Closing Stock 5,000 55,000
118 Material
Particulars ` Particulars ` Preparation of Trial Balance
To Direct Wages 10,000 and Final Accounts, and
Depreciation Accounting
To Carriage Charges 5,000
To Factory Power 5,000
To Depreciation on Factory
Machines 5,000 NOTES
85,000 85,000
TRADING ACCOUNT
for the year ending 31.12.2017
Particulars ` Particulars `
To Stock of Finished Goods By Stock of Finished Goods
on 1.1.2017 20,000 on 31.12.2017 30,000
To Cost of Production of By Sale of Finished Goods 1,00,000
Finished Goods Transferred
from Manufacturing Account 70,000
To Purchases of Finished
Goods 30,000
To Cartage on Finished
Goods Purchased 2,000
To Gross Profit Transferred
to Profit and Loss A/c 8,000
1,30,000 1,30,000
Self-Instructional
Material 119
Preparation of Trial Balance It will be useful here to quote definitions of the Balance Sheet given
and Final Accounts, and
Depreciation Accounting by some prominent writers. According to Palmer, ‘‘The Balance Sheet is
a statement at a given date showing on one side the trader’s property and
possessions and on the other side his liabilities.’’ According to Freeman, ‘‘A
NOTES Balance Sheet is an itemised list of the assets, liabilities and proprietorship
of the business of an individual at a certain date.’’ The definition given by
the American Institute of Certified Public Accountants makes the meaning of
Balance Sheet more clear. According to it, Balance Sheet is ‘‘a list of balances
of the asset and liability accounts. This list depicts the position of assets and
liabilities of a specific business at a specific point of time.’’
Proforma of Balance Sheet and Principle of Marshalling
Marshalling: There is no prescribed form of Balance Sheet for a sole
proprietary and partnership firm.2 However, the principle of marshalling is
applied while arranging the assets and liabilities in the balance sheet of a
firm. Marshalling refers to arrangement of assets and liabilities in the balance
sheet in any of the following order:
1. Liquidity Order 2. Permanency Order
1. Liquidity Order: In case a concern adopts liquidity order, the assets which
are more readily convertible into cash come first and those which cannot be
so readily converted come next and so on. Similarly, those liabilities which
are payable first come first, and those payable later, come next and so on.
A proforma of Balance Sheet according to liquidity order is given below:
BALANCE SHEET
as on .......
Liabilities ` Assets `
Bank Overdraft ....... Cash in Hand .......
Outstanding Expenses ....... Cash at Bank .......
Bills Payable ....... Prepaid Expenses .......
Sundry Creditors ....... Bills Receivable .......
Long-term Loans ....... Sundry Debtors .......
Capital ....... Closing Stock:
Raw Materials .......
Work-in-Progress .......
Finished Goods ....... .......
Plant and Machinery .......
Furniture .......
Building .......
Land .......
Goodwill .......
....... .......
Self-Instructional
Material 121
Preparation of Trial Balance Important Points Regarding Balance Sheet
and Final Accounts, and
Depreciation Accounting
1. Liabilities: The term ‘‘Liabilities’’ denotes claims against the assets of a
firm, whether those of owners of the business or of the creditors. As a matter
NOTES of fact, the term “Equity” is more appropriate than the term “Liabilities”. This
is supported by the definition given by American Accounting Association.
According to this Association, Liabilities are “claims of the creditors against
the enterprise arising out of past activities that are to be satisfied by the
disbursement or utilisation of corporate resources”. While the term “Equity”
stands both for owners equity (owners claims) as well as the outsiders equity
(outsiders claims). However, for the sake of convenience, we are using the
term “Liabilities” for the purposes of this book.
Liabilities can be classified into two categories:
(i) Current Liabilities (ii) Long-Term or Fixed Liabilities
Current liabilities: The term “Current Liabilities” is used for such liabilities
which are payable within a year from the date of the Balance Sheet either out
of existing current assets or by creation of new current liabilities. The broad
categories of current liabilities are as follows:
(a) Accounts Payable, i.e., bills payable and trade creditors.
(b) Outstanding Expenses, i.e., expenses for which services have been
received by the business but for which payments have not been made.
(c) Bank Overdraft.
(d) Short-term Loans, i.e., loans from Bank which are payable within one
year from the date of the Balance Sheet.
(e) Advance payments received by the business for the services to be
rendered or goods to be supplied in future.
Fixed liabilities: All liabilities other than Current Liabilities come within
this category. In other words, these are the liabilities which do not become
due for payment in one year and which do not require current assets for their
payment.
2. Assets: The term ‘‘Assets’’ denotes the resources acquired by the business
from the funds made available either by the owners of the business or
others. It thus includes all rights or properties which a business owns. Cash,
investments, bills receivable, debtors, stock of raw materials, work-in-
progress and finished goods, land, buildings, machinery, trademarks, patent
rights, etc., are some examples of assets.
Assets may be classified into the following categories:
(a) Current assets: Current Assets are those assets which are acquired with
the intention of converting them into cash during the normal business
operations of the enterprise. According to Grady, ‘‘the term Current
Self-Instructional
122 Material
Assets is used to designate cash and other assets or resources commonly Preparation of Trial Balance
and Final Accounts, and
identified as those which are reasonably expected to be realised in cash Depreciation Accounting
or sold during the normal operating cycle of the business.’’3 Thus,
the term “Current Assets” includes cash and bank balances, stocks
of raw materials, work-in-progress and finished goods, debtors, bills NOTES
receivable, short-term investments, prepaid expenses, etc.
(b) Liquid assets: Liquid Assets are those assets which are immediately
convertible into cash without much loss. Liquid Assets are a part of
current asset. In computing liquid assets, stock of raw materials, work-
in-progress and finished goods and prepaid expenses are excluded while
all other current assets are taken.
(c) Fixed assets: Fixed assets are those assets which are acquired for
relatively long periods for carrying on the business of the enterprise.
They are not meant for resale. Land and building, machinery, furniture
are some of the examples of Fixed Assets. Sometimes, the term “Block
Capital” is also used for them.
(d) Intangible assets: Intangible Assets are those assets which cannot
be seen and touched. Goodwill, patents, trademarks, etc., are some
examples of Intangible Assets.
(e) Fictitious assets: There are assets not represented by tangible
possession or property. Examples of such assets are formation expenses
incurred for establishing a business such as registration charge paid
to the Registrar of joint stock companies for getting a company
incorporated, discount on issue of shares, debit balance in the Profit
and Loss Account when shown on the assets side in case of a joint
stock company etc.
Valuation of Assets: The following requirements of various accounting
standards (ASs) should be kept in mind while valuing assets.
(i) The cost of a fixed asset should comprise its purchase price and any
attributable costs of bringing the asset to its working condition for its
intended use. (AS 10)
(ii) Goodwill should be recorded in the books only when some consideration
in money or money’s worth has been paid for it. (AS 10)
(iii) The direct costs incurred in developing the patents should be capitalised,
and written off over their legal term of validity or over their working
life, whichever is shorter. (AS 10)
(iv) Amount paid for knowhow for the plants, lay-out and designs of
building and/or design of the machiery should be capitalised under
the relevant asset heads, such as buildings, plants and machinery, etc.,
(AS 10)
3. Paul Grady, ‘‘Inventory of Generally Accepted Accounting Principles for Business Enterprises’’,
pages 234-35. Self-Instructional
Material 123
Preparation of Trial Balance (v) If the recoverable amount of an asset is less than its carrying amount,
and Final Accounts, and
Depreciation Accounting i.e., it has become an impaired asset, the carrying amount of the asset
should be reduced to its recoverable amount. That reduction is an
impairment loss. Impairment loss should be recognised as an expense in
NOTES the statement of profit and loss immediately, unless the asset is carried
at revalued amount in accordance with another Accounting Standard
(see Accounting Standard (AS) 10, Accounting for Fixed Assets), in
which case any impairment loss of a revalued asset should be treated
as a revaluation decrease under that Accounting Standard. (AS 28)
(vi) The current assets are meant for converting into cash during the normal
operating cycle of business, hence, they are valued on the principle of
‘‘cost or market price whichever is less’’.
(vii) Assets and liabilities should be adjusted for events occurring after
the balance sheet date that provide additional evidence to assist the
estimation of amounts relating to conditions existing at the balance
sheet date or that indicates that the fundamental accounting assumption
of going concern (i.e., the continuance of existence or substratum of
the enterprise) is not appropriate. (AS 4)
Illustration 3.8. From the following balance extracted from the books of M/s
Rajendra Kumar Gupta & Co., pass the necessary closing entries, prepare a
Trading and Profit and Loss Account and a Balance Sheet.
Particulars ` Particulars `
Opening Stock 1,250 Plant and Machinery 6,230
Sales 11,800 Returns Outwards 1,380
Depreciation 667 Cash in hand 895
Commission (Cr.) 211 Salaries 750
Insurance 380 Debtors 1,905
Carriage Inwards 300 Discount (Dr.) 328
Furniture 670 Bills Receivable 2,730
Printing Charges 481 Wages 1,589
Carriage Outwards 200 Returns Inwards 1,659
Capital 9,228 Bank Overdraft 4,000
Creditors 1,780 Purchases 8,679
Bills Payable 541 Petty Cash in hand 47
Bad Debts 180
Self-Instructional
124 Material
Date Particulars Dr. Amt ` Cr. Amt ` Preparation of Trial Balance
To Trading A/c 13,180 and Final Accounts, and
(For closing all accounts to be credited to the Trading A/c) Depreciation Accounting
BALANCE SHEET
as on 31st December, 2017
Liabilities ` Assets `
Bills Payable 541 Cash 895
Creditors 1,780 Petty Cash 47
Bank Overdraft 4,000 Bills Receivable 2,730
Capital 9,228 Debtors 1,905
Add: Net Profit 628 9,856 Closing Stock 3,700
Plant and Machinery 6,230
Furniture 670
16,177 16,177
Illustration 9.9. From the following Trial Balance prepare the Manufacturing
Account, Trading and Profit and Loss Account for the year ending 31st March,
2017 and the Balance Sheet as on that date: Self-Instructional
Material 125
Preparation of Trial Balance Particulars Debit ` Credit `
and Final Accounts, and Shri Banker’s Capital Account 41,000
Depreciation Accounting Shri Banker’s Drawing Account 6,100
Mrs Banker’s Loan Account 4,000
Sundry Creditors 45,000
NOTES Cash in Hand
Cash at Bank
250
4,000
Sundry Debtors 40,500
Patents 2,000
Plant and Machinery 20,000
Land and Buildings 26,000
Purchases of Raw Materials 35,000
Raw Material as on 1.4.2016 3,500
Work-in-process as on 1.4.2016 2,000
Finished Stock as on 1.4.2016 18,000
Carriage Inwards 1,100
Wages 27,000
Salary of Works Manager 5,600
Factory Expenses 3,400
Factory Rent and Taxes 2,500
Royalties (paid on sales) 1,200
Sales (less Returns) 1,23,400
Advertising 3,000
Office Rent and Insurance 4,800
Printing and Stationery 1,000
Office Expenses 5,800
Carriage Outwards 600
Discounts 1,400 2,100
Bad Debts 750
2,15,500 2,15,500
BALANCE SHEET
as on 31st March, 2017
Particulars ` Particulars `
Sundry Creditors 45,000 Current Assets:
Mrs. Banker’s Loan 4,000 Cash in hand 250
Capital Account Cash at Bank 4,000
Balance on Sundry Debtors 40,500
1.4.2016 41,000 Closing Stock:
Profit 45,350 Raw Materials 4,000
86,350 Work-in-process
4,500
Less: Drawings 6,100 80,250 F i n i s h e d g o o d s 36,500
28,000
Fixed Assets:
Patents 2,000
Plant and Machinery 20,000
Land and Buildings 26,000
1,29,250 1,29,250
Self-Instructional
Material 127
Preparation of Trial Balance ERRORS
and Final Accounts, and
Depreciation Accounting
OMISSION COMMISSION PRINCIPLE COMPENSATING
Clerical errors may be of three kinds. These are explained here below.
NOTES
I. Clerical Errors
These include the following errors:
1. Errors of omission: These errors are incurred in those cases when a
transaction is completely omitted from the books of account. It happens
when a transaction is not recorded in the books of the original entry
(i.e., various journals). For example, if a purchase of goods on credit
from Shri Ram Lal has not at all been recorded in the books of account,
such an error will be termed as an error of omission. Since, there has
been neither a debit entry nor a credit entry, therefore, the two sides
of the Trial Balance will not be at all affected on account of this error.
Such errors, therefore, cannot be located out very easily. They come to
the notice of the businessman when statement of accounts are received
from or sent to creditors or debtors, as the case may be.
2. Errors of commission: Such errors include errors on account of wrong
balancing of an account, wrong posting, wrong carry forwards, wrong
totalling, etc. For example, if a sum of ` 50 received from Mukesh
is credited to his account as ` 500, this is an error of commission.
Similarly, if the total of debit side of an account is carried forward
from one page to another and the mistake is committed in such carry
forward (e.g., total of ` 996 is carried forward as ` 699) such an error
is an error of commission. Errors of commission affect the agreement
of the Trial Balance and, therefore, their location is easier.
3. Errors of principle: Errors of principle are committed, where a
proper distinction between revenue and capital items is not made, i.e.,
a capital expenditure is taken as a revenue expenditure or vice versa,
or a capital receipt may have been taken as a revenue receipt or vice
versa. For example, a sale of old furniture of ` 500 should be credited
to the Furniture Account, but if it is credited to the Sales Account, it
will be termed as an error of principle. Sale of old furniture is a capital
receipt. If it is credited to Sales Account, it has been taken as a revenue
receipt. Such errors by themselves do not affect the agreement of the
Trial Balance. Therefore, they are also difficult to be located.
4. Compensating errors: As the name indicates, compensating errors
are those errors which compensate each other. For example, if a sale of
` 500 to Ram is debited as only of ` 50 to his account, while a sale of
` 50 to Shyam is debited as of ` 500 to his account, it is a compensating
error. These errors also do not affect the agreement of the Trial Balance
Self-Instructional and, therefore, their location is also difficult.
128 Material
Thus, errors of omission, errors of principle and compensating errors Preparation of Trial Balance
and Final Accounts, and
by themselves alone do not affect the agreement of the Trial Balance. In Depreciation Accounting
case these errors get combined with errors of commission, they may affect
the agreement of the Trial Balance. For example, if a sale of old furniture of
` 500 is credited to the Sales Account only as of ` 50, the error combines in NOTES
itself both an error of principle as well as error of commission. Thus, such
an error will affect the agreement of the Trial Balance.
Location of Errors
Location of errors of principle, errors of compensating nature and errors
of omission is slightly difficult because of the fact that such errors do not
affect the agreement of the Trial Balance and, therefore, their location may
be considerably delayed. However, location of errors of commission is
comparatively easier because they affect the agreement of the Trial Balance.
Thus, the errors can be classified into two categories from the point of view
of locating them:
(i) Errors which do not affect the agreement of the Trial Balance.
(ii) Errors which affect the agreement of the Trial Balance.
Errors which do not affect the agreement of the trial balance: As stated
before, errors of omission, errors of commission and errors of compensating
nature by themselves do not affect the agreement of the Trial Balance. Their
location is, therefore, a difficult process. They are usually found out when
statement of accounts are received by the business or sent to the customers
or during the course of internal or external audit and sometimes by chance.
For example, if a credit purchase of ` 500 from Ram has not been recorded
in the books of accounts, the error will not affect the agreement of the Trial
Balance and, therefore, at the time of finalising the accounts it may not be
traced out. However, this will be found out when a statement of account is
sent to Ram showing the money due to him or when a statement of account
is received from Ram showing the money recoverable by him.
Errors which affect the agreement of the trial balance: Such errors are
easy to be located since they are caught at an early stage. As soon as the Trial
Balance does not tally, the accountant can proceed to find out these errors. The
procedure to be followed for location of such errors can be put as follows:
(i) The difference of the two sides of the Trial Balance should be found
out. The amount should then be divided by two. The two sides of the
Trial Balance should then be checked to find out if there is an amount
equal to that figure. It is possible that the amount was placed on a
wrong side resulting in a difference in the totals of the Trial Balance.
For example, if the total of the debit side of the Trial Balance is ` 450
more than the credit side of the Trial Balance, ` 450 should be divided
by 2, thus giving a figure of 225. The debit side should then be checked
Self-Instructional
Material 129
Preparation of Trial Balance to find out if there is an amount of ` 225 appearing on that side. If it
and Final Accounts, and
Depreciation Accounting is so, it should be seen whether the amount has been correctly put to
that side or it should have gone to the credit side.
(ii) If the mistake is not found out by taking step number (i), the difference
NOTES
should be divided by 9. If the difference is completely divisible, it can
be error of transposition of figures. For example, if the figure of 698
is written as 986, the difference is of ` 198. This figure is completely
divisible by 9. Thus it can be concluded that in such cases where the
difference is divisible by 9, there can be a probability of this type of
error.
(iii) In case the difference is still not traceable, the following further
possibilities should be checked:
(a) If the difference is in a round figure, there is a possibility of wrong
casting or wrong carry forwards of the totals of a subsidiary books
or there is an error in balancing the accounts.
(b) In case the difference is not in a round figure, there is a possibility
of error being committed in posting the transactions from the
Journal to the Ledger.
(c) If the difference is of a substantial amount, it will be appropriate
to compare the Trial Balance of the current year with the Trial
Balance of the preceding year and see whether there is any
abnormal difference between the balances of important accounts
of the two Trial Balances.
(iv) Since, cash and bank account are not maintained usually in the Ledger,
it will be also advisable to check whether the balances of the cash and
bank accounts have been taken in the Trial Balance or not.
(v) The schedules of sundry debtors and sundry creditors should be checked
to find out whether all balances of debtors and creditors have been
included in these schedules or not.
(vi) The totals of the subsidiary books such as the Sales Book, Purchases
Book should be checked and it should be seen whether posting has
been done from these two books correctly to the Sales, Purchases or
other accounts as the case might be.
(vii) If the error is still not traceable, check thoroughly the books of original
entry and their posting into the Ledger and finally the balancing of
different accounts.
(viii) A business may keep ledgers on sectional self-balancing system. In such
a case, there are three ledgers: (a) Sales Ledger containing personal
accounts of all trade debtors, (b) Purchases Ledger containing personal
accounts of all trade creditors, and (c) General Ledger containing all
other real, nominal and personal accounts except those of trade debtors
Self-Instructional
130 Material
and trade creditors. However, there will be two total accounts in this Preparation of Trial Balance
and Final Accounts, and
ledger. (i) Total Debtors Accounts, and (ii) Total Creditors Account. Depreciation Accounting
The balance of the Total Debtors Account should tally with the total of
the Schedule of Debtors as prepared from the Sales Ledger. Similarly,
the balance of the Total Creditors Account should tally with the total NOTES
of the Schedule of Creditors as prepared from the Purchases Ledger.
In case the balance of Total Debtors Account does not tally with the
total of the Schedule of Debtors, the personal accounts in the Sales
Ledger should be checked and the other Ledger may not be touched.
Same is true of the Total Creditors Account and the Schedule of Total
Creditors.
Suspense Account
The accountant should take the above-mentioned steps one after the other
to locate the difference in the totals of the Trial Balance. In case he is not
in position to locate the difference and he is in hurry to close the books of
accounts, he may transfer the difference to an account known as “Suspense
Account”. Thus, Suspense Account is an account to which the difference in the
Trial Balance has been put temporarily. On locating the errors in the beginning
or during the course of the next year, suitable accounting entries are passed
(as explained later) and the Suspense Account is closed. However, it should
be noted that Suspense Account should be opened by the accountant only
when he has failed to locate the errors in spite of his best efforts. It should
not be by way of normal practice, because the very existence of the Suspense
Account creates doubt about the authenticity of the books of accounts. The
result shown by the books of accounts may not be trusted by the proprietors,
tax officials and other government authorities in such a case. This may create
complications for the business.
Rectifying Accounting Entries
The errors committed in the books of accounts when located out, have to be
corrected. However, corrections in the books of accounts should be done by
passing proper rectifying entries and not by cutting or erasing figures. Such
entries, as explained earlier, are passed in the General Journal or Journal
Proper. The passing of proper rectifying entries is being explained below
with suitable examples.
Example 1: The Sales Book overcast by ` 50.
Overcasting of Sales Book will result in over-credit to Sales Account by ` 50
since the total of the Sales Book is posted to the credit of the Sales Account
at the end of a period. There can be two situations in such a case:
(i) The error might have been located out by the accountant before
transferring the difference to the Suspense Account. In such a case,
there is mistake only in one account, i.e., the Sales Account. It has been
Self-Instructional
Material 131
Preparation of Trial Balance credited more by ` 50. The error can be rectified if the Sales Account
and Final Accounts, and
Depreciation Accounting is debited by ` 50. Thus, the following will be the rectifying entry in
the Journal Proper:
The Sales Account has been credited more by ` 50. In order to rectify the error,
the Sales Account should, therefore, be debited by ` 50. Suspense Account
has been debited because of this mistake which has now been found out. It
should therefore, be closed by giving credit to it. The rectifying accounting
entry should, therefore, be passed as follows:
Particulars Dr. ` Cr. `
Sales Account Dr. 50
To Suspense Account 50
Example 2: A credit sale of ` 100 to Ramesh has been entered in the Sales
Book as a sale of ` 1,000.
In order to pass a rectifying entry, it will be appropriate to find out the accounts
involved. In this case, the error involves two accounts: (i) Sales Account,
and (ii) The account of Ramesh. This is because the posting is done in the
individual accounts from the Sales Book and, therefore, if a transaction is
wrongly recorded in the Sales Book (which is the book of original entry)
not only the total of the Sales Book will be wrong, but also the entry in the
personal account will be wrong as shown below:
Sales Book
Particulars `
Sales to Ramesh (wrongly recorded in place of ` 100) 1,000
Self-Instructional
Sales Account Cr. 1,000
132 Material
Ledger Preparation of Trial Balance
and Final Accounts, and
Dr. RameshCr. Depreciation Accounting
Particulars ` Particulars `
To Sales A/c 1,000
NOTES
Dr. Sales Account Cr.
Particulars ` Particulars `
By Sundries (including sales to 1,000
Ramesh)
The recording of the transactions as shown above shows that the Sales
Account has been credited by ` 1,000 in place of ` 100. Similarly, the
account of Ramesh has been debited by ` 1,000 in place of ` 100. Thus,
Sales Account has been over-credited by ` 900, while the account of
Ramesh has been over-debited by ` 900. In order to set the matters
right, Sales Account should now be debited by ` 900 and the account
of Ramesh should be credited by ` 900. The error should not have affected
the agreement of the Trial Balance because of the same amount being put
to the debit as well as the credit sides. The Suspense Account is, therefore,
not at all involved.
The rectifying accounting entry will, therefore, be as follows:
Particulars Dr. ` Cr. `
Sales Account Dr. 900
To Ramesh 900
Thus, on the basis of the above examples, the following rules can be
framed out:
(i) Find out the accounts affected by the error.
(ii) Find out what should have been and what has been done.
(iii) Credit or Debit the respective account in order to set the matters
right.
(iv) Put the difference to Suspense Account.
The above rules will be further clear by the following example.
Example 5: A sales of ` 1,000 to Suresh was entered in the Purchases Book
from where the account of Suresh was debited by ` 100.
The above error affects the following accounts: (i) Sales Account,
(ii) Purchases Account, and (iii) Account of Suresh.
Sales Account should have been credited by a sum of ` 1,000. It has
not been done since it has been recorded in the Purchases Book. Thus, Sales
Account should be credited (i.e., what should have been done).
Purchases Account has been debited since the transaction has been
entered in the Purchases Book from where it must have been posted to the
Purchases Account. It has been debited by a sum of ` 1,000 unnecessarily.
It should, therefore, be credited to rectify what has been done wrongly.
Self-Instructional
134 Material
Account of Suresh should have been debited by ` 1,000. In the normal Preparation of Trial Balance
and Final Accounts, and
course, since the transaction has been recorded in the Purchases Book, his Depreciation Accounting
account should have been credited. However, the accountant has debited his
account by ` 100 instead of ` 1,000. His account should, therefore, be debited
by ` 900 more in order to give full debit to his account. NOTES
The difference, if any, should be transferred to the Suspense Account
as given in rule (iv) explained above.
The rectifying journal entry will, therefore, be as follows:
Particulars Dr. ` Cr. `
Suspense A/c Dr. 1,100
Sales A/c Dr. 900
To Purchases A/c 1,000
To Sales A/c 1,000
Dr. Cr.
` `
Total as per Trial Balance 3,65,000 2,26,000
Add: Opening stock understated 5,000
3,70,000 2,26,000
Less/Add: Adjustments Rent and rates overstated (27,000)
Sundry Creditors— understated 63,000
Sundry Debtors—Overstated (54,000)
Correct Total 2,89,000 2,89,000
Self-Instructional
Material 135
Preparation of Trial Balance
and Final Accounts, and 3.5 CLASSIFICATION OF CAPITAL AND REVENUE
Depreciation Accounting
Implications of AS 26
Accounting Standards 26: ‘‘Intangible Assets’’ has almost eliminated the NOTES
concept of deferred revenue expenditure. The standard is now applicable to
all enterprises w.e.f. 1.4.2004. According to this standard an asset should be
recognised as intangible asset when it is ‘‘an identifiable non-monetary asset,
without physical substance, held to use in the production or supply of goods
or services, for rental to others, or for administrative purposes.’’ As a result,
an expenditure on intangible item incurred after 1.4.2004, viz., preliminary
expenses, heavy advertisement expenditure, training cost, compensation for
voluntary retirement should be expensed when incurred since it does not meet
the definition of an asset as per AS 26.
Distinction between Capital Expenditure and Revenue Expenditure
The following are the points of distinction between a Capital Expenditure
and a Revenue Expenditure:
(a) Capital expenditure is incurred for acquisition of fixed assets for
the business. while revenue expenditure is incurred for day-to-day
operation of the business.
(b) Capital expenditure is incurred for increasing the earning capacity of
the business while revenue expenditure is incurred for maintaining the
earning capacity of the business.
(c) Capital expenditure is of non-recurring nature while revenue
expenditure is of a recurring nature.
(d) The benefit of capital expenditure is received over a number of years
and only a small part of it, as depreciation, is charged to the profit and
loss account each year. The rest appears in the balance sheet as an asset.
While the benefit of revenue expenditure expires in the year in which
the expenditure is incurred and it is entirely charged to the profit and
loss account of the relevant year.
Revenue Expenditure that becomes Capital Expenditure
Following are some of the circumstances under which an expenditure which is
usually of a revenue nature may be taken as an expenditure of a capital nature:
1. Repairs: The amount spent on repairs of plant, furniture, building, etc.
is usually taken as a revenue expenditure. However, when a second-
hand plant or motor-car is purchased, the expenditure incurred for
immediate repairs of such a plant or motor-car to make it fit for use
will be taken as a capital expenditure.
Self-Instructional
Material 139
Preparation of Trial Balance 2. Wages: The amount spent as wages is usually taken as a revenue
and Final Accounts, and
Depreciation Accounting expense. However, wages paid for erection of a new plant or machinery
or wages paid to workmen engaged in construction of a fixed asset are
taken as expenditure of a capital nature.
NOTES
3. Legal charges: Legal charges are usually taken as expenditure of a
revenue nature, but legal charges incurred in connection with purchase
of fixed assets should be taken as a part of the cost of the fixed asset.
4. Transport charges: Transport charges are generally of a revenue nature,
but transport charges incurred for a new plant or machinery are taken
as expenditure of a capital nature and are added to the cost of the asset.
5. Interest on capital: Interest on capital paid during the construction of
works, buildings or plant may be capitalised and thus added to the cost
of the asset concerned.
6. Raw materials and stores: They are usually taken as of a revenue nature,
but raw materials and stores consumed in construction of fixed assets
should be treated as capital expenditure and be taken as a part of the
cost of such fixed asset.
7. Development expenditure: In case of industries like tea, rubber
plantations, horticulture, etc., a long period is required for development.
They start earning only after expiry of a long period which can be
termed as development period. The expenditure incurred during such
periods is termed as Development Expenditure and may be treated as
a Capital Expenditure. For example, in the case of tea industry, it takes
4-5 years for a tea plant to mature. When a new tea garden is to be
started, new tea plants have to be planted. They have to be cared for
and looked after for at least 5 years before any tea can be manufactured.
All such expenditure during this period is development expenditure and
is, therefore, of a capital nature. However, once the tea plants begin
to bear tea leaves, the expenditure incurred to maintain them will be
revenue expenditure.
Advertising: Cost of advertising for the purpose of introducing a new
8.
product should be treated as capital expenditure, since the benefit of
such expenditure will be available only in future years.
Preliminary expenses: Expenses incurred in formation of a new
9.
company are termed as preliminary expenses and should be treated as
capital expenditure.
Expenditure covered under paras 8 and 9 are generally treated as
Deferred Revenue Expenditure and are usually written off over a period of
3–4 years.
Self-Instructional
140 Material
Revenue Loss Preparation of Trial Balance
and Final Accounts, and
Depreciation Accounting
Revenue losses are those losses which arise during the normal course of
running of the business because of fall in the value of the current assets
of the business. The term ‘Revenue Loss’ is similar to the term ‘Revenue NOTES
Expenditure’ in the respect that it is also charged to the Profit and Loss
Account of the business like Revenue Expenditure. However, the term
‘Expenditure’ is different from the term ‘loss’. Expenditure is supposed to
bring some benefit to the firm, whereas a loss brings no benefit to the firm.
For example, loss on account of bad debts, loss on account of destruction of
goods by fire, etc.
Capital Loss
It is the loss which does not arise during the normal course of running the
business. It is essentially the difference between the purchase price and the
price at which the capital asset is sold or exchanged. It thus, represents the
excess of the cost of the whole or a part of the cost of a capital asset over
the proceeds realised from its sale, transfer or exchange. For example, a
machine costing `10,000 purchased for use in the business is sold for `8,000
on account of its being found redundant. The excess of `2,000 of cost over
the sale value is the capital loss suffered by the firm.
Classification of Receipts
Receipts can be classified into two categories:
(i) Capital Receipts (ii) Revenue Receipts.
(i) Capital Receipts: Capital Receipts consist of additional payments
made to the business either by shareholders of the company or by the
proprietors of the business, or receipts from sale of fixed assets of a business.
For example, the amount raised by the company by way of share capital is a
capital receipt. Similarly, if a firm sells its machinery for a sum of `10,000,
the receipt is a capital receipt.
It should be noted that a capital receipt is different from a capital profit.
Receipt denotes receiving payment in cash. Moreover, the whole of it may or
may not be a capital profit. There may be a capital loss too. For example, if a
plant costing `10,000 is sold for `12,000 there is a capital receipt of `12,000,
but there will be a capital profit of only `2,000. Similarly, if the same plant
had been sold only for `8,000, there is a capital receipt of `8,000 but there
is a capital loss of `2,000.
(ii) Revenue Receipts: Any receipt which is not a capital receipt is
a revenue receipt. In a business most of the receipts are revenue receipts.
However, a revenue receipt is also different from revenue profit or revenue
income. Receipt denotes receiving of payment in cash. Moreover, the entire
Self-Instructional
Material 141
Preparation of Trial Balance amount of receipt may or may not be a revenue income. For example, if goods
and Final Accounts, and
Depreciation Accounting costing `20,000 are sold for `25,000, there is a revenue receipt of `25,000,
but revenue profit or income is only `5,000.
The distinction between capital and revenue is important both for
NOTES
income determination and taxation purposes. Various tests have been laid
down from time to time for distinguishing between these two. Some of these
are based on economic considerations, some on accounting principles and
some have been pronounced by the courts. However, difficulties still arise
in making a clear cut distinction between these two. There have been cases
which fall on the border line. In many cases, the policies of those incharge
of the business will decide whether certain expenditure or income should
be classified as revenue or capital. However, the rules given in the preceding
pages and illustrations given in the following pages will to a great extent
help a student in making a fairly reasonable distinction between capital and
revenue.
Illustration 3.11. State whether the following items of expenditure are of
capital or revenue nature:
(a) A second-hand car was purchased for a sum of `20,000. A sum of
`5,000 was spent on its overhauling.
(b) `1,000 was spent on painting the factory.
(c) Freight and cartage amounting to `1,000 was paid on purchase of
a new plant and a sum of `200 was spent as erection charges of that
plant.
(d) Furniture at book value of `1,500 was sold for a sum of `1,000. New
furniture of `2,000 was purchased and sum of `20 was spent towards
cartage.
Solution:
(a) The total expenditure of `25,000 should be taken as a Capital
Expenditure. The sum of `20,000 was spent on a capital asset while
another `5,000 was spent for making the capital asset fit for use.
(b) The painting charges are for maintenance of a capital asset, hence they
are of a revenue nature.
(c) The expenditure incurred by way of freight and cartage amounting to
`1,000 and the erection charges of `200 are both of a capital nature.
The former has been incurred in connection with the receipt of a capital
asset, while the later for erecting it so that it may be used for business
purposes.
(d) The loss suffered on sale of old furniture amounting to `500 should
be taken as a revenue loss. This is because the furniture was used for
business purposes and loss on its sale show that proper depreciation
was not charged. The amount spent on purchase of new furniture and
Self-Instructional
142 Material
the cartage charge should be taken as capital expenditure. The former Preparation of Trial Balance
and Final Accounts, and
represents the cost of acquisition of a capital asset while the latter Depreciation Accounting
represents the cost incurred for receipt of such a capital asset, to make
it available for use in the business.
NOTES
Illustration 3.12. Classify the following as Capital Expenditure or Deferred
Revenue Expenditure giving brief reasons for each.
(i) Cost of `30,000 for dismantling, removing and reinstalling a plant by
a Sugar Mill incurred in connection with the removal of works to a
more suitable locality.
(ii) A sum of `10,000 spent for alteration of an existing plant incorporating
thereby new devices which could affect substantial reduction in power
consumption.
(iii) Imported goods worth `25,000 confiscated by Customs Authorities for
non-disclosure of material facts.
Solution:
(i) The expenditure of `30,000 incurred on dismantling, removing and
reinstalling the plant to a more suitable locality should strictly be treated
as a deferred revenue expenditure. This is because the expenditure has
not resulted in any tangible asset. Moreover, the increase in profit in
view of the new location is difficult to assess exactly. The expenditure
can be written off over a period of 4 or 5 years until then the amount
not yet written off should be shown in the Balance Sheet on the asset
side.
It may also not be wrong to write off the entire expenditure of
`30,000 from the Profit and Loss Account of the current year, since
the expenditure of `30,000 is quite small for a factory manufacturing
sugar and which must therefore be large in size.
(ii) The expenditure of `10,000, on alteration of the existing plant to
incorporate a new device, leading to reduced consumption of power
in future should be treated as a Capital Expenditure. This is because it
will result in definite savings in the years to come. Depreciation may
be charged on the increased value of the machine, on account of this
expenditure being capitalised.
(iii) The confiscation of imported goods by the customs authorities is a loss.
Of course, the loss has arisen on account of gross negligence and is
of an abnormal nature. It will be better to write it off from the Profit
and Loss Account as a revenue loss, with proper description. This
course of action should be adopted only when the amount of loss is
small in relation to the current year’s profit. However, if the profits of
the current year are inadequate, the loss may be treated as a deferred
revenue expenditure, to be written off over a period of 2 or 3 years.
Self-Instructional
Material 143
Preparation of Trial Balance
and Final Accounts, and
Depreciation Accounting Check Your Progress
7. State the meaning of errors of principle.
NOTES 8. Mention the synonyms for the term ‘Capital Income’.
9. Give examples of wages which are taken as expenditure of a capital
nature.
Self-Instructional
144 Material
Depreciation: Meaning, Need and Cause Preparation of Trial Balance
and Final Accounts, and
Depreciation Accounting
In this section, we will study the meaning, need, features and causes of
depreciation.
Causes of Depreciation NOTES
NOTES Depreciation
The term ‘depreciation’ is to be distinguished from other terms such a
depletions, amortization etc. though they are used often interchangeably.
Depletion: Depletion implies removal of an available but irreplaceable
resource such as extracting coal from a coal mine or oil out of an oil well.
Amortization: The process of writing off intangible assets is termed as
amortization. Some intangible assets like patents, copyrights, leaseholds have
a limited useful life. Hence, their cost must be written off over such period.
The American Institute of Certified Public Accountants (AICPA) has
put the difference between depreciation, depletion, and amortization in the
following words.
“Depreciation can be distinguished from other terms with specialised
meaning used by accountants to describe assets cost allocation procedures.
Depreciation is concerned with charging the cost of man made fixed assets
to operations (and not with determination of asset value for the balance
sheet). Depletion refers to cost allocations for natural resources such as oil
and mineral deposits. Amortization relates to cost allocation for intangible
assets such as patent and leaseholds. The use of the term depreciation should
also be avoided in connection with the valuation procedures for securities
and investments.”
Dilapidations: The term dilapidation refers to damage done to a
building or other property during tenancy. When a property is taken on lease,
is returned to the landlord he may ask the lessee as per agreement to put it
in as good condition as it was at the time it was leased out. In order to meet
cost of such dilapidation, a provision may be created by debiting the property
account with the estimated amount of dilapidation and crediting the provision
for dilapidations account. Depreciation may then be charged on the total cost
of the asset so arrived at. Any payment made later on dilapidation may be
debited to the provision for dilapidation account. The balance, if any, may
be transferred to profit and loss account.
Meaning of Depreciation Accounting
Depreciation Accounting is mainly concerned with a rational and systematic
distribution of cost over the estimated useful life of the asset. According to the
American Institute of Certified Public Accountants, Depreciation Accounting
is ‘a system of accounting which aims to distribute the cost or other basic
values of the tangible capital assets less salvage (if any) over the estimated
useful life of the unit (which may be a group of assets) in a systematic and
Self-Instructional rational manner. It is the process of allocation and not of valuation”.
146 Material
The objective of Depreciation Accounting is to absorb the cost of using Preparation of Trial Balance
and Final Accounts, and
the assets to different accounting periods in a way so as to give the true figure Depreciation Accounting
of profit or loss made by the business.
Objectives of Providing Depreciation NOTES
The following are objectives of providing depreciation:
1. Ascertainment of true profits: When an asset is purchased, it is
nothing more than a payment in advance for an expense. For example,
if a building is purchased for `10,000 for business, the effect of such
a purchase will be saving in the cost of rent in the future. But, after a
certain number of years, the building will become useless. The cost of
the building is, therefore, nothing except paying rent in advance for a
period of years. If the rent had been paid, it would have been charged as
an expense for determination of the true profits, made by the business
during a particular period. The amount paid for the purchase of building
should, therefore, be charged over a period of time for which the asset
would be serviceable.
2. Presentation of true financial position: The assets get depreciated
in their value over a period of time on account of various factors,
as explained before. In order to present a true state of affairs of the
business, the assets should be shown in the Balance Sheet, at their
proper values.
3. Replacement of assets: Assets used in the business need replacement
after the expiry of their service life. By providing depreciation a part
of the profits of the business is kept in the business which can be used
for purchase of new assets on the old fixed assets becoming useless.
Fixation of Depreciation Amount
Following are the three important factors which should be considered for
determining the amount of depreciation to be charged to the Profit and Loss
Account in respect of a particular asset.
1. Cost of the asset: The cost of the asset includes the invoice price of the
asset, less any trade discount plus all costs essential to bring the asset
to a usable condition. It should be noted that financial charges, such as
interest on money borrowed for the purchase of the asset, should not
be included in the cost of the asset.
2. Estimated scrap value: The term scrap value means the residual or
the salvage value which is estimated to be realised on account of the
sale of the asset at the end of its useful life. In determining the scrap
value, the cost to be incurred in the disposal or removing of the asset
should be deducted out of the total realisable value.
Self-Instructional
Material 147
Preparation of Trial Balance 3. Estimated useful life: This is also termed as economic life of the
and Final Accounts, and
Depreciation Accounting asset. This may be calculated in terms of years, months, hours, units
of output of other operating measures such as kilometres in case of a
taxi or a truck.
NOTES
Methods of Recording Depreciation
Depreciation can be recorded in the books of accounts by two different
methods:
1. When a provision for depreciation account is maintained: In case of
this method, the amount of depreciation to be charged in a particular year
is credited to Provision for Depreciation Account and debited to Profit and
Loss Account. The Asset Account appears in the books at original cost. In
case the asset is sold, the Provision for Depreciation Account is transferred
to the Asset Account. Any amount realised on account of sale of the asset is
also credited to the Asset Account. The balance, if any, in the Asset Account
is transferred to the Profit and Loss Account.
The following journal entries are passed in case this method is followed:
(i) For providing depreciation:
Depreciation Account Dr.
To Depreciation Account
(ii) For transfer of depreciation to Profit and Loss Account:
Profit and Loss Account Dr.
To Depreciation Account
(iii) On sale of asset:
(a) Provision for Depreciation Account Dr.
To Asset Account
(b) In case of profit or loss on sale of an asset:
If Profit: Asset Account Dr.
To Profit and Loss Account
If Loss: Profit and Loss Account Dr.
To Asset Account
Alternatively, on sale of an asset, an ‘asset disposal account’ may be opened.
The following entries will be passed in such a case on sale of an asset:
Asset Disposal Account Dr.
To Asset Account
(with original cost of asset)
Bank Account Dr.
Self-Instructional
To Asset Disposal Account
148 Material
(with the actual sale proceeds on account of sale of asset) Preparation of Trial Balance
and Final Accounts, and
Provision for Depreciation Account Dr. Depreciation Accounting
or
For example, if an asset has been purchased for `10,000 and it will have
a scrap value of `1,000 at the end of its useful life of 10 years, the amount
of depreciation to be charged every year over the effective life of the asset
will be computed as follows:
Self-Instructional
150 Material
(ii) The total charge for use of the asset (i.e., depreciation and repairs) Preparation of Trial Balance
and Final Accounts, and
goes on increasing from year to year though the asset might have been used Depreciation Accounting
uniformly from year to year. For example, in the initial years, the amount spent
on repairs is quite normal. It goes on increasing in the later years. The amount
of depreciation remains the same for each year. Thus, each subsequent year NOTES
is burdened with greater charge for the use of asset on account of increasing
cost on repairs.
(iii) The method tends to report an increasing rate of return on
investment in the asset on account of the fact that net balance of the asset
account is taken. For example, if the cost of an asset is `10,000, life 10 years,
net revenue before charging depreciation `2,000, the earnings for the first
three years will be calculated as follows:
Year 1 Year 2 Year 3
` ` `
Revenue 2,000 2,000 2,000
Less: Depreciation 1,000 1,000 1,000
Profit 1,000 1,000 1,000
Book Value of the asset .......... .......... ..........
(capital employed) 10,000 9,000 8,000
Rate of Return 10% 11.1% 12.5%
Depreciation rate
Merits
(i) The method puts an equal burden for use of the asset on each
subsequent year. The amount of depreciation goes on decreasing for
each subsequent year while the charge for repairs goes on increasing
for each subsequent year. Thus, increase in the cost of repairs for
each subsequent year is compensated by decrease in the amount of
depreciation for each subsequent year.
(ii) The method is simple to understand and easy to follow.
Demerits
(i) The value of the asset cannot be brought down to zero under this
method.
Self-Instructional
152 Material
(ii) The determination of a suitable rate of depreciation is also difficult Preparation of Trial Balance
and Final Accounts, and
under this method as compared to the Fixed Instalment Method. Depreciation Accounting
Straight Line Method and Diminishing Balance Method
The difference between straight line method and diminishing balance method NOTES
can be put as follows:
(a) Amount on depreciation: In case of straight line method, the amount
of depreciation remains same throughout the life of the asset. While
in case of diminishing balance method, the amount of depreciation is
more during the earlier years of the life of the asset as compared to
the later years. Thus, the amount of depreciation charged every year
is not the same.
(b) Value on expiry of the life of the asset: In case of straight line method,
the value of the asset on expiry of its life becomes zero. While in case
of diminishing balance method, the value at the end of the life of the
asset would never become zero.
(c) Overall charge for the use of the asset: In case of fixed instalment
method, the overall charge for use of the asset goes on increasing
because of fixed amount of depreciation plus increasing cost of repairs
year after year. While in case of diminishing balance method, the overall
cost for use of the asset almost remains the same year after year. This
is because of decrease in the amount of depreciation and increase in
the cost of repairs.
Illustration 3.14. A firm purchases plant and machinery on 1st January, 2015
for `10,000. Prepare the Plant Account for three years charging depreciation
@ 10% p.a. according to the Diminishing Balance Method.
Solution:
PLANT AND MACHINERY ACCOUNT
Self-Instructional
156 Material
Note: The amount to be charged to the Profit and Loss Account has been arrived as follows: Preparation of Trial Balance
and Final Accounts, and
Original Cost of the Plant 1,00,000 Depreciation Accounting
Less: Estimated scrap value 16,000
Depreciation on the plant for its whole life 84,000
The amount to be charged to the
NOTES
Profit and Loss Account = `84,000 × 0.180975 = `15,201.90 or `15,202
Self-Instructional
Material 157
Preparation of Trial Balance 10. These methods are suitable in those case where (a) the receipts are
and Final Accounts, and
Depreciation Accounting expected to decline as the asset gets older and (b) it is believed that
the allocation of depreciation should be related to the pattern of asset’s
expected receipts.
NOTES
11. The disadvantage of the depreciating (or sinking) fund method is that it
puts an increasing burden on the profit and loss of each year on account
of a fixed charge for depreciation but increasing charge for repairs.
3.8 SUMMARY
• The accuracy of the books of accounts is determined by means of
preparing a Trial Balance. Having determined the accuracy of the
books of accounts every businessman is interested in knowing about
two more facts. They are: (i) Whether he has earned a profit or suffered
a loss during the period covered by the Trial Balance, (ii) Where does
he stand now? In other words, what is his financial position?
• The determination of the Profit or Loss is done by preparing a Trading
and Profit and Loss Account (or an Income Statement). While the
financial position is judged by means of preparing a Balance Sheet of
the business. The two statements together, i.e., Income Statement and
the Balance Sheet, are termed as Final Accounts. As the term indicates,
Final Accounts means accounts which are prepared at the final stage
to give the financial position of the business.
• Trading Account gives the overall result of trading, i.e., purchasing
and selling of goods. In other words, it explains whether purchasing
of goods and selling them has proved to be profitable for the business
or not. It takes into account on the one hand the cost of goods sold and
on the other the value for which they have been sold away.
• The Trading Account simply tells about the gross profit or loss made
by a businessman on purchasing and selling of goods. It does not take
into account the other operating expenses incurred by him during the
course of running the business. All such expenses are charged to the
Profit and Loss Account.
• Having prepared the Manufacturing, Trading and Profit and Loss
Account, a businessman will like to know the financial position of his
business. For this purpose, he prepares a statement of his assets and
liabilities as on a particular date. Such a statement is termed as ‘‘Balance
Sheet’’. It is a classified summary of the various remaining accounts
after accounts relating to Incomes and Expenses have been closed by
transfer to Manufacturing, Trading and Profit and Loss Account.
• Errors are broadly classified as: omission, commission, principle and
compensating.
Self-Instructional
158 Material
• Incomes are classified as: Capital income and revenue income. Preparation of Trial Balance
and Final Accounts, and
Expenditures are classified into the following three categories: capital Depreciation Accounting
expenditure, revenue expenditure and deferred revenue expenditure.
Receipts are classified as capital and revenue receipts.
NOTES
• Depreciation Accounting is mainly concerned with a rational and
systematic distribution of cost over the estimated useful life of the
asset. The objective of Depreciation Accounting is to absorb the cost
of using the assets to different accounting periods in a way so as to
give the true figure of profit or loss made by the business.
• The major methods for providing depreciation are: Uniform charge
methods, declining charge methods and other methods.
• Uniform charge methods include: (a) Fixed instalment method,
(b) Depletion method and (c) Machine hour rate method. Declining
charge or accelerated depreciation methods: (a) Diminishing balance
method, (b) Sum of years digits method and (c) Double declining
method. Other methods: (a) Group depreciation method, (b) Inventory
system of depreciation, (c) Annuity method (d) Depreciation fund
method and (e) Insurance policy method.
Self-Instructional
160 Material
Preparing Final Accounts
UNIT 4 PREPARING FINAL from Incomplete Records
ACCOUNTS FROM
NOTES
INCOMPLETE RECORDS
Structure
4.0 Introduction
4.1 Objectives
4.2 Single Entry System: Salient Features
4.3 Net Worth Method/Statement of Affairs Method
4.4 Conversion Method
4.4.1 Preparation of Final Accounts
4.5 Answers to Check Your Progress Questions
4.6 Summary
4.7 Key Words
4.8 Self Assessment Questions and Exercises
4.9 Further Readings
4.0 INTRODUCTION
In unit 2, we have explained that there are two systems of recording
transactions in the books of a business (i) Single Entry System, and (ii) Double
Entry System. The system of double entry has already been explained in the
preceding chapters. As a matter of fact, the system has been followed by us
so far throughout the book.
Single Entry System may be defined as any system which is not exactly
the Double Entry System. In other words, Single Entry System may consist of:
(i) Double entry in respect of certain transactions such as cash received from debtors,
cash paid to creditors etc.; (ii) Single Entry in respect of certain transactions such
as cash purchases, cash sales, expenses in current, fixed assets purchased etc.;
(iii) No Entry in respect of certain transactions such as depreciation, bad
debts etc. Thus, a business is said to be using Single Entry System if it is not
following completely the principles of Double Entry System of Book-keeping.
Kohler defines Single Entry System as, ‘‘A system of book-keeping in which
as a rule only records of cash and of personal accounts are maintained, it is
always incomplete double entry varying with the circumstances”.
In this unit, we will discuss the preparation of Trading, Profit and Loss
Account as well as Balancesheet from incomplete records.
4.1 OBJECTIVES
After going through this unit, you will be able to:
· Recall the concept of single entry system Self-Instructional
Material 161
Preparing Final Accounts · Describe the features and limitations of single entry system
from Incomplete Records
· Compute the profits as per Net Worth Method and Conversion Method
· Explain the meaning of statement of affairs method
NOTES
4.2 SINGLE ENTRY SYSTEM: SALIENT FEATURES
The salient features of the Single Entry System can be put as follows:
(i) Maintenance of personal accounts: Usually under this system
personal accounts are maintained while real and nominal accounts
are avoided. On account of this reason some accountants define it as
a system where only personal accounts are maintained.
(ii) Maintenance of cash book: A Cash Book is maintained, which usually
mixes up both the personal transactions and the business transactions.
(iii) Dependence on original vouchers: In order to collect the necessary
information one has to depend on original voucher. For example, the
figure of credit purchases may not be readily available, it may have
to be found out on the basis of original invoices received from the
suppliers. Similarly, the total figure of sales at the end of a particular
period may have to be found out on the basis of the invoices which
have been issued by the business from time to time.
(iv) No uniformity: The system may differ from firm to firm as per their
individual requirements and conveniences.
(v) Suitability: The system is suitable in case of small, proprietary or
partnership concerns. Limited companies can not adopt this system
on account of legal requirements.
Disadvantages
The system suffers from several disadvantages:
(i) Arithmetical accuracy cannot be checked: In case of Double Entry
System of Book-keeping Trial Balance is prepared to check the
arithmetical accuracy of the books of accounts. This is possible because
every transaction is recorded at two places. In case of Single Entry
System, this is not done. Hence, Trial Balance cannot be prepared and
the arithmetical accuracy of the books of accounts cannot be checked.
This increases the possibility of more frauds and misappropriations as
compared to the Double Entry System of Book-keeping.
(ii) True profits cannot be known: In the absence of complete information
for sales, purchases and other expenses, it is not possible to draw the
Profit and Loss Account. Hence, the true profit or loss made or suffered
by the business cannot be known.
(iii) Financial position of the business cannot be judged: In the absence
Self-Instructional of true figure of profit and correct information about the assets and
162 Material
liabilities of the business, the Balance Sheet cannot be drawn up to give Preparing Final Accounts
from Incomplete Records
a correct picture of the financial position of the business on a particular
date.
(iv) Make planning and decision-making difficult: The system does not
NOTES
provide accurate figures about the performance of the business and its
financial position. For example, separate figures of gross profit, net
profit and sales are not available. Thus, the ratio of gross profit to sales
or net profit to sales cannot be found out. Similarly in the absence of
any information about the cost of goods sold, the proportion of different
elements of cost of sales cannot be found out. In the absence of such
information, it becomes difficult for the proprietor of the business to
know the reasons of his improving or deteriorating profitability and
financial position. Thus, he is not in a position to compare, plan and
take sound decision for the prosperity of the business. Moreover, it
may be difficult for him to find the real value of his business in the
event of his deciding to sell the business.
Computation of Profit
The profit (or loss) in case of a business maintaining accounts according to
Single Entry System can be computed by two methods:
(i) Net Worth Method.
(ii) Conversion Method. (Conversion of Single entry into Double Entry
System)
Solution:
STATEMENT OF PROFIT
for the year 2017
Particulars `
Capital as on 31.12.2017 90,000
Add: Drawings 5,000
95,000
Less: Further capital introduced by A 3,000
92,000
Less: Capital as on 1.1.2017 80,000
Profit made during the year 12,000
Self-Instructional
164 Material
living expenses of the proprietor of the business and also other estimated Preparing Final Accounts
from Incomplete Records
payments which might have been made on his behalf.
Steps for preparing Statement of Affairs
The following steps may be taken for preparing the Statement of Affairs. NOTES
(i) In most cases in single entry system, a cash book is maintained. In case
this has been done, the cash and the bank balances can be taken from the
cash book. In the absence of a proper cash book, cash balance may have
to be found out by preparing a receipts and payments account on the
basis of information collected from the proprietor of the business and
the statement of accounts which might have been received or sent by
the proprietor from/to his debtors and creditors. Information regarding
other business expenses can be collected from the salaries register of
his employees, petty cash book, if any, maintained by him, etc., and
the actual cash balance available with the business The balance at the
bank can be verified from the bank pass book or Statement of Account
from the Bank.
(ii) A list of sundry debtors and creditors should be prepared. This may
not be difficult because in most cases, a record of personal accounts
is maintained under the single entry system.
(iii) The value of the fixed assets like building, plant, furniture, etc., should
be ascertained from vouchers or other documents available with the
business. A reasonable charge for depreciation should also be made and
the assets should be shown in the Statement of Affairs after charging
depreciation.
(iv) A physical verification of the stock should be taken and the value of
the stock in hand should be ascertained on the basis of the different
invoices received from suppliers from time to time in respect of the
goods purchased.
(v) The amount of outstanding expenses and the accrued income should
also be determined. Last year’s figures about these items may be of
considerable help in this respect.
(vi) The excess of assets over liabilities should be found out and this will
denote the net worth or the capital of the business on the date on which
the Statement of Affairs has been prepared.
Difference between Balance Sheet and Statement of Affairs
Both balance sheet and statement of affairs show the financial position of a
business on a particular date. However, they differ from each other in several
ways:
(i) A balance sheet is prepared from the Trial Balance extracted on the
basis of ledger accounts. While a statement of affairs is prepared from Self-Instructional
Material 165
Preparing Final Accounts ledger accounts and several additional informations available from
from Incomplete Records
other sources.
(ii) Balance sheet is assumed to show the true financial position of the
business while it may not be the case in case of statement of affairs.
NOTES
(iii) The omissions of assets and liabilities cannot be easily traced in a
statement of affairs while such omissions can be traced in a balance
sheet.
(iv) A balance sheet is bascially prepared to show the financial position of
a business on a particular date. While a statement of affairs helps in
ascertaining not only the financial position but also the profit made by
the business during a particular period.
(v) The capital account balance shown in the balance sheet is taken from
the ledger. While the capital account balance in case of a statement of
affaris is the excess of assets over liabilities on a particular date.
Sole-proprietary Firms
Illustration 4.2. Mahesh, who keeps his books by Single Entry, has submitted
returns to the Income Tax Authorities showing his income to be as follows:
`
Year ending December 31, 2011 7,350
Year ending December 31, 2012 7,400
Year ending December 31, 2013 7,870
Year ending December 31, 2014 13,750
Year ending December 31, 2015 12,140
Year ending December 31, 2016 9,26
The Income Tax Officer is not satisfied as to the accuracy of the accounts
submitted. You are instructed to assist in establishing their correctness, and
for that purpose you are supplied with the following information:
(a) Business liabilities and assets as 31st December, 2010 were: Debtors
`1,450; Cash at Bank and in hand, `9,470; Stock, `5,420 (at selling
price which is 25% above cost); Creditors, `7,320.
(b) Mahesh owed his brother, `4,000 on 31st December, 2010. On 15th
February, 2013 he repaid this amount and on 1st January, 2016, he lent
his brother `3,000.
(c) Mahesh owns a house which he purchased in 2016 for `20,000 and a
car purchased in 2012 for `7,500. In 2015, he bought 10,000 shares
in X Ltd. for `7,500.
(d) In 2016 `3,000 was stolen from his house.
(e) Mahesh estimates that living expenses have been: 2011, `3,000;
2012, `4,000; 2013, `6,000; 2014, 2015 and 2016, `7,000 per annum
exclusive of the amount stolen.
Self-Instructional
166 Material
(f) On 31st December, 2017, the business Liabilities and Assets were: Preparing Final Accounts
from Incomplete Records
Creditors `8,400, Debtors, `5,920; Cash in hand and at bank, `19,450
and Stock `6,740 (at selling price which shows a gross profit of 25%).
From the information submitted, prepare a statement showing whether
NOTES
or not the income declared by Mahesh is correct.
Solution:
STATEMENT OF AFFAIRS
as on 31.12.2016
Liabilities ` Assets `
Creditors 8,400 Cash in hand and at Bank 19,450
Capital (balancing figure) 22,025 Debtors 5,920
Stock 6,740
Less: Profit 1,685* 5,055
30,425 30,425
* The percentage of gross profit to sales is 25%. The amount of profit involved in the stock of `6,740
(at selling price) has been computed as follows:
6,704 × 25 = 1,685
100
STATEMENT OF AFFAIRS
as on 31.12.2010
Liabilities ` Assets `
Creditors 7,320 Cash at Bank and in hand 9,470
Capital (balancing figure) 7,936 Debtors 1,450
Stock 5,420**
Less: Profit 20% 1,084 4,336
15,256 15,256
**The stock is appearing at selling price which includes a profit of 25% on cost. In other words, if
cost is `100, the selling price is `125. The amount of profit involved in the stock or `5,420 has been
computed as follows:
5,420 × 25 = 1,084 `1,084
125
STATEMENT OF PROFIT
for the period from 1.1.2011 to 31.12.2016
Particulars `
Capital as on 31.12.2016 as per Statement of Affairs 22,025
Add: Living expenses during this period:
20011 3,000
20012 4,000
20013 6,000
20014 to 2016 21,000 34,000
56,025
Less: Capital as on 31.12.2010 as per Statement of Affairs 7,936
Profit as per Books during the period: 48,089
Add: Undisclosed incomes:*
(a) Repayment of Brother’s loan 4,000
(b) Money lent to Brother 3,000
(c) Purchase of car 7,500
(d) Purchase of shares 7,500
(e) Amount stolen from the house 3,000 25,000
73,089 Self-Instructional
Material 167
Preparing Final Accounts
Particulars `
from Incomplete Records
Actual Income during the period
Less: Declared Income
2011 7,350
2012 7,400
NOTES
2013 7,870
2014 13,750
2015 12,140
2016 9,260 57,770
Excess of Actual Income over Declared Income 15,319
*Any purchase of property or lending of money or repayment of loan etc. during the period 1.1.2011
to 31.12.2016 will be taken as additional income of Mahesh, since only the living expenses have been
so far added to the capital at the end of 2016. The house was purchased by Mahesh in 2006. It does
not fall within the period from 1.1.2011 to 31.12.2016 and, therefore, it has been excluded. However,
repayment of the brother’s loan, lending money to his brother, purchase of shares, purchase of car and
theft of money from his house have all been added in order to find out his real income.
Partnership Firms
In case of a partnership firm, the balances in the capital accounts of all the
partners will have to be considered for ascertainment of the profit made by
the business. However, where partners have a fixed capital system (i.e., where
current accounts are maintained), the balances in the current accounts should
be considered while preparing Statement of Profit. Capital Accounts of the
partners should be adjusted for any fresh capital introduced or withdrawn by
the partners before ascertaining the combined closing balance of the current
accounts.
Illustration 4.3. A, B and C were in partnership, and towards the end of 2017
most of their books and records were destroyed in a fire. The Balance Sheet
as on 31st December, 2016 was as under:
Liabilities ` Assets `
Creditors 5,500 Cash 2,400
Capitals: Debtors 3,600
A 4,500 Stock 6,500
B 3,000 Machinery 1,440
C 1,500 9,000 Fixture and Fittings 600
Current Accounts: Advance Payments 35
A 145 Current Account:
B 100 245 C 170
14,745 14,745
The partners’ drawings during 2017 have been proved at A: `1,400; B: `1,000
and C: `650. A introduced `1,500 as additional capital on July 1, 2017. On
31st December, 2017 the cash was `3,200, Debtors `4,025, Stock `5,900,
Advanced Payments `25 and Creditors `4,540. Machinery is to be depreciated
by 10% per annum and Fixtures and Fittings as 7½%. 5% interest is to be
allowed on capitals. No interest is to be charged on drawings. The partners
share profits in the proportions of 3 : 2 : 1.
Self-Instructional
168 Material
You are required to prepare a statement, showing the net trading profit Preparing Final Accounts
from Incomplete Records
for the year 2017 and the division of the same between the partners, together
with the Balance Sheet as on 31st December, 2017.
Solution:
NOTES
A, B and C
STATEMENT OF AFFAIRS
as on 31st December, 2017
Liabilities ` Assets `
Sundry Creditors 4,540 Cash 3,200
Capital Accounts: (Fixed) Sundry Debtors 4,025
A 6,000 Stock 5,900
B 3,000 Advance Payments 25
C 1,500 10,500 Machinery 1,440
Less: Depreciation 144 1,296
Fixtures & Fittings 600
Less: Depreciation 45 555
Combined Current Accounts
(balancing figure) 39
15,040 15,040
CURRENT ACCOUNTS
Particulars A B C Particulars A B C
` ` ` ` ` `
To Balance b/d 170 By Balance b/d 145 100
To Drawing 1,400 1,000 650 By Interest on
To Balance c/d 232 66 Capitals 263 150 75
By Profit 1,224 816 408
By Balance c/d 337
1,632 1,066 820 1,632 1,066 820 Self-Instructional
Material 169
Preparing Final Accounts A, B, and C
from Incomplete Records BALANCE SHEET
as on 31st December, 2017
Liabilities ` Assets `
Sundry Creditors 4,540 Cash 3,200
NOTES Capital Accounts (Fixed) Sundry Debtors 4,025
A 6,000 Stock 5,900
B 3,000 Advance Payments 25
C 1,500 10,500 Machinery: 1,440
Current Accounts Less: Depreciation 144 1,296
A 232 Fixtures & Fittings 600
B 66 298 Less: Depreciation 45 555
C’s Current Account 337
15,328 15,238
Solution:
TOTAL DEBTORS ACCOUNT
(or Sundry Debtors Account)
Particulars ` Particulars `
To Balance b/d 12,000 By Returns Inward 5,000
To Bill Receivable dishonoured 3,500 By Cash 45,000
To Credit Sales By Discount 3,000
(balancing figure) 66,000 By Bills Receivable 17,000
By Bad Debts 1,500
By Balance c/d 10,000
81,500 81,500
The amount of Cash Sales may be given in the Cash Book. However,
its amount may have to be ascertained by preparing a Receipts and Payments
Account in case complete Cash Book has not been given.
Illustration 4.5. From the following cash transactions ascertain the amount
of Cash Sales:
` `
Cash Balance as on 1.1.2017 5,000 Payment made to Creditors 10,000
Bank Balance as on 1.1.2017 10,000 Cash Purchases 20,000
Cash collected from Debtors 20,000 Cash Balance as on 31.12.2017 10,000
Other Income 5,000 Bank Balance as on 31.12.2017 15,000
Self-Instructional
Material 171
Preparing Final Accounts Solution:
from Incomplete Records
RECEIPTS AND PAYMENTS ACCOUNT
for the year ending 31st December, 2017
Particulars ` Particulars `
NOTES
To Balance: By Creditors 10,000
Cash in Hand 5,000 By Purchases 20,000
To Cash at Bank 10,000 By Balance:
To Debtors 20,000 Cash in Hand 10,000
To Other Incomes 5,000 Balance at Bank 15,000
To Cash Sales (balancing figure) 15,000
55,000 55,000
In the above illustration, cash receipts (including opening cash and bank
balances) without taking into account the amount of cash sales amounts
to `40,000, while cash payments (including closing cash and bank
balances) amount to `55,000. This means `15,000 must have been received
from somewhere. There can be three important sources: (i) Cash Sales,
(ii)Collections from debtors, and (iii) Introduction of further capital by the
proprietor. Since the amount of cash collected from debtors has already been
given the choice falls between introduction of further capital by the proprietor
and the sales. In the absence of any other information, it will be proper to
presume that cash `15,000 is on account of cash sales.
On the same basis, the amount of cash collected from debtors can be
found out. For example, if in the above illustration, the cash sales are given
as `20,000, and other figures remain the same, the amount of cash collected
from debtors can be taken as `15,000.
2. Ascertainment of purchases: The purchases may be of two types (i)
Credit purchases, and (ii) Cash purchases. The amount of credit purchases
can be ascertained by preparing a Total Creditors Account.
Illustration 4.6. From the following information, find out the Credit
Purchases for the year 2010.
` `
Balance of Creditors on 1.1.2017 7,600 Returns Outward 2,400
Cash paid to Creditors 20,000 Bills accepted 4,600
Discount allowed by them 500 Creditors on 31.12.2017 9,500
Solution:
TOTAL CREDITORS ACCOUNT
Particulars ` Particulars `
To Cash 20,000 By Balance b/d 7,600
To Discount 500 By Credit Purchases
To Returns Outward 2,400 (balancing figure) 29,400
To Bills Payable A/c 4,600
To Balance c/d 9,500
37,000 37,000
Self-Instructional
172 Material
The amount of cash purchases can be ascertained from the Cash Book. In Preparing Final Accounts
from Incomplete Records
case complete Cash Book has not been given, the amount of cash purchases
can be ascertained by preparing a Receipts and Payments Account.
Illustration 4.7. From the following cash transactions, ascertain the amount
NOTES
of cash purchases.
Particulars ` Particulars `
Balance as on 1.1.2017 Cash 10,000 Cash paid to Creditors 40,000
Bank 20,000 Balances as on 31.12.2017
Cash receipts from debtors 30,000 Cash 10,000
Cash sales 10,000 Bank 10,000
Solution:
RECEIPTS AND PAYMENTS ACCOUNT
for the year ending 31st December, 2017
Particulars ` Particulars `
To Balance b/d: By Creditors 40,000
To Cash in Hand 10,000 By Cash Purchases
To Cash at Bank 20,000 (balancing figure) 10,000
To Debtors 30,000 By Balance c/d:
To Cash Sales 10,000 Cash in Hand 10,000
Cash at Bank 10,000
70,000 70,000
Self-Instructional
Material 173
Preparing Final Accounts Solution:
from Incomplete Records MEMORANDUM TRADING ACCOUNT
Particulars ` Particulars `
To Opening Stock By Sales 30,000
NOTES (balancing figure) 14,000 By Closing Stock 10,000
To Purchases 20,000
To Gross Profit (20% of Sales) 6,000
40,000 40,000
Solution:
RECEIPTS AND PAYMENTS ACCOUNT
Particulars ` Particulars `
To Balance on 1.1.2017 By Cash Payments 35,000
Cash in Hand 5,000 By Balance:
Cash at Bank 10,000 15,000 Cash in Hand
To Cash Receipts 30,000 (balancing figure) 5,000
Cash at Bank 5,000
45,000 45,000
Self-Instructional
174 Material
Solution: Preparing Final Accounts
TOTAL DEBTORS ACCOUNT from Incomplete Records
Particulars ` Particulars `
To Balance b/d By Bills Receivable 10,000
(balancing figure) 33,000 By Cash 30,000 NOTES
To Credit Sales 30,000 By Discount 5,000
To Bills Receivable dishonoured 5,000 By Bad Debts 3,000
By Returns Inward 5,000
By Balance c/d 15,000
68,000 68,000
On the same basis the Closing Balance in the Debtors Account can be
ascertained in case other information have been given.
6. Ascertainment of total creditors’ balances: The balance in the Total
Creditors Account in the beginning or at the end of the accounting year can
be ascertained by preparing a Total Creditors Account.
Illustration 4.11. From the following date, ascertain the amount of creditors
as on 31.12.2017.
` `
Creditors as on 1.1.2017 10,000 Bills Payable issued to creditors 5,000
Cash paid to creditors 20,000 Returns Outward 5,000
Purchases (including credit purchases of
`25,000) 35,000 Discount allowed by creditors 1,000
Solution:
TOTAL CREDITORS ACCOUNT
Particulars ` Particulars `
To Cash 20,000 By Balance b/d 10,000
To Bills Payable 5,000 By Credit Purchases 25,000
To Returns Outward 5,000
To Discount 1,000
To Balance c/d (balancing figure) 4,000
35,000 35,000
On the same basis the Opening Balance in the Creditors Account can
be ascertained.
7. Ascertainment of bills receivable balance: The balance of bills receivable
at the beginning or at the end of the accounting year can be ascertained by
preparing a Bills Receivable Account.
Illustration 4.12. From the following data, calculate the amount of Bills
Receivable as on 31.12.2017.
` `
Bills Receivable as on 1.1.2017 10,000 Cash received on account of
Bills Receivable received during bills receivable 5,000
the year 30,000 Bills Receivable dishonoured 5,000
Bills Receivable discounted Bills Receivable endorsed in
from the bankers 10,000 favour of creditors 5,000
Self-Instructional
Material 175
Preparing Final Accounts Solution:
from Incomplete Records BILLS RECEIVABLE ACCOUNT
Particulars ` Particulars `
To Balance b/d 10,000 By Bank and Discount
NOTES To Sundry Debtors (Bills discounted) 10,000
(Bills receivable received) 30,000 By Cash 5,000
By Sundry Debtors 5,000
By Creditors 5,000
By Balance c/d (balancing figure) 15,000
40,000 40,000
On the same basis, the balance in the beginning of the accounting year
in the Bills Receivable Account can be ascertained if other details are given.
8. Ascertainment of bills payable balance: The balance of the Bills
Payable Account at the beginning or at the end of the accounting year can
be ascertained by preparing a Bills Payable Account.
Illustration 4.13. Ascertain the amount of bills payable as on 1.1.2017.
` `
Bills payable issued in favour of Bills payable dishonoured
creditors during 2017 30,000 during the year 5,000
Bills payable paid during the year 20,000 Bills payable on 31.12.2017 10,000
Solution:
BILLS PAYABLE ACCOUNT
Particulars ` Particulars `
To Cash 20,000 By Balance b/d
To Sundry Creditors (balancing figure) 5,000
(Bills payable dishonoured) 5,000 By Sundry Creditors
To Balance c/d 10,000 (Bills payable issued) 30,000
35,000 35,000
Self-Instructional
176 Material
Solution: Preparing Final Accounts
from Incomplete Records
BALANCE SHEET
as on 1.1.2017
10. Ascertainment of other balances: The balances of some other assets such
as Land, Building, Plant and Machinery, Furniture, etc., can be ascertained
by taking into account the following:
(i) Balance in the beginning of the accounting year as shown by last year’s
Balance Sheet.
(ii) Any purchase or sale of the asset as shown by the Cash Book.
(iii) Depreciation on the basis of additional information given.
Illustration 4.15. Ascertain the Balance in the Plant Account as on 31.12.2017
on the basis of the following information:
` `
Plant as on 1.1.2017 Provision Depreciation on Plant
(at original cost) 10,000 on 1.1.2017 2,000
Purchase of Plant during 2017 20,000 Book Value of the Plant sold 4,000
Sale of Plant during 2017
(original cost `5,000) 2,000
Solution:
PLANT ACCOUNT
Particulars ` Particulars `
To Balance 10,000 By Plant Disposal A/c 5,000
To Bank (purchase of plant) 20,000 By Balance c/d 25,000
30,000 30,000
Particulars ` Particulars `
To Plant Disposal Account By Balance b/d 2,000
(depreciation on plant sold) 1,000 By P & L Account
To Balance c/d 3,500 (depreciation for the year on
`25,000 at the rate of 10%) 2,500
4,500 4,500
Self-Instructional
Material 177
Preparing Final Accounts PLANT DISPOSAL ACCOUNT
from Incomplete Records
Particulars ` Particulars `
To Plant Account 5,000 By Provision for Depreciation
on Plant Account 1,000
NOTES By Bank (sale proceeds) 2,000
By P & L Account
(loss on sale of plant) 2,000
5,000 5,000
Suneel took cloth worth `500 from the shop for private use and paid
`200 to his son, but omitted to record these transactions in his books. On
31st December, 2017, his sundry debtors were `5,200 and sundry creditors
`3,600. Stock in hand on 31st December, 2017, was `6,500.
Solution:
SUNEEL’S TRADING AND PROFIT & LOSS ACCOUNT
for the year ending 31st December, 2017
Particulars ` Particulars `
To Purchases 15,000 By Sales 17,000
Less: Drawings 500 14,500 By Closing Stock 6,500
To Gross Profit c/d 9,000
23,500 23,500
Self-Instructional
178 Material
Preparing Final Accounts
To Salaries 2,000 By Gross Profit b/d 9,000
from Incomplete Records
To Bad Debts 500
To Business Expenses 700
To Net Profit 5,800
9,000 9,000
NOTES
SUNEEL’S BALANCE SHEET
as on 31.12.2017
Particulars ` Particulars `
Sundry Creditors 3,600 Cash Balance 2,800
Capital 10,000 Sundry Debtors 5,200
Less: Drawings 1,900 Closing Stock 6,500
8,100 Furniture & Fittings 3,000
Add: Net Profit 5,800 13,900
17,500 17,500
Working Notes:
1. RECEIPTS AND PAYMENTS ACCOUNT
for the year ending 31.12.2017
Particulars ` Particulars `
To Capital A/c 10,000 By Furniture 3,000
To Cash Sales 7,000 By Cash Purchases 4,000
To Sundry Debtors (Note 2) 4,300 By Drawing (1,200 + 200) 1,400
By Salaries 2,000
By Business Expenses 700
By Sundry Creditors (Note 3) 7,400
By Balance c/d 2,800
21,300 21,300
Particulars ` Particulars `
To Credit Sales 10,000 By Cash (balancing figure) 4,300
By Bad Debts 500
By Balance c/d 5,200
10,000 10,000
Particulars ` Particulars `
To Cash (balancing figure) 7,400 By Credit Purchases 11,000
To Balance c/d 3,600
11,000 11,000
4. The Money given by Suneel to his son and cloth taken by him from the
business have been taken as his drawings. The value of cloth taken has been
deducted from purchases.
4.6 SUMMARY
• Single Entry System may be defined as any system which is not exactly
the Double Entry System. In other words, Single Entry System may
consist of: (i) Double entry in respect of certain transactions such as
cash received from debtors, cash paid to creditors etc.; (ii) Single
Entry in respect of certain transactions such as cash purchases, cash
sales, expenses in current, fixed assets purchased etc.; (iii) No Entry
in respect of certain transactions such as depreciation, bad debts, etc.
• In case of Double Entry System of Book-keeping Trial Balance is
prepared to check the arithmetical accuracy of the books of accounts.
This is possible because every transaction is recorded at two places.
In case of Single Entry System, this is not done.
• The profit (or loss) in case of a business maintaining accounts according
to Single Entry System can be computed by two methods: (i) Net Worth
Method. (ii) Conversion Method.
• In order to determine profit or loss made during a period on the basis
of net worth method, it is necessary to know the net worth or capital
both in the beginning as well as at the end of the accounting period.
This is done by preparing a Statement of Affairs.
• Both balance sheet and statement of affairs show the financial position
of a business on a particular date. However, they differ from each other
in several ways.
Self-Instructional
180 Material
• Sales may be of two types (i) Credit Sales, and (ii) Cash Sales. Credit Preparing Final Accounts
from Incomplete Records
Sales should be found out by preparing a Total Debtors Account while
cash sales should be found out from the Cash Book.
• The purchases may be of two types (i) Credit purchases, and (ii) Cash
NOTES
purchases. The amount of credit purchases can be ascertained by
preparing a Total Creditors Account.
• Stocks may be classified into two categories: (i) Opening Stock, and
(ii) Closing Stock. The amount of Opening Stock or Closing Stock can
be ascertained by preparing a Memorandum Trading Account.
• The balance in the Debtors Account in the beginning of accounting year
or at the end of the accounting year can be ascertained by preparing a
Total Debtors Account.
• The balance in the Total Creditors Account in the beginning or at the
end of the accounting year can be ascertained by preparing a Total
Creditors Account.
• The balance of bills receivable at the beginning or at the end of the
accounting year can be ascertained by preparing a Bills Receivable
Account.
• The balance of the Bills Payable Account at the beginning or at the end
of the accounting year can be ascertained by preparing a Bills Payable
Account.
• The amount of capital in beginning of the accounting year can be
ascertained by preparing a Statement of Affairs which may be called
the Balance Sheet of the business in case of Conversion Method.
• In case of a partnership firm, the balances in the capital accounts of all
the partners will have to be considered for ascertainment of the profit
made by the business. However, where partners have a fixed capital
system (i.e., where current accounts are maintained), the balances in
the current accounts should be considered while preparing Statement
of Profit.
• The Net Worth Method explained in the preceding pages does not
provide a clear picture of the operational results of a business. It does
not give information about sales, purchases, gross profit, operating
expenses etc. of the business. As a result, a meaningful analysis of the
financial statements cannot be done nor effective steps can be taken
to improve the financial position of business.
Self-Instructional
182 Material
(b) Total Creditors Account. Preparing Final Accounts
from Incomplete Records
(c) Opening Statement of Affairs.
(ii) The closing balance in the Creditors Account can be ascertained
from NOTES
(a) Cash Account
(b) Total Creditors Account.
(c) Balance Sheet at the end of the accounting period.
(iii) If the rate of gross profit is 25% of sales and the cost of goods
sold is `1,00,000, the amount of gross profit will be
(a) `25,000
(b) `33,333
(c) `20,000
(iv) If the rate of gross profit is 20% on cost of goods sold and the
sales are `1,00,000, the amount of gross profit will be
(a) `20,000
(b) `25,000
(c) `16,667
Long Answer Questions
1. Explain in detail the steps to convert a set of books kept under Single
Entry System into Double Entry System.
2. Describe in detail the steps required to prepare the final accounts
according to the conversion method.
3. Discuss the process of preparing other balances.
Self-Instructional
Material 183
Financial/Management
Statement Analysis - I BLOCK - II
FINANCIAL RATIO ANALYSIS
NOTES
UNIT 5 FINANCIAL/MANAGEMENT
STATEMENT ANALYSIS - I
Structure
5.0 Introduction
5.1 Objectives
5.2 Meaning, Nature, Types and Limitations of Financial Statements
5.3 Analysis and Interpretation of Financial Statements
5.4 Answers to Check Your Progress Questions
5.5 Summary
5.6 Key Words
5.7 Self Assessment Questions and Exercises
5.8 Further Readings
5.0 INTRODUCTION
Companies need to several decisions daily. These pertain to not just future vision
but also smaller goals and budgets to be met while in operation. There are several
users of the financial statement analysis including apart from the management, the
creditors, the investors, and the regulatory authorities. The financial strengths and
weaknesses are revealed through these statements. Several elements including the
profit margins, status of debts, the position of inventory along with debt to equity
ratio is understood through these statements. The financial statements also assist
the company to observe and effectively utilize the relationship between different
factors. In this unit, you will learn about the meaning, nature, objectives and
limitations of financial statements along with the concept of analysis and interpretation
of these financial statements.
5.1 OBJECTIVES
Self-Instructional
184 Material
Financial/Management
5.2 MEANING, NATURE, TYPES AND Statement Analysis - I
Self-Instructional
Material 189
Financial/Management Shareholders’ Net Worth (10) – (11) = (12) ....
Statement Analysis - I (or total tangible net worth) ....
Preference Share Capital (13) ....
Equity Shareholders’ Net Worth (12) – (13) = (14) ....
Equity Shareholders’ Net Worth is represented by: ....
NOTES Equity Share Capital ...
Forfeited Shares ....
Reserves ....
Surplus ....
Equity Shareholders’ Claims ....
Less: Accumulated Losses ....
Miscellaneous Expenditure ....
(such as preliminary expenses, discount on issue of shares
or debentures not written off) .... ....
Equity Shareholders’ Net Worth ....
* Goodwill to be included only when it has been paid for and has the value.
* * Patents, Copyrights, etc., should be shown only when they have the value. In case these assets are
valueless, they should not be included here but should be written off against shareholders’ claims with other
losses.
The process of methodical classification of the data will be clear with the
help of the following illustration:
Illustration 5.1. The balance sheet of Prospective Ltd is given below as on
31 March 2016, together with the profit and loss account is as follows:
Balance Sheet
as on 31 March 2016
(` in lakhs)
Liabilities ` Assets `
Self-Instructional
190 Material
Profit and Loss Account Financial/Management
for the year ended 31 March 2016 Statement Analysis - I
(` in lakhs)
Particulars ` Particulars `
You are required to present the information suitably summarized in single-column statements
(vertical form), showing distinctly the following:
(i) Total Capital employed
(ii) Shareholders' Funds
(iii) Gross Profit
(iv) Net Operating Profit
(v) Cost of goods sold
Solution:
Prospective Ltd
Balance Sheet
as on 31 March 2016 (` in lakhs)
Cash at Bank 88
Book Debts (net) 222
Bills Receivable 30
Liquid Assets (1) 340
Deposit with Customs 30
Stock:
Materials 90
Finished goods 160
Work-in-progress 60 310
Current Assets (2) 680
Bank Overdraft 150
Creditors 210
Unpaid Dividend 10
Current Liabilities (3) 370
Self-Instructional
Material 191
Financial/Management Proposed Dividend 60
Statement Analysis - I Provision for Taxation 170
Current Liabilities and Provisions (4) 600
Net Working Capital (2) – (4) = (5) 80
Land and Building (at cost) 320
NOTES Plant and Machinery (at cost) 650
Patents 30
Fixed Assets 1,000
Less: Provision for Depreciation (6) 250
Net Fixed Assets 750
Advance against Machinery 60
Trade Investments 200
Total Fixed Investment (7) 1,010
Staff Provident Funds Investments 80
Less: Staff Provident Funds 80 Nil
Total Capital employed (8) 1,090
Less: 6 per cent Debentures (9) 250
Shareholders’ Funds (10) 840
Represented by:
Equity Share Capital 500
General Reserve 110
Dividend Equalization Reserve 70
Profit and Loss A/c (Less: Preliminary Expenses) 160
840
Sales 2,000
Less: Cost of goods sold 1,284
Gross Profit 716
Less: Operating Expenses:
Salaries 80
Miscellaneous Expenses 90
Selling and Distribution Expenses 120
Advertisements 80 370
Net Operating Profit 346
Add: Non-operating Income
(Dividends on Investments) 30
Less: Non-operating Expenses
(interest on debentures) 15 15
361
Less: Preliminary Expenses written off 5
Profit before Tax 356
Less: Income Tax payable 170
Profit after Tax 186
Less: Proposed Dividend 60
Profit retained in the business 126
Self-Instructional
192 Material
Statement of Cost of Good Sold Financial/Management
for the year ended 31 March 2006 (` in lakhs) Statement Analysis - I
Self-Instructional
Material 193
Financial/Management
Statement Analysis - I 5.5 SUMMARY
Self-Instructional
194 Material
accounting adjustments, legal judgments, or one-time transactions), and Financial/Management
Statement Analysis - I
other income statement items not directly related to a company’s core
business operations.
NOTES
5.7 SELF ASSESSMENT QUESTIONS AND
EXERCISES
Self-Instructional
Material 195
Financial/Management
Statement Analysis - II
UNIT 6 FINANCIAL/MANAGEMENT
STATEMENT ANALYSIS - II
NOTES
Structure
6.0 Introduction
6.1 Objectives
6.2 Techniques of Financial/Management Analysis
6.2.1 Comparative Financial Statements
6.2.2 Common-size Financial Statements
6.2.3 Trend Percentages
6.2.4 Funds Flow Analysis
6.2.5 Cost-Volume-Profit Analysis
6.2.6 Ratio Analysis
6.3 Answers to Check Your Progress Questions
6.4 Summary
6.5 Key Words
6.6 Self Assessment Questions and Exercises
6.7 Further Readings
6.0 INTRODUCTION
You have learned in the previous unit that the financial statements are made by the
companies to ascertain their true position based on the performance in the reporting
period. You have already studied the meaning, nature, objectives of financial
statement analysis in the previous unit along with the methodological classification
of data in the financial statements.
A management statement is a process that is followed by every kind of firm
irrespective of whether they are profit making or non-profit making. This is done
for the purpose of assuring the current investors and consumers about the products
and services offered with respect to their quality and profitability. Generally, the
management statement is used in business which is created by the senior
management of a company for strengthening public relations. The main emphasis
is made on the quality of the goods and services with the hope of retaining current
investment as well as drawing in new consumers and investors. It offers a detailed
list of the services and products offered and highlight the main goals attained through
the services.
The main focus of a management statement is on providing a detailed list
and keeping the quality of the products and service offered and to highlight the
goal that is achieved throughout the service.
Management discussion and analysis (MD&A) is the portion of a public
company’s annual report in which management addresses the company’s
Self-Instructional
196 Material
performance over the previous twelve months. In this section, the company’s high- Financial/Management
Statement Analysis - II
ranking officers analyze the company’s performance using qualitative and
quantitative performance measures. In the MD&A section, management also
provides commentary on financial statements, systems and controls, compliance
with laws and regulations, and actions it has planned or has taken to address any NOTES
challenges the company is facing. Management also discusses the upcoming year
by outlining future goals and approaches to new projects. The MD&A is an
important source of information for analysts and investors who want to review the
company’s financial fundamentals and management performance.
In this unit, you will learn about the various techniques of financial/
management analysis, such as Common Size Statements, Comparative Financial
Statements and Trend Percentages.
6.1 OBJECTIVES
Balance Sheet
as on 31st December
(` in lakhs)
Self-Instructional
198 Material
Solution: Financial/Management
Statement Analysis - II
Swadeshi Polytext Limited
Comparative Income Statement
For the years ended 31st December 2015 and 2016
(` in lakhs)
NOTES
Absolute Percentage:
increase or increase or
decrease in decrease in
2015 2016 2015 2016
Net Sales 800 1,000 + 200 + 25
Cost of Goods Sold 600 750 + 150 + 25
Gross Profit 200 250 +50 + 25
Operating Expenses:
Administration Expenses 20 20 — —
Selling Expenses 30 40 + 10 + 33.33
Total Operating Expenses 50 60 10 + 20
Operating Profit 150 190 + 40 + 26.67
Solution:
Comparative Balance Sheet
as on 31st December, 2012–2015
Assets Dec. 31 (` in thousands) Trend percentages Base year 2000
2012 2013 2014 2015 2012 2013 2014 2015
Current Assets:
Caah 100 120 80 140 100 120 80 140
Debtors 200 250 325 400 100 125 163 200
Stock-in-trade 300 400 350 500 100 133 117 167
Other Current
Assets 50 75 125 150 100 150 250 300
Total Current
Assets 650 845 880 1,190 100 129 135 183
Fixed Assets:
Land 400 500 500 500 100 125 125 125
Building 800 1,000 1,200 1,500 100 125 150 175
Plant 1,000 1,000 1,200 1,500 100 100 120 150
Total Fixed
Assets 2,200 2,500 2,900 3,500 100 114 132 159
Self-Instructional
Material 203
Financial/Management 6.2.4 Funds Flow Analysis
Statement Analysis - II
Funds flow analysis has become an important tool in the analytical kit of financial
analysts, credit granting institutions and financial managers. This is because the
NOTES Balance Sheet of a business reveals its financial status at a particular point of time.
It does not sharply focus those major financial transactions which have been behind
the Balance Sheet changes. For example, if a loan of `2,00,000 was raised and
paid during the accounting year, the balance sheet will not depict this transaction.
However, a financial analyst must know the purpose for wliich the loan was utilised
and the source from which it was obtained. This will help him in making a better
estimate about the company’s financial position and policies.
Funds flow analysis reveals the changes in working capital position. It tells
about the sources from which the working capital was obtained and the purposes
for which it was used. It brings out in open the changes which have taken place
behind the Balance Sheet. Working capital being the life-blood of the business,
such an analysis is extremely useful. The technique and the procedure involved in
funds flow analysis has been discussed in the succeeding units. This is discussed in
detail in Unit 8.
6.2.5 Cost-Volume-Profit Analysis
Cost-Volume-Profit Analysis is an important tool of profit planning. It studies the
relationship between cost, volume of production, sales and profit. Of course, it is
not strictly a technique used for analysis of financial statements. However, it is an
important tool for the management for decision making since the data is provided
by both cost and financial records. It tells the volume of sales at which the firm will
break-even, the effect on profit on account of variation in output, selling price and
cost, and finally, the quantity to be produced and sold to reach the target profit
level. This is discussed in detail in Unit 12.
6.2.6 Ratio Analysis
This is the most important tool available to financial analysts for their work. An
accounting ratio shows the relationship in mathematical terms between two
interrelated accounting figures. The figures have to be interrelated (e.g., Gross
Profit and Sales, Current Assets and Current Liabilities), because no useful purpose
will be served if ratios are calculated between two figures which are not at all
related to each other, e.g., sales and discount on issue of debentures.
A financial analyst may calculate different accounting ratio for different
purposes.
This aspect has been discussed in detail in Unit 7.
Self-Instructional
204 Material
Financial/Management
Statement Analysis - II
Check Your Progress
1. What is not given by the horizontal reading of the comparative common-
size financial statements? NOTES
2. In Trend Percentages method, what is taken as 100?
3. Name the technique of financial analysis which reveals the financial status
at a particular point of time.
6.4 SUMMARY
Self-Instructional
Material 205
Financial/Management Funds flow analysis reveals the changes in working capital position. It tells
Statement Analysis - II
about the sources from which the working capital was obtained and the
purposes for which it was used.
Cost-Volume-Profit Analysis is an important tool of profit planning. It studies
NOTES
the relationship between cost, volume of production, sales and profit.
An accounting ratio shows the relationship in mathematical terms between
two interrelated accounting figures.
Self-Instructional
206 Material
Jain, S.P. and Narang, K.L. 2001. Advanced Accountancy. New Delhi: Kalyani Financial/Management
Statement Analysis - II
Publishers.
Ahmed, N. 2008. Financial Accounting. New Delhi: Atlantic Publishers and
Distributors Pvt. Ltd.
NOTES
Self-Instructional
Material 207
Ratio Analysis
7.0 INTRODUCTION
In this unit, you will learn about ratio analysis, which is a quantitative analysis of
information contained in a company’s financial statements. Ratio analysis is used
to evaluate various aspects of a company’s operating and financial performance,
such as its efficiency, liquidity, profitability and solvency. It involves evaluating the
performance and financial health of a company by using data from the current and
historical financial statements. Ratios are categorized into three main groups,
namely profitability ratios, turnover ratios and financial or accounting ratios.
7.1 OBJECTIVES
Ratios can be classified into different categories depending upon the basis of
classification.
Self-Instructional
208 Material
Traditional Classification: This classification has been on the basis of the financial Ratio Analysis
statements to which the determinants of a ratio belong. On this basis, the ratios
could be classified as:
1. Profit and loss account ratios, i.e., ratios calculated on the basis of the
NOTES
items of the profit and loss account only, e.g., gross profit ratio and stock
turnover ratio.
2. Balance sheet ratios, i.e., ratios calculated on the basis of the figures of
balance sheet only, e.g., current ratio and debt-equity ratio.
3. Composite ratios or inter-statement ratios, i.e., ratios based on figures of
profit and loss account as well as the balance sheet, e.g., fixed assets turnover
ratio and overall profitability ratio.
Functional Classification: The traditional classification has been found to be
too crude and unsuitable because the analysis of balance sheet and income statement
cannot be done in isolation. They have to be studied together in order to determine
the profitability and solvency of the business. In order that ratios serve as a tool
for financial analysis, they are classified according to their functions as follows:
1. Profitability Ratios
2. Turnover Ratios
3. Financial Ratios
In the following pages we are explaining the ratios covered by each of the
above categories in detail.
Profitability is an indication of the efficiency with which the operations of the business
are carried on. Poor operational performance may indicate poor sales and hence
poor profits. A lower profitability may arise due to the lack of control over the
expenses. Bankers, financial institutions and other creditors look at the profitability
ratios as an indicator whether or not the firm earns substantially more than it pays
interest for the use of borrowed funds and whether the ultimate repayment of their
debt appears reasonably certain. Owners are interested to know the profitability
as it indicates the return which they can get on their investments. The following are
the important profitability ratios
Overall Profitability Ratio
It is also called as ‘return on investment’ (ROI). It indicates the percentage of
return on the total capital employed in the business. It is calculated on the basis of
the following formula:
Operating Profit
× 100
Capital Employed
Self-Instructional
Material 209
Ratio Analysis The term capital employed has been given different meanings by different
accountants. Some of the popular meanings are as follows:
(i) Sum-total of all assets whether fixed or current
NOTES (ii) Sum-total of fixed assets
(iii) Sum-total of long-term funds employed in the business, i.e.:
Share Reserves Long-term Non-business + Fictitious
+ + – Assests
Capital and Surplus Loans Assets
Solution: It will be appropriate to prepare the profit and loss account and the
balance sheet of the company before computation of the return on capital employed.
Anu Sales Pvt. Limited
Profit and Loss Account
Particulars ` Particulars `
Self-Instructional
210 Material
Balance Sheet Ratio Analysis
as on.....
Liabilities ` Assets `
The term net profit here means ‘net income after interest and tax’. It is
different from the ‘net operating profit’, which is used for computing the
‘return on total capital employed’ in the business. This is because the
shareholders are interested in total income after tax including net-non-
operating income (i.e., non-operating income – non-operating expenses).
Taking the figures from Illustration 7.1, the Return on Shareholders' Funds
will be computed as follows:
`1,00, 000
100 20 per cent
`5,00,000
(ii) Return on Equity Shareholders’ Funds: The profitability from the point of
view of the equity shareholders will be judged after taking into account the
Self-Instructional
Material 211
Ratio Analysis amount of dividend payable to the preference shareholders. The return on
equity shareholders’ funds will, therefore, be computed on the following
basis:
Net Profit after Interest, Tax and Preference Dividend
× 100
NOTES Equity Shareholders Funds
Taking the figure from the Illustration 7.1, the return on equity shareholders’
funds will be computed as follows:
`90,000
100 23 p er cen t
`3,90,000
(iii) Return on Total Assets: This ratio is computed to know the ‘productivity
of the total assets.’ There are three methods for computing it:
Net Profit after Tax
(a) × 100
Total Assets
On the basis of the figures in the Illustration 6.1, the ratio will be:
1,00,000
100
7, 00,000
(b)
Net Profit after Tax + Interest
× 100 = 14.29 per cent
Total Assets
On the basis of the figures given in the Illustration 6.1, the ratio will be:
1,00,000 10,000
100 15.71 per cent
7,00,000
The inclusion of interest is conceptually sound because total assets have
been financed from the ‘pool’ of funds supplied by the creditors and the
owners. The objective of computing the ‘return on total assets’ is to find out
how effectively the funds pooled together have been used. Hence, it will be
proper to include the interest in computing the return on total assets.
A further modification of this formula has been suggested by many
accountants. It excludes ‘intangible assets’ from the ‘total assets‘. However,
it will be proper to exclude only fictitious assets and not all intangible assets.
The term ‘fictitious assets' includes assets such as preliminary expenses,
debit balance in the profit and loss account, etc. The return on assets,
according to this method, may, therefore, be calculated as follows:
Net Profit after Tax + Interest
(c) × 100
Total Assets excluding Fictitious Assets
(iv) Return on Gross Capital employed: The term gross capital employed
means the total of fixed assets and the current assets employed in the business.
The formula for its computation can be put as follows:
Net Profit before Interest (on long as well as
short - term borrowings) and Tax
× 100
Gross Capital employed (i.e., Net Fixed Assets
Self-Instructional + Current Assets employed in the business)
212 Material
On the basis of the figures given in the Illustration 7.1, the Return on Gross Ratio Analysis
2,00,000
100
1 2(5,00,000 4,50,000)
2,00,000
100 42.11%
4,75,000
It should be noted that while computing ‘return on investment” according to
any of the above methods ‘abnormal gains or losses’ should always be excluded
from net profit.
Significance of ROI: The return on capital invested is a concept that measures
the profit which a firm earns on investing a unit of capital. ‘Yield on capital’ is
another term employed to express the idea. It is desirable to ascertain this
periodically. The profit being the net result of all operations, the return on capital
expresses all efficiencies or inefficiencies of a business collectively and, thus, is a
dependable measure for judging its overall efficiency or inefficiency. On this basis,
there can be comparison of the efficiency of one department with that of another,
of one plant with that of another, one company with that of another and one industry
with that of another. For this purpose, the amount of profits considered is that
before making deductions on account of interest, income tax and dividends and
capital is the aggregate of all the capital at the disposal of the company, viz., equity
capital, preference capital, reserves, debentures, etc.
The return on capital, when calculated in this manner, would also show
whether the company’s borrowing policy was wise economically and whether the
capital had been employed fruitfully. Suppose funds have been borrowed at 8 per
cent and the return on capital is 7½ per cent, it would have been better not to
borrow (unless borrowing was vital for survival). It would also show that the firm
had not been employing the funds efficiently.
Return on capital, as explained, may also be calculated on equity
shareholders’ capital. In that case, the profit after deductions for interest, income
tax and preference dividend will have to be compared with equity shareholders’
Self-Instructional
Material 213
Ratio Analysis funds. It would not indicate operational efficiency or inefficiency but merely the
maximum rate of dividend that might be declared.
The business can survive only when the return on capital employed is more
than the cost of capital employed in the business.
NOTES
Earning Per Share (EPS)
In order to avoid confusion on account of the varied meanings of the term ‘capital
employed’, the overall profitability can also be judged by calculating earning per
share with the help of the following formula:
Net Profit after Tax and Preference Dividend
Earning per Equity Share =
Number of Equity Shares
Illustration 7.2. Calculate the earning per share from the following data:
Net Profit before Tax `1,00,000
Taxation at 50% of Net Profit
10% Preference Share Capital (`10 each) `1,00,000
Equity Share Capital (`10 shares) `1,00,000
Solution:
Net Profit after Tax and Preference Dividend
Earning per Share =
Number of Equity Shares
` 40,000
= = `4 per share
10,000
Significance: The earning per share helps in determining the market price of the
equity share of the company. A comparison of earning per share of the company
with another will also help in deciding whether the equity share capital is being
effectively used or not. It also helps in estimating the company’s capacity to pay
dividend to its equity shareholders.
Earnings Per Share (EPS – AS 20)
The Institute of Chartered Accountants of India (ICAI) has issued AS 20 – Earnings
per Share, which has become mandatory w.e.f. 1.4.2001, in respect of enterprises
whose equity shares or potential equity shares are listed on a recognized stock
exchange in India.
The Standard makes a distinction between basic and diluted earning per
share. The enterprise has to give both types of earnings as per the standard.
(i) Basic Earnings Per Share (BEPS): The basic earnings per share is computed
as follows:
Net Profit (or Loss) for the Period Attributable to Equity Shareholders
Weighted Average Number of Equity Shares Outstanding during the year
Self-Instructional
214 Material
The net profit for the above purpose means profit after deducting preference Ratio Analysis
dividend and tax, excluding dividend tax on equity shares. The weighted average
number of equity shares are the equity shares outstanding at the beginning of the
period adjusted by the number of equity shares bought back or issued in the
period, multiplied by the time weighting factor. NOTES
Illustration 7.3. From the following details, compute the basic earnings per share:
Net profit for the year ending 31-12-2016 after tax and preference dividend `21,000
Equity as on 1-1-2016 1,800
Issued Equity Shares for Cash on 31-5-2016 600
Bought back Equity Shares on 1-11-2016 300
Solution:
Weighted Average Number of
Equity Shares Outstanding = (1,800 × 12/12 + 600 × 7/12 – 300 × 2/12) = 2,100
shares
Basic Earnings Per Share =
Net Profit for the Period Attributable to Equity Shareholders
Weighted Average No. of Equity Shares Outstanding during the Year
21,000
= = `10 per share
2,100
(ii) Diluted Earnings Per Share (DEPS): Diluted earnings per share are
calculated when there are potential equity shares in the capital structures of the
enterprise. A potential equity share is a financial instrument or other contract (e.g.,
convertible debentures, convertible preference shares, option warrants, etc.) that
entitles or may entitle its holder to equity shares. The diluted earnings per share
are calculated as follows:
Adjusted Net Profit (or Loss) for the Period Attributable to Equity Shareholders
Adjusted Weighted Average Number of Shares
For example, if the market price of a share is `30 and earning per share is
`5, the price earning ratio would be 6 (i.e., 30 ÷ 5). It means the market value of
every one rupee of earning is six times or `6. The ratio is useful in financial
forecasting. It also help in knowing whether the shares of a company are under or
overvalued. For example, if the earning per share of AB Limited is `20, its market
price `140 and earning ratio of similar companies is 8, it means that the market
value of a share of AB Limited should be `160 (i.e., 8 × 20). The share of AB
Limited is, therefore, undervalued in the market by `20. In case the price earning
ratio of similar companies is only 6, the value of share of AB Limited should have
been `120 (6 × 20), thus the share is overvalued by `20.
Significance: Price-earning ratio helps the investor in deciding whether to buy or
not to buy the shares of a company at a particular market price.
Gross Profit Ratio
This ratio expresses relationship between gross profit and net-sales. Its formula is:
Gross Profit
× 100
Net Sales
Illustration 7.5. Calculate the gross profit ratio from the following figures:
` `
Sales 1,00,000 Purchases 60,000
Sales Returns 10,000 Purchases Returns 15,000
Opening Stock 20,000 Closing Stock 5,000
Self-Instructional
216 Material
Solution: Ratio Analysis
Gross Profit
Gross Profit Ratio = 100
Net Sales
Net Sales Cost of goods sold
= 100
Net Sales NOTES
`90,000 ` 60,000
= 100
`90,000
` 30,000
= 100
` 90,000
1
= 33 %
3
Significance: This ratio indicates the degree to which the selling price of goods
per unit may decline without resulting in losses from operations to the firm. It also
helps in ascertaining whether the average percentage of mark up on the goods is
maintained.
There is no norm for judging the gross profit ratio, therefore, the evaluation
of the business on its basis is a matter of judgement. However, the gross profits
should be adequate to cover operating expenses and to provide for fixed charges,
dividends and building up of reserves.
Net Profit Ratio
This ratio indicates net margin earned on a sale of `100. It is calculated as follows:
Net Operating Profit
× 100
Net Sales
Solution:
Net Operating Profit
Net Profit Ratio = 100
Net Sales
20,000
= 100 = 20%
1,00,000
Significance: This ratio helps in determining the efficiency with which affairs of
the business are being managed. An increase in the ratio over the previous period
indicates improvement in the operational efficiency of the business, provided the
gross profit ratio is constant. The ratio is thus an effective measure to check the
profitability of a business.
Self-Instructional
Material 217
Ratio Analysis An investor has to judge the adequacy or otherwise of this ratio by taking
into account the cost of capital, the return in the industry as a whole and market
conditions such as boom or depression period. No norms can be laid down.
However, constant increase in the above ratio year after year is a definite indication
NOTES of improving conditions of the business.
Operating Ratio
This ratio is complementary to net profit ratio. In case the net profit ratio is 20%,
it means that the operating ratio is 80%. It is calculated as follows:
Operating Costs
× 100
Net Sales
Operating costs include the cost of direct materials, direct labour and other
overheads, viz., factory, office or selling. Financial charges such as interest, provision
for taxation, etc., are generally excluded from operating costs.
For example, in the Illustration 7.6 given for the net profit ratio above, when
the net profit ratio is 20%, the operating ratio will be 80%. The ratio can be
calculated regarding each element of operating cost to sales, viz.
Direct Material Cost
(i) Direct Material Cost to Sales = × 100
Net Sales
Direct Labour Cost
(ii) Direct Labour Cost to Sales = × 100
Net Sales
Factory Overheads
(iii) Factory Overheads to Sales = × 100
Net Sales
Self-Instructional
218 Material
This ratio is also called as ‘debt service ratio.’ Ratio Analysis
The standard for this ratio for an industrial company is that interest charges
should be covered six to seven times.
Illustration 7.7. The operating profit of A Ltd after charging interest on debentures NOTES
and tax is a sum of `10,000. The amount of interest charged is `2,000 and the
provision for tax has been made of `4,000.
Calculate the interest charges cover ratio.
Solution:
Net Profit before Interest and Tax
Interest Charges Cover =
Interest Charges
`16,000
= = 8 times
` 2000
The principle payment instalment is adjusted for tax effects since such
payment is not deductible from net profit for tax purposes.
Illustration 7.8. Net profit before interest and tax `50,000. 10 per cent Debentures
(payable in 10 year in equal instalments) `1,00,000.
Tax Rate 50%
Calculate the Debt Service Coverage Ratio.
Solution:
Net Profit before Interest and Tax
Debt Service Coverage Ratio =
Principal Payment Instalment
Interest +
1 – Tax rate
Self-Instructional
Material 219
Ratio Analysis The ratio comes to 1.67. It means net profit before interest and tax covers
adequately both interest and principal repayment instalment. Some accountants
prefer to compute the debt service coverage ratio as under:
Cash Profit available for Debts Service
NOTES
Interest + Principal Payment Instalment
Cash Profit available for debt service is computed by adding to net profit
items like depreciation, interest on debt and amortization of items like goodwill,
preliminary expenses, etc.
However, the former seems to be a better method since by giving the tax
effect, it puts the two items interest and principal payment instalment on the same
footing.
The higher the ratio, better it is.
Payout Ratio
This ratio indicates what proportion of earning per share has been used for paying
dividend. The ratio can be calculated as follows:
Dividend per Equity Share
Earning per Equity Share
Illustration 7.9. Compute the payout ratio and the retained earning ratio from the
following data:
` `
Solution:
Dividend per Equity Share
Payout Ratio = 100
Earning per Equity Share
` 0.40
= 100 = 40%
`1
Retained Earnings
Retained Earning Ratio = 100
Total Earning
`1,800
= 100 = 60%
`3,000
Self-Instructional
220 Material
Retained Earning per share Ratio Analysis
= 100
Total Earning per share
` 0.60
= 100 = 60%
`1
Significance: The payout ratio and the retained earnings ratio are indicators of NOTES
the amount of earnings that have been ploughed back in the business. The lower
the payout ratio, the higher will be the amount of earnings ploughed back in the
business and vice versa. Similarly, the lower the retained earnings ratio, the lower
will be the amount of earnings ploughed back into the business and vice versa. A
lower payout ratio or a higher retained earnings ratio means a stronger financial
position of the company.
Dividend Yield Ratio
This ratio is particularly useful for those investors who are interested only in dividend
income. The ratio is calculated by comparing the rate of dividend per share with
market value. Its formula can be put as follows:
Dividend per share
Market Price per share
Significance: The ratio helps an intending investor in knowing the effective return
he is going to get on the proposed investment. For example, in the above case
though the company is paying a dividend of 20% on its shares, a person who
purchases the shares of the company from the market will get only an effective
return of 6.4%. He, therefore, can decide whether he should opt for this investment
or not.
Du-Pont Model
Profit analysis is the most important application of profitability ratios. Internal
management would like to understand where extra efforts are needed to improve
profitability and where the company has done well. There are mainly three functions
of business, namely, (a) operations, (b) investment and (c) financing. Profits can
be earned or lost from any of these functions. Operations functions involve day-
to-day decisions whereas investing and financing decisions have long-term
implications. These three functions must be tied together to identify areas where
profit is earned or lost. The Du-Pont Company developed a method for tying
these three to explain the incidence of profit earning, which is explained in the next
section.
Self-Instructional
Material 221
Ratio Analysis Simple Du-Pont Chart
Du-Pont Company developed the method of analysing profit making activities
that can be understood from the relevant ratios. The simple Du-Pont chart ties
NOTES three ratios namely, (a) net margin ratio, (b) net asset turnover ratio and (c) capital
structure ratio.
Net Profit Sales Net Assets
ROE
Sales Net Assets Equity
For the XYZ Company, the simple Du-Pont analysis will be as follows:
86.50 1, 900 1, 700
ROE 2013 4.55% 1.12 1.33 6.78%
1,900 1,700 1, 275
The turnover ratios or activity ratios indicate the efficiency with which the capital
employed is rotated in the business. The overall profitability of the business depends NOTES
on two factors: (i) the rate of return of capital employed; and (ii) the turnover, i.e.,
the speed at which the capital employed in the business rotates. Higher the rate of
rotation, the greater will be the profitability. Thus, overall profitability ratio can be
classified into:
1. Net Profit Ratio
2. Turnover Ratio
As already explained the Net Profit Ratio is calculated as follows:
Net Op eratin g Profit
100
Sales
Turnover ratio is calculated as follows:
Sales
Capital employed
Turnover ratio indicates the number of times the capital has been rotated in
the process of doing business.
When these two ratios are put together, we get the overall profitability ratio.
Overall profitability ratio = Net Profit Ratio × Turnover Ratio
Solution: In the above case, if only net profit ratio is seen, Company B seems to
be more profitable. But actually Company A is more profitable, because it has a
higher turnover ratio which gives it a higher return on capital employed, i.e., 30%
in com parison to 24% in case of Company B.
In order to find out which part of capital is efficiently employed and which
part not, different turnover ratios are calculated. These ratios are as follows:
Fixed Assets Turnover Ratio
This ratio indicates the extent to which the investments in fixed assets contributed
towards sales. If compared with a previous period, it indicates whether the
Self-Instructional
Material 223
Ratio Analysis investment in fixed assets has been judicious or not. The ratio is calculated as
follows:
Net Sales
Fixed Assets (Net)
NOTES
Illustration 7.11. The following details have been given to you for Messrs Reckless
Ltd for two years. You are required to find out the fixed assets turnover ratio and
comment on it.
2007 2008
` `
Solution:
Sales
Fixed Assets Turnover Ratio =
Fixed Assets
2007 2008
= 6,00,000 ÷ 1,50,000 = 4 times 8,00,000 ÷ 3,00,000 = 2.67 times
There has been a decline in the fixed assets turnover ratio though, absolute
figures of sales have gone up. It means, increase in the investment in fixed assets
has not brought about commensurate gain. However, the results for next two or
three years must also be seen before commenting on judiciousness or otherwise
of increase in investments in the fixed assets.
The fixed assets turnover ratio can further be divided into turnover of each
item of fixed assets to find out the extent each fixed asset has been properly used.
For example:
Ne t Sale s
Plant and Machinery to Turnover =
Pla nt and Machine ry (Ne t)
Ne t Sale s
Land and Buildings to Turnover
Land a nd Buildings (Ne t)
Working capital turnover ratio may take different forms for different
purposes. Some of them are being explained below:
(i) Debtors’ Turnover Ratio (Debtors’ Velocity): Debtors constitute an
important constituent of current assets and therefore the quality of debtors to a
great extent determines a firm’s liquidity. Two ratios are used by financial analysts
to judge the liquidity of a firm. They are (i) debtors turnover ratio, and (ii) debt
collection period ratio.
Self-Instructional
224 Material
The debtors turnover ratio is calculated as under: Ratio Analysis
The term accounts receivable include ‘trade debtors’ and ‘bills receivable.’ NOTES
Illustration 7.12. Calculate the Debtors Turnover Ratio from the following figures:
`
Total Sales for the year 2017 1,00,000
Cash Sales for the year 2017 20,000
Debtors as on 1 January 2017 10,000
Debtors as on 31 December 2017 15,000
Bills Receivable as on 1 January 2017 7,500
Bills Receivable as on 31 December 2017 12,500
Solution:
Credit Sales
Debtors’ Turnover Ratio =
Average Accounts Receivable
`80,000
= = 3.56 times
` 22,500*
*
1/2 of (`17,500 + `27,500)
In case the details regarding opening and closing receivables and credit
sales are not available the ratio may be calculated as follows:
Total Sales
Accounts Receivable
The two ratios are interrelated. Debtor’s turnover can be obtained by dividing
the months (or days) in a year by the average collection period (e.g., 12/2 = 6).
Similarly, where the number of months (or days) in a year are divided by the
debtors turnover, average debt collection period is obtained (i.e., 12/6 = 2 months).
Significance: Debtors’ collection period measures the quality of debtors since it
measures the rapidity or slowness with which money is collected from them. A
shorter collection period implies prompt payment by debtors. It reduces the chances
of bad debts. A longer collection period implies a too liberal and inefficient credit
collection performance. However, in order to measure a firm’s credit and collection
efficiency, its average collection period should be compared with the average of
the industry. It should be neither too liberal nor too restrictive. A restrictive policy
will result in lower sales which will reduce profits.
It is difficult to provide a standard collection period of debtors. It depends
upon the nature of the industry, seasonal character of the business and credit
policies of the firm. In general, the amount of receivables should not exceed 3–4
months’ credit sales.
(iii) Creditors’ Turnover Ratio (Creditors’ Veloci0ty): It is similar to debtors’
turnover ratio. It indicates the speed with which the payments for credit purchases
are made to the creditors. The ratio can be computed as follows:
Credit Purchases
Average Accounts Payable
The term accounts payable includes ‘trade creditors’ and ‘bills payable.’
Self-Instructional
226 Material
In case the details regarding credit purchases, opening and closing accounts Ratio Analysis
payable have not been given, the ratio may be calculated as follows:
Total Purchases
Accounts Payable
NOTES
(iv) Debt Payment Period Enjoyed Ratio (Average Age of Payables): The
ratio gives the average credit period enjoyed from the creditors. It can be computed
by any one of the following methods:
Months (or days) in a year
(a)
Creditors’ Turnover
Average Accounts Payable × Months (or days) in a year
(b)
Creditors’ Turnover
Average Accounts Payable
(c)
Average Monthly (or daily) Credit Purchases
Illustration 7.14. From the following figures, calculate the creditors’ turnover
ratio and the average age of accounts payable:
` `
Credit Purchases during 2017 1,00,000 Bills Payable on 1 Jan. 2017 4,000
Creditors on 1 Jan. 2017 20,000 Bills Payable on 31 Dec. 2017 6,000
Creditors on 31 Dec. 2017 10,000
Solution:
Credit Purchase ` 1,00,000
Creditors’ Turnover Ratio = = 5 times
Average Accounts Payable ` 20,000
Months in a year 12
Average Age of Accounts Payable = = = 2.4 months
(or credit period enjoyed) Creditor's Turnover 5
Or
Average Accounts Payable × Months in a year 20,000 × 12
= = 2.4 months
Credit Purchases in the year 1,00,000
Or
Average Accounts Payable 20,000
= = 2.4 months
Average Monthly Credit Purchases 8,333.33
Significance: Both the creditors turnover ratio and the debt payment period
enjoyed ratio indicate about the promptness or otherwise in making payment of
credit purchases. A higher ‘creditors turnover ratio’ or a ‘lower credit period
enjoyed ratio’ signifies that the creditors are being paid promptly, thus enhancing
the creditworthiness of the company. However, a very favourable ratio to this
effect also shows that business is not taking full advantage of credit facilities which
can be allowed by the creditors.
(v) Stock Turnover Ratio: This ratio indicates whether investment in inventory is
efficiently used or not. It, therefore, explains whether investment in inventories is
within proper limits or not. The ratio is calculated as follows:
Cost of Goods Sold during the year
Average Inventory
Self-Instructional
Material 227
Ratio Analysis Average inventory is calculated by taking stock levels of raw materials,
work-in-process, finished goods at the end of each month, adding them up and
dividing by twelve.
Inventory ratio can be calculated regarding each constituent of inventory. It
NOTES
may thus be calculated regarding raw materials, work-in-progress and finished
goods:
Cost of Goods Sold
(a)
Average Stock of Finished Goods
Material Consumed
(b)
Average Stock of Raw Materials
The method discussed above is, as a matter of fact, the best basis for
computing the stock turnover ratio. However, in the absence of complete
information, the inventory turnover ratio may also be computed on the following
basis:
Net Sales
Average Inventory at Selling Price
The average inventory may also be calculated on the basis of the average of
inventory at the beginning and at the end of the accounting period.
Inventory at the beginning of the accounting period +
Inventory at the end of the accounting period
Average Inventory =
2
Illustration 7.15. Following is the trading account of Skylarks Ltd. Calculate the
stock turnover ratio:
Dr. Trading Account Cr.
Particulars ` Particulars `
Solution:
Cost of Sales `1,30,000
Stock Turnover Ratio = = 4.33 times
Average Stock 30,000
Significance of the ratio: As already stated, the inventory turnover ratio signifies
the liquidity of the inventory. A high inventory turnover ratio indicates brisk sales.
The ratio is, therefore, a measure to discover the possible trouble in the form of
overstocking or overvaluation. The stock position is known as the graveyard of
Self-Instructional
228 Material
the balance sheet. If the sales are quick such a position would not arise unless the Ratio Analysis
stocks consist of unsaleable items. A low inventory turnover ratio results in blocking
of funds in inventory which may ultimately result in heavy losses due to the inventory
becoming obsolete or deteriorating in quality.
NOTES
7.5 FINANCIAL (ACCOUNTING) RATIOS
Financial ratios indicate the financial position of the company. A company is deemed
to be financially sound if it is in a position to carry on its business smoothly and
meet all its obligations—both long-term as well as short-term without strain. Thus,
its financial position has to be judged from two angles—long-term as well as short-
term. It is a sound principle of finance that long-term requirements of funds should
be met out of long-term funds and short-term requirements should be met out of
short-term funds. For example, if fixed assets are purchased out of funds provided
by bank overdraft, the company will come to grief because such assets cannot be
sold away when payment will be demanded by the bank. We are giving below
some of the important ratios which are calculated in order to judge the financial
position of the company.
Fixed Assets Ratio
This ratio is expressed as follows:
Fixed Assets
Long-term Funds
The ratio should not be more than 1. If it is less than 1, it shows that a part
of the working capital has been financed through long-term funds. This is desirable
to some extent because a part of working capital termed as ‘core working capital’
is more or less of a fixed nature. The ideal ratio is 0.67.
Fixed assets include ‘net fixed assets’ (i.e., original cost – depreciation to
date) and trade investments including shares in subsidiaries. Long-term funds
included share capital, reserves and long-term loans.
Illustration 7.16. From the following information compute the fixed assets ratio:
Particulars ` Particulars `
Solution:
Fixed Assets 2,25,000
Fixed Assets Ratio = = 0.9
Long-term Funds 2,50,000
Self-Instructional
Material 229
Ratio Analysis Current Ratio
This ratio is an indicator of the firm’s commitment to meet its short-term liabilities.
It is expressed as follows:
NOTES Current Assets
Current Liabilities
Solution:
Current Assets `90,000
Current Ratio = 1.8
Current Liabilities `50,000
examples:
Example 1:
` NOTES
Current Assets: Sundry Debtors 40,000
Inventories 60,000
Cash in Hand 1,00,000
Current Liabilities: Sundry Creditors 80,000
Bills Payable 20,000
`2,00,000
Current Ratio = = 3.
`1,00,000
In case the creditors are paid to the extent of `50,000 out of cash in hand,
the current ratio will be as follows:
1,50,000
Current Ratio = = 3.
50,000
Significance: The current ratio is an index of the concern’s financial stability since
it shows the extent of the working capital which is the amount by which the current
assets exceed the current liabilities. As stated earlier, a higher current ratio would
indicate inadequate employment of funds while a poor current ratio is a danger
signal to the management. It shows that the business is trading beyond its resources.
Liquidity Ratio
This ratio is also termed as ‘acid test ratio’ or ‘quick ratio.’ This ratio is ascertained
by comparing the liquid assets (i.e., assets which are immediately convertible into
cash without much loss) to current liabilities prepaid expenses and stock are not
taken as liquid assets. The ratio may be expressed as under:
Liquid Assets
Current Liabilities
On the basis of the figures given in the Illustration the liquidity ratio will be
computed as under:
Liqu id Assets `90,000 ` 40,000 `50,000
= = = = 1
Current Liabilities `50,000 `50,000
Some accountants prefer the term ‘liquid liabilities’ for ‘current liabilities’
for the purpose of ascertaining this ratio. Liquid liabilities mean liabilities which are
Self-Instructional
Material 231
Ratio Analysis payable within a short period. The bank overdraft (if it becomes a permanent
mode of financing) and cash credit facilities will be excluded from current liabilities
in such a case:
The term ‘external equities’ refers to total outside liabilities and the term
‘internal equities’ refers to shareholders’ funds or the tangible net worth (as used
in the pro forma balance sheet given in the preceding pages). In case the ratio is
1 (i.e., outsider's funds are equal to shareholders’ funds), it is considered to be
quite satisfactory.
Total Long-term Debt
(i) Debt–equity Ratio =
Total Long-term Funds
Shareholders' Funds
(ii) Debt–equity Ratio =
Total Long-term Funds
years from the date of their issue should be taken as a part of debt.
Illustration 7.18. From the following figures calculate the debt–equity ratio:
Particulars ` Particulars ` NOTES
Preference Share capital 1,00,000 Unsecured Loans 50,000
Equity Share Capital 2,00,000 Creditors 40,000
Capital Reserves 50,000 Bills Payable 20,000
Profit and Loss A/c 50,000 Provision for Taxes 10,000
12 per cent Mortgage Debenture 1,00,000 Provision for Dividends 20,000
Solution: The debt–equity ratio may be calculated according to any of the following
methods depending on the purpose for which the information is required.
External Equities 2,40,000
(i) Debt–equity Ratio = Internal Equities = = 0.6
4,00,000
Significance: The ratio indicates the proportion of owners’ stake in the business.
Excessive liabilities tend to cause insolvency. The ratio indicates the extent to which
the firm depends upon outsiders for its existence. The ratio provides a margin of
safety to the creditors. It tells the owners the extent to which they can gain the
benefits of maintaining control with a limited investment.
Proprietary Ratio
It is a variant of debt–equity ratio. It establishes relationship between the
proprietors’ or shareholders’ funds and the total tangible assets. It may be expressed
as under:
Shareholders’ Funds
Total Tangible Assets
Self-Instructional
Material 233
Ratio Analysis Solution:
Shareholders’ Funds `3,00,000
Proprietary Ratio = 0.67 or 67%
Total Tangible Assets ` 4,50,000
NOTES Significance: This ratio focuses the attention on the general financial strength of
the business enterprise. The ratio is of particular importance to the creditors who
can find out the proportion of shareholders’ funds in the total assets employed in
the business. A high proprietary ratio will indicate a relatively lesser danger to the
creditors, etc., in the event of forced reorganization or winding up of the company.
A low proprietary ratio indicates greater risk to the creditors since in the event of
losses a part of their money may be lost besides loss to the proprietors of the
business. The higher the ratio, the better it is. A ratio below 50 per cent may be
alarming for the creditors since they may have to lose heavily in the event of
company’s liquidation on account of heavy losses.
The computation of different accounting ratios and the analysis of the financial
statements on their basis can be very well understood with the help of the illustrations
given in the following pages.
Illustration 7.20. Following is the profit and loss account and balance sheet of
Jai Hind Ltd. Redraft them for the purpose of analysis and calculate the following
ratios:
(i) Gross profit ratio; (ii) Overall profitability ratio; (iii) Current ratio;
(iv) Debt–equity ratio; (v) Stock turnover ratio; (vi) Liquidity ratio.
Profit and Loss Account
Particulars ` Particulars `
Balance Sheet
Liabilities ` Assets `
` `
NOTES Sales 10,00,000
Less: Cost of Sales:
Raw Materials consumed
(Opening Stock + Purchases – Closing Stock) 2,00,000
Direct wages 2,00,000
Manufacturing Expenses 1,00,000
Cost of Production 5,00,000
Add: Opening Stock of Finished Goods 1,00,000
6,00,000
Less: Closing Stock of Finished Goods 1,00,000
Cost of goods sold 5,00,000
Gross Profit 5,00,000
Less: Operating Expenses:
Administration Expenses 50,000
Selling and Distribution Expenses 50,000 1,00,000
Net Operating Profit: 4,00,000
Add: Non-trading Income:
Profit on Sale of Shares 50,000
4,50,000
Less: Non-trading Expenses or Losses:
Loss on sale of Plant 55,000
Income before Interest and Tax 3,95,000
Less: Interest on Debentures 10,000
Net Profit before Tax 3,85,000
Self-Instructional
238 Material
Add: Fixed Assets 2,50,000 Ratio Analysis
Capital Employed 5,00,000
Less: Debentures 2,00,000
Shareholders’ Net Worth 3,00,000
Less: Preference Share Capital 1,00,000
NOTES
Equity Shareholders’ Net Worth 2,00,000
Equity Shareholders’ Net Worth is represented by: Equity Share Capital 1,00,000
Reserves 1,00,000
2,00,000
Ratios:
Gross profit 5,00,000
(i) Gross Profit Ratio: 100 = × 100 = 50%
Sales 10,00,000
Operating profit 4,00,000
(ii) Overall Profitability Ratio: Capital employed 100 = 100 = 80%
5,00,000
Current Assets 4,00,000
(iii) Current Ratio: Current Liabilities = = 2.67
5,00,000
External Equities 3,50,000
(iv) Debt–Equity Ratio: Internal Equities = = 1.17
3,00,000
Or
Total Long-term Debt 2,00,000
= = = 0.40
Total Long-term Funds 5,00,000
Or
Total Long-term Debt 2,00,000
= = = 0.67
Total Long-term Funds 3,00,000
(v) Stock Turnover Ratio:
(a) As regards average total inventory
Cost of goods sold 5,00,000
= = 2.5
Average inventory* 2,00,000
(* of raw material as well as finished goods)
(b) As regards average inventory of raw materials:
Cost of goods sold 5,00,000
= =5
Average inventory of raw materials 1,00,000
(c) As regards average inventory of finished goods:
Cost of goods sold 5,00,000
= =5
Average inventory of finished goods 1,00,000
(vi) Liquidity Ratio:
Liquid Assets 1,50,000
Current Liabilities 1,50,000
Self-Instructional
Material 239
Ratio Analysis Illustration 7.21. The balance sheet of Y Ltd stood as follows as on:
(` in lakhs)
You are given the following information for the year 2004–05:
(` in lakhs)
Sales 600
PBIT 150
Interest 24
Provision for tax 60
Proposed dividend 50
From the above particulars calculate for the year 2004–05:
(a) Return on Capital Employed Ratio
(b) Stock Turnover Ratio
(c) Return on Net Worth Ratio
(d) Current Ratio
(e) Proprietary Ratio
Solution:
(i) Return on Capital Employed
PBIT 150
100 i.e., 100 = 37.22%
Average Capital Employed 403
(ii) Stock Turnover Ratio
Sales 600
i.e., = 5.45 times
Average Stock 110
(iii) Return on Net Worth
PAT 235
× 100 i.e., = 22.53%
Average Net Worth 129
(iv) Current Ratio
Current Assets 235
i.e., = 1.82 times
Current Liabilities 129
Self-Instructional
240 Material
Working Notes: Ratio Analysis
(i) Average capital employed (` in lakhs)
31-3-2005 31-3-2004
Total Assets (excluding Misc. ex) 535 425
Less: Creditors and Other Current Liabilities 129 25
NOTES
406 400
Illustration 7.22. With the help of the following ratios regarding Indu Films, draw
the balance sheet of the company for the year 2005:
Current Ratio 2.5
Liquidity Ratio 1.5
Net Working Capital `3,00,000
Stock Turnover Ratio (cost of sales/closing stock) 6 times
Gross Profit Ratio 20 per cent
Fixed Assets Turnover Ratio (on cost of sales) 2 times
Debt Collection Period 2 months
Fixed assets to Shareholders Net Worth 0.80
Reserve and Surplus to Capital 0.50
Self-Instructional
Material 241
Ratio Analysis Solution:
Balance Sheet
as on......
Liabilities ` Assets `
NOTES
Share Capital 5,00,000 Fixed Assets 6,00,000
Reserve and Surplus 2,50,000 Debtors 2,50,000
Long-term Borrowings Stock 2,00,000
(balancing figure) 1,50,000 Bank 50,000
Current Liabilities 2,00,000
11,00,000 11,00,000
Working Notes:
If Current Liabilities =1
Current Assets = 2.5
It means the difference or Working Capital = 1.5
Working Capital is 1.5 = `3,00,000
Therefore, Current Assets = `5,00,000
Current Liabilities = `2,00,000
As Liquidity Ratio = 1.5
And Current Liabilities = `2,00,000
Therefore, the Liquid Assets
(bank and debtors) (2,00,000 × 1.5) = `3,00,000
Stock (5,00,000 – 3,00,000, i.e.,
current assets–liquid assets) = `2,00,000
Cost of Sales (as stock turnover ratio is 6) = `12,00,000
Sales (as G.P. ratio is 20 per cent,
20
12,00, 000 12,00,000 = `15,00,000
80
Fixed Assets are `12,00,000/2 since fixed assets
turnover ratio is 2 = `6,00,000
Debtors are `15,00,000/6 since debt collection
period is 2 months = `2,50,000
6,00,00 1
Shareholders’ Net Worth = `7,50,000
0.80
Out of Shareholders’ Net Worth Reserves and Surplus = `2,50,000
Therefore, share capital = `5,00,000
Illustration 7.23. With the following ratios and further information given below,
prepare a trading account, profit and loss account and a balance sheet of Shri
Narain:
(i) Gross Profit Ratio 25% (vi) Fixed Assets/Capital 5/4
(ii) Net Profit/Sales 20% (vii) Fixed Assets/Total
(iii) Stock-turnover Ratio 10 Current Assets 5/7
(iv) Net Profit/Capital 1/5 (viii) Fixed Assets `10,00,000
(v) Capital to Total (ix) Closing Stock `1,00,000
Liabilities 1/2
Self-Instructional
242 Material
Solution: Ratio Analysis
Trading and Profit & Loss Account
for the year ended...
Particulars ` Particulars `
Balance Sheet
as on....
Liabilities ` Assets `
Working Notes:
1. Fixed Assets are `10,00,000
Fixed Assets Capital = 5 4
Capital = 10,00,000 4 5 = `8,00,000
2. Capital is 1/2 of Total Liabilities
Liabilities = 8,00,000 2 = `16,00,000
3. Net Profit is 1/5 of Capital
Net Profit = 8,00,000 1/5 = `1,60,000
4. Net Profit is 20% of Sales
Sales = 1,60,000 100 20 = `8,00,000
5. Gross Profit Ratio is 25% of Sales
Gross Profit = `2,00,000
6. Stock Turnover Ratio (i.e., Cost of Sales/Average Inventory) is 10
Cost of Sales = Sales – Gross Profit
= `8,00,000 – 2,00,000 = `6,00,000
Average Inventory is `6,00,000
7. Closing Stock is `1,00,000
Average Inventory is `60,000
Opening Stock is `20,000
8. Fixed Assets are `10,00,000
Fixed Assets/Total Current Assets = 5 7
Total Current assets are 10,00,000 7/5 `14,00,000
Stock is `1,00,000
Other Current Assets are `13,00,000
Illustration 7.24. From the following, you are required to comment upon the
long-term as well as short-term solvency of the company.
Self-Instructional
Material 243
Ratio Analysis Balance Sheet
as on 31 December 2008
Liabilities ` Assets `
Solution:
Long-term Solvency Ratios:
Total Long-term Debt 2,50,000
Debt–Equity Ratio 0.33
Total Long-term Funds 7,50,000
The proportion of the long-term debt in total long-term funds is only 33%. It
means shareholders’ funds are 67% of the total long-term funds. Even if borrowed
funds would have been 50%, the financial position of the company would have been
considered as quite good. The company, therefore, has a sound financial position from
this angle.
Fixed Assets 6,00,000
Fixed Assets Ratio 0.8
Long-term Funds 7,50,000
Long-term requirements of funds should be met out of long-term funds. Judged
from this angle the company has not only met the long-term financial requirements
(i.e., for Fixed Assets) out of long-term funds but it has also met a part of working
capital requirements from long-term funds. The ideal ratio is 0.67. The present ratio is
0.8 and hence it is quite satisfactory.
Short-term Solvency Ratios:
Current Assets 4,00,000
Current Ratio = = = 1.6
Current Liabilities 2,50,000
The ideal ratio is from 1.5 to 2; the position is, therefore, quite satisfactory.
Liquid Assets 3,00,000
Liquidity Ratio = = = 1.2
Current Liabilities 2,50,000
The ideal ratio is 1. The present ratio of 1.2 is, therefore, also satisfactory.
Illustration 7.25. Shamsher Sterling Limited has been operating for two years.
The most important facts as appearing from its accounts are as under:
Balance Sheet
First Year Second First Year Second
Liabilities Assets
` Year ` ` Year `
Equity Shares Goodwill 60,000 60,000
of `10 each 1,00,000 1,00,000 Fixed Assets (at cost) 1,40,000 1,60,000
Reserves 20,000 30,000 Stocks 30,000 60,000
Profit and Loss Balance 30,000 20,000 Sundry Debtors 30,000 60,000
Secured Loans 80,000 80,000 Advances 10,000
Bank overdraft 20,000 Cash Balances 30,000 —
Sundry Creditors 50,000 70,000 —
Provision for Taxation 20,000 20,000
3,00,000 3,40,000 3,00,000 3,40,000
Self-Instructional
244 Material
Profit and Loss Appropriation Account Ratio Analysis
You find that the total sales amounted to `6,00,000 in the first year and `5,00,000
in the second year.
Examine the above details and give a step-by-step analysis in a manner which
indicates the overall efficiency of the business and its financial position.
Solution: Shamsher Sterling Limited
Analysis of Working Capital and Financial Position
Self-Instructional
Material 245
Ratio Analysis The last reason seems to be most probable, because normally the selling
price of the articles can be adjusted to cover rise in the costs of the product.
(2) There has been an all-round decline in utilization of the resources, as
evidenced by capital turnover ratio. Even if it is assumed that there has
NOTES
been a fall in the fixed assets turnover ratios because the fixed assets were
added towards the end of the year and, therefore, they could not properly
be utilized, there seems little justification for a very sharp fall in the stock
turnover ratio. On the same basis, there is no justification for increase in the
debt collection period. These two ratios are very disturbing and they
immediately raise the question regarding the reliability of the two figures of
stocks and sundry debtors. The fall in sales but increase in inventories and
debt collection period are indicators that the unsaleable items have been
included in the stocks and the sundry debtors include doubtful debts. If that
is true, the profit figure in the second year seems to be unreliable. Actually,
there may be a loss. The management should, therefore, investigate
thoroughly to determine the truth.
(3) The sharp fall in the quantum of sales has raised one more adverse possibility.
The company might be operating extremely close to the break-even point.
This may ultimately result in losses to the company if the sales decrease still
further. The management should, therefore, see that the sales are augmented
and the costs are reduced by full utilization of the present facilities and
resources available at the disposal of the company.
Financial Position: The following ratios reveal the financial position of the
company:
First Year Second Year
(iii) Paying dividend and that too at double the rate of the previous year
Moreover, the company has paid dividend without providing for depreciation
on fixed assets. This is clear violation of the provisions of section 205 of the NOTES
Companies Act. The company will be put to serious difficulties when the assets
become useless after their useful life in case the company continues to follow the
policy of not providing for depreciation, as it will be almost impossible for the
company to replace these assets. The company has also not made any provision
for repayment of loan. It should have created a sinking fund for this purpose. The
amount of goodwill appearing in the balance sheet of the company is also valueless
in view of the fact that the company has extremely low profits.
Management should, therefore, take immediate remedial measures regarding
the following matters:
(i) Better sales performance
(ii) Cost control and cost reduction
(iii) Ascertainment of profits of the business according to strict accounting
principles
(iv) Better control over inventories and collection of book debts
(v) No payment of dividend till the company raises enough cash resources to
meet it requirements
Self-Instructional
Material 247
Ratio Analysis 4. The two factors on which the overall profitability of the business depends
are: (i) the rate of return of capital employed, (ii) the turnover.
5. The debtors’ collection period measures the quality of debtors since it
measures the rapidity or slowness with which the money is collected from
NOTES
them.
6. The ideal fixed assets ratio is 0.67.
7. Another name for ‘debt-equity’ ratio is ‘external-internal’ equity ratio.
8. Window dressing means manipulation of accounts in a way so as to conceal
vital facts and present the financial statements in a way as to show a better
position than what it actually is.
9. Two techniques which are helpful in incorporating price level changes in
ratio analysis are: current purchasing power and current cost accounting.
7.9 SUMMARY
Ratios can be classified into different categories depending upon the basis
of classification.
As per the Traditional classification, ratios could be classified as: profit and
loss account ratios, balance sheet ratios, and composite ratios.
In order that ratios serve as a tool for financial analysis, they are classified
according to their functions as follows: (i) Profitability ratios, (ii) Turnover
ratios, and (iii) Financial ratios.
Profitability is an indication of the efficiency with which the operations of
the business are carried on.
The following are the different profitability ratios: overall profitability ratio,
earning per share, price earnings ratio, gross profit ratio, operating ratio,
fixed charges cover, debt service coverage ratio, payout ratio and dividend
yield ratio.
The turnover ratios or activity ratios indicate the efficiency with which the
capital employed is rotated in the business.
The following are the different turnover ratios: fixed assets turnover ratio
and working capital turnover ratio.
Financial ratios indicate the financial position of the company. The following
are the different financial ratios: fixed assets ratio, current ratio, liquidity
ratio, debt-equity ratio, and proprietary ratio.
The following are some of the advantages of ratio analysis: simplifies financial
statements, facilitates inter-firm comparison, makes intra-firm comparison
possible and helps in planning.
Self-Instructional
248 Material
The limitations of ratio analysis is that: it requires comparative study, the Ratio Analysis
Self-Instructional
Material 249
Ratio Analysis Long Answer Questions
1. Explain the role of ratio analysis in the interpretation of financial statements.
Examine the limitations of ratio analysis.
NOTES 2. How do you analyse and interpret financial statements of a company for
reporting on the soundness of its capital structure and solvency.
3. ‘Ratios like statistics have a set of principles and finality about them which
at times may be misleading.’ Discuss with illustrations.
4. ‘Accounting Ratios are mere guides and complete reliance on them in
decision making is suicidal.’ Elucidate.
5. The four basic group of financial ratios are liquidity, leverage, activity
(efficiency) and profitability. Explain their nature and indicate its principal
users.
6. Write short notes on:
(i) Proprietary Ratio
(ii) Debt Coverage Ratio
(iii) P/E Ratio
(iv) Yield Ratio
(v) Market Value/Book Value of Shares
Self-Instructional
250 Material
Fund Flow Analysis
8.0 INTRODUCTION
The funds flow statement is widely used by the financial analysts, credit granting
institutions and financial managers in performance of their jobs. It has become a
useful tool in their analytical kit. This is because the financial statements, i.e., ‘income
statement’ and the ‘balance sheet’ have a limited role to perform. Income statement
measures flows restricted to transactions that pertain to rendering of goods or
services to customers. The balance sheet is merely a static statement. It is a statement
of assets and liabilities as on a particular date. It does not sharply focus those major
financial transactions which have been behind the balance sheet changes. One has to
draw inferences from the balance sheet about major financial transactions only after
comparing the balance sheets of two periods. For example, if the fixed assets worth
`2,00,000 are purchased during the current year by raising share capital of
`2,00,000, the balance sheet will simply show a higher capital figure and higher fixed
assets figure. In case, one compares the current year’s balance sheet with the
previous year’s balance sheet, then only one can draw an inference that fixed assets
were acquired by raising share capital of `2,00,000. Similarly, certain important
transactions which might occur during the course of the accounting year might not Self-Instructional
Material 251
Fund Flow Analysis find any place in the balance sheet. For example, if a loan of `2,00,000 was raised
and paid in the accounting year, the balance sheet will not depict this transaction.
However, a financial analyst must know the purpose for which the loan was utilized
and the source from which it was raised. This will help him in making a better estimate
NOTES about the company’s financial position and policies. In the following pages, we are
explaining the meaning and utility of this type of statement and the technique of
preparing it.
8.1 OBJECTIVES
It will be appropriate to explain the meaning of the term ‘funds’ and the term ‘flow
of funds’ before explaining the meaning of the term ‘funds flow statement’.
8.2.1 Meaning of Funds
The term ‘funds’ has a variety of meanings. There are people who take it synonymous
to cash and to them there is no difference between a funds flow statement and a
cash flow statement. While others include marketable securities besides cash in
the definition of the term ‘funds’. The International Accounting Standard No. 7 on
‘Statement of Changes in Financial Position’ also recognizes the absence of a
single, generally accepted, definition of the term. According to the standard, ‘the
term ‘fund’ generally refers to cash and cash equivalents, or to working capital.’
Of these, the last definition of the term is by far the most common definition of
‘fund’.
There are also two concepts of working capital—gross concept and net
concept. Gross working capital refers to the firm’s investment in current assets
while term net working capital means excess of current assets over current
liabilities. It is in the latter sense in which the term ‘funds’ is generally used.
Current Assets: The term ‘current assets’ includes assets which are acquired
with the intention of converting them into cash during the normal business operations
of the company. However, the best definition of the term ‘current assets’ has been
given by Grady in the following words:
‘For accounting purposes, the term ‘current assets’ is used to designate
Self-Instructional cash and other assets or resources commonly identified as those which
252 Material
are reasonably expected to be realised in cash or sold or consumed Fund Flow Analysis
during the normal operating cycle of the business.’
The broad categories of current assets, therefore, are (i) cash including
fixed deposits with banks, (ii) accounts receivable, i.e., trade debtors and bills
receivable, (iii) inventory, i.e., stocks of raw materials, work-in-progress, finished NOTES
goods, stores and spare parts, (iv) advances recoverable, i.e., the advances given
to supplier of goods and services or deposits with government or other public
authorities, e.g., customs, port authorities and advance income tax, (v) prepaid
expenses, i.e., cost of unexpired services, e.g., insurance premiums paid in advance,
etc.
It should be noted that short-term investments should be included in the
definition of the term current assets, while loose tools should be excluded from the
category of current assets. Of course, this is not strictly according to the requirements
of the Companies Act, regarding the presentation of financial statements, where
investments even though held temporarily are to be shown separately from current
assets while loose tools are to be shown under the category of current assets.
Current Liabilities: The term ‘current liabilities’ is used principally to designate
such obligations whose liquidation is reasonably expected to require the use of
assets classified as current assets in the same balance sheet or the creation of
other current liabilities, or those expected to be satisfied within a relatively short
period of time usually one year. However, this concept of current liabilities has
now undergone a change. The more modern version designates current liabilities
as all obligations that will require within the coming year or the operating cycle,
whichever, is longer (i) the use of existing current assets or (ii) the creation of
other current liabilities. In other words, the mere fact that an amount is due within
a year does not make it a current liability unless it is payable out of existing current
assets or by creation of current liabilities. For example, debentures due for
redemption within a year of the balance sheet date will not be taken as a current
liability if they are to be paid out of the proceeds of a fresh issue of shares/
debentures or out of the proceeds realised on account of sale of debentures
redemption fund investments.
The term current liabilities also includes amounts set apart or provided for
any known liability of which the amount cannot be determined with substantial
accuracy, e.g., provision for taxation and pension. These liabilities are technically
called provisions rather than liabilities.
The broad categories of current liabilities are:
(i) Accounts payable, e.g., bills payable and trade creditors
(ii) Outstanding expenses, i.e., expenses for which services have been
received by the business but for which the payment has not been made
(iii) Bank overdrafts
(iv) Short-term loans, i.e., loans from banks, etc., which are payable within
one year from the date of balance sheet
Self-Instructional
Material 253
Fund Flow Analysis (v) Advance payments received by the business for the services to be
rendered or goods to be supplied in future
(vi) Current maturities of long-term loans, i.e., long-term debts due within
a year of the balance sheet date or instalments due within a year in
NOTES
respect of these loans, provided payable out of existing current assets
or by creation of current liabilities, as discussed earlier. However,
instalments of long-term loans due after a year should be taken as
non-current liabilities.
Provisions against Current Assets: Provisions against current assets, such
as provision for doubtful debts, provisions for loss of stock and provision for
discount on debtors, are treated as current liabilities, since they reduce the amount
of current assets.
Non-current Assets: All liabilities other than current assets come within the
category of non-current assets. Such assets include goodwill, land, building,
machinery, furniture, long-term investments, patent rights, trade marks, debit balance
of the profit and loss account, discount on issue of shares and debentures,
preliminary expenses, etc.
Non-current Liabilities: All liabilities other than current liabilities come within
the category of non-current liabilities. They include share capital, long-term loans,
debentures, securities premium, credit balance in the profit and loss account, revenue
and capital reserves (e.g., general reserve, dividend equalization fund, debentures
sinking fund and capital redemption reserve).
Meaning of ‘Flow of Funds’
The term ‘flow’ means change and, therefore, the term ‘flow of funds’ means
‘change in funds’ or ‘change in working capital.’ In other words, any increase or
decrease in working capital means ‘flow of funds.’
In business, several transactions take place. Some of these transactions
increase the funds while others decrease the funds. Some may not make any change
in the funds position. In case a transaction results in increase of funds, it will be
termed as a ‘source of funds.’ For example, if the funds are `10,000 and on account
of a business transaction, say, issue of shares, they become `15,000, ‘issue of
shares’ will be taken as a source of funds. In case a transaction results in decrease of
funds it will be taken as an application or use of funds. For example, if the funds are
` 10,000 and on account of a transaction say, purchase of furniture of `5,000, they
stand reduced to `5,000, the purchase of furniture will be taken as an ‘application of
funds.’ In case a transaction does not make any change in the funds position that
existed just before the happening of the transaction, it is said that it is a non-fund
transaction. For example, if the funds are `10,000 and a fixed asset of `5,000 is
purchased by issuing shares of `5,000 the funds position will not change, and
therefore, this transaction will be taken as a non-fund transaction.
Self-Instructional
254 Material
The following extracts from the balance sheet of a company will give a more Fund Flow Analysis
The above extracts from the balance sheet show that the company has got
a working capital of `1,50,000 computed as given below:
`
Current Assets 3,00,000
Current Liabilities 1,50,000
Working Capital 1,50,000
There will be flow of funds in case working capital position of the company
changes on account of any transaction. We are giving some of the transactions
which have taken place after preparation of the above balance sheet of the company.
Each transaction has been considered independently:
1. The company realizes, `20,000 from its debtors. This transaction will reduce
the debtors from `80,000 to `60,000 but increase the cash balance from
` 20,000 to `40,000. Thus, the total current assets continue at the old figure of
`3,00,000. This means this transaction will not bring any change in the working
capital position of the company. It is simply conversion of one current asset into
another current asset.
2. The company pays to its creditors a sum of `10,000 out of the cash balance.
This will reduce the cash balance from `20,000 to `10,000. The total current
assets will stand reduced from `3,00,000 to `2,90,000. The sundry creditors
will stand reduced from `50,000 to `40,000. Thus, the position will be as
follows:
Self-Instructional
Material 255
Fund Flow Analysis `
Current Assets 2,90,000
Current Liabilities 1,40,000
Working Capital 1,50,000
NOTES Thus, the transaction has not resulted into any change in the working capital
position. It continues to stand at `1,50,000. This is because the two accounts
involved in the transaction are the constituents of working capital itself, i.e.,
current assets and current liabilities.
3. The company purchases furniture of `10,000 by raising long-term loan of
`10,000. This transaction will not have any effect on working capital position,
since the transaction involves a non-current asset and a non-current liability
which are not the constituents of the working capital.
4. The company redeems preference shares of `1,00,000 by issuing 12
per cent debentures of `1,00,000. This transaction will also not involve any
change in the working capital position on account of the fact that both the two
accounts involved in the transactions are not the constituents of the working
capital.
5. The company raises `50,000 in cash by issue of new shares. This transaction
will increase the cash balance of the company from `20,000 to `70,000
while there will be no change in the current liabilities position. The working
capital will, therefore, be computed as follows:
`
Current Assets 3,50,000
Current Liabilities 1,50,000
Working Capital 2,00,000
(vi) current liabilities and fixed assets e.g., buildings transferred to creditors
in satisfaction of their claims
2. There will be ‘no flow of funds’ if a transaction involves: NOTES
(i) current assets and current liabilities., e.g., payment made to creditors
in cash
(ii) fixed assets and fixed liabilities, e.g., building purchased and payment
made in debentures
(iii) fixed assets and capital, e.g., building purchased and payment made
in shares
8.2.2 Finding out of Transaction Involving Change in Working
Capital
In order to determine whether a transaction will result in change in working capital
or not, it will be appropriate to pass a journal entry for the transaction. In case the
entry involves accounts which are only of a fixed (asset or liability) nature or only
of a current (asset or liability) nature there will be no flow of funds. But a ‘cross
transaction’ (i.e., a transaction involving a fixed asset or a fixed liability and a
current asset or a current liability) will result in flow of funds. We have given an
analysis of certain transactions to make this point clear.
1. When shares are issued for cash, the journal entry is:
Bank A/c Dr.
To Share Capital A/c
Bank account is a current asset while share capital account is a fixed liability.
Thus, this is a cross-transaction. It will, therefore, result in change in working
capital.
2. When shares are issued to the vendors for purchase of building, the effective
journal entry is:
Building A/c Dr.
To Share Capital A/c
Building is a fixed asset while share capital is a fixed liability. There is no ‘cross-
transaction’ and, therefore, there will be no change in the funds position of the
business.
3. When debtors are realized:
Bank A/c Dr.
To Sundry Debtors A/c
Bank and Debtors both are current assets and, therefore, there will be no
change in the funds position of the business.
4. When a provision for doubtful debts is made:
Profit and Loss A/c Dr.
To Provision for Doubtful Debts A/c
Profit and loss account is a fixed liability since it is part of the shareholders’
funds while provision for doubtful debts is a current liability (it reduces debtors).
There is a ‘cross’ transaction and, therefore, there will be flow of funds. The funds
will decrease. Self-Instructional
Material 257
Fund Flow Analysis 5. When creditors are issued bills payable:
Creditors A/c Dr.
To Bills Payable A/c
Both creditors and bills payable are current liabilities and, therefore, there will
NOTES be no effect on funds.
6. When payment of bills payable is made:
Bills Payable A/c Dr.
To Bank A/c
Bills payable and bank both belong to the category of ‘current’ accounts and,
therefore, there will be no effect on funds.
7. Cash realized from bills receivable:
Bank A/c Dr.
To Bills Receivable A/c
There will be no flow of funds since both are ‘current’ accounts.
8. Loss on sale of machinery:
Profit and Loss A/c Dr.
To Machinery A/c
Since both are ‘non-current’ accounts, there will be no flow of funds.
9. Money realized on account of sale of machinery:
Bank A/c Dr.
To Machinery A/c
Bank account is a current asset account, while machinery account is a fixed
asset account. Hence, there is a ‘cross’ transaction. The funds will, therefore,
increase on account of this transaction.
10. Transfer to general reserve:
Profit and Loss Appropriation A/c Dr.
To General Reserve A/c
Both are ‘non-current’ accounts and, therefore, there will be no flow of funds.
11. Building sold on credit:
Debtors A/c Dr.
To Building A/c
Debtors account is a current asset account, while building account is a fixed
asset account. Thus, there is a ‘cross’ transaction and, therefore, there will be flow
of funds. The funds would increase by the sale value of the building.
12. Inventory purchased by issuing shares:
Inventories A/c Dr.
To Share Capital A/c
Inventories belong to the category of current assets while share capital belongs to
the category of non-current liabilities. There is a ‘cross’ transaction and, therefore, there
will be flow of funds. The funds would increase by the amount.
13. Rent paid:
Rent A/c Dr.
To Bank A/c
Rent account will be transferred to the profit and loss account at the end of the
accounting period. The entry will be:
Profit and Loss A/c Dr.
Self-Instructional To Rent A/c
258 Material
Thus, the effective entry has been: Fund Flow Analysis
Profit and Loss A/c Dr.
To Bank A/c
Profit and loss account is a non-current liability, while bank account is a current
asset. There is a ‘cross’ transaction and hence, there will be flow of funds. NOTES
A funds flow statement is, therefore, a statement depicting change in working
capital. It is also termed as a ‘Statement of Sources and application of funds’,
‘summary of financial operations’, ‘funds generated and expended’, ‘where got
and where gone statement’, ‘Statement of changes in working capital’, etc.
8.2.3 Uses of Funds Flow Statement
Funds flow statement helps the financial analyst in having a more detailed analysis
and understanding of changes in the distribution of resources between two balance
sheet dates. In case such a study is required regarding the future working capital
position of the company, a projected funds flow statement can be prepared. The
uses of a funds flow statement can be put as follows:
1. It explains the financial consequences of business operations: Funds
flow statement provides a ready answer to so many conflicting situations.
Such as:
(a) Why the liquid position of the business is becoming more and more
unbalanced in spite of business making more and more profits?
(b) How was it possible to distribute dividends in excess of current earnings
or in the presence of a net loss for the period?
(c) How the business could have good liquid position in spite of business
making losses or acquisition of fixed assets?
(d) Where have the profits gone?
Definite answers to these questions will help the financial analyst in advising
his employer/client regarding directing of funds to those channels which will
be most profitable for the business.
2. It answers intricate queries: The financial analyst can find out answer to
a number of intricate questions:
(a) What is the overall creditworthiness of the enterprise?
(b) What are the sources of repayments of the loans taken?
(c) How much funds are generated through normal business operations?
(d) In what way the management has utilized the funds in the past and
what are going to be likely uses of funds?
3. It acts as an instrument for allocation of resources: A projected funds
flow statement will help analyst in finding out how the management is going
to allocate the scarce resources for meeting the productive requirements of
the business. The use of funds should be phased in such an order that the
Self-Instructional
Material 259
Fund Flow Analysis available resources are put to the best use of the enterprise. The funds
should be managed in such a way that the business is in a position to make
payment of interest and loan instalments as per the agreed schedule.
4. It is a test as to effective or otherwise use of working capital: Funds
NOTES
flow statement is a test of effective use of working capital by the management
during a particular period. The adequacy or inadequacy of working capital
will tell the financial analyst about the possible steps that the management
should take for effective use of surplus working capital or make arrangements
in case of inadequacy of working capital.
8.2.4 Funds Flow Statement vs Income Statement
A funds flow statement differs from an income statement (i.e., profit and loss
account) in several aspects:
(i) A funds flow statement deals with the financial resources required for running
the business activities. It explains how were the funds obtained and how
were they used. An income statement however, discloses the results of the
business activities, i.e., how much has been earned and how it has been
spent.
(ii) A funds flow statement matches the ‘funds raised’ and ‘funds applied’ during
a particular period. The sources and applications of funds may be of capital
as well as of revenue nature. An income statement matches the incomes of
a period with the expenditure of that period which are both of a revenue
nature. For example, where shares are issued for cash, it becomes a source
of funds while preparing a funds flow statement but it is not an item of
income for an income statement.
(iii) Sources of funds are many besides operations such as share capital,
debentures, sale of fixed assets, etc. An income statement which discloses
the results of operations cannot even accurately tell about the funds from
operations alone because of non-fund items (such as depreciation, writing
off of fictitious assets, etc.) being included therein.
Thus, both income statement and funds flow statement have different
functions to perform. Modern management needs both. One cannot be a substitute
for the other rather they are complementary to each other.
Self-Instructional
260 Material
Fund Flow Analysis
8.3 PREPARATION OF FUNDS FLOW
STATEMENT
In order to prepare a funds flow statement, it is necessary to find out the ‘sources’ NOTES
and ‘applications’ of funds.
8.3.1 Sources of Funds
The source of funds can be both internal as well as external.
1. Internal Sources: Funds from operations are the only internal source of funds.
However, following adjustments will be required in the figure of net profit for
finding out real funds from operations:
(a) Add the following items as they do not result in outflow of funds:
(i) Depreciation on fixed assets
(ii) Preliminary expenses or goodwill, etc., written off
(iii) Contribution to debenture redemption fund, transfer to general reserve,
etc., if they have been deducted before arriving at the figure of net
profit
(iv) Provision for taxation and proposed dividend are usually taken as
appropriation of profits only and not current liabilities for the purposes
of funds flow statement. This is being discussed in detail later. Tax or
dividends actually paid are taken as applications of funds. Similarly
interim dividend paid is shown as an application of funds. All these
items will be added back to net profit, if already deducted, to find
funds from operations.
(v) Loss on sale of fixed assets
(b) Deduct the following items as they do not increase funds:
(i) Profit on sale of fixed assets, since the full sale proceeds are taken as
a separate source of funds and inclusion here will result in duplication
(ii) Profit on revaluation of fixed assets
(iii) Non-operating incomes, such as dividend received or accrued
dividend, refund of income tax, rent received or accrued rent. These
items increase funds but they are non-operating incomes. They will be
a shown under separate heads as ‘source of funds’ in the funds flow
statement.
In case the profit and loss account shows ‘net loss’, this should be taken as
an item which decreases the funds.
Self-Instructional
Material 261
Fund Flow Analysis Illustration 8.1. From the following profit and loss account, compute the funds
from operations:
Solution:
Funds from Operations
` `
Net Loss as per Profit and Loss A/c (–) 5,000
Add: Items which do not decrease funds: 1,000
Depreciation
Preliminary Expenses 2,000
Loss on Sale of Land 5,000 8,000
Funds from Operations 3,000
It may be noted that the two items ‘Rent’ and ‘Interest on Investments’ are
strictly, not items of operating incomes. In case it is desired to calculate ‘funds
from operations’ in a strict sense, any non-operating income will have also to be
excluded while finding out funds from operations. Such items will be shown as a
separate source under the head. ‘Non-operating Incomes’ in the funds flow
statement. In the present Illustration the items will then appear in the funds flow
statement as follows:
`
Sources:
Funds from Non-operating Incomes 9,000
Applications:
Outflow of Funds on account of operations (`3,000 – `9,000) 6,000
Increase in Working Capital 3,000
Tutorial Note: The students may not interpret the term ‘funds from operations’ so strictly. They may
solve an examination problem as per solution given in the first alternative.
Illustration 8.2. The net profit after making a provision of `3,30,000 for Income
Tax of Tata Ltd for the year ended 31 March 2017 amounts to `3,00,000. This
figure of the net profit has been arrived at after taking into account the following
items:
Self-Instructional
262 Material
Fund Flow Analysis
`
Depreciation on Fixed Assets 65,000
Preliminary Expenses written off 7,000
Bad debts 1,000
Loss on sale of furniture 1,500 NOTES
Profit on sale of long-term investments 5,000
`
Profit after Tax 3,00,000
Add: Depreciation on Fixed Assets 65,000
Preliminary expenses written off 7,000
Loss on sale of furniture 1,500
73,500
3,73,500
Less: Profit on sale of Long-term Investments 5,000
Funds from Operations 3,68,500
Illustration 8.3. Following are the extracts from the balance sheet of a company
as on 31 December 2016 and 31 December 2017. You are required to calculate
funds from operations:
Balance Sheet
as on 31 December
(`)
As on 31 December
2016 2017
Profit and Loss Appropriation Account 30,000 40,000
General Reserve 20,000 25,000
Goodwill 10,000 5000
Preliminary Expenses 6,000 4,000
Provisions for Depreciation on Machinery 10,000 12,000
Solution:
Funds from Operations
`
Profit and Loss Appropriation A/c balance as on 31 December 2017 40,000
Add: Items which do not decrease funds:
Transfer to General Reserve 5,000
Goodwill written off 5,000
Preliminary Expenses written off 2,000
Provision for Depreciation on Machinery 2,000
54,000
Less: Profit and Loss Appropriation A/c balance as on 31 December 2016 30,000
Funds from Operations 24,000
Self-Instructional
Material 263
Fund Flow Analysis The funds from operations can also be found out by preparing an adjusted
profit and loss account:
Adjusted Profit and Loss Account
Particulars ` Particulars `
NOTES
To Transfer to General Reserve 5,000 By Balance b/d 30,000
To Goodwill written off 5,000 By Funds from Operations
To Preliminary Expenses written off 2,000 (bal. fig.) 24,000
To Provision for Depreciation 2,000
To Balance c/d 40,000
54,000 54,000
Sources of Funds:
Issue of Shares .....
Issue of Debentures .....
Long-term Borrowings .....
Sale of Fixed Assets .....
Operating Profit* .....
Applications of Funds: Total Sources .....
Redemption of Redeemable Preference Shares .....
Redemption of Debentures .....
Payment of other Long-term Loans .....
Purchase of Fixed Assets .....
Operating Loss* .....
Payment of Dividends, Tax, etc. .....
Total Uses .....
Net Increase/Decrease in Working Capital (Total Sources—Total Uses) .....
Self-Instructional
* Only one of the figures will be there. Material 265
Fund Flow Analysis The funds flow statement can also be prepared in ‘T ’ shape form as shown below:
Funds Flow Statement
Particulars ` Particulars `
Additional Information:
Tax paid during 2017 `2,500
Dividends paid during 2017 `1,000
Solution:
(i) When provision for tax and proposed dividends are taken as non-current
liabilities:
Schedule of Changes in Working Capital
Self-Instructional
Material 267
Fund Flow Analysis Funds Flow Statement
Sources
Increase in Share Capital 5,000
Funds from Operations:
NOTES Net Profit 2,000
Add: Provision for Tax made during
the year (`3,000 + `2,500 – `2,000) 3,500
Add: Proposed Dividends 1,500 7,000
Total Sources 12,000
Applications:
Fixed assets purchased 10,000
Tax paid 2,500
Dividends paid 1,000
Total Applications 13,500
Net Decrease in Working Capital 1,500
(ii) When provision for tax and proposed dividends are taken as current liabilities:
Particulars `
Sources:
Increase in Share Capital 5,000
Funds from Operations 2,000
Total Sources 7,000
Applications:
Purchase of Fixed Assets 10,000
Decrease in Working Capital 3,000
Alternative Solution to (ii): Sometimes it is desired to show the real funds from
operations before tax and making any appropriations for dividends, etc. In such a
case proposed dividends and provision for tax are first added back to profit if
already subtracted and then any tax or dividend paid for the year or outstanding
for the year is shown as an application.
The funds flow statement, in the above illustration, will appear as follows if
this alternate approach is followed.
Self-Instructional
268 Material
Funds Flow Statement Fund Flow Analysis
Particulars ` `
Sources:
Increase in Share Capital 5,000
Funds from Operations: NOTES
Net Profit 2,000
Add: Provision for Tax made during the year 3,500
Proposed Dividends for the year 1,500 7,000
(A) 12,000
Applications:
Fixed assets purchased 10,000
Tax paid and outstanding for the year (500 + 3,000)* 3,500
Dividends paid and outstanding for the year (0 + 1,500)* 1,500
(B) 15,000
Decrease in Working Capital (A) – (B) 3,000
* Provision for tax was `2,000 last year. Tax paid amounts to `2,500 this year. It means excess of `500
relates to this year. A provision of `3,500 has been made during the year. Thus, `3,000 is still outstanding.
Tax paid and outstanding for the year therefore amounts to `3,500. In other words, whatever was added
to the amount of net Profits for ascertaining ‘real funds from operations’ has been shown as an application.
The net effect is zero. The same applies to proposed dividends.
It has become customary to take provisions for tax as a charge against profits for accounting
purposes. Hence, funds from operations should be found out after tax. However, where proposed
dividend is taken as a current liability, the above approach in respect of it may be adopted.
Tutorial Note: Students are advised to state their presumptions clearly. However, where from the
question it is implied that these liabilities are to be taken as current liabilities (e.g., the items have been put
under the heading ‘current liabilities’ in the balance sheet, the students are advised to treat them as current
liabilities. We have generally taken these two items as non-current liabilities.
In case the balance sheet contains the amount of ‘proposed dividends’ as well as the amount of
‘provision for taxation’, it can be presumed that the ‘proposed dividends’ and ‘provisions for taxation’
appearing in the last year’s balance sheet must have been paid during the year in the absence of any other
information. This presumption should generally be made at least for ‘proposed dividends.’
Example: The following are extracts from the balance sheets of a company on
two different dates:
As on 31 December As on 31 December
Liabilities
2017 2018
Profit and Loss A/c 50,000 80,000
Provision for Taxation 10,000 15,000
Proposed Dividends 5,000 10,000
Thus, effectively the profit and loss account is debited while the fixed asset
account is credited with the amount of depreciation. Since, both profit and loss
account and the fixed asset account are non-current accounts, depreciation is a
non-fund item. It is neither a source nor an application of funds. It is added back
to operating profit to find out funds from operations since it has already been
charged to profit but it does not decrease funds from operations. Depreciation
should not, therefore, be taken as a ‘source of funds’. If depreciation was really a
source of funds by itself, any enterprise could have improved its funds position at
will, by merely increasing the periodical depreciation charge.
However, depreciation can be taken as a source of funds in a limited sense
because of there reasons:
(i) Depreciation finds its way into current assets through charging of overheads
(including depreciation). The value of closing inventory may include
depreciation of fixed assets as an element of cost.
(ii) Depreciation does not generate funds but it definitely saves funds. For
example, if the business had taken the fixed assets on hire, it would have
been required to pay rent for them. Since it owns fixed assets, it saves
outflow of funds which would have otherwise gone out in the form of rent.
(iii) Depreciation reduces taxable income and therefore, income tax liability for
the period is reduced. This will be clear with the following example:
Self-Instructional
270 Material
Fund Flow Analysis
Particulars Case I (`) Case II (`)
The above example shows that in Case II, the net flow of funds is more by
`7,500 as compared to Case I. This is because on account of depreciation charge
being claimed as an expense, tax liability has been reduced by `7,500 in case of
Case II. It may therefore be said that true funds flow from depreciation is the
opportunity saving of cash outflow through taxation.
The technique of preparing a schedule of changes in working capital and a
funds flow statement can be very well understood with the help of exhaustive
illustrations given in the following pages.
8.4.4 Computation of Funds from Operations
Illustration 8.5. From the following details, find out the funds from operations:
Particulars ` Particulars `
To Salaries 40,000 By Gross Profit 1,00,000
To Rent 15,000 By Profit on sale of Building
To Provision for Bad Debts 5,000 Sold for `10,000
To Preliminary Expenses written off 10,000 Book value ` 5,000
5,000
To Goodwill written off 5,000
To Depreciation on Machinery 5,000
To Loss on sale of Plant
Book value `10,000
Sold for ` 8,000 2,000
To Provision for Tax 5,000
To Net Profit 18,000
1,05,000 1,05,000
Solution:
Funds from Operations
Particulars `
Net Profit as per Profit and Loss Account 18,000
Add: Items which do not decrease funds from operations
Provision for Tax (i) 5,000
Loss on sale of Plant (ii) 2,000
Depreciation (iii) 5,000
Goodwill written off (iv) 5,000
Preliminary expenses written off (v) 10,000 27,000
45,000
Less: Items which do not increase funds from operations:
Profit on sale of buildings (vi) 5,000
Funds from Operations 40,000
Self-Instructional
Material 271
Fund Flow Analysis Working Notes:
(i) Provision for tax is only an appropriation of profits and therefore, to find out funds from
operations it will have to be added back. The amount of tax actually paid will be shown as a
separate item under ‘application of funds’.
(ii) The entry for loss on sale of plant is:
NOTES
P & L A/c Dr.
To Plant A/c
Since both accounts are ‘fixed’, i.e., one a fixed liability and the other a fixed asset, there
is no flow of funds.
(iii) Depreciation of Machinery
P & L (Depreciation) A/c Dr.
To Machinery
Both accounts are ‘fixed’, therefore, there is no flow of funds.
(iv) and (v) also involve “fixed” accounts only.
(v) The entry for profit on sale of buildings:
Building A/c Dr.
To P & L A/c
Since both accounts are ‘fixed’ there is no flow of funds. Moreover, proceeds realized from sale of
buildings `10,000 will be taken as a separate source of funds. In case the item is considered here also, it will
amount to considering it twice. Moreover, it is not an income or profit from operations.
Particulars ` Particulars `
The provision for tax charged to profit and loss appropriation account for the year
is `17,000. In case the figure of net profit given is after tax, `17,000 will have to be added
back to net profit in order to find out funds from operations. On the same pattern,
accounts may have to be prepared for dividends, plant, building to find out the hidden
information.
Take another example. The machinery account gives a balance of `1,00,000
in the beginning of the accounting year while at the end of the accounting year its
balance is a sum of `1,50,000. The provision for depreciation of the machinery
stands at `30,000 in the beginning of the accounting year and `40,000 at the end of
the accounting year. during the year, a machinery whose original cost was `5,000
Self-Instructional
272 Material
and on which depreciation of `4,000 had been charged so far, is sold for `2,000. In Fund Flow Analysis
such a case, the amount of depreciation charged from the profit and loss account on
machinery and the value of the machinery purchased during the accounting year will
be found out by preparing (i) machinery account, and (ii) provision for depreciation
on machinery account as given: NOTES
Machinery Account
Particulars ` Particulars `
Particulars ` Particulars `
Illustration 8.6. The annual accounts of Atlas Cycles Ltd disclosed the following
balances:
31 March 31 March
2017 2016
The company had sold its 40% interest in another company for a sum of
`23,500. There was a gain of `13,500 on account of such sale and the amount was
credited to retained surplus account. State the sources and uses of company’s funds.
Solution:
1. The company is having investments in other companies. It has sold its interest
in one of the companies for a sum of `23,500. It has made a profit of
`13,500. It means cost of investment sold was `10,000. The investments on
31 March 2016 stood at `34,000, out of which investments of `10,000 have
been sold away during the year. In the absence of any purchase of investment,
the balance in the investments account should have been only `24,000.
However, it stands at `28,000. This shows that investments have been
purchased to the extent of `4,000. It is an application of ‘funds’.
The same results can be derived by preparing ‘Investments in other
companies account.’
Self-Instructional
Material 273
Fund Flow Analysis Investments in Other Companies’ Account
Particulars ` Particulars `
2. The gain on sale of investments `13,500 has been credited to the retained
surplus account. Since the company is not trading in investments, the profit of
`13,500 should not have been taken to that account. The funds from
operations for the year should, therefore, be calculated as follows:
`
Particulars ` Particulars `
Particulars `
Sources:
Sale of Investments 23,500
Total Sources 23,500
Applications:
Purchase of Investments 4,000
Operational Loss 3,000
Total Uses 7,000
Net Increase in Working Capital 16,500
Particulars `
Source:
Funds from Operations (See Note 1) 36,000
Total Sources 36,000
Applications: 3,000
Purchase of Plant (See Note 2)
Tax paid (See Note 3) 17,000
Investments purchased (See Note 4) 1,000
Interim Dividend paid 8,000
Total Applications 29,000
Net Increase in Working Capital 7,000
36,000
Self-Instructional
Material 275
Fund Flow Analysis Working Notes:
1. Funds from operations:
Particulars `
2. Purchase of Plant: This has been found out by preparing the plant account.
Plant Account
Particulars ` Particulars `
3. Tax paid during the year has been found out by preparing a provision for tax account.
Particulars ` Particulars `
4. ‘Investments’ have been taken as a fixed asset presuming they are long-term investments.
Self-Instructional
276 Material
A. Statement of Income and Reconciliation of Earnings for 2017 Fund Flow Analysis
Particulars ` `
Particulars `
Sources:
Issue of Shares 84,000
Funds from Operations:
Trading Profit 72,000
Depreciation 60,000 1,32,000
Sale of Fixed Assets (Equipment) 36,000
Total Sources (A) 2,52,000
Applications:
Purchase of Land 48,000
Purchase of Building and Equipments 2,88,000
Dividend paid 72,000
Total Applications (B) 4,08,000
Decrease in Working Capital (A) – (B) 1,56,000
Self-Instructional
Material 277
Fund Flow Analysis Statement of Changes in Working Capital
The chief development portrayed by the funds flow statement is big expansion
in fixed assets financed by issue of shares, depreciation funds and the major part
of working capital.
Working Notes:
(i) Building and Equipment Account
Particulars ` Particulars `
Since tax payable is a current liability, the amount of tax paid `86,800 (i.e.,
`12,000 + `88,000 – `13,200) has not been shown as application of funds in the
funds flow statement.
1. Net working capital means the excess of current assets over current liabilities. NOTES
2. Some of the non-current liabilities are long-term loans, credit balance in the
profit and loss account, revenue and capital reserves, share capital, securities
premium and debentures.
3. Yes, a cross transaction (i.e., a transaction involving a fixed asset or a fixed
liability and a current asset or a current liability) will result in a flow of funds.
4. In case of debentures issued in consideration of some fixed assets, there
will be no flow of funds.
5. While preparing a funds flow statement, current assets and current liabilities
are to be ignored. Attention is to be given to changes in fixed assets and
fixed liabilities.
6. Depreciation does not generate fund, but it definitely saves funds. For
example, if the business had taken the fixed assets on hire, it would have
been required to pay rent for them. Since it owns fixed assets, it saves
outflow of funds which would have otherwise gone out in the form of rent.
8.7 SUMMARY
The funds flow statement is widely used by the financial analysts, credit
granting institutions and financial managers in performance of their jobs.
This is because the financial statements does not sharply focus on those
major financial transactions which have been behind the balance sheet
changes.
The term ‘fund’ generally refers to cash and cash equivalents, or to working
capital. There are two concepts of working capital: gross concept and net
concept.
The term ‘flow’ means change and, therefore, the term ‘flow of funds’ means
‘change in funds’ or ‘change in working capital.’
In order to determine whether a transaction will result in change in working
capital or not, it will be appropriate to pass a journal entry for the transaction.
In case the entry involves account which are only of a fixed nature there will
be no flow of funds. But a cross transaction will result in flow of funds.
The uses of a funds flow statement can be put as follows: it explains the
financial consequences of business operations, it answers intricate queries,
it acts as an instrument for allocation of resources and it is a test as to
effective or otherwise use of working capital.
Self-Instructional
Material 279
Fund Flow Analysis Both income statement and funds flow statement have different functions to
perform, Modern management needs both. One cannot be a substitute for
the other rather they are complementary to each other.
The sources of funds can be both internal as well as external. Funds from
NOTES
operations are the only internal source of funds. The external sources of
funds include funds from long-term loans, sale of fixed assets and funds
from increase in share capital.
The technique for preparing a funds flow statement includes the preparation
of schedule of changes in working capital and funds flow statement.
The schedule of changes in working capital can be prepared by comparing
the current assets and the current liabilities of two periods.
While preparing a funds flow statement, current assets and current liabilities
are to be ignored. Attention is to be given to changes in fixed assets and
fixed liabilities.
Current Assets: Cash and other assets that are expected to be converted
into cash or consumed in the production of goods or rendering of services
in the normal course of business.
Current Liabilities: Liabilities payable within a year either out of the existing
current assets or by creation of new current liabilities.
Funds: It refers to the working capital of a business.
Funds Flow Statement: A statement summarizing inflows and outflows of
funds from any business activity.
Working Capital: It represents excess of current assets over current
liabilities.
Self-Instructional
280 Material
Long Answer Questions Fund Flow Analysis
Self-Instructional
Material 281
Cash Flow Statement
9.0 INTRODUCTION
Every company needs to have an overall understanding of its cash position mainly
comprising of information related to where the cash is being generated in the
company and where it is being spent. Both of this information allows the company
to ascertain not only their liquidity position but also their long-term solvency
standing. These statements assess the cash flow from activities which are mainly
categorized as investing, operating and financing activities. Further, the cash flow
statements become extremely crucial in decision making as it has dual utility. A
historical cash flow statements helps in the systematic evaluation of the bygone
activities to check for any activities which need to be realigned or can be made in
the form of a projected cash flow statement by using anticipated price changes to
project the company’s future cash flows under the current scheme of operations.
In this unit, you will learn all about the concept of cash flow analysis, the managerial
benefits and limitations of cash flow statements and the uses of cash flow statements
along with its preparation.
9.1 OBJECTIVES
Self-Instructional
282 Material
Cash Flow Statement
9.2 MEANING AND IMPORTANCE OF CASH
FLOW STATEMENT
A cash flow statement is a statement depicting change in cash and cash equivalents NOTES
position from one period to another. For example, if the cash balance of a business is
shown by its balance sheet on 31 December 2017 at `20,000 while the cash balance
as per its balance sheet on 31 December 2017 is 30,000, there has been an inflow of
cash of `10,000 in the year 2017 as compared to the year 2016. The cash flow
statement explains the reasons for such inflows or outflows of cash, as the cash might
be. It also helps management in making plans for the immediate future. A projected
cash flow statement or a cash budget will help the management in ascertaining how
much cash will be available to meet obligations to trade creditors, to pay bank loans
and to pay dividend to the shareholders. A proper planning of the cash resources will
enable the management to have cash available whenever needed and put it to some
profitable or productive use, in case there is surplus cash available.
The term ‘cash’ here stands for cash and demand deposits with banks. Cash
equivalents are short-term, highly liquid investments that are readily convertible
into known amount of cash and which are subject to an insignificant risk of changes
in value. They have a short maturity, say three months or less from the date of
acquisition. It has already been explained in the previous unit that the term ‘funds’, in
a narrower sense, is also used to denote cash. In such a case, the term ‘funds’ will
exclude from its purview all other current assets and current liabilities and the term
‘funds flow statement’ and ‘cash flow statement’ will have synonymous meanings.
However, for the purpose of this study, we are calling this part of study as cash flow
analysis and not funds flow analysis.
Preparation of Cash Flow Statement
A cash flow statement can be prepared on the same pattern on which a funds flow
statement is prepared. The change in the cash position from one period to another
is computed by taking in account ‘sources’ and ‘applications’ of cash. The sources
of each have been discussed in greater detail below.
Sources of Cash
Sources of cash can be internal as well as external.
Internal Sources
Cash from operations is the main internal source. The net profit shown by the
profit and loss account will have to be adjusted for non-cash items for finding out
cash from operations. Some of these items are as follows:
(i) Depreciation: Depreciation does not result in outflow of cash and,
therefore, net profit will have to be increased by the amount of depreciation
or development rebate charged, in order to find out the real cash generated
from operations.
Self-Instructional
Material 283
Cash Flow Statement (ii) Amortization of intangible assets: Goodwill, preliminary expenses, etc.,
when written off against profits, reduce the net profits without affecting the
cash balance. The amounts written off should, therefore, be added back to
profits to find out the cash from operations.
NOTES
(iii) Loss on sale of fixed assets: It does not result in outflow of cash and,
therefore, should be added back to profits.
(iv) Gain from sale of fixed assets: Since sale of fixed assets is taken as a
separate source of cash, it should be deducted from net profits.
(v) Creation of reserves: If profit for the year has been arrived at after charging
transfers to reserves, such transfers should be added back to profits. In
case operations show a net loss, such net loss after making adjustments for
non-cash items will be shown as an application of cash.
Thus, cash from operations is computed on the pattern of computation of
‘funds’ from operations, as explained in the earlier unit. However, to find out real
cash from operations, adjustments will have to be made for ‘changes’ in current
assets and current liabilities arising on account of operations, viz., trade debtors,
trade creditors, bills receivable, bills payable, etc.
For the sake of convenience, computation of cash from operations can be
studied by taking two different situations: (1) when all transactions are cash
transactions, and (2) when all transactions are not cash transactions.
When all transactions are cash transactions: The computation of cash from
operations will be very simple in this case. The net profit as shown by the profit
and loss account will be taken as the amount of cash from operations as shown in
the following example:
Example:
Profit and Loss Account
for the year ended 31 December 2017
Particulars ` Particulars `
In the example given above, if all transactions are cash transactions, i.e., all
purchases have been paid for in cash and all sales have been realized in cash, the
cash from operations will be `22,000, i.e., the net profit as shown by the profit and
loss account. Thus, in case of all transactions being cash transactions, the equation
for computing cash from operations can be put as follows:
Cash from Operations = Net Profit
Self-Instructional
284 Material
When all transactions are not cash transactions: In the example given above, Cash Flow Statement
we have computed cash from operations on the basis that all transactions are cash
transactions. It does not really happen in actual practice. The business sells goods
on credit. It purchases goods on credit. Certain expenses are always outstanding
and some of the incomes are not realized immediately. Under such circumstances, NOTES
the net profit made by a firm cannot generate equivalent amount of cash. The
computation of cash from operations in such a situation can be done conveniently
if it is done in two stages:
(i) Computation of funds (i.e., working capital) from operations, as explained
in the preceding unit.
(ii) Adjustments in the funds so calculated for changes in the current assets
(excluding cash) and current liabilities.
We are giving below an illustration for computing ‘funds’ from operations.
However, since there are no credit transactions, hence the amount of ‘funds’ from
operations is as a matter of cash from operations as shown in the illustration.
Illustration 9.1.
Trading, Profit and Loss Account
for the year ended 31 March 2018
Particulars ` Particulars `
` `
Net Profit as per P&L A/c 5,500
Add: Non-cash items (i.e., items which do not result in outflow of cash):
Depreciation 1,000
Loss on sale of furniture 500
Goodwill written off 1,000 2,500
8,000
Less: Non-cash items (items which do not result inflow of cash):
Profit on sale of building (`15,000 will be taken as a source of cash) 5,000
Cash from Operations 3,000
Self-Instructional
Material 285
Cash Flow Statement External Sources
The external sources of cash are:
(i) Issue of New Shares: In case shares have been issued for cash, the net
NOTES cash received (i.e., after deducting expenses on issue of shares or discount
on issue of shares) will be taken as a source of cash.
(ii) Raising Long-term Loans: Long-term loans, such as issue of debentures,
loans from Industrial Finance Corporations, State Financial Corporation
and IDBI are sources of cash. They should be shown separately.
(iii) Purchase of Plant and Machinery on deferred payments: In case plant
and machinery has been purchased on a deferred payment system, it should
be shown as a separate source of cash to the extent of deferred credit.
However, the cost of machinery purchased will be shown as an application
of cash.
(iv) Short-term Borrowings—cash credit from banks: Short-term borrowing,
etc., from banks increase cash available and they have to be shown
separately under this head.
(v) Sale of Fixed Assets, Investments, etc.: It results in generation of cash
and therefore, is, a source of cash.
Decrease in various current assets and increase in various current liabilities
(as discussed further) may be taken as external sources of cash, if they are not
adjusted while computing cash from operations.
Adjustments for Changes in Current Assets and Current Liabilities
In Illustration 9.1, the cash from operations has been computed on the same pattern
on which funds from operations are computed. As a matter of fact, the funds from
operations is equivalent to cash from operations in this case. This is because of the
presumption that all are cash transactions and all goods have been sold. However,
there may be credit purchases, credit sales, outstanding and prepaid expenses,
etc. In such a case, adjustments will have to be made for each of these items in
order to find out cash from operations. This has been explained in the following
sections:
(i) Effects of credit sales: In business, there are both cash sales and credit
sales. In case, the total sales are `30,000 out of which the credit sales are `10,000,
it means sales have contributed only the extent of `20,000 in providing cash from
operations. Thus, while computing cash from operations, it will be necessary that
suitable adjustments for outstanding debtors are also made.
Example 1:
`
Net Profit for the year 20,000
Total Sales 40,000
Debtors Outstanding at the end of the accounting year 10,000
Self-Instructional
286 Material
The above figures show that out of total sales of `40,000 which must have Cash Flow Statement
been considered from computing net profit, `10,000 has still to be realised in cash
from debtors. Therefore, cash from operations should be computed as follows:
`
Net Profit for the year 20,000 NOTES
Less: Debtors Outstanding at the end of the accounting year 10,000
Cash from Operations 10,000
In case, there were outstanding debtors in the beginning of the accounting year
amounting to `15,000, it can safely be presumed that they must have been realised
during the course of the year. The amount of cash from operations will therefore be
computed as follows:
`
Net Profit for the year 20,000
Less: Debtors Outstanding at the end of the accounting year 10,000
10,000
Add: Debtors Outstanding at the end of the accounting year 15,000
Cash from operations 25,000
Thus, cash from operations can be calculated on the basis of the following
equation if there are debtors outstanding at the end as in the beginning of the
accounting year:
+ Debtors Outstanding at the
beginning of the accounting year
Cash from Operations = Net Profit Or
– Debtors Outstanding at the
end of the accounting year
Or
+ Decrease in Debtors
Cash from Operations = Net Profit Or
– Increase in Debtors
For example, in the above case, cash from operations can be computed as follows:
`20,000 + `5,000 = `25,000
(ii) Effect of Credit Purchases: Whatever have been stated regarding
credit sales is also applicable to credit purchases. The only difference will be that
decrease in creditors from one period to another will result in decrease of cash
from operations because it means more cash payments have been made to the
creditors, which will result in outflow of cash. On the other hand, increase in creditors
from one period to another will result in increase of cash from operations because
less payment has been made to the creditors for goods supplied which will result
in increase of cash balance at the disposal of the business.
Example 2:
`
Purchases for the year (including credit purchases of `10,000) 30,000
Sales for the year 40,000
Expenses 5,000
Self-Instructional
Material 287
Cash Flow Statement The amount of net profit comes to:
`
Sales ` 40,000
Less: Purchases 30,000
Expenses 5000 35,000
NOTES
Net Profit 5,000
Though the net profit is `5000, the cash operations will be `15,000 (`5,000
+ `10,000 for credit purchases). This is because though purchases of `30,000 have
been considered for calculating the net profit, the actual cash which has been paid for
purchases is only `20,000. Thus, cash from operations stands increased by
` 10,000, the amount of creditors outstanding at the end of the year.
Example 3:
`
Sales 40,000
Purchases 30,000
Expenses 5,000
Creditors Outstanding in the beginning of the accounting year 10,000
Creditors Outstanding at the end of the accounting year 15,000
The cash from operations will be computed as follows:
`
Sales ` 40,000
Less: Purchases 30,000
Expenses 5,000 35,000
Net Profit 5,000
Add: Creditors Outstanding at the end of the accounting year 15,000
20,000
Less: Creditors Outstanding at the beginning of the accounting year 10,000
Cash from operations 10,000
Alternatively, cash from operations can be computed as follows:
Net Profit for the year 5,000
Add: Increase in Creditors (`15,000 – `10,000) 5,000
Cash from Operations 10,000
Thus, the effect of credit purchases can be shown with the help of the following
equation in computing cash from operations:
+ Increase in Creditors
Cash from Operations = Net Profit Or
– Decreases in Creditors
(iii) Effect of Opening and Closing Stocks: The amount of opening
stock is charged to the debit side of the profit and loss account. It thus reduces the
net profit without reducing the cash from operations. Similarly, the amount of closing
stock is put on the credit side of the profit and loss account. It thus increases the
amount of net profit without increasing the cash from operations. This will be clear
with the help of the following example:
Self-Instructional
288 Material
Example 4: Cash Flow Statement
`
Opening Stock 5000
Purchases 20,000
Sales 35,000 NOTES
Closing Stock 10,000
Expenses 5,000
The amount of net profit can be computed as follows:
Profit and Loss Account
Particulars ` Particulars `
The net profit for the year is `15,000. The cash from operations will be computed as
follows:
`
Net Profit for the year 15,000
Add: Opening Stock 5,000
20,000
Less: Closing Stock 10,000
Cash from Operations 10,000
Alternatively, the amount of cash from operations can be computed as follows:
`
Net Profit for the year 15,000
Less: Outflow of cash on account of increase in stock 5,000
Cash from Operations 10,000
The effect of change in stock on cash from operations can now be put up as follows:
+ Decrease in Stock
Cash from Operations = Net Profit Or
– Increase in Stock
(iv) Effect of Outstanding Expenses, Incomes received in Advance,
etc.: The effect of these items on cash from operations is similar to the effect of
creditors. This means any increase in these items will result in increase in cash from
operations while any decrease means decrease in cash from operations. This is
because net profit from operations is computed after charging to it all expenses
whether paid or outstanding. In case certain expenses have not been paid, this will
result in decrease of net profit without a corresponding decrease in cash from
operations. Similarly, income received in advance is not taken into account while
calculating profit from operations, since it relates to the next year. It, therefore,
means cash from operations will be higher than the actual net profit as shown by
the profit and loss account. Consider the following example:
Self-Instructional
Material 289
Cash Flow Statement Example 5:
`
Gross Profit 30,000
Expenses paid 10,000
NOTES Interest received 2,000
`2,000 are outstanding on account of expenses while `500 has been received
as interest for the next year. The net profit will be computed as follows:
Profit and Loss Account
Particulars ` Particulars `
Particulars ` Particulars `
Illustration 9.2. Continuing the figures given as Illustration 9.1, calculate the cash
from operations with the following additional information:
Self-Instructional
292 Material
Balance as on ... Cash Flow Statement
Solution
The computation of cash from operations can be done conveniently if it is done as
explained before in two stages:
(i) Computation of ‘funds’ from operations, taking the meaning of ‘funds’
as working capital.
(ii) Adjustment in the amount of ‘funds’ so computed on the basis of ‘current
assets’ and ‘current liabilities’.
The funds from operations amount `3,000 (as computed in Illustration 9.1).
However, adjustments will have to be made in this amount for current assets
and current liabilities in order to compute cash from operations. This has to be done
by taking each item of current assets and current liabilities independently as
explained below:
(i) The investment in stock has increased by `2,000 as compared to the
previous year. This means cash must gone out to the extent of `2,000. It
will, therefore, decrease the cash balance.
(ii) Debtors have gone up from `15,000 on March 2017 to `20,000 on 31
March 2018. There is an increase of `5,000. It shows that sales to the of
`5,000 have not been realised in cash. Hence, cash from operations will
be reduced by `5,000.
(iii) Creditors have gone up by `2,500. Thus, purchases to the extent of this
amount have not been paid in cash. It is, therefore, a ‘source’ of cash.
(iv) Bills receivable have increased by `3,000. Thus, sales to the extent of
`3,000 have not been paid in cash. Hence cash, on account of operations
will be reduced by `3,000.
(v) Bills payable have come down by `2,000. It shows more payments of
cash. The cash fromoperations will stand reduced by `2,000.
(vi) Outstanding expenses have increased by `2,000. Thus, expenses to this
extent have not been paid resulting in increase of cash from operations by
this amount.
Self-Instructional
Material 293
Cash Flow Statement (vii) Prepaid expenses have come down by `500. This shows less of payment
and hence cash operations will increase by `500.
Cash from operations can now be computed as follows:
NOTES Increase (+) Decrease (–) Net
Applications of Cash
Applications of cash may take any of the following forms:
(i) Purchase of Fixed Assets: Cash may be utilized for additional fixed assets
or renewals or replacement of existing fixed assets.
(ii) Payment of Long-term Loans: The payment of long-term loans such as
loans from financial institutions or debentures results in decrease in cash. It
is, therefore, an application of cash.
(iii) Decrease in Deferred Payment Liabilities: Payments for plant and
machinery purchased on deferred payment basis has to be made as per the
agreement. It is, therefore, an application of cash.
(iv) Loss on account of Operations: Loss suffered on account of business
operations will result in outflow of cash.
(v) Payment of Tax: Payment of tax will result in decrease of cash and hence
it is an application of cash.
(vi) Payment of Dividend: This decreases the cash available for business and
hence it is an application of cash.
(vii) Decrease in Unsecured Loans, Deposits, etc: The decrease in these
liabilities denotes they have been paid off to that extent. It results, therefore,
in outflow of cash.
Increase in various current assets or decrease in various current liabilities
may be shown as applications of cash, if changes, in these items have not been
adjusted while finding out cash from operations.
Self-Instructional
294 Material
Format of a Cash Flow Statement Cash Flow Statement
information about funds which will be available from operations. This will
help the management in determining policies regarding internal financial
management, e.g., possibility of repayment of long-term debts, dividend
policies and planning the replacement of plant and machinery. NOTES
3. Discloses the movements of cash: Cash flow statement discloses the
complete story of cash movement. The increase in or decrease of cash and
the reasons therefore can be known. It discloses the reasons for low cash
balance in spite of heavy operating profits or for heavy cash balance in spite
of low profits. However, comparison of original forecast with the actual
results highlights the trends of movements of cash which may otherwise go
undetected.
4. Discloses success or failure of cash planning: The extent of success or
failure of cash planning can be known by comparing the projected cash
flow statement with the actual cash flow statement and necessary remedial
measures can be taken.
Limitations of Cash Flow Analysis
Cash flow analysis is a useful tool of financial analysis. However, it has its own
limitations. These limitations are as under:
1. Cash flow statement cannot be equated with the income statement. An
income statement takes into account both cash as well as non-cash items
and, therefore, net cash does not necessarily mean net income of the business.
2. The cash balance as disclosed by the cash flow statement may not represent
the real liquid position of the business since it can be easily influenced by
postponing purchases and other payments.
3. Cash flow statement cannot replace the income statement or the funds flow
statement. Each of them has a separate function to perform.
In spite of these limitations it can be said that cash flow statement is a useful
supplementary instrument. It discloses the volume as well as the speed at which
the cash flows in the different segments of the business. This helps the management
in knowing the amount of capital tied up in a particular segment of the business.
The technique of cash flow analysis, when used in conjunction with ratio analysis,
serves as a barometer in measuring the profitability and financial position of the
business.
The following are the salient features of the AS 3 (Revised): Cash Flow Statements,
issued by the Council of the Institute of Chartered Accountants of India in March
1997. This Standard supersedes AS 3, Changes in Financial Position, issued in
June 1981. Self-Instructional
Material 297
Cash Flow Statement The standard has been made mandatory for all enterprises from accounting
period commencing or after 1.4.2001.
Objectives
NOTES Information about the cash flows of an enterprise is useful in providing users of
financial statements with a basis to assess the ability of the enterprise to generate
cash and cash equivalents and needs of the enterprise to utilize those cash flows.
The economic decisions that are taken by users require an evaluation of the ability
of an enterprise to generate cash and cash equivalents and the timings and certainty
of their generation.
The statement deals with the provisions of information about the historical
changes in cash and cash equivalents of an enterprise by means of a cash flow
statement which classifies cash flows during the period from operating, investing
and financing activities.
Scope
(1) An enterprise should prepare a cash flow statement and should present it
for each period for which financial statements are presented.
(2) Users of an enterprise’s financial statements are interested in how the
enterprise generates and uses cash and cash equivalents. This is the case
regardless of the nature of the enterprise’s activities and irrespective of
whether cash can be viewed as the product of the enterprise, as may be the
case with a financial enterprise. Enterprises need cash for essentially the
same reasons, however different their principal revenue-producing activities
might be. They need cash to conduct their operations, to pay their obligations,
and to provide returns to their investors.
Benefits of Cash Flow Information
(1) A cash flow statement, when used in conjunction with the other financial
statements, provides information that enables users to evaluate the changes
in net assets of an enterprise, its financial structure (including its liquidity and
solvency), and its ability to affect the amounts and timing of cash flows in
order to adapt to changing circumstances and opportunities. Cash flow
information is useful in assessing the ability of the enterprise to generate
cash and cash equivalents and enables users to develop models to assess
and compare the present value of the future cash flows of different enterprises.
(2) It also enhances the comparability of the reporting of operating performance
by different enterprises because it eliminates the effects of using different
accounting treatments for the same transactions and events.
(3) Historical cash flow information is often used as an indicator of the amount,
timing and certainty of future cash flows. It is also useful in checking the
accuracy of past assessments of future cash flows and in examining the
Self-Instructional
298 Material
relationship between profitability and net cash flow and the impact of Cash Flow Statement
changing prices.
Definitions
The following terms are used in this statement with the meanings specified: NOTES
(1) Cash comprises cash on hand and demand deposits with banks.
(2) Cash equivalents are short term, highly liquid investments that are readily
convertible into known amounts of cash and which are subject to an
insignificant risk of changes in value.
(3) Cash flows are inflows and outflows of cash and cash equivalents.
(4) Operating activities are the principal revenue-producing activities of the
enterprise and other activities that are not investing or financing activities.
(5) Investing activities are the acquisition and disposal of long-term assets
and other investments not included in cash equivalents.
(6) Financing activities are activities that result in changes in the size and
composition of the owner’s capital (including preference share capital in
the case of a company) and borrowings of the enterprise.
Presentation of a Cash Flow Statement
The cash flow statement should report cash flows during the period classified by
operating, investing and financing activities.
(1) Operating activities: Cash flows from operating activities are primarily
derived from the principal revenue-producing activities of the enterprise.
Therefore, they generally result from the transactions and other events that
enter into the determination of net profit or loss. Examples of cash flows
from operating activities are:
(a) cash receipts from the sale of goods and the rendering of services
(b) cash receipts from royalties, fees, commissions, and other revenue
(c) cash payments to suppliers for goods and services
(d) cash payments to and on behalf of employees
(e) Cash receipts and cash payments of an insurance enterprise for
premiums and claims, annuities and other policy benefits
(f) cash payments or refunds of income taxes unless they can be
specifically identified with financing and investing activities
(g) cash receipts and payments relating to futures contracts, forward
contracts, option contracts and swap contracts when the contracts
are held for dealing or trading purposes.
Self-Instructional
Material 299
Cash Flow Statement Modes of reporting cash flows from operating activities
An enterprise may report cash flows from operating activities using either
any of the following methods:
NOTES (a) Direct Method: In case of this method major classes of gross cash
receipts and gross cash payments are disclosed; or
(b) Indirect Method: In case of this method net profit or loss is adjusted
for the effects of transactions of a non-cash nature, any deferrals or
accruals of past or future operating cash receipts or payments, and
items of income or expense associated with investing or financing cash
flows.
(2) Investing activities: Examples of cash flows arising from investing activities
are:
(a) cash payments to acquire fixed assets (including intangibles). These
payments include those relating to capitalized research and
development costs and self-constructed fixed assets
(b) cash receipts from disposal of fixed assets (including intangibles)
(c) cash payments to acquire shares, warrants, or debt instruments of
other enterprises and interests in joint ventures (other than payments
for those instruments considered to be cash equivalents and those
held for dealing or trading purposes)
(d) cash receipts from disposal of shares, warrants, or debt instruments
of other enterprises and interests in joint ventures (other than receipts
from those instruments considered to be cash equivalents and those
held for dealing or trading purposes)
(e) cash advances and loans made to third parties (other than advances
and loans made by financial enterprise)
(f) cash receipts from the repayment of advances and loans made to
third parties (other that than advances and loans of a financial enterprise)
(g) cash payments for futures contracts, forward contracts, option
contracts, and swap contract except when the contracts are held for
dealing or trading purposes, or the payments and classified as financing
activities
(h) cash receipts from futures contracts, forward contracts, option
contracts, and swap contracts except when the contracts are held for
dealing or trading purposes, or the receipts are classified as financing
activities
(3) Financing activities: Examples of cash flows arising from financing activities
are:
(a) cash proceeds from issuing shares or other similar instruments
Self-Instructional
300 Material
(b) cash proceeds from issuing debentures, loans, notes, bonds, and other Cash Flow Statement
An enterprise should report separately major classes of gross cash receipts and
gross cash payments arising from investing and financing activities, except to the
extent that cash flows described in paragraph 6 are reported on a net basis.
Reporting Cash Flows on a Net Basis
(1) Cash flows arising from the following operating, investing or financing activities
may reported on a net basis:
(i) Cash receipts and payments on behalf of customers when the cash
flows reflect the activities of the customer rather than those of the
enterprise.
Examples of cash receipts and payments referred above are as follows:
(a) the acceptance and repayment of demand deposits by a bank;
(b) funds help for customers by an investment enterprise; and
(c) rents collected on behalf of, and paid over to, the owners of
properties.
(ii) Cash receipts and payments for items in which the turnover is quick,
the amounts large, and the maturities are short.
Examples of cash receipts and payments referred above are advances
made for, and the repayments of:
(a) Principal amounts relating to credit card customers;
(b) the purchase and sale of investments; and
(c) other short-term borrowings, for example, those which have a
maturity period of three months or less.
(2) Cash flows arising from each of the following activities of a financial enterprise
may be reported on a net basis:
(a) Cash receipts and payments for the acceptance and repayment of
deposits with a fixed maturity date;
(b) The placement of deposits with and withdrawal of deposits from other
financial enterprises; and
(c) Cash advances and loans made to customers and the repayment of
those advances and loans.
Self-Instructional
Material 301
Cash Flow Statement Disclosure
(1) Components of cash and cash equivalents: An enterprise should disclose
the components of cash and cash equivalents and should present a
NOTES reconciliation of the amounts in its cash flow statement with the equivalent
items reported in the balance sheet.
(2) Other disclosures: An enterprise should disclose, together with a commentary
by management, the amount of significant cash and cash equivalent balances
held by the enterprise that are not available for use by it.
The concept and technique of preparing a cash flow statement will be clear with
the help of the illustration given in the following pages.
Cash from Operations
Illustration 9.3. From the following information prepare a cash flow statement
accounting to (a) direct method (b) indirect method. Working notes should form a
part of your answer.
Balance Sheet
as on 31.12.2016 (` in’000)
2016 2015
Assets:
Cash on hand and balances with banks 200 25
Short-term Investment 670 135
Sundry Debtors 1,700 1,200
Interest Receivable 100 —
Inventories 900 1,950
Long-term Investments 2,500 2,500
Fixed Assets at Cost 2,180 1,910
Less : Accumlated Depreciation (1,450) (1,060)
Fixed Assets (Net) 730 850
Total Assets 6,800 6,660
Liabilities:
Sundry Creditors 150 1,890
Interest Payable 230 100
Income Taxes Payable 400 1,000
Long-term Debt 1,110 1,040
Total Liabilities 1,890 4,030
Shareholder’s Funds
Share Capital 1,500 1,250
Reserves 3,410 1,380
Total Shareholder’s Funds 4,910 2,630
Total Liabilities and Shareholders’ funds 6,800 6,660
Self-Instructional
302 Material
Statement of Profit and Loss Cash Flow Statement
for the period ended 31.12.2016
(` ’000)
2016
Self-Instructional
304 Material
Notes to the Cash Flow Statement (Direct & Indirect Methods): Cash Flow Statement
1. Cash and cash equivalents: Cash and cash equivalents consist of cash on hand and balances with
banks, and investments in monery-market instruments. Cash and cash equivalents included in the
cash flow statement comprising the following balance sheet amounts:
Cash and cash equivalents at the end of the period include deposits with banks of 100 held by a branch
which are not freely permissible to the company because of currency exchange restrictions.
The company has undrawn borrowing facilities of 2,000 of which 700 may be used only for future
expansion.
2. Total tax paid during the year (including tax deducted at source on dividend received) amounted to
900.
During the year, a machine costing `10,000 (accumulated depreciation `3,000) was sold for
`5,000. The provisions for depreciation against machinery as on 1 January 2006 was `25,000 and on
31 December 2006 was `40,000. Net profit for the year 2006 amount to `45,000. You are required to
prepare cash flow statement.
Solution:
Cash Flow Statement
Particulars ` Particulars `
Particulars ` Particulars `
Illustration 9.5. From the following balance sheets of Exe. Ltd, prepare the
statement of sources and use of cash:
Liabilities 2016 (`) 2017 (`) Assets 2016 (`) 2017 (`)
Additional Information:
(1) Depreciation of `10,000 and `20,000 have been charged on plant and land and buildings,
respectively, in 2017.
(2) An interim dividend of `20,000 has been paid in 2017.
(3) `35,000 income tax was paid during the year 2017.
Self-Instructional
306 Material
Solution: Cash Flow Statement
Cash Flow Statement
for the year ending 31 Dec. 2017
`
Net Cash Flows from Operating Activities : NOTES
(1,60,000 – Income tax paid 35,000)1 1,25,000
Cash Flows from Investing Activities
Sale of Land & Buildings 10,000
Plant Purchased (1,30,000)
Net Cash Used for Investing Activities (1,20,000)
Cash Flows from Financing Activities:
Issue of Share Capital 1,00,000
Redemption of Red Pref. Shares (50,000)
Interim Dividend Paid (20,000)
Dividend Paid (42,000)
Net Cash Used in Financing Activities (12,000)
Net Increase (Decrease) in Cash and Cash Equivalents (7,000)
Cash and Cash Equivalents as on 1 Jan. 2007
(Cash 15,000 + Bank 10,000) 25,000
Cash and Cash Equivalents as on 31 Dec. 2007 18,000
Particulars ` Particulars `
Particulars ` Particulars `
Particulars ` Particulars `
Particulars ` Particulars `
Particulars ` `
(vi) In the absence of information, it has been presumed that there is no profit (loss) and no
accumulated depreciation on that part of land and building which has been sold.
The delivery van was purchased in December, 2016 on hire-purchase basis; a payment of `5000
was made immediately and the balance of the amount is to be paid in 20 monthly instalments of `1000
each together with interest at 12 per cent p.a. During the year, the partners withdrew `26,000 for domestic
expenditure. The provision for depreciation against machinery on 31 December 2015 was `27,000 and on
31 December 2016 `36,000. You are required to prepare the cash flow statement. show also the funds flow
statement.
Self-Instructional
308 Material
Solution: Cash Flow Statement
Funds Flow Statement
for the year ending 31 December 2016
Particulars `
Working Notes:
1. Funds from Operations
`
Capital as on 31 December 2016 1,54,000
Add: Drawings during the year 26,000
1,80,000
Less: Capital as on 1 January 2016 1,48,000
Profit for the year 32,000
Add: Depreciation for the year (`36,000 – `27,000) 9,000
Funds form operations 41,000
2. Cash from Operations
Funds from Operations 41,000
Add: Decrease in Stock 3,000
Increase in Creditors 4,600 7,600
48,600
Less: Increase in Debtors 3,000
Cash from Operations 45,600
Self-Instructional
Material 309
Cash Flow Statement
1. The following are the ways in which computation of cash from operations is
undertaken in cases of outstanding expenses and unrealized incomes:
(i) Computation of funds from operations,
(ii) Adjustments in the funds so calculated for changes in the current assets
and current liabilities
2. The formula for calculating cash from operations in case of adjusting the
effect of closing stock is: Cash from operations = Net Profit – Decrease in
Stock or Net Profit – Increase in Stock.
3. A cash flow statement cannot be equated with the income statement because
an income statement takes into account both cash as well as non-cash items
and, therefore, net cash does not necessarily mean net income of the business.
4. The indirect method of reporting cash flows from operating activities is the
method in which net profit or loss is adjusted for the effects of transactions
of a non-cash nature, any deferrals or accruals of past or future operating
cash receipts or payments, and items of income or expense associated with
investing or financing cash flows.
9.6 SUMMARY
Self-Instructional
310 Material
Computation of cash from operations can be studied by taking two different Cash Flow Statement
situations: (1) when all transactions are cash transactions, and (2) when all
transactions are not cash transactions.
External sources of cash include: issue of new shares, raising long-term
NOTES
loans, purchase of plant and machinery, sale of fixed assets, etc.
Computation of cash from operations is based on the same pattern on which
funds from operations are computed with the adjustments in lieu of credit
sales, outstanding and prepaid expenses, credit purchases, etc.
The following comprises the utility of cash flow analysis: helps in efficient
cash management, helps in internal financial management, discloses the
movements of cash and discloses success or failure of cash planning.
The limitations include its not being at par with income statement, not
disclosing the liquid position of the business and its inability of replace the
income or the funds flow statements.
The cash flow statement should report cash flows during the period classified
by operating, investing and financing activities.
Cash: The term comprises for cash and demand deposits with banks.
Cash Equivalents: They are short-term highly liquid investments that are
readily convertible into cash without any significant loss.
Cash Flow Analysis: A technique involving analysis of the causes of flows
of cash and cash equivalents from one period to another.
Cash Flow Statement: A statement depicting change in cash and cash
equivalents position from one period to another.
Self-Instructional
Material 311
Cash Flow Statement 3. Write a short note on the applications of cash.
4. What are the internal sources of cash?
Long Answer Questions
NOTES
1. Explain the meaning of a cash flow statement. Discuss its utility.
2. Explain the technique of preparing a cash flow statement with imaginary
figures.
3. Distinguish between funds flow statement and cash flow statement.
4. Discuss the benefits and limitations of cash flow analysis.
Self-Instructional
312 Material
Cost Accounting
10.0 INTRODUCTION
10.1 OBJECTIVES
In the initial stages, cost accounting was merely considered to be a technique for
ascertainment of costs of products or services on the basis of historical data. In
the course of time, due to competitive nature of the market, it was realized that
ascertainment of cost is not so important as controlling costs. Hence, cost accounting
started to be considered more as a technique for cost control as compared to cost
ascertainment. Due to technological developments in all fields, now cost reduction
has also come within the ambit of cost accounting. Cost accounting is thus concerned
with recording, classifying and summarising, costs, for determination of costs of
products or services; planning, controlling and reducing such costs and furnishing
of information to management for decision making.
According to Charles T Horngren, cost accounting is ‘a quantitative method
that accumulates, classifies, summarizes, and interprets information for three major
purposes: (i) operational planning and control, (ii) special decisions, and
(iii) product decisions.’
According to the Chartered Institute of Management Accountants (CIMA),
London, cost accounting is ‘the process of accounting for costs from the point at
which the expenditure is incurred or committed to the establishment of its ultimate
relationship with cost units. In its widest sense, it embraces the preparation of
statistical data, the application of cost control methods and the ascertainment of
the profitability of the activities carried out or planned.’
Self-Instructional
314 Material
According to Morse, ‘Cost accounting is the processing and evaluation of Cost Accounting
wages for products A, B and C, financial accounts will record the total
wages paid, while cost accounts will record wages separately for each
product. Besides that in cost accounts a difference will also be made between
direct and indirect wages, etc. NOTES
4. Analysing profit: Financial accounting reveals the profit of the business as
a whole, while cost accounting shows the profit made on each product, job
or process. This enables the management to eliminate the less profitable product
lines and maximize the profits by concentrating on more profitable ones.
5. Periodicity of reporting: Financial accounting is largely concerned with
the transactions between the undertaking and the third parties and therefore
it has to observe the accounting period convention which is usually a year.
The income statement and the balance sheet are, therefore, prepared and
presented before the members, usually once at the end of the accounting
period, while cost accounting is mainly concerned with the people in the
organization and, therefore, it is not subject to the domination of this
convention. The cost reports are frequently submitted to the management
and in some cases they are submitted every week.
6. Degree of accuracy: Since financial accounting provides information useful
to the outsiders, the information has to be absolutely accurate. Cost
accounting provides information to the insiders, i.e., the management, and
hence the information may be fairly accurate. Thus, degree of accuracy is
more in financial accounting as compared to cost accounting.
It may be noted that in spite of these differences, cost accounting does not
totally discard the basic principles and procedures used in financial accounting. As
a matter of fact, cost accounting is concerned with a more adequate and detailed
recording, measurement and analysis of cost elements as they originate and flow
through the productive processes.
10.2.3 Objectives of Cost Accounting
The main objectives of cost accounting can be summarized as follows:
(i) Ascertainment of cost: This used to be the primary function of a cost
accountant in the good old days. The cost accountant was basically
concerned with the computation of the cost of a job, product or process on
the basis of historical data. In other words, having incurred the expenditure,
the cost accountant was simply required to add up the expenditure and find
out the total and/or per unit cost. However, these days, with growing
competition and the realization that only ‘the fittest will survive’, cost
ascertainment has become only a secondary objective of cost accounting.
(ii) Estimation of cost: In today’s competitive world, it is not only enough to
know ‘what has been the cost.’ It is more important to know ‘what is likely
Self-Instructional
Material 317
Cost Accounting to be the cost’, or rather ‘what should be the cost’ of a job, product or
process. The technique of a standard costing which is now widely used by
large professionally managed companies mainly emphasizes on this aspect.
(iii) Cost control: This has now become the primary objective of cost
NOTES
accounting. Controlling cost requires (i) determination of standard costs
(i.e., cost which should be there), (ii) analysing the causes of variations
between the standard costs and the actual costs. The techniques of budgetary
control and standard costing considerably facilitate this work and increase
the operating efficiency of an enterprise.
(iv) Cost reduction: This is a recent function or objective of cost accounting.
Costs are not only to be controlled (i.e., to be kept within limits) but constant
efforts are to be made for reducing them. Constant reduction in cost through
research and development widens the market for the company’s products
which enables an organization to enjoy the economies of scale and other
consequential benefits.
(v) Determining selling price: Business enterprises are run on a profit-making
basis. It is thus necessary that the revenue should be greater than the costs
incurred in producing goods and services from which the revenue is to be
derived. Cost accounting provides information regarding the cost to make
and sell such products or services. Of course, many other factors, such as
the condition of the market, the area of distribution, the quantity which can
be supplied, etc., are also be given due consideration by the management
before deciding upon the price, but the cost plays a dominating role.
(vi) Facilitating preparation of financial and other statements: One main
objective of cost accounting is to produce statements at such short intervals
as the management may require. The financial statements prepared under
financial accounting generally once a year, or half-yearly, are spaced too far
apart in time to meet the needs of the management. In order to operate the
business at a high level of efficiency, it is essential for the management to
have a frequent review of production, sales and operating results. Cost
accounting provides daily, weekly or monthly volumes of units produced,
accumulated costs together with appropriate analysis. A developed cost
accounting system provides immediate information regarding stock of raw
materials, work-in-progress and finished goods. This helps in speedy
preparation of financial statements.
(vii) Providing basis for operating policy: Cost accounting helps the
management in formulating operating policies. These policies may relate to
any of the following matters:
(i) Determination of cost-volume-profit relationship
(ii) Shutting down or operating at a loss
(iii) Making or buying from outside suppliers
Self-Instructional
318 Material
(iv) Continuing with the existing plant and machinery or replacing by Cost Accounting
Self-Instructional
Material 319
Cost Accounting (c) Expansion plans, installation of new capital project, etc.
(d) Utilization of idle capacity and development of a proper information
system to provide prompt and correct cost information to the
management.
NOTES
(e) Installation of a cost audit system.
The term cost refers to the amount of resources given up in exchange for some of
goods or services. The resources so given up are always expressed in terms of
money. According to the Chartered Institute of Management Accountants (CIMA),
London, the term cost in general means ‘the amount of expenditure (actual or
notional) incurred on or attributable to a given thing or activity.’ However, the term
cost cannot be exactly defined. Its interpretation depends upon:
(a) the nature of business, or industry, and
(b) the context in which it is used.
In a business where selling and distribution expenses are quite nominal, the
cost of the article may be calculated without considering the selling and distribution
overheads. While in business where the nature of the product requires heavy selling
and distribution expenses, the calculation of cost without taking into account selling
and distribution expenses may prove very costly to the business. The cost may
be—factory, office cost, cost of sales; even an item of expense is also termed as
cost. For example, prime cost includes expenditure on direct materials, direct
labour and direct expenses. Money spent on material is termed as cost of materials,
that spent on labour as cost of labour and so on. Thus, the use of the term cost
without qualification is also quite misleading. Again, different costs are found out
for different purposes. The work-in-progress is valued at factory cost while stock
of finished goods is valued at office cost. Numerous other examples can be given
to show that the term ‘cost’ does not mean the same thing under all circumstances.
The fact that word ‘cost’ cannot be fixed with a definite meaning was well
illustrated in Vardon vs the Commonwealth case. In this case the price of made-
to-order goods or services sold by a trader was fixed by a notification from the
price commissioner at ‘the cost of those goods or services, plus 20 per cent
thereof.’ The goods in question were suits of clothes and other garments, the
material for which was provided by the retailer who rendered certain service in
measuring the customer, and arranged for the making of the suit by another person,
who supplied other material required. It was held that cost of a suit of clothes
might be ascertained in different ways for different persons. For example, it might
include factory cost only, or might include also costs of distribution and
merchandizing. Therefore, the word ‘cost’ being uncertain and ambiguous in
meaning, the notification could not be regarded as declaring a price.
Self-Instructional
320 Material
It may also be noted that there is no such thing as exact cost or a true cost Cost Accounting
because no figure of cost is true in all circumstances and for all purposes. Many
items of cost of production are handled in an optional manner which may give
different costs for the same product or job without in any way going against the
accepted principles of cost accounting. Depreciation is one such item. Its amount NOTES
varies in accordance with the method of depreciation being used. However,
endeavour should be to obtain as far as possible accurate cost of a product or
service.
Cost, Expense and Loss
As explained above, the term cost refers to the resources sacrificed or forgone to
achieve a specific objective. It represents the expenditure which has been made
or incurred for an economic benefit. There can be three situations regarding such
benefit: (i) benefit may have already been received; (ii) benefit is yet to be received
and (iii) the possibility of receiving the benefits may have been lost. For example,
an organization takes a fire insurance policy on its building on 1 August 2017 by
paying a premium of `2,400. As on 31 December, the organization has already
used the insurance cover for five months. While the benefit of insurance cover for
remaining seven months is yet to be received. In this case, the total cost of the
insurance policy is `2,400. However, the amount of expense is only `1,000, i.e.,
2,400 × 5/12. The amount of unexpired or deferred cost is `1,400.
However, if at the end of 2017, it is found that the insurance company has
gone into liquidation and it will not be possible to get the insurance benefit for the
next seven months, the amount of unexpired cost will be treated as loss.
Thus, the term cost refers to the total resources forgone which may or may
not bring matching economic benefits. In the former case, it will be termed as an
expense while in the latter case it will be termed as a loss. Both the expense and
loss are charged to the profit and loss account while deferred cost or unexpired
cost is shown as an asset in the balance sheet.
In brief, it can be said that the term expense is a ‘timing concept’ while the
term cost is a ‘valuation concept’.
10.3.1 Elements of Cost
There are three broad elements of cost:
Self-Instructional
Material 321
Cost Accounting Each of these elements is explained below:
Material
The substance from which the product is made is known as material. It may be in
NOTES raw, semi-manufactured or a manufactured state. It can be direct as well as indirect.
(a) Direct Material: All material which becomes an integral part of the finished
product and which can be conveniently assigned to specific physical units is
termed as ‘direct material.’ Following are some examples of direct material:
(i) All material or components specifically purchased, produced or
requisitioned from stores.
(ii) Primary packing material (e.g., carton, wrapping, cardboard boxes,
etc.).
(iii) Purchased or partly-produced components.
Direct material is also described as process material, prime cost material,
production material, stores material, constructional material, etc.
(b) Indirect Material: All material which is used for purpose ancillary to the
business and which cannot be conveniently assigned to specific physical
units is termed as ‘indirect material’. Consumable stores, oil and waste and
printing and stationery material, are a few examples of indirect material.
Indirect material may be used in the factory, the office or the selling and
distribution divisions.
Labour
For conversion of materials into finished goods, human effort is needed, such
human effort is called labour. Labour can be direct as well as indirect:
(i) Direct Labour: Labour which takes an active and direct part in the
production of a particular commodity is called direct labour. Direct labour
costs are, therefore, specifically and conveniently traceable to specific
products.
Direct labour is also described as process labour, productive labour,
operating labour, etc.
Self-Instructional
322 Material
(ii) Indirect Labour: Labour employed for the purpose of carrying out tasks Cost Accounting
(i) Direct Expenses: These are expenses which can be directly, conveniently
and wholly allocated to specific cost centres or cost units. Examples of
such expenses are: hiring of some special machinery, required for a particular
contract; cost of defective work, incurred in connection with a particular
job or contract, etc.
Direct expenses are sometimes also described as ‘chargeable expenses.’
(ii) Indirect Expenses: These are expenses which cannot be directly,
conveniently and wholly allocated to cost centres or cost units.
The examples of indirect expenses are rent, rates, insurance, salaries and
lighting charges.
Overheads
The term overheads includes indirect material, indirect labour and indirect expenses.
Thus, all indirect costs are overheads.
A manufacturing organization can broadly be divided into three divisions :
(i) Factory or Works where production is done
(ii) Office and Administration, where routine as well as policy matters are
decided
(iii) Selling and Distribution where products are sold and finally despatched
to the customer
Overheads may be incurred in the factory or office or selling and distribution
divisions. Thus, overheads may be of three types:
Self-Instructional
Material 323
Cost Accounting
NOTES
Self-Instructional
324 Material
Components of Total Cost Cost Accounting
Illustration 10.1. Calculate the prime cost from the following particulars of an
optical manufacturer:
`
Cost of lens purchses 10,000
Cost of frames purchased 2,000
Cost of screws 200
Wages paid for manufacturing opticals 4,000
Hire of a special machine 800
Solution:
Statement of Prime Cost
Direct Material: ` `
Cost of lens purchased 10,000
Cost of frames purchased 2,000
Cost of screws 200 12,200
Direct Labour: Wages paid for manufacturing opticals 4,000
Direct Expenses: Hire of a special machine 800
Prime Cost 17,000
2. Factory Cost: It comprises prime cost plus works or factory overheads. The
cost is also known as works cost, production or manufacturing cost.
Illustration 10.2. Calculate the factory cost from the following particulars:
`
Materials consumed 50,000
Productive wages 30,000
Unproductive wages 3,000
Salary of factory manager 6,000
Consumable spares 1,000
Rent of factory premises 2,500
Machine depreciation and repairs 1,500
Oil, grease, etc. 500
Salary of factory clerks 2,000
Rent of factory furniture 800
Self-Instructional
Material 325
Cost Accounting Solution:
Statement Showing Factory Cost
3. Office Cost: If office and administrative overheads are added to factory cost,
office cost is arrived at. This is also termed as administrative cost or cost of
production.
The inclusion of office and administration overheads in the cost of production
is based on the presumption that such overheads solely relate to production.
The amount of office and administration overheads relating to sales are a part of
selling overheads and unless otherwise specified, must have already been included
in them.
Illustration 10.3. From the following particulars compute the cost of production
of a product:
`
Materials used 12,000
Labour employed 8,000
Salary of inspector engaged on this product 1,000
Proportionate lighting and heating (factory and office 3 : 2) 500
Proportionate depreciation, repairs and rent (50% is related to factory) 1,000
Municipal taxes and insurance of building (40% relates to office) 800
Trade subscription 100
Self-Instructional
326 Material
Solution: Cost Accounting
Statement Showing Total Cost of Production
` ` `
4. Total Cost or Cost of Sales: Total cost is ascertained by adding selling and
distribution overheads to cost of production of goods sold.
The various components of total cost can be depicted through the help of
the following chart:
Self-Instructional
Material 327
Cost Accounting Illustration 10.4. From the following compute the value of raw materials consumed:
Raw Material purchased 50,000
Opening Stock 10,000
Closing Stock 8,000
NOTES Solution:
Value of Raw Materials Consumed = Opening Stock + Purchases – Closing Stock
= `10,000 + 50,000 – 8,000 = `52,000
for highly sensitive or competitive market (e.g., fashion goods). The demand
of such goods may come down any moment and, therefore, they may have
to be sold even at prime cost.
NOTES
3. In case of building contracts, in order to have a margin for contingencies,
overheads may not be considered while valuing uncertified work-in-
progress.
4. Where stocks have to be held for a long period for maturing, usually overhead
expenses are not added because the ultimate selling price may or may not
be adequate for the purpose.
5. Where levels of production and sales are subject to material fluctuations,
overheads are not added to the cost of work-in-progress. In such a case if
overheads are added to the cost of work-in-progress, they would have the
effect of relieving the profit and loss account of overheads in the period
when they were incurred and would be charged to the profit and loss account
of the period to which they do not relate.
Thus, the object of excluding works overheads or any other overheads
from being included in the cost of work-in-progress is to prevent the work-in-
progress, from being valued at a price higher than the price which such goods may
fetch on being sold. This is only a financial consideration. However, from the costing
point of view a proportionate part of all overheads should be added to for valuing
work-in-progress. But, in practice, only a proportionate part of factory overheads
is considered for this purpose.
Illustration 10.5. From the following calculate the works cost:
`
Materials 60,000
Labour 40,000
Direct Expenses 10,000
Factory Overheads 50,000
Work-in-progress: Opening Stock 10,000
Closing Stock 8,000
Solution:
Computation of Works Cost
`
Materials 60,000
Labour 40,000
Direct Expenses 10,000
Prime Cost 1,10,000
Factory Overheads 50,000
Gross Works Cost 1,60,000
Add: Opening Stock of work-in-progress 10,000
1,70,000
Less: Closing Stock of work-in-progress 8,000
Works or Factory Cost 1,62,000
Self-Instructional
Material 329
Cost Accounting Adjustment for Finished Goods Stocks
In the cost of production relating to a particular commodity or unit of production,
the opening stock of finished goods is added and closing stock subtracted to find
NOTES out the cost of goods sold.
Stock of finished goods is generally valued at the total cost of production.
The selling and distribution overheads are charged on units sold and not on units
produced and, therefore, the value of stock at the end takes into account the total
production costs. The current cost is considered while valuing closing stock on
the assumption that the stocks are being disposed of on ‘first in, first out’ basis;
thus the last year’s stocks muct have been sold first and whatever remains is of the
current year’s production lot.
Example: From the following, calculate the cost of production of goods sold:
`
Cost of Production 1,00,000
Opening Stock 10,000
Closing Stock 15,000
Cost of Production of goods sold = Cost of Production + Opening Stock – Closing Stock
= 1,00,000 + 10,000 – 15,000
= `95,000
Computation of Profit
While preparing a cost sheet profit may have to be calculated either as a percentage
of cost or as a percentage of selling price. The easiest course for a student will be
to take that figure as 100 on which percentage of profit has been given and then to
proceed whit the calculations.
Example 1:
Cost Price is `10,000
Profit is 10% of cost
Take cost price as 100. The profit is `10 on a cost of `100. Therefore, the profit on a cost
of `10,000 will be:
10,000 × 10/100 = `1,000
Example 2:
Cost price is `10,000
Profit is 10% on selling price.
Take selling price as 100. Cost price will be `90 (`100 – `10). Since profit is
`10 on a cost of `90, the profit on a cost price of `10,000 will be:
10,000 × 10/90 = `1,111 (approx.)
Example 3:
Selling Price is `10,000.
Profit is 10% on cost.
Take cost price as `100. The selling price will be `110 (`100 + `10). The profit on a selling
price of `110 is `10, the profit on a selling price of `10,000 will be:
10,000 × 10/110 = `909 (approx.)
Self-Instructional
330 Material
Cost Accounting
In the preceding pages, we have explained the different elements which constitute
the cost of a product, job or a process. All these elements of cost can be put in the
form of a statement which is technically called as a cost sheet or a cost statement.
According to CIMA, London a cost sheet is ‘a document which provides for the
assembly of the estimated detailed cost in respect of a cost centre or a cost unit.’
It analyses and classifies in a tabular form, the expenses incurred on different items
for a particular period. Additional columns may also be provided to show the cost
per unit pertaining to each item of expenditure and the total per unit cost. Variations
of stock are also recorded and proper adjustments made to arrive at the correct
figures of raw materials consumed and the cost of goods sold.
Cost sheet may also depict data for the preceding period along with the
data for the present period so as to have quick appraisal of trends and tendencies
in a single statement of cost. Cost data for more than two periods can also be
depicted in a cost sheet for a comparative study. It may also be prepared for
making inter-firm comparison by including cost data for different firms. Such a
single statement will facilitate inter-firm comparison of costs for taking decision
about the policy formulation in the event of market competition.
Types of Cost Sheets
Cost sheet may be prepared on the basis of actual data or on the basis of estimated
data, depending on the technique of costing employed and the purpose to be
achieved. Thus, cost sheet may be of two types:
Historical cost sheet: Such a cost sheet is prepared periodically after the
costs have been incurred. The period may be a year, half-year, a quarter or a
month. Actual costs are compiled and presented through such a cost statement.
Estimated cost sheet: Such a cost sheet is prepared before the actual
commencement of production. The estimating process is repeated at regular
intervals. Estimated cost sheets may be prepared on a yearly, half-yearly, quarterly
or monthly basis. The estimated costs are compared with the actual costs every
time whenever estimates are prepared so that costs can be controlled effectively
since the ultimate aim of adoption of estimated costing technique is effective cost
control. Costs are predetermined having regard to the present conditions and the
circumstances likely to prevail in future, besides the past performances.
Self-Instructional
Material 331
Cost Accounting Importance of Cost Sheet
A cost sheet helps both in ascertainment and control of costs. It also provides
data on the basis of which the selling prices of the products can be fixed. Thus, a
NOTES cost sheet performs the following functions:
(i) Ascertainment of cost: A cost sheet helps in ascertainment of total cost,
cost per unit at different stages of production. The information provided by
the cost sheet helps the management in taking various decisions, viz., to
make or buy a product, to sell or not to sell in a foreign market, to process
a product completely in the factory or to purchase in a semi-finished form
from outside, etc.
(ii) Controlling costs: A cost sheet presents the cost data for two or more
periods in a comparative form. Such a presentation helps in identifying the
elements whose costs have gone up and where control is required.
(iii) Fixing up of selling price: A cost sheet provides data about the cost of a
job, product or process. The business can fix appropriate selling prices for
its products on the basis of such data.
(iv) Submitting of tenders: Costs have to be ascertained for submitting of
tenders, giving price quotations, etc. Preparation of an estimated cost sheet
about the relevant product or job considerably facilitates this work.
10.4.1 Problems on Cost Sheet
Illustration 10.6. The cost of sale of Product A is made up as follows :
`
Materials used in manufacturing 5,500
Materials used in packing materials 1,000
Materials used in selling the product 150
Materials used in the factory 75
Materials used in the office 125
Labour required in producing 1,000
Labour required for supervision of the management-Factory 200
Expenses—Direct-Factory 500
Expenses—Indirect-Factory 100
Expenses—Office 125
Depreciation—Office Building and Equipment 75
Depreciation—Factory 175
Selling Expenses 350
Freight 500
Advertising 125
Assuming that all the products manufactured are sold, what should be the
selling price to obtain a profit of 25 per cent on selling price? Illustrate in a chart
form for presentation to your manager, the divisions of costs for Product A.
Self-Instructional
332 Material
Solution: Cost Accounting
Statement of Cost For Product A
` ` `
Direct Materials
Materials used in manufacturing 5,500 NOTES
Add: Freight 500
Materials used in packing materials 1,000 7,000
Direct Labour:
Labour required in producing 1,000
Direct Expenses Facrory 500
Prime Cost 8,500
Add: Factory Overheads:
Material used in the factory 75
Labour for supervision of management — Factory 200
Expenses—Indirect—Factory 100
Depreciation—Factory 175 550
Works Cost 9,050
Add: Office Overheads:
Materials used in the office 125
Expenses—Office 125
Depreciation—Office Building and Equipment 75 325
Cost of Production 9,375
Add: Selling and Distribution Overheads:
Materials used in selling the product 150
Selling expenses 350
Advertisement 125 625
Total Cost 10,000
Profit (25% on selling price) 3,333
Selling Price 13,333
Note: It has been assumed that the freight has been paid on raw materials purchased.
Working Notes:
The elements of cost have been shown by means of a pie diagram:
Direct Materials 360 × 7,000/10,000 = 252°
Direct Expenses 360 × 500/10,000 = 18°
Selling Overheads 360 × 625/10,000 = 22.5°
Factory Overheads 360 × 550/10,000 = 19.8°
Direct Labour 360 × 1,000/10,000 = 36°
Office Overheads 360 × 325/10,000 = 11.7°
Self-Instructional
Material 333
Cost Accounting Illustration 10.7. The following particulars relating to the year 2017 have been
taken from the books of a chemical works, manufacturing and selling a chemical
mixture:
Stock on 1 January 2017: kg `
NOTES Raw materials 2,000 2,000
Finished mixture 500 1,750
Factory stosres 7,250
Purchases:
Raw materials 1,60,000 1,80,000
Factory stores 24,250
Sales:
Finished mixture 1,53,050 9,18,000
Factory scrap 8,170
Factory wages 1,78,650
Power 30,400
Depreciation on Machinery 18,000
Salaries:
Factory 72,220
Office 37,220
Selling 41,500
Expenses:
Direct 18,500
Office 18,200
Selling 18,000
Stock on 31 December 2017:
Raw materials 1,200
Finished mixture 450
Factory stores 5,550
(b) Total variable costs (`50 per unit) increase as volume of production
increases:
Self-Instructional
336 Material
(d) Step costs remain constant over a range of activity: Cost Accounting
NOTES
created by a decision that was made in the past that cannot be changed by any
decision that will be made in the future. Investment in plant and machinery, building,
etc., are prime examples of such costs. Since sunk costs cannot be altered by later
decisions, they are irrelevant for decision making. NOTES
According to National Association of Accountants, USA sunk cost means
‘an expenditure for equipment or productive resources which has no economic
relevance to the present decision-making process.’ On account of this reason, all
past costs, since they are irrelevant for decision making, come in the category of
sunk costs.
An individual may regret having made a purchase or constructing an asset
but having purchased or constructed it, cannot avoid it by taking any subsequent
action. Of course, the asset can be sold, in which case the cost of the asset will be
matched against the proceeds from sale of the asset for the purpose of determining
gain or loss. The person may decide to continue to own the asset in which case the
cost of the asset will be matched against the revenue realised over its effective life.
However, he cannot avoid that cost which has already been incurred by him for
the acquisition of the asset. It is as a matter of fact the sunk cost for all present and
future decisions.
Example:
Jolly Ltd purchased a machine for `30,000. The machine has an operating life of
five years without any scrap value. Soon after making the purchase the management
of Jolly Ltd feels that the machine should not have been purchased since it cannot
yield the operating advantage originally contemplated. Of course, it is expected to
result is saving in operating costs of `18,000 over a period of 5 years. The machine
can be sold immediately for a sum of `22,000.
In taking the decision whether the machine should be sold or be used, the
relevant amounts to be compared are `18,000 in cost savings over five years and
`22,000 that can be realised in case it is immediately disposed of `30,000 invested
in the asset is not relevant since it is the same in both cases. The amount is the sunk
cost. Jolly Ltd should, therefore, sell the machinery for `22,000 since it will result
in an extra profit of `4,000 as compared to keeping and using it.
Controllable and Uncontrollable Costs
Controllable costs are those costs which can be influenced by the action of a
specified member of an undertaking. Costs which cannot be so influenced are
termed as uncontrollable costs. A factory is usually divided into a number of
responsibility centres each of which is in charge of a specified level of management.
The officer-in-charge of a particular department or cost centre can control costs
only of those matters which come directly under his control but not of other matters.
For example, the expenditure incurred by the tool room is controllable by the
foreman-in-charge of that section but the share of the tool room expenditure,
Self-Instructional
Material 339
Cost Accounting which is apportioned to a machine shop cannot be controlled by a machine shop
foreman. Thus, the difference between controllable and uncontrollable costs is
only in relation to particular individual or level of management. An expenditure
which is controllable by one individual may be uncontrollable as far as another
NOTES individual is concerned.
The difference between controllable and uncontrollable costs is important
from the point of view of cost control and responsibility accounting. The concerned
executives should be held responsible for escalation of only such costs, which are
controllable by them.
Avoidable or Escapable Costs and Unavoidable or Inescapable Costs
Avoidable costs are those which will be eliminated, if a segment of the business
(e.g., a product or department), with which they are directly related, is discontinued.
Unavoidable costs are those which will not be eliminated with the segment. Such
costs are merely reallocated if the segment is discontinued. For example, in case a
product is discontinued, the salary of the factory manager or factory rent cannot
be eliminated. It will simply mean that certain other products will have to absorb a
higher amount of such overheads. However, salary of clerks attached to the product
or bad debts traceable to the product would be eliminated. Certain costs are
partly avoidable and partly unavoidable, e.g., closing of one department of a store
might result in decrease in delivery expenses but may not eliminate them completely.
It is to be noted that only avoidable costs are relevant for deciding whether
to continue or eliminate a segment of the business.
Imputed or Hypothetical Costs
These are costs which do not involve any cash outlay. They are not included in
cost accounts but are important for consideration while making management
decisions. Examples of such costs are interest on internally generated funds, salaries
of the proprietor or partner of a partnership firm and rented value of company’s
own property. Since these costs are notional costs, they do not enter into traditional
system. However, they are important, as stated above, for managerial decisions.
For example, where two projects require unequal, outlays of cash, the management
must take into consideration interest on capital for judging the relative profitability
of the projects, though the company may use internally generated funds for the
purpose.
Differential, Incremental or Decremental Costs
The difference in total costs between two alternatives is termed as ‘differential
costs’. In case the choice of an alternative results in increase in total costs, such
increase in costs is known as ‘incremental cost’. In case the choice results in
decrease in total costs, such decrease in total costs is termed as ‘decremental
cost’. While assessing the profitability of a proposed change, the incremental costs
Self-Instructional
340 Material
are matched with the incremental revenue or decremental costs are matched with Cost Accounting
Self-Instructional
344 Material
Cost Centre Cost Accounting
Self-Instructional
346 Material
1. Collection and Classification of Overheads Cost Accounting
After the overheads have been classified into factory, office and selling, it will be
advisable to group items covered by each category under suitable account headings.
For example, depreciation may relate to factory buildings, factory plant, factory NOTES
furniture, etc. It will be appropriate to group all items of depreciation relating to
factory assets at one place under a common heading ‘Depreciation’ with suitable
sub-headings. This grouping of like items with the like is necessary to collect
overhead items in a convenient and expeditious manner. The guiding principle in
selecting such headings must be that the, headings are clear and unambiguous so
that they may not be confused with each other.
2. Departmentalization of Overheads
After collecting and classifying overheads under suitable account headings, the
next step involved in overhead distribution is the departmentalization of these
overheads to different cost centres on a suitable basis. This involves two stages:
(i) Allocation of overheads: Allocation is the process of charging the full
amount of overhead costs to a particular cost centre. This is possible when
the nature of expenses is such that it can be easily identified with a particular
cost centre. For example, the salary paid to a foreman of a particular
production department can be directly identified with that department and
therefore it will be directly charged to that department.
(ii) Apportionment of overheads: It is the process of splitting up an item of
overhead cost and charging it to the cost centres on an equitable basis. This
is done in case of those overhead items which cannot wholly be allocated to
a particular department. For example, the salary paid to the works manager
of the factory cannot be charged wholly to a particular production
department but will have to be charged to all departments of the factory on
an equitable basis.
However, in common parlance no such distinction is observed.
The basis of apportionment and the details of apportionment are mentioned
in the card maintained for each Standing Order/Cost Account Number. For
example, rent of the factory will be apportioned over various departments
of the factory according to the area occupied by each department. The
amount of rent which each department has to bear will be mentioned in the
standing order number card allocated to rent. The same is true for other
items.
3. Absorption of Overheads
The term absorption refers to charging of overheads of a cost centre to different
cost units in such a way that each cost unit bears an appropriate portion of its
share of overheads. This is done by means of overhead rates. The term overhead
Self-Instructional
Material 347
Cost Accounting rate refers to the rate at which the overheads are to be charged to different cost
units. It may be in the form of a percentage or a rate per unit. For instance, if the
overheads of a department are ` 10,000 and the total wages paid for different
jobs completed in the department are ` 40,000 and if the overheads are to be
NOTES charged as a percentage of wages to different jobs, the overhead rate will be
25 per cent of wages. The share of overheads of each job completed in the
department will now be calculated on this basis.
Actual vs Predetermined Overheads Rates
Overhead rates may be determined either on the actual (historical) or the
predetermined basis.
1. Actual overheads rate: This rate is calculated by dividing the actual overheads
to be absorbed by the actual quantity or value of the base selected. The rate can
be calculated only after the costs have been actually incurred. It may be calculated
after a month or year or any other period which the concern may choose according
to its convenience. Assuming that overhead rate is worked out monthly, the formula
for calculating the rate may be put as follows:
Examples `
Factory overheads for the month of January 10,000
Wages for direct labour for the month of January 40,000
If the factory overheads rate is calculated as a percentage of direct labour,
it will be:
Examples `
Overabsorbed overheads 5,000
Actual hours (base) 10,000
The supplementary rate will be 50 paise per hour.
In case of underabsorption of overheads the rate is termed as positive,
while in case of overabsorption of overheads, it is termed as negative. In case of
underabsorption the cost of the job or product is increased by adding to it more
overheads on the basis of a positive supplementary rate and in case of
overabsorption the cost of the job or product is decreased by deducting the extra
amount of overheads charged by applying a negative supplementary rate.
3. Transfer to costing profit and loss account
In case the difference between actual or absorbed overheads is not very large or
the difference is due to abnormal circumstances; such difference should be
transferred at the end of the accounting year to the costing profit and loss account.
Illustration 10.9. The total overhead expenses of a factory are ` 4,50,608. Taking
into account the normal working of the factory, overhead was recovered from
production at ` 1.25 per hour. The actual hours worked were 2,93,104. How
would you proceed to close the books of accounts, assuming that besides 7,800
units produced of which 7,000 were sold, there were 200 equivalent units in
work-in-progress. On investigation it was found that 50% of the unabsorbed
overhead was on account of increase in the cost of indirect material and indirect
labour and other 50% was due to factory’s inefficiency.
Solution:
Unabsorbed overheads:
`
Overheads recovered from production 3,66,380
(2,903,104 hrs. × ` 1.25)
Actual overheads 4,50,608
84,228
Out of the total unabsorbed overheads of ` 84,228, 50% was due to increase
in the cost of indirect material and labour. The amount of ` 42,114 (50% of
Self-Instructional
350 Material
` 84,228) should, therefore, be charged to units produced by means of Cost Accounting
supplementary rate.
Supplementary rate:
Unabsorbed overheads = ` 42,114 NOTES
Units produced (7,800 + 200) = 8,000
Apportionment of Overheads
The amount of overheads of ` 42,114 will be apportioned between cost of sales,
finished goods and work-in-progress as follows:
Cost of Sales a/c (7,000 × 5.26425) = 36,849.75
Finished Goods a/c (800 × 5.26425) = 4,211.40
Work-in-progress a/c (200 × 5.26425) = 1,052.85
` 42,114.00
The balance of ` 42,114 (5% of ` 84,228) which represents unabsorbed
overheads on account of factory’s inefficiency (an abnormal factor) should be
transferred to the costing profit and loss account.
NOTES
Bills of Materials
The Production and Planning Department also prepares a list of materials and
stores (Bill of Materials) required for the completion of the job. It is sent to the
storekeeper so that he may arrange for the necessary materials required for the
job. A copy is also sent to the concerned foreman with the Production Order
which serves as an authority to him for collecting the materials and stores mentioned
from the storekeeper. On the same pattern, a list of tools required is also prepared.
Job Cost Card
Job cost card or job cost sheet is the most important document used in the job
costing system. A separate card or cost sheet is maintained for each job in which
all expenses regarding materials, labour and overheads are recorded directly from
costing records. The following method can be used to find out the cost of these
elements in respect of a particular order.
(i) Materials: The information regarding cost of materials or stores used for a
particular job order can be obtained from materials or stores requisition
slips. In case of large job orders, Materials Abstracts can be prepared for
finding out the total value of materials issued to different jobs.
(ii) Labour: The cost of labour incurred on each job can be ascertained with
the help of time and job cards. In case of a large number of jobs, preparation
of ‘Wages Abstract’ may considerably help in computing the amount paid
as wages for completion of specific jobs. Wages paid for indirect labour
will constitute an item of factory overheads.
(iii) Overheads: Every job will be charged with amount of overheads
determined on the basis of the method selected for allocation of overheads.
Normally, on the basis of past results an overhead rate is determined and
each job is charged for overheads at the predetermined rate. Self-Instructional
Material 353
Cost Accounting Profit or loss on a job can also be found out by preparing a Job Account.
The job account is debited with all expenses incurred on the job and is credited
with the job price. The difference of the two sides will be the profit or loss made
or suffered on the job.
NOTES
A pro forma of a Job Cost Card is as follows:
JOB COST CARD
Product............................ Job Order No...............................
Ordered by...................... Buyer’s Purchase Order No..........
Date Started..................................
Date Completed............................
DEPARTMENT A
Direct Materials Direct Labour Overheads
Date Reference Amount Date Reference Amount Date Amount
(Store Req. Worker’s (Based on
No.) Ticket No. Pre-determined
overhead rate)
DEPARTMENT B
Direct Materials Direct Labour Overheads
SUMMARY
Selling Price ×××
Dept. A Dept. B Total
Cost: Direct Material ×× ×× ×××
Direct Labour ×× ×× ×××
Factory Overheads ×× ×× ××× ×××
Gross Profit ×××
Work-in-process
The account is maintained in the cost ledger and it represents the jobs under
production. The account may be maintained in any of the following two ways
depending upon the requirements of the business-:
1. A composite work-in-process account for the entire factory.
2. A composite work-in-process account for every department. For example,
if the factory has three departments A, B and C, a work-in-process for
each of these three departments will be opened.
The work-in-process account is periodically debited with all costs—direct
and indirect—incurred in the execution of the jobs. At intervals of a month or so,
Self-Instructional
354 Material
a summary of completed jobs is prepared and the work-in-process account is Cost Accounting
credited with the cost of completed jobs. In case work-in-progress account for
each department of the factory has been opened, it will be necessary to find out
the cost of completed jobs regarding each department. The balance in work-in-
process account at any time represents the cost of jobs not yet completed. NOTES
JOB TICKET
JOB No. 1089
Customer ..................................................................... Date ...............................
Quantity .....................................................................
Description ....................................................................
...........................................................................................
Date required ..................................................................
JOB No. 1089
Operation No. 3
Quantity Completed ........................................................ Operator’s initial
Checked ............................................................................ or Number
JOB No. 1089
Operation No. 2
Quantity Completed ........................................................ Operator’s initial
Checked ............................................................................ or Number
JOB No. 1089
Operation No. 1
Quantity Completed........................................................ Operator’s initial
Checked............................................................................. or Number
N.B. Ticket should be perforated on dotted lines
The job ticket is useful for both production control and costing departments.
On completion of an operation, the relevant portion of the ticket is detached and
sent to Production Control Department. This enables Production Control
Department in keeping production schedule up-to-date. On the basis of the
detached portion a ‘Departmental Summary of Production’ can be prepared which
is very useful for costing purposes. Moreover, the amount of work-in--process as
shown by the cost ledger can be checked by listing the ticket number of jobs in
process in any department and valuing this list.
Progress Advice
The foreman of a department may be required to send periodically a statement
regarding the stage of completion of each job to ensure completion of jobs by
scheduled dates. Such a note is called ‘Progress Advice’. It may be in the following
form:
Self-Instructional
Material 355
Cost Accounting
NOTES
Illustration 10.10: Following information has been extracted from the costing
record of the Jai Engineering Works in respect of Job No. 28.
Materials ` 3,450
Wages
Department A 60 hours @ ` 3/- per hour
Department B 40 hours @ ` 2/- per hour
Department C 20 hours @ ` 4/- per hour
Overhead expenses for the three departments were estimated as follows-—
Variable Overheads:
Department A: ` 4,000 for 4,000 direct
labour hours
Department B: ` 3,000 for 1,500 direct
labour hours
Department C: ` 1,000 for 500 direct
labour hours
Fixed Overheads:
Estimated at ` 10,000 for 10,000 normal working hours.
You are required to calculate the cost of Job No. 28 and calculate the price
to be charged so as to give a profit of 20% on selling price.
Solution:
COST SHEET
Job No. 28
Particulars Amount ` Amount `
Direct Materials 3,450
Wages :
Department A—60 hrs. @ 3/- per hour 180
Department B—60 hrs. @ 2/- per hour 80
Department C—60 hrs. @ 4/- per hour 80 340
Prime Cost 3,790
*Overheads—Variable
Department A—60 hrs. @ 1/- per hour 60
Department B—40 hrs. @ 2/- per hour 80
Self-Instructional
356 Material
Department C—20 hrs. @ 2/- per hour 40 180 Cost Accounting
Contract costing is a special form of job costing. The only difference between a
job and a contract is that of size. Where big jobs are involved, requiring considerable
length of time to complete and comprising activities to be done outside the precincts
of the factory, the system of contract costing is employed. The system is very
much common in firms of constructional engineers, ship-builders, etc., who
undertake definite contracts. The price agreed to be paid by the contractee is
termed as the contract price. The system of contract costing is very simple. A
separate account is opened for each contract in the General Ledger, or in the
Contract Ledger—which may be maintained in case the number of contracts happen
to be quite large. The contract account is debited with all direct and indirect
expenditure incurred in relation to the contract. It is credited with the amount of
contract price on completion of the contract. The balance represents profit or loss
made on the contract and is transferred to the Profit and Loss Account. In case
the contract is not complete at the end of the accounting period, a reasonable
amount of profit, as explained later, out of the total profit made so far on the
incomplete contract, may be transferred to the Profit and Loss Account.
Specific Aspects of Contract Costing
The following are certain special aspects of contract costing and treatment of
some important items of expense in contract accounts.
Materials
In case of materials purchased specially for a contract and directly received at the
contract site, the necessity of maintaining a proper system of stores accounting will
not arise. But proper store accounting will be necessary for those materials which
are less frequently required and have been stored in the contractor’s central store
Self-Instructional
Material 357
Cost Accounting and issued to contracts, whenever required. When materials are specially purchased
for a contract, the contract account will be debited, and supplier’s or cash account
will be credited with the value of materials purchased, In case the materials have
been issued from stores, the relevant contract account will be debited and stores
NOTES control account in the General Ledger will be credited with the amount of materials
issued. In case certain materials charged to a contract are returned to stores,
stores control account will be debited, and the contract account will be credited1.
Sale of surplus materials at contract sites is also very common. The sale
proceeds should be credited to the concerned contract account. In case sale of
materials has been made on account of some extraneous reasons, any profit or
loss on such a sale should be transferred directly to the Profit and Loss Account.
This applies not only to materials, but also to sale of plant, machinery, tools, etc. In
other words, the cost of a contract should in no way be affected by any abnormal
profit or loss.
In case the contractee himself has supplied materials for the contract, the
value of such materials should not be charged to the contract account. A separate
record for such materials should be maintained because the unused materials will
have to be returned back to the contractee.
Labour
All labour employed at the contract site is regarded as direct, irrespective of the
nature of job performed by the workers concerned. Salary of the supervisory
staff will also be considered as a direct charge against a contract if they have
rendered their whole-time attention to it. Wages of workers which cannot be
identified with a particular contract, or salary of the supervisory staff looking after
two or more contracts, will be considered as an indirect cost and apportioned
over the contracts concerned on a reasonable basis. In case the contract has been
divided into several sections and it is required to ascertain the labour cost of each
section, each worker should be provided with a job card as explained earlier.
Where simultaneously a number of contracts are being executed, it will be desirable
to maintain a separate wage sheet for each contract as it will facilitate the work of
charging wages to individual contracts. If it does not seem to be convenient, the
whole of wages paid should be summarized on a ‘Wages Abstract’, a specimen of
which is as follows:
Self-Instructional
358 Material
Plant Cost Accounting
The plant used on a contract can be dealt with in the contract accounts in any of
the two ways:
(a) Where a plant has been specially purchased for a particular contract and it NOTES
will be exhausted at site, contract account should be debited with the cost
of the plant. At the end of the accounting period, the depreciated value of
the plant should be put on the credit side of the contract account.
(b) Where the services of a particular plant upon a contract are required only
for a short period, the contract account should be debited with the amount
of usual depreciation of the plant.
Overheads
Where a contractor has a number of contracts-in-process, he may have a common
office and common supervisory staff for all contracts. The expenses of the office
and the salaries of such supervisory staff will be considered items of overheads.
They will be apportioned to different contracts in accordance with any of the
methods discussed in earlier in the unit ‘Overheads-Distribution’. Sometimes, the
overheads are also apportioned to different contracts on the basis of expenditure
incurred on materials, labour and plant for each contract.
Cost-plus contracts
In certain contracts the contractee agrees to pay to the contractor the cost price
(usually prime cost) of the work done on the contract plus an agreed percentage
thereof by way of overhead cost and profit. Such contracts are known as cost-
plus contracts. The system of cost-plus contract costing is employed in cases
where it is very difficult for the contractor to quote the contract price, because
there has been no precedent which he may take as a basis. It is also employed
where the work to be done is not fixed at the time of placing order for the contract.
The method is generally used where government happens to be the contractee.
Illustration 10.11: The expenses of a machine cost centre for a particular month
are as follows:
(i) Power ` 50,000,
(ii) Maintenance and Repairs ` 10,000;
(iii) Machine Operator’s Wages ` 2,000;
(iv) Supervision ` 6,000;
(v) Depreciation ` 40,000.
Other particulars are as follows:
Product Rate of Production Production (Units)
A 30 Units per hour 1,800
B 10 Units per hour 500
Self-Instructional
Material 359
Cost Accounting C 6 Units per hour 300
D 4 Units per hour 260
The entire production was to be offered to government on ‘Cost Plus 20%’
NOTES basis. Material costs per unit ate A ` 40; B ` 60; C ` 100; and D ` 300.
Prepare a statement showing productwise ‘cost’ and ‘offer price’.
Solution:
Working Notes:
(a) Computation of Machine Hour Rate `
Power 50,000
Maintenance 10,000
Wages 2,000
Supervision 6,000
Depreciation 40,000
Total Expenses 1,08,000
Number of Machines Hours 225
Machine Hour Rate 1,08,000/225 = ` 480
(b) The machine expenses for the output of each product have been computed by multiplying
the machine hour rate with the relevant output of each product, i.e., for product A 60
× ` 480
= ` 28,800 and so on.
(c) The offer price for each product per unit has been ascertained by adding 20% profit
to the cost of each product, e.g., for product, 4, ` 56 (+) 20% of 56 = ` 56 + ` 11.20
= ` 67.20.
Extras
A contractee may require some additions or alterations to be made in the work
originally agreed to be done under the contract. The contractor will charge extra
money in addition to the contract price for all such extra work. Frequently, a
charge for extra work is made on the ‘cost plus’ basis. It, therefore, becomes
necessary to maintain separate records for all such extra work done. In case the
extra work is not substantial, the cost of such work can be charged to the original
contract which may also be credited with the price charged for the extra work.
However, a separate account should be maintained of extra work if it happens to
be quite substantial.
Self-Instructional
360 Material
Sub-contracts Cost Accounting
The contractor may entrust some portion of the work to be done under the contract
to a sub-contractor. Usually, work of a specialized nature, e.g., steel work, special
flooring, etc., is done by sub-contractors, who are responsible to the main contractor. NOTES
The cost of such sub-contracts is a direct charge against the contract for which the
work has been done.
Escalation clause (or materials and labour variation clause)
Escalation clause is usually provided in the contract as a safeguard against any
likely changes in the price or utilization of material and labour. The clause provides
that in case prices of items of raw materials, labour, etc., specified in the contract,
change during the execution of the contract, beyond a specified limit over the
prices prevailing at the time of signing the agreement, the contract price will be
suitably adjusted. The terms of the contract specify the procedure for calculating
such adjustment in order to avoid all future disputes. Thus, such a clause safeguards
the interests of both the contractor and the contractee in case of fluctuations in the
prices of materials and labour, etc.
Payment
In case of small contracts, the contractee pays the contract price on completion of
the contract. But in case of large contracts the system of Progress Payment is
adopted. The contractee agrees to pay a part of the contract price from time to
time depending upon satisfactory progress of the work. The progress will be judged
by the contractee’s architect, surveyor or engineer, who will issue a certificate
known as ‘Surveyor’s Certificate’, stating the value of work so far done and
approved by him. Such work is termed as Work Certified. The contractee usually
does not pay 100 per cent of the work certified. He may pay only 75 per cent or
80 per cent of the work certified depending upon the terms of the contract. The
balance not paid is called Retention Money.
The value of the work certified and the consequent payment may be dealt
with in cost accounts in any of the following two ways:
(1) The amount of work certified may be debited to the contractee’s personal
account and credited to the contract account. On receipt of money from
the contractee, his personal account will be credited and cash or bank account
will be debited. For example, if the value of work certified is ` 1,00,000
and the contractee has paid 80% in cash, the following journal entries will
be passed:
Contractee’s Account Dr. ` 1,00,000
To Contract Account ` 1 ,00,000
(Being the value of work certified)
Bank Account Dr. ` 80,000
To Contractee’s Account ` 80,000
(Being the amount of cash received) Self-Instructional
Material 361
Cost Accounting In the Balance Sheet the Contractee’s Account will be shown on the assets
side. It is to be carefully noted that in the following year, entry for the amount
of work certified should not include ` 1,00,000, the entry for which has
already been passed.
NOTES
(2) A memorandum of record of work certified may be kept. The cash received
from the contractee may be credited to his personal account. The amount
of work certified will be debited to work-in-progress account and credited
to the contract account. The work-in-progress account will be shown as an
asset in the balance sheet after deducting the amount received from the
contractee. In the next year, the work-in-progress account will be transferred
to the debit side of the contract account. On completion of the contract, the
contractee’s personal account will be debited and contract account will be
credited. Taking the data from the above example the following journal
entries will be passed:
Work-in-progress Account Dr. `1,00,000
To Contract Account ` 1,00,000
(Being the value of work certified)
Bank Account Dr. ` 80,000
To Contractee’s Account ` 80,000
(Being amount of cash received)
In the Balance Sheet the items will appear as follows:
EXTRACTS FROM BALANCE SHEET as on.........
Assets Amount
`
Work-in-progress (Contract No..................) 1,00,000
Less: Amount received from the contractee 80,000 20,000
job costing system. A separate card or cost sheet is maintained for each job
in which all expenses regarding materials, labour and overheads are recorded
directly from costing records
NOTES
9. The only difference between a job and a contract is that of size.
10.11 SUMMARY
Direct expenses: Costs other than materials and wages which are incurred
for a specific product or saleable service
Work-in-progress: Units which are not yet complete but on which some
work has been done
Overheads: Costs, which cannot be economically identified with a specific
saleable cost unit
Overheads allocation: The process of charging overhead costs to a
particular cost centre
Overhead apportionment: The process of splitting up an item of overhead
cost and charging it to the costs units on an equitable basis
Job cost: A record of the cost of labour and materials used and overhead
attributed for a particular job
Contract costing: A form of specific order costing involving attribution of
costs to individual contracts
rate.
4. Why do underabsorption and overabsorption of overheads arise?
5. What is job costing? What are its objectives? NOTES
6. List the advantages of job costing.
Long Answer Questions
1. Discuss the various elements of cost.
2. Explain the various components of total cost with the help of suitable
examples.
3. Describe the method of computing profit while preparing a cost sheet.
4. Give a detailed account of the classification of costs.
5. Distinguish between allocation, absorption and apportionment of overheads.
6. Explain the method of job costing with the help of a suitable example.
7. What is contract costing? Discuss briefly the method of contract costing.
Explain the accounting treatment of incomplete contracts.
Self-Instructional
Material 367
Operating Costing, Inventory
Control and Labour Costing
UNIT 11 OPERATING COSTING,
INVENTORY CONTROL
NOTES
AND LABOUR COSTING
Structure
11.0 Introduction
11.1 Objectives
11.2 Operating Costing
11.3 Material/Inventory Control
11.4 Inventory Control and Valuation
11.4.1 Inventory Systems
11.4.2 Methods of Valuation of Inventories
11.5 Techniques of Inventory Control: EOQ, ABC Analysis and Setting of
Reorder Level
11.5.1 ABC Analysis
11.5.2 Setting of Reorder Level, Maximum Level and Minimum Level
11.6 Labour Cost Accounting: Remuneration and Incentive Schemes
11.6.1 Remuneration/Wage Schemes
11.6.2 Incentive Schemes
11.7 Reconciliation of Financial and Cost Accounting
11.8 Answers to Check Your Progress Questions
11.9 Summary
11.10 Key Words
11.11 Self Assessment Questions and Exercises
11.12 Further Readings
11.0 INTRODUCTION
Self-Instructional
368 Material
Operating Costing, Inventory
11.1 OBJECTIVES Control and Labour Costing
Self-Instructional
Material 369
Operating Costing, Inventory Costing procedure
Control and Labour Costing
The cost procedure for operation costing is the same as for process costing
discussed in the preceding unit. However, for the convenience of the reader we
NOTES are summarizing its basic characteristics:
1. Operation costing is a special type of process costing. In this case, cost
centre is each operation in place of a process.
2. An account is opened for each operation. The operation is charged with its
material, labour and overhead costs. The total cost of each operation is
transferred to the next operation as is the case with process costing.
3. In case a process has too many operations, keeping a separate account for
each operation may involve have clerical costs. Moreover, this may also
make the distribution of manufacturing overheads difficult. In such a case
accounts are maintained in the General Ledger only for large processes and
analysis sheet is maintained for each operation as a subsidiary document
individually.
4. In case the operation costs comprise only of the conversion cost, the cost
of materials is added to the conversion cost of each of the operation through
which the product passes. The total cost of the product is the aggregate of
cost of materials and the costs of different operations relating to the product.
Illustration 11.1. An Article passes through three successive operations in process
A to make it a finished product for process B. The following data are available
from the production records of a particular month:
Input Rejected Output
Operation No. No. of pcs. No. of pcs. No. of pcs.
1. 60,000 20,000 40,000
2. 66,000 6,000 60,000
3. 48,000 8,000 40,000
(i) Determine the input required to be introduced in the first operation in number
of pieces, in order to obtain the finished output of 100 pieces after the last
operation.
(ii) Calculate the cost of raw material required to produce one piece of finished
product in process A, given the following information :
Weight of the finished piece is 0.10 kg. and the price of raw material is ` 20
per kg.
Self-Instructional
370 Material
Solution. Operating Costing, Inventory
Control and Labour Costing
STATEMENT OF PRODUCTION
(for a month)
Operation Input Rejections Output
No. Total No. Total no. % rejection Total No. NOTES
to output
1. 60,000 20,000 50% 40,000
2. 66,000 6,000 10% 60,000
3. 48,000 8,000 20% 40,000
Input required for final output of 100 units in Process A :
Output of operation 3 100
Loss in operation, 20% of 100 20
Input to operation 3 or output of operation 2 120
Loss in operation 2, 10% of 120 12
Input to operation 2 or output of operation 1 132
Loss in operation 1, 50% of 132 66
Input to operation 1 198
(ii) In order to produce 100 prices of final output in process A, 198 pieces of
initial input is used. The weight of one piece of finished output is 0.10 kg.
Thus, the total weight of input to produce one piece of output is 0.198 kg. The
price being ` 20 per kg., the cost of materials for producing 1 piece comes to
` 3.96 (i.e. 20 × 198).
Illustration 11.2. A company is manufacturing two distinct varieties of cloth:
(i) Janta and (ii) Superfine. The company purchases the raw cloth for both types
of varieties and passes it through two different operations for finishing. The following
are the costing details for the month of December, 1998.
Purchase of Raw Cloth : Janta @ ` 5 per metre and Superfine @ ` 20 per
metre
Operations 1 : Wages ` 20,000 Finished Output :
Overheads ` 10,000 Janta 1,000 metres
Operations 2 : Wages ` 10,000 Superfine 1,000 metres
Overheads ` 5,000
Self-Instructional
Material 371
Operating Costing, Inventory OPERATION 2 ACCOUNT
Control and Labour Costing
` `
To Wages 10,000 By Cost of production 15,000
To Overheads 5,000 (@ ` 5 per metre)
NOTES 15,000 15,000
COMPUTATION OF COST
Particulars Janta Output Superfine Output
2,000 metres 1,000 metres
(`) (`)
Raw Cloth :
110
Janta 2,000 5 11,000
100
110
Superfine 1, 000 20 22,000
100
Operation 1
Janta 2,000 × 10 20,000
Superfine 1,000 × 10 10,000
Operation 2
Janta 2,000 × 5 10,000
Superfine 1,000 × 5 5,000
Total Cost 41,000 37,000
Total Output (metres) 2,000 1,000
Cost per metre 20.5 37.00
The term ‘material’ refers to all commodities that are consumed in the process of
manufacture. It is defined as ‘anything that can be stored, stacked or stockpiled.’
Materials are classified into ‘direct’ materials and ‘indirect’ materials.
“Direct material cost is the cost of material which can be directly allocated
to a cost centre or a cost object in an economically feasible way.” CAS - I of
ICAI. Direct materials include not only the raw materials entering at the start of the
production but all of the following:
(a) Component parts used in a product, e.g., tyres and tubes in a car or picture
tube in a television set.
(b) Any material used in production but wholly consumed in the production
process, e.g., fertilizer used in growing plants.
(c) Any primary packing material, i.e., any container sold with the final product,
e.g., cans for tinned food and drink, bottles for beer, etc.
Indirect materials are those which cannot be easily identified with a particular
cost centre or cost object. Examples are coal, grease and oil, soap and sandpaper.
The term ‘inventory’ is used to cover the stocks of raw materials,
components, work-in-progress and finished goods. It has been defined by the
Accounting Principles Board as ‘the aggregate of those items of tangible
personal property which (i) are held for sale in the ordinary course of business;
(ii) are in the process of production for such sales; or (iii) are to be currently
consumed in the production of goods or services to be available for sale.’
Self-Instructional
374 Material
Perpetual Inventory System Operating Costing, Inventory
Control and Labour Costing
It is also known as an Automatic Inventory System. According to the Chartered
Institute of Management Accountants London, it is “A system of records maintained
by the controlling department, which reflects the physical movement of stocks and NOTES
their current balance.” The definition given by Wheldon is more exhaustive and
explanatory. According to him, it is “a method of recording inventory balances
after every receipt and issue to facilitate regular checking and to obviate closing
down for stocktaking.” In case of this system the stores ledger gives balance of
raw materials, work-in-progress, and finished goods on a continuing basis. The
basic objective of this system is to make available details about the quantity and
value of stock of each item at all times. The system, thus, provides a rigid control
over stock of materials, as physical stock can regularly be verified with the stock
records kept in the stores and the cost office.
11.4.2 Methods of Valuation of Inventories
According to Accounting Standard: 2 (Revised), the inventories should be valued
at the lowest of “cost” and “net realisable value”.
Cost of Inventories
Cost of inventories is the aggregate of cost of purchase, cost of conversion, and
other costs incurred in bringing the inventories to their present location and condition.
Thus, cost includes not only the price paid for acquisition of inventories but
also all costs incurred for bringing and making them fit for use in production or for
sale, e.g., transportation costs, duties paid, insurance-in-transit, manufacturing
expenses, wages paid or manufacturing expenses incurred for converting raw
materials into finished products, etc. Selling expenses such as advertisement
expenses or storage costs should not be included.
A major objective of accounting for inventories is the proper determination
of income through the process of matching appropriate costs against revenues. It
requires assigning of proper costs to inventory as well as goods sold.
However, it should be noted that assigning of such costs need not conform
to the physical flow of goods.
The various methods for assigning historical costs to inventory and goods
sold are being explained below.
1. Specific Identification Method: According to this method, each item of
inventory is identified with its cost. The total of the various costs so identified
constitutes the value of inventory. This method is generally used when the materials
or goods have been purchased for a specific job or customer. Such materials or
goods when received are earmarked for the job or purpose they are purchased
and are issued or sold whenever demanded.
Self-Instructional
Material 375
Operating Costing, Inventory This technique of inventory valuation can be adopted only by a company
Control and Labour Costing
which is handling a small number of items. In case of a manufacturing company
having a number of inventory items, it is almost impossible to identify the cost of
each individual item of inventory. Thus, this method is inappropriate in most cases
NOTES on account of practical considerations. Moreover, the method opens door to income
manipulation when like items are purchased at different prices. For example, a
company purchases 10,000 units of an item in equal lots of 2,500 each at costs
`2.50, `3, `3.50, and `4 per unit. It sells 7,500 units at `4 per unit. In case the
management follows this method for valuation of inventory, it can determine the
income reported for the period by selecting that lot of units which will produce the
desired objective. If it is assumed that the inventory consists of the last lot purchased,
the value of the inventory would be a sum of `10,000 as compared to the
presumption that the inventory consists of units purchased in the first lot in which
case the value of inventory would be `6,250.
The working of the system can be understood with the help of the following
illustration.
Illustration 11.3. The following is the record of receipts of certain materials during
February, 2011:
Feb. 1 Received 400 units for Job No. 12 @ `10 per unit.
Feb. 4 Received 300 units for Job No. 13 @ `11 per unit.
Feb. 16 Received 200 units for Job No. 14 @ `12 per unit.
Feb. 25 Received 400 units for Job No. 15 @ `13 per unit.
During February 2011, the following issues of materials are made:
Feb. 10 Issued 200 units to Job No. 12.
Feb. 15 Issued 100 units to Job No. 13.
Feb. 17 Issued 200 units to Job No. 12.
Feb. 20 Issued 200 units to Job No. 14.
Feb. 26 Issued 100 units to Job No. 13.
Feb. 28 Issued 200 units to Job No. 15.
Show how these transactions will appear in the Stores Ledger and state the
amount of inventory of Feb. 28, 2011.
Solution:
Stores Ledger
Receipts Issues Balance
Date Job Qty Rate Amt Date Job Qty Due Rate Amt Qty Amt
No. ` ` No. ` ` `
Feb. 1 12 400 10 4,000 Feb. ... ... ... ... ... 400 4,000
Feb. 4 13 300 11 3,300 ... ... ... ... . ... 700 7,300
10 12 200 200 10 2,000 500 5,300
15 13 100 200 11 1,100 400 4,200
Feb. 16 16 200 12 2,400 ... ... ... ... ... ... 600 6,600
17 12 200 ... 10 2,000 400 4,600
20 14 200 ... 12 2,400 200 2,200
Self-Instructional
376 Material
Feb. 25 15 400 13 5,200 ... ... ... ... ... ... 600 7,400 Operating Costing, Inventory
26 13 100 100 11 1,100 500 6,300 Control and Labour Costing
28 15 200 200 13 2,600 300 3,700
Total 1,300 14,900 1,000 11,200 300 3,700*
2. First In First Out (FIFO) Method: Under this method, it is assumed that the
materials/goods first received are the first to be issued/sold. Thus, according to
this method, the inventory on a particular date is presumed to be composed of the
items which have been acquired most recently. The working of this method can be
understood with the following illustration.
Illustration 11.4. The following are the details regarding purchases of a certain
item during January:
January 1 Purchases 200 units @ `7 `1,400
January 8 Purchases 900 units @ `8 `7,200
January 25 Purchases 300 units @ `9 `2,700
January 30 Purchases 400 units @ `10 ` 4,000
`15,300
A physical inventory of the items taken on 31 January shows that there are
700 units in hand. You are required to calculate the value of the inventory according
FIFO method.
Solution:
In case of FIFO method, the inventory is presumed to be consisting of items
purchased most recently. Accordingly the value of the inventory on 31st January
will be as follows:
January 31 Purchases 400 units @ `10 `4,000
January 25 Purchases 300 units @ `9 `2,700
`6,700
In the above cases, the valuation of inventory has been done on the
presumption that the concern follows “Periodic Inventory System”. Of course, in
case of FIFO method, the value of inventory would remain the same even if the
perpetual inventory system is followed. For example, if, out of 1,100 units issued,
150 units were issued on January 4, while 950 units were issued on January 10,
the valuation of inventory using perpetual inventory system will be calculated as
follows:
Self-Instructional
Material 377
Operating Costing, Inventory Stock Ledger
Control and Labour Costing
Receipts Issues Balance
Date
Qty Rate Amount Qty Rate Amount Qty
Amount
NOTES
January 1 200 7 1,400 — — — 200 1,400
January 4 — — — 150 7 1,050 50 350
January 8 900 8 7,200 — — — 950 7,550
January 10 — — — 50 7 350 — —
900 8 7,200
January 25 300 9 2,700 — — — 300 2,700
January 30 400 10 4,000 — — — 700 6,700
It is clear from the above that the value of inventory in case of periodic inventory
system as well as perpetual inventory system is the same, i.e., `6,700, if the FIFO method
is followed. The cost of goods sold in both the cases, therefore, also amounts to `8,600
(i.e., `15,300 – `6,700).
Advantages: The FIFO method has the following advantages:
1. It values stock nearer to current market prices since stock is presumed to
be consisting of the most recent purchases.
2. It is based on cost and, therefore, no unrealised profit enters into the financial
accounts of the company.
3. The method is realistic since it takes into account the normal procedure of
utilising/selling those materials/goods which have been longest in stock.
Disadvantages: The method suffers from the following disadvantages:
1. It involves complicated calculations and hence increases the possibility of
clerical errors.
2. Comparison between different jobs using the same type of material becomes
sometimes difficult. A job commenced a few minutes after another job may
have to bear an entirely different charge for materials because the first job
completely exhausted the supply of materials of the particular lot.
The FIFO method of valuation of inventories is particularly suitable in the
following circumstances:
(i) The materials/goods are of a perishable nature.
(ii) The frequency of purchases is not large.
(iii) There are only moderate fluctuations in the prices of materials/goods
purchased.
(iv) Materials are easily identifiable as belonging to a particular purchase lot.
3. Last In First Out (LIFO) Method: This method is based on the assumption
that the last items of materials/goods purchased are the first to be issued/sold.
Thus, according to this method, inventory consists of items purchased at the earliest
cost.
Self-Instructional
378 Material
Illustration 11.5. Calculate the value of the inventory of 31 January from the Operating Costing, Inventory
Control and Labour Costing
following data using (i) periodic inventory system and (ii) perpetual inventory
system:
Receipts `
January 1 Inventory in hand 200 units @ `7 1,400 NOTES
January 8 Purchases 1,100 units @ `8 8,800
January 25 Purchases 300 units @ `9 2,700
January 31 Purchases 400 units @ `10 4,000
Issued for sale
January 6 100 units January 15 400 units
January 9 200 units January 27 600 units
Solution:
(i) Valuation of inventory under periodic inventory system
January 1 Opening inventory 200 units @ `7 1,400
January 8 Purchases 500 units @ `8 4,000
Total 700 units 5,400
(ii) Valuation of inventory under perpetual inventory system:
Stock Ledger
Receipts Issues
DateBalance
Self-Instructional
380 Material
It may also be noted that no sweeping generalisation can be made regarding Operating Costing, Inventory
Control and Labour Costing
superiority of LIFO over FIFO or vice versa. Each method has its own merits and
demerits depending upon the circumstances prevailing at a particular moment of
time.
NOTES
4. Highest In First Out (HIFO) Method: According to this method, the inventory
of materials or goods should be valued at the lowest possible prices. Materials
or goods purchased at the highest prices are treated as being first issued/sold
irrespective of the date of purchase. This method is very suitable when the market
is constantly fluctuating because cost of heavily priced materials or goods is
recovered from the production or sales at the earliest. However, the method
involves too many calculations as in the case of FIFO or LIFO method. The
method has, therefore, not been adopted widely.
5. Base Stock Method: The method is based on the contention that each
enterprise maintains at all times a minimum quantity of materials or finished goods
in its stock. This quantity is termed as base stock. The base stock is deemed to
have been created out of the first lot purchased and, therefore, it is always valued
at this price and is carried forward as a fixed asset. Any quantity over and above
the base stock is valued in accordance with any other appropriate method. As this
method aims at matching current costs to current sales, the LIFO method will be
the most suitable for valuing stock of materials or finished goods other than the
base stock. The base stock method has the advantage of charging out materials/
goods at actual cost. Its other merits or demerits will depend on the method which
is used for valuing materials other than the base stock.
6. Next In First Out (NIFO) Method: The method attempts to value materials
issued or goods sold at actual price which is as near as possible to the market
price. Under this method, the issues are made or cost of goods sold is taken to
the next price, i.e., the price of materials or goods which has been ordered but
not yet received. In other words, issues of goods for further processing or sale
are made at the latest price at which the company has been committed even
though materials/goods have not yet been physically received. This method is
better than the marked price method under which every time when materials or
goods are issued or sold, their market price will have to be ascertained. In case
of this method, the materials or goods will be issued at the price at which a new
order has been placed and this price will hold good for all future issues till a next
order is placed. For example, 100 units of material A purchased @ `1 per unit
are lying in the store and an order for another 100 units @ `1.25 has already been
placed. If a requisition of 50 units from a department is made, they will be issued
to the department at `1.25 per unit (i.e., the price at which the materials are yet
to be received).
The value of inventory on a particular date is ascertained by deducting the
cost of materials issued or goods sold from the total value of materials or goods
purchased.
Self-Instructional
Material 381
Operating Costing, Inventory Calculations of issue prices are complicated in this method and, therefore,
Control and Labour Costing
the method is not widely used.
7. Weighted Average Price Method: This method is based on the presumption
that once the materials or goods are put into a common bin, they lose their
NOTES
separate identity. Hence, the inventory consists of no specific batch of goods. The
inventory is thus priced on the basis of average prices paid for the goods, weighted
according to the quantity purchased at each price.
Illustration 11.6. From the following details, calculate the value of inventory on
January 31 according to the Weighted Average Price Method when the firm follows:
(i) Periodic Inventory System and (ii) Perpetual Inventory System.
Jan. 1 Purchases 100 units @ `4 per unit
Jan. 8 Purchases 200 units @ `5 per unit
Jan. 20 Sales 100 units
Jan. 25 Purchases 200 units @ `6 per unit
Jan. 31 Sales 200 units
Solution:
(i) Valuation of Inventory Under Periodic Inventory System
Jan. 1 Purchases @ `4 100 units ` 400
Jan. 8 Purchases @ `5 200 units 1,000
Jan. 24 Purchases @ `6 200 units 1,200
Total 500 units 2,600
Self-Instructional
382 Material
Accounting Standard 2 (Revised) provides First in First out (FIFO) or Operating Costing, Inventory
Control and Labour Costing
Weighted Average method for computing the cost of inventories. It has
recommended the use of specific Identification Method only in case of goods or
services which are meant for specific projects.
NOTES
The following comprehensive illustration will further help the students in
understanding the working of different methods.
Illustration 11.7. M/s Swadeshi Cotton Mills Ltd. take a periodic inventory of
their stocks on chemical Y at the end of each month. The physical inventory taken
on June 30 shows a balance of 1,000 litres of chemical Y in hand @ `2.28 per
litre. The following purchases were made during July:
July 1 14,000 litres @ `2.30 per litre.
July 8 10,000 litres @ `2.32 per litre.
July 9 20,000 litres @ `2.33 per litre.
July 25 5,000 litres @ `2.35 per litre.
A physical inventory on July 31 discloses that there is a stock of 10,000 litres.
You are required to compute the inventory value on July 31, by each of the following methods:
(i) First In First Out, (ii) Last In First Out, and (iii) Average Cost Method.
Solution:
(i) First In First Out Method
`
July 25 5,000 litres @ `2.35 = 11,750
July 9 5,000 litres @ `2.33 = 11,650
Closing inventory on July 31:10,000 litres 23,400
(ii) Last In First Out Method
`
June 30 1,000 litres @ `2.28 = 2,280
July 1 9,000 litres @ `2.30 = 20,700
Closing inventory on July 31: 10,000 litres 22,980
(iii) Average Cost Method
`
June 30 1,000 litres @ `2.28 = 2,280
July 1 14,000 litres @ `2.30 = 32,200
July 7 10,000 litres @ `2.32 = 23,200
July 9 20,000 litres @ `2.33 = 46,600
July 25 5,000 litres @ `2.35 = 11,750
Total 50,000 litres 1,16,030
1,16,030
Average cost per litre = = 2.3206
50,000
Total value of inventory on July 31 = 10,000 × 2.3206 = `23,206.
Self-Instructional
Material 383
Operating Costing, Inventory Net Realisable Value
Control and Labour Costing
According to Accounting Standard: 2 (Revised), the net realisable value means
“the estimated selling price in the ordinary course of business less costs of completion
NOTES and estimated costs necessary to make the sale”. Thus, net realisable value is to
be calculated after taking into consideration all expenses which might have to be
incurred for making sales. For example, if the seller will have to pay a commission
of 20% on sales, the net realisable value of an article having a selling price of `10
should be taken as only `8.
Inventories are to be valued at cost or net realisable value, whichever is
less. The ascertainment of net realisable value of different items and its comparison
with the historical costs can be done by any of the following methods:
1. Aggregate or total inventory method According to this method, the
total cost prices of the different items of inventories are calculated and the
total, so calculated, is compared with the total of net realisable value of the
different items of inventory. Inventory is valued at a price which is the least
of the two.
2. Group method According to this method, groups are formed of
homogeneous items of inventory. The cost and the net realisable value of
each group so formed are found out. The lower of the cost or net realisable
value of each group of items is taken for valuation of inventory.
3. Item by item method According to this method, the cost and net realisable
prices of each item of inventory are found out. Each item is valued at a price
which is lower of the cost or net realisable value.
AS 2 (Revised) has recommended the use of ‘item by item’ method for
valuation of inventory except materials and other supplies held for use in production,
of inventories, are not written down below cost if the finished products in which
they are to be used, are expected to be sold at or above cost. The ‘aggregate
or total inventory’ or group method has not found favour with the Accounting
Standards Committee of the Institute of Chartered Accountants of India.
The following illustration will explain the difference between all the three
methods.
Illustration 11.8. The following are the details regarding inventories of a
manufacturing concern as on 31st December, 2011:
Inventory Categories Cost (`) Market
Price (`)
Self-Instructional
384 Material
You are required to determine inventory value using “lower of cost or market value” Operating Costing, Inventory
basis, according to each of the following methods: Control and Labour Costing
(i) Aggregate or total inventory method, (ii) Group method, and (iii) Item by item
method.
SOLUTION: NOTES
Determination of Value of Inventory
at 31st December, 2011
Items Cost Market Aggregate Group Item by Item
` Price Inventory Method Method
` ` ` `
Self-Instructional
Material 385
Operating Costing, Inventory
Control and Labour Costing 11.5 TECHNIQUES OF INVENTORY CONTROL:
EOQ, ABC ANALYSIS AND SETTING OF
REORDER LEVEL
NOTES
Inventory refers to the goods or materials available for use by a business. It is a
stock of materials that are used to facilitate production or to satisfy customer
demand. These inventories in the form of raw materials, work-in-process and
finished goods must be adequately managed and controlled. Carrying of inventory
is a necessity, and proper planning and control of inventories reduces the level of
stock to minimum desirable. These inventories are necessary for the following
reasons.
1. Inventories help in the smooth production of the end product. Lack of
availability of parts and materials when needed can disrupt the production
process.
2. The customer is served better and his goodwill obtained when the item
required by the customer is in the inventory and is ready to be shipped.
3. Inventory serves as a hedge against uncertain lead time. A lead time is the
time gap between ordering and receiving goods. If this lead time is long or
uncertain, then it is necessary to keep adequate stock of inventory as a
buffer against shortages.
Inventory control is concerned with systematic acquisition, storage and
recording of materials in such a manner as to furnish the desired degree of service
to the operating departments and to the customers at the lowest cost. Inventory
control models are designed to achieve a balance between the risk of being out of
stock and the cost of carrying excess inventory. While the cost of being out of
stock is comparatively intangible in terms of loss of customer goodwill and potential
sales, the inventory carrying costs are fairly quantifiable.
There are basically two types of costs associated with inventories. These
are the ordering costs and carrying costs. The ordering costs are associated with
time, effort and money involved in ordering the inventory items. The inventory
carrying costs are the costs associated with holding the items in storage for future
use. Some of the carrying costs are : the cost of capital tied up, insurance premiums
on inventory, possibility of obsolescence, possible pilferage of stock, deterioration
and damage to goods, storage space costs and storage labour costs.
Economic Order Quantity (EOQ) Method of Inventory control
The economic order quantity (EOQ) method is a procedure for balancing ordering
costs and carrying costs so as to minimize total inventory costs. The total inventory
cost associated with a particular order of items is given as :
Total inventory cost = ordering cost + carrying cost.
Self-Instructional
386 Material
The objective is to balance these costs and order such quantity as to Operating Costing, Inventory
Control and Labour Costing
minimize the total inventory cost. The more items are ordered per order, the less
will be the ordering cost because there will be fewer number of orders in a given
period of time and the ordering cost is the same irrespective of the number of
items ordered. However, it will increase the carrying costs. Similarly, more frequent NOTES
orders will increase the ordering costs but reduce the inventory carrying costs.
The following graph depicts the economic order quantity that would minimize the
total cost.
Self-Instructional
Material 389
Operating Costing, Inventory Accuracy The system uses logic and The basis used apportionment
Control and Labour Costing reason for the selection of the is arbitrary which is not based
basis for apportionment of on any scientific approach,
costs among different cost therefore, its accuracy is
objects, therefore, it is bound to always doubtful.
NOTES be accurate.
Affordability Costly to establish, regulate Relatively inexpensive,
and sustain, therefore, medium therefore, even small
and large-scale organization organizations find it
can afford to have the system. affordable.
= ` 3.93 (approx.)
` 8, 20,000
= 64 Set - ups = ` 12.812.50
` 6,18,000
= 544 orders = ` 1,136.03
Self-Instructional
Material 393
Operating Costing, Inventory (i) Statement of Overhead Cost Per Unit
Control and Labour Costing
(Based on Traditional Method of Charging Overheads)
Products Annual Total Overhead Cost Overhead Cost
Output Machine Component per unit
NOTES (units) hours (BW I)
`
A 5,000 20,000 2,84,000 56.80
(20,000 hrs. × ` 14.20) (` 2,84,000/5,000 units)
B 60,000 1,20,000 17,04,000 28.40
(1,20,000 hrs. × ` 14.20) (` 17,04,000/60,000 units)
Self-Instructional
394 Material
Number of Events or Transactions Operating Costing, Inventory
Control and Labour Costing
Activity Traceable Costs ` Total Product A Product B
Machine set-ups 2,30,000 5,000 3,000 2,000
Quality inspections 1,60,000 8,000 5,000 3,000
Production orders 81,000 600 200 400 NOTES
Machine-hours worked 3,14,000 40,000 12,000 28,000
Material receipts 90,000 750 150 600
Total 8,75,000
You are required to compute per unit cost for each product using:
(i) Direct Labour Hour Rate Method for absorption of overhead costs.
(ii) Activity-Based Costing Technique for absorption of overhead costs.
Comment on your results.
Solution:
(i) Computation of product cost using Direct Labour Hour Rate Method
The company’s overhead rate is `17.50 per hour if direct labour hours are
used as a base for assigning overhead costs. This rate has been computed as
follows:
Manufacturing Overhead Costs ` 8,75,000
= = ` 17.50 per hour..
Direct Labour Hours 50,000
Using this rate, the cost to manufacture each of the products is given below:
Product
A B
Direct Materials (given) ` 25 ` 15
Direct Labour (given) 10 10
Manufacturing Overhead (2 hours × 17.50) 35 35
Total Cost to Manufacture 70 70
(ii) Computation of Product Cost using Activity-Based Costing
(a) Overheads Rates by Activity
Activity Traceable Total Events Rate per Event
Costs or Transactions or Transactions
` ` `
(a) (b) (a)/(b)
Machine setups 2,30,000 5,000 46 per set up
Quality inspections 1,60,000 8,000 20 per inspection
Production orders 81,000 600 135 per order
Machine-hours worked 3,14,000 40,000 7.85 per hour
Material receipts 90,000 750 120 per receipt
Self-Instructional
Material 395
Operating Costing, Inventory (b) Overhead Cost Per Unit of Product
Control and Labour Costing
Product A Product B
Particulars Events or Amount Events or Amount
Transactions ` Transactions `
NOTES Machine setups (at ` 46 per setup) 3,000 1,38,000 2,000 92,000
Quality inspections (at `20 per inspection) 5,000 1,00,000 3,000 60,000
Production orders (at `135 per order) 200 27,000 400 54,000
Machine-hours worked (at `7.85 per hour) 12,000 94,200 28,000 2,19,800
Material receipts (at `120 per receipt) 150 18,000 600 72,000
Total overhead Cost assigned (a) 3,77,200 4,97,800
No. of units product (b) 5,000 20,000
Overhead cost per unit (a)/(b) 75.44 24.89
Comments. The analysis shows that in case a company adopts direct rate method
for absorption of overhead costs, the amount of overheads charged would be `35
per unit for each product. In other words, the overhead cost is the same for both the
products in spite of the fact that they have widely different cost-driving activities.
For instance, the company recorded 5,000 machine setups during the year, of which
3,000 setups were traceable to Product A while 2,000 setups were traceable to
product B. It is, therefore appropriate to use ABC for charging overhead costs to
prevent any distortions in assigning costs to products. The cost statement for product
shows that as per ABC, the manufacturing overheads charged to product A are
almost three times of the manufacturing overheads charged to Product B.
11.5.2 Setting of Reorder Level, Maximum Level and Minimum
Level
The reorder level formula is that inventory level at which an entity should issue a
purchase order to replenish the amount on hand. When calculated correctly, the
reorder level should result in replenishment inventory arriving just as the existing
inventory quantity has declined to zero. In other words, The reorder point (ROP)
is the level of inventory which triggers an action to replenish that particular inventory
stock. It is a minimum amount of an item which a firm holds in stock, such that,
when stock falls to this amount, the item must be reordered.
The maximum stock limit is upper level of the inventory and the quantity that
must not be exceeded without specific authority from management. In other words,
the maximum stock level is that quantity of material above which the stock of any
item should not normally be allowed to go. The minimum stock level is the level
below which inventory should never drop.
Self-Instructional
396 Material
The formulae for setting up of different inventory levels are discussed as Operating Costing, Inventory
Control and Labour Costing
follows
(i) Maximum Level of Stock = (Reorder Level + Reorder Quantity) –
(Minimum rate of consumption x Minimum reorder period)
NOTES
Maximum Level may be alternatively fixed as Safety Stock + Reorder
Quantity or EOQ.
(ii) Minimum level of stock = Reorder level – (Average rate of consumption
x Average reorder period)
(iii) Safety Stock = (Annual Demand/365) x (Maximum Reorder Period –
Average Reorder Period)
(iv) Reorder level or Ordering level = Maximum rate of consumption ×
Maximum reorder period. Alternatively, it will be = safety stock + lead time
consumption
[lead time consumption will be = (Annual consumption -s- 360) × lead
time]
Total earnings = Time rate × Time taken + 50% of [Time saved × Time rate]
Example:
Standard time (or Allowed time) = 50 hours
Wage rate per hour = `3
Actual time taken = 42 hours
Thus, time saved = 50 hrs – 42 hrs = 8 hours
Earnings = `3 × 42 hrs + 50% of (8 hrs × `3)
= `126 + 12 = `138
2. Halsey Weir Plan
This method is precisely the same as Halsey Plan except that in Halsey Weir
Plan the bonus is equal to 30% of the time saved.
3. Rowan Plan
This plan is also similar to Halsey Plan except in the calculation of bonus. The
main features of Rowan Plan are as follows:
(a) Wages are paid on time basis for the actual time worked by the workers.
(b) A standard time is determined for each piece of work or job.
Self-Instructional
400 Material
(c) If a worker completes his work in standard time or in more than the Operating Costing, Inventory
Control and Labour Costing
standard time, he is paid wages for the time actually taken by him.
(d) If a worker completes his work in less than the standard time, he is entitled
to a bonus.
NOTES
(e) Bonus is that proportion of wages of actual time taken which the time saved
bears to the standard time. Its formula is:
Time saved
Bonus = × Time taken × Time rate
Time allowed
Like Taylor’s plan, this method also does not guarantee minimum wages. The
general criticism levelled against Taylor’s plan also applies to it except that it
lessens the punitive character of Taylor’s plan.
6. Gantt’s Task and Bonus Plan
The main features of this plan are as follows:
(a) Day wages on time basis are guaranteed to all workers.
(b) This plan is a combination of time rate, differential piece rate and bonus.
(c) A standard is set and remuneration is calculated as follows:
(i) When output is below standard—payment at time rate.
(ii) When output is at standard—payment at time rate plus 20% bonus.
(iii) When output is above standard—payment at high piece rate.
7. Emerson’s Efficiency Plan
This scheme is designed to give encouragement to the slow workers to perform
better than before. Time wages are guaranteed. The standard output in this plan
is fixed to represent 100% efficiency. A bonus is paid to a worker whose
efficiency exceeds 66%. As efficiency increases, the bonus also increases gradually
in steps, at a stated rate, so that at 100% efficiency, bonus would rise to 20%
of wages. Beyond 100% the bonus increases at 1% of the basic rate for each
Self-Instructional 1per cent increase in efficiency. It can thus, be shown as below in a tabular form:
402 Material
Operating Costing, Inventory
Efficiency Bonus
Control and Labour Costing
(a) Below 66 2 3 % No bonus (Only time wages)
(b) 66 2 3 % to 100% Bonus increases in steps and rises to 20% at 100% efficiency
(c) Over 100% 20% bonus plus 1% bonus for each increase of 1% in efficiency NOTES
Example:
Standard output in 8 hours = 60 units
Actual output in 8 hours = 72 units
Time rate = `2 per hour
Calculate the earnings under Emerson’s plan.
72
Efficiency in % = 100 = 120%
60
Bonus % = 20% + 20%
= 40%
Time wages = 8 hours @ `2 = `16.00
Add: Bonus 40% of `16 = `6.40
Self-Instructional
Material 403
Operating Costing, Inventory Example:
Control and Labour Costing
Standard time for job = 600 B’s
Hourly rate `2, Time taken 8 hours, i.e., 480 minutes
Points or B’s saved = 600 – 480 = 120
NOTES
120 2 75
Bonus = = `3
60 100
Earnings = (8 hours × `2) + `3 bonus = `19
If the worker takes 12 hours to complete the job, i.e. more than the standard
time, he will be paid for the actual time taken, i.e. 12 hrs × `2 = `24.
Time wages are thus guaranteed to those who are not able to save any points.
It may be noted that the Bedaux Plan is not different from the Halsey Plan except
that bonus is 75 per cent of the time saved instead of 50 per cent. The system
is particularly suitable where output can be measured with greater accuracy and
conditions are standardized. To make the system a success, very accurate time
study is required for each operation to set standard time in terms of standard
minutes.
Self-Instructional
Material 405
Operating Costing, Inventory Bases of payment of bonus to indirect workers
Control and Labour Costing
The indirect workers may be paid a bonus on any one of the following bases:
1. Where indirect workers serve a group of direct workers, they may be
NOTES paid a bonus on the basis of performance of the group of direct workers
whom they serve, e.g., maintenance workers attached to a particular
department.
2. When indirect workers provide general services, e.g., sweeping and
storekeeping, bonus may be paid on the basis of the output of the whole
factory.
3. On the basis of job evaluation and merit rating of indirect workers.
4. On some arbitrary basis, like enhanced day rate so as to include an
element of bonus in the rate itself.
Self-Instructional
406 Material
Operating Costing, Inventory
11.7 RECONCILIATION OF FINANCIAL AND Control and Labour Costing
COST ACCOUNTING
When cost accounts and financial accounts are maintained separately in two NOTES
different sets of books, two profit and loss accounts will be prepared—one for
costing books and the other for financial books. The profit or loss shown by
costing books may not agree with that shown by financial books. Therefore, it
becomes necessary that profit or loss shown by the two sets of accounts is
reconciled.
It is important to note that the question of reconciliation of cost financial
accounts arises only under non-integral system. However, under the integral
accounts, since cost and financial accounts are integrated into one set of books
and only one Profit and Loss Account is prepared, the problem of reconciliation
does not arise.
Method of Reconciliation
The cost and financial accounts are reconciled by preparing a Reconciliation
Statement or a Memorandum Reconciliation Account. The following procedure
is recommended for preparing a Reconciliation Statement:
1. Ascertain the points of difference between cost accounts and financial
accounts.
2. Start with the profit as per cost accounts.
3. (a) Regarding items of expenses and losses:
Add: Items over-charged in cost accounts
Deduct: Items under-charged in cost accounts
For example, depreciation in cost accounts is `2,500 and that in
financial accounts is `2,700. This has the effect of increasing costing
profit by `200 as compared to financial profit. Then in order to
reconcile, `200 will be deducted from costing profit.
(b) Regarding items of incomes and gains:
Add: Items under-recorded or not recorded in cost accounts
Deduct: Items over-recorded in cost accounts
For example, interest on investments received amounting to `1,500
is not recorded in cost accounts. This will have the effect of reducing
profit as per cost books. Thus, in order to reconcile, this amount of
`1,500 for interest should be added in the costing profit.
(c) Regarding valuation of stock:
(i) Opening Stock— Add: Amount of over-valuation in cost accounts
Deduct: Amount of under-valuation in cost
accounts
(ii) Closing Stock— Add: Amount of under-valuation in cost accounts
Deduct: Amount of over-valuation in cost
accounts
4. After making all the above additions and deductions in costing profit, the
resulting figure shall be the profit as per financial books.
5. The above treatment of items will be reversed when the starting point in
the Reconciliation Statement is the profit as per financial accounts or loss
as per cost accounts.
Self-Instructional
Material 409
Operating Costing, Inventory Pro forma of Reconciliation Statement
Control and Labour Costing
Profit as per cost accounts ` `
Add: 1. Over-absorption of overheads
2. Financial incomes not recorded in cost books
NOTES 3. Items charged only in cost accounts
(Notional rent and interest on capital, etc.)
4. Over-valuation of opening stocks in cost books
5. Under-valuation of closing stock in cost books
Less: 1. Under-absorption of overheads
2. Purely financial charges
3. Under-valuation of opening stock in cost books
4. Over-valuation of closing stock in cost books
Profit as per financial accounts
11.9 SUMMARY
EXERCISES
Self-Instructional
Material 413
Marginal Costing
12.0 INTRODUCTION
The elements of cost (materials, labour and expenses) can broadly be put into two
categories: fixed costs and variable costs. Fixed costs are those costs which do
not vary but remain constant within a given period of time and range of activity in
spite of fluctuations in production. The examples of fixed costs are rent, insurance
charges and management salaries. On the other hand, variable costs are costs
which vary in direct proportion to any change in the volume of output. The costs of
direct material, direct wages, etc., can be put into this category. The cost of a
product or process can be ascertained using the different elements of cost according
to any of the following two techniques:
(i) Absorption Costing
(ii) Marginal Costing
The major purpose of marginal costing technique is not to provide new
concepts of income or inventory but rather to clarify the relationship between
Self-Instructional
414 Material
costs, volume and profits, particularly in the area of decision making. In the present Marginal Costing
unit, we are dealing with a group of specific operating decisions that require the
decision maker to be selective in deciding which cost data he will use and how will
he use them. But before that we will learn about the break-even analysis,
contribution, key factors, etc. NOTES
12.1 OBJECTIVES
The total overheads are `6,000 out of which `3,000 are fixed and rest are
variable. It is decided to apportion these costs over different products in the ratio
of output. You are required to prepare a statement showing cost of each product
and profit according to absorption costing.
Solution:
The cost of each product would be ascertained according to absorption costing is
as follows: Self-Instructional
Material 415
Marginal Costing Statement Showing Cost and Profit
(according to absorption costing technique)
A B C
Particulars
NOTES Per Unit Total Per Unit Total Per Unit Total
` ` ` ` ` `
Under absorption costing, each unit of product has to bear its total share of
cost. It may be true that some products may not be able to bear their full share of
cost but may be able to contribute to the overall profitability of the firm. For
example, a product can be sold at a price which is sufficient to recover more than
its variable cost required to produce it, but may not be sufficient to recover its full
share of fixed cost. On the other hand, there may be products which contribute
much more than their share of variable and fixed costs. Under absorption costing,
the management is interested in knowing whether or not a product can produce an
adequate return on investment after absorbing its share of the overall cost whether
fixed or variable or direct or indirect. This is because in the long run, all costs must
be more than recovered to assure a satisfactory return to the investors on their
investment.
However, charging of fixed costs creates problems. These costs are
apportioned to different products on some suitable basis, e.g., as a percentage of
direct material, a percentage of direct labour or a rate per article. But, there is
always some doubt about the suitability of the method adopted for apportionment
of these fixed costs. It cannot be said with definiteness that fixed costs so charged
are really the costs which should have been charged to each of the different products.
It, therefore, brings more inexactness in costing. Moreover, fixed costs have to be
incurred whether there is production or no production. It means cost of a product
not only depends upon the costs which are directly incurred but also on the volume
of output. For example, if the cost of direct material and direct labour for a unit is
`3 and `4, respectively and the fixed costs are `2,000 and the volume of output
is 1,000 units, the total cost of production will be as follows:
`
Cost of Direct Materials 3,000
Cost of Direct Labour 4,000
Fixed Overheads 2,000
Total Costs 9,000
Self-Instructional
416 Material
The cost per unit comes to `9. In case, the output is 800 units only, the cost Marginal Costing
A B C
Particulars
Per Unit Total Per Unit Total Per Unit Total
` ` ` ` ` `
Thus, the total contribution from the three products A, B and C amounts to
`21,000. The profit will now be computed as follows: Self-Instructional
Material 417
Marginal Costing
`
Total Contribution 21,000
Less: Fixed Costs 3,000
Profit 18,000
NOTES
Thus, marginal costing considers only the variable costs while computing
the cost of the product. As a matter of fact, it is not a system of cost finding such
as job, process or operating costing, but it is a special technique concerned
particularly with the effect of fixed overheads on running the business. This is being
explained in the following pages while explaining the difference between marginal
costing and absorption costing.
12.2.2 Difference between Absorption Costing and Marginal Costing
As explained earlier, under absorption costing, full costs are charged to production,
i.e., all fixed and variable costs are recovered from production, while under marginal
costing, only variable costs are charged to production. Fixed costs are ignored.
This is on the basis that for additional output only variable costs are incurred since
fixed costs remain constant. There is, therefore, no reason to burden the additional
output with the share of fixed overheads; otherwise, it will give a wrong idea about
the likely profit to be earned on additional sales. On account of charging of only
variable costs to production, the closing stock under marginal costing is valued
only at marginal cost. Thus, marginal costing system differs from absorption costing
system in three respects:
(i) Recovery of Overheads: In case of absorption costing, both fixed and
variable overheads are charged to production. On the other hand, in marginal
costing only variable overheads are charged to production while fixed
overheads are transferred in full to the costing, profit and loss account.
Thus, in case of marginal costing, there is under-recovery of overheads
since only variable overheads are charged to production.
(ii) Valuation of Stocks: In case of absorption costing, stocks of work-in-
progress and finished goods are valued at works cost and total cost of
production, respectively. The works cost or cost of production so used
includes the amount of fixed overheads also. In case of marginal costing
only variable costs are considered while computing the value of work-in-
progress or finished goods. Thus, the closing stock in marginal costing is
under-valued as compared to absorption costing.
(iii) Carrying Over of Fixed Overheads: In case of absorption costing, the
fixed overheads of one period are transferred to the next period through
their inclusion in inventory values. While in case of marginal costing, the
fixed overheads are charged against the revenue of the same period and are
not carried forward.
The above points of difference will be clear with the help of the following
illustration:
Self-Instructional
418 Material
Illustration 12.3. Taking the figures given in Illustration 12.1, compute the amount Marginal Costing
of profit under marginal and traditional costing systems, in case the units sold of
the products A, B and C are 900 in each case.
Solution:
NOTES
Statement of Profit
(under absorption costing system)
A B C
Particulars ` ` `
Statement of Profit
(under marginal costing system)
A B C
Particulars ` ` `
Total Marginal Cost 6,000 8,000 10,000
Less: Closing Stock 600 800 1,000
Cost of goods sold 5,400 7,200 9,000
Contribution 3,600 6,300 9,000
(Sales–Marginal Cost of Production)
Sales 9,000 13,500 18,000
If production is increased by one unit, i.e., it becomes 501 fans per annum,
the cost sheet will then appear as follows:
`
Marginal cost per unit is, therefore, `500. Marginal cost is, thus, the total
variable cost because within the capacity of the organization, an increase of one
unit in production will cause an increase in variable cost only. The variable cost
consists of direct materials, direct labour, variable direct expenses and variable
overheads. The term ‘all variable overheads’ includes variable overheads plus the
variable portion contained in semi-variable overheads. This portion has to be
segregated from the total semi-variable overheads according to the methods
discussed later in this chapter.
Self-Instructional
420 Material
The accountant’s concept of marginal cost differs from the economist’s Marginal Costing
Show the effect of increase in output on per unit cost of production through
a chart and calculate the marginal cost of production.
Solution:
Total Variable Cost Fixed Cost Per Total Cost
Production
Per Unit Unit Per Unit
Units
` ` `
500 4.50 2.00 6.50
1,000 4.50 1.00 5.50
1,500 4.50 0.67 5.17
2,000 4.50 0.50 5.00
2,500 4.50 0.40 4.90
Self-Instructional
Material 421
Marginal Costing The above chart shows that with an increase in production, the total cost
per unit is decreasing. This is because the fixed overheads are constant at every
level and their effect per unit goes on decreasing with increase in volume of output.
The marginal cost of production per unit has remained constant and the
NOTES
fixed cost per unit has lowered down from `2 to `0.40. This will affect to a great
extent firm’s decision to increase production in the present illustration.
Marginal cost in the present illustration can be calculated with the help of
the following formula:
Marginal Cost = Direct Material Cost + Direct Labour Cost + Other Variable Costs
Or
Total Cost – Fixed Cost
When the production is 500 units, the marginal cost of production shall be equal to `1,000 +
`750 + `500, i.e., `2,250 (or `3,250 – `1,000). Marginal cost at other levels of output can be known
in the similar fashion.
Illustration 12.5. Ambitious Enterprises is currently working at 50 per cent
capacity and produces 10,000 units.
At 60 per cent working, raw material cost increases by 2 per cent and
selling price falls by 2 per cent. At 80 per cent working, raw material cost
increases by 5 per cent and selling price falls by 5 per cent. At 50 per cent
capacity working, the product costs `180 per unit and is sold at `200 per unit.
The unit cost of `180 is made up as follows:
`
Material 100
Wages 30
Factory Overheads 30 (40% Fixed)
Administration Overheads 20 (50% Fixed)
Prepare a marginal cost statement showing the estimated profit of the business
when it is operated at 60 per cent and 80 per cent capacity.
Solution:
Marginal Cost Statement
60% Capacity 80% Capacity
Output 12,000 units Output 16,000 units
Particulars
Total Per unit Total Per unit
` ` ` `
Materials 12,24,000 102 16,80,000 105
Wages 3,60,000 30 4,80,000 30
Variable Factory Overheads 2,16,000 18 2,88,000 18
Variable Administration 1,20,000 10 1,60,000 10
Overheads
Total Marginal Cost (i) 19,20,000 160 26,08,000 163
Sales (ii) 23,52,000 196 30,40,000 190
Contribution (iii) 4,32,000 36 4,32,000 27
Fixed Factory Overheads 1,20,000 10 1,20,000 7.50
Fixed Administration 1,00,000 8.23 1,00,000 6.25
Overheads
Fixed Costs (iv) 2,20,000 18.23 2,20,000 13.75
Net Profit [(iii) – (iv)] 2,12,000 17.77 2,12,000 13.25
Self-Instructional
422 Material
Working Notes: Marginal Costing
Marginal costing requires segregation of all costs between two parts—fixed and
variable. This means that the semi-variable cost will have to be segregated into
fixed and variable elements. This may be done by any one of the following methods:
1. Levels of output compared to levels of expenses method
2. Range method
3. Degree of variability method
4. Scattergraph method
5. Least squares method
Each of the above methods has been discussed in detail with the help of the
following Illustration:
Self-Instructional
Material 423
Marginal Costing Illustration 12.6.
Production Semi-variable expenses
2008
Units `
July 50 150
NOTES
August 30 132
September 80 200
October 60 170
November 100 230
December 70 190
During the month of January 2009 the production is 40 units only. Calculate
the amount of fixed, variable and total semi-variable expenses for the month.
1. Levels of output compared to levels of expenses method: According to
this method, the output at two different levels is compared with corresponding
level of expenses. Since the fixed expenses remain constant, the variable overheads
are arrived at by the ratio of change in expense to change in output.
Solution:
Taking the figures of the month of September and November of the Illustration
given above:
Semi-variable
Production Fixed Variable
Month Expenses
Units ` `
`
2. Range Method: This method is similar to the previous method except that
only the highest and lowest points of output are considered out of various levels.
This method is also designated as ‘high and low’ method.
Self-Instructional
424 Material
Solution: Marginal Costing
The highest production in the Illustration is in the month of November while the
lowest is in the month of August. The figures of these 2 months, therefore, have
been taken.
NOTES
Semi-variable
Production Fixed Variable
Month Expenses
Units ` `
`
August 30 132 90 * 42 *
November 100 230 90** 140**
Difference 70 98
Self-Instructional
Material 425
Marginal Costing (iii) A straight line of best fit is then drawn through the points plotted. This is the
total cost line. The point where this line intersects the vertical axis is taken to
be the amount of fixed element.
(iv) A line parallel to the horizontal axis is drawn from the point where the line of
NOTES
best fit intersects the vertical axis. This is the fixed cost line.
(v) The variable cost at any level can be known by noting difference between
fixed cost and total cost line.
Solution:
An inspection of the above graph tells us that fixed expenses are `85
approximately. For the month of January 2009, the semi-variable expenses (see
Graph) are `143 and, therefore, the variable expenses are `58 (i.e. `143 – `85).
5. Method of least squares: This method is based on the mathematical technique
of fitting an equation with the help of a number of observations. The linear equation,
i.e., a straight line equation, can be assumed as:
y = a + bx and the various sub-equations shall be
y = na + bx
xy = ax + bx2
An equation of second order, i.e., a curvilinear equation can be drawn as y
= a + bx + cx2 and the various sub-equations to solve it (i.e., to find out the value
of constants a, b and c, shall be:
y = na + bc2
xy = ax + bx2 + x3
x2y = ax2 + bx3 + cx4
Similarly, the equation can be fitted for any number of orders or degrees
depending upon the number of observations available and the accuracy desired.
Self-Instructional
426 Material
Solution: Marginal Costing
A linear equation can be obtained with the help of the following values, thus:
Production Expenses
Months (Units) ` x2 xy
x y
NOTES
Assuming, the equation as y = a + bx, we have to find the values of constants a and b with the help
of above figures. The other two equations are:
y = na + bx ...(i)
xy = ax + hx2 ... (ii)
Putting the values in these equations, we have
1,072 = 60a + 390b ...(iii)
73,960 = 390a + 28,300b ... (iv)
Multiplying equation (iii) by 65 and deducting it from (iv), we get
4,280 = 2,950b b = 1.45 (approx.)
Putting the value of b in equation (iii), we can know the value of a:
1, 072 (390 × 1.45)
= = 84.42 (approx.)
6
The desired equation is:
y = 84.42 + 1.45x,
where `84.42 is the amount of fixed element and `1.45 is the rate per unit for variable element.
Putting the value of x, i.e., 40 units for January 2009, we get the total semi-variable expenses for the
month as
`84.42 + (`1.45 × 40), i.e., `142.42
12.4 CONTRIBUTION
The difference between selling price and variable cost (i.e., the marginal cost) is
known as ‘contribution’ or gross margin. In other words, fixed costs plus the
amount of profit is equivalent to contribution. It can be expressed by the following
formula:
Contribution = Selling Price – Variable Cost
= Fixed Cost + Profit
We can derive from it that profit cannot result unless contribution exceeds
fixed costs. In other words, the ‘point of no profit no loss’ shall be arrived at
where contribution is equal to fixed costs.
Self-Instructional
Material 427
Marginal Costing Example 2:
Variable Cost = `50,000
Fixed Cost = `20,000
Selling Price = `80,000
NOTES Contribution = Selling Price – Variable Cost
= `80,000 – `50,000 = `30,000
Profit = Contribution – Fixed Cost
= `30,000 – `20,000 = `10,000
Hence, contribution exceeds fixed cost and, therefore, the profit is of the magnitude of
`10,000. Suppose the fixed cost is `40,000 then the position shall be
Contribution – Fixed Cost = Profit
= `30,000 – `40,000 = (–) `10,000
The amount of `10,000 represents the extent of loss since the fixed costs are more than
the contribution. At the level of fixed cost of `30,000, there shall be no profit and no loss. The
concept of the break-even analysis (discussed ahead in the unit) emerges out of this theory.
S –V Variable Costs
or C/S = or 1 –
S Sales
This ratio can also be called as ‘contribution/sales ratio’. This ratio can
also be known by comparing the change in contribution to change in sales or
change in profit to change in sales. Any increase in contribution would mean increase
in profit only because fixed costs are assumed to be constant at all levels of
production. Thus,
Change in Contribution Change in Profit
P/V Ratio = or
Change in Sales Change in Sales
This ratio would remain constant at different levels of production since
variable costs as a proportion to sales remain constant at various levels.
Example 3:
`
Sales 2,00,000
Variable Costs 1,20,000
Fixed Costs 40,000
`2,00,000 `1,20,000
P/V Ratio =
`2,00,000
= 0.4 or 40%
Self-Instructional
428 Material
Marginal Costing
The ratio is useful for the determination of the desired level of output or
profit and for the calculation of variable costs for any volume of sales. The variable
costs can be expressed as:
VC = S (1 – P/V Ratio)
NOTES
In the above example:
If we know the P/V Ratio and sales beforehand, the variable costs can be
computed as follows:
Variable Costs = 1 – 0.4, = 0.6, i.e., 60% of Sales
= `1,20,000 (60% of `2,00,000)
Alternatively, by the formula
S V
Since P/V ratio = , S – V = S × P/V Ratio
S
or V = S – S × P/V ratio or S (1 – P/V ratio)
Comparison of P/V Ratios of different products is usually made by the
management to find out which product is more profitable. Management tries to
increase the value of the ratio by reducing the variable cost or by increasing the
selling price.
12.4.2 Key Factor Analysis
Key factor is that factor which limits the volume of output in the activities of an
undertaking, at a particular point of time or over a period. The extent of its influence
must be assessed first so as to maximize the profits. Generally on the basis of
contribution, the decision regarding product mix is taken. It is not the maximizing
of total contribution that matter, but the contribution in terms of the key factor that
is to be compared for relative profitability. Thus, it is the limiting factor or the
governing factor or principal budget factor. If sales cannot exceed a given quantity,
sales is regarded as the key factor; if production capacity is limited, contribution
per unit, i.e., in terms of output, has to be compared. If raw material is in short
supply, contribution has to be expressed in relation to per unit of raw material
required. There may be labour shortage and in such a case, the contribution per
labour hour is to be known. If machine capacity is a limitation, contribution per
machine hour is to be considered for appropriate decision making. Thus, profitability
can be measured as:
Contribution
Key Factor
The following illustrations would clearly show how key factor affects the
relative profitability of different products.
Illustration 12.8. A company manufactures and markets three products A, B and
C. All the three products are made from the same set of machines. Production is
limited by machine capacity. From data given below indicate priorities for products
A, B and C with a view to maximizing profits:
Self-Instructional
Material 429
Marginal Costing
Product A Product B Product C
Particulars
` ` `
In the following year, the company faces extreme shortage of raw materials.
It is noted that 3 kgs, 4 kgs, and 5 kgs of raw materials are required to produce
one unit of A, B and C, respectively. How would products priorities change?
Solution:
Comparative Statement of Profitability
(a) When raw material is in short supply, contribution per litre of product A is higher
and hence product A is more profitable.
(b) When production capacity is limited, contribution per hour of product B is higher
and hence product B is more profitable.
(c) When sales quantity is limited, contribution per unit of product B is higher and
hence product B is more profitable.
(d) When sales value is limited, the P/V Ratio of product A is higher and hence product
A is more profitable.
(e) When raw material as well as sales quantity both are limited, the raw materials
should first be used for maximum number of units of product A, i.e., for 300 units.
This will consume 600 litres of material and the balance 400 litres shall be utilized
for producing 50 units (i.e., 400/8) of product B.
`
The profit in such a case would be:
Contribution from 300 units of product A (300 × 90) 27,000
Contribution from 50 units of product B (50 × 200) 10,000
Total Contribution 37,000
Less: Fixed Overheads 15,000
Maximum Profit 22,000
The basic objective of running any business organization is to earn profits. Profits
NOTES determine the financial position, liquidity and solvency of the company. Profits
serve as a yardstick for judging the competence and efficiency of the management.
Profit planning is, therefore, a fundamental part of the overall management function
and is a vital part of the total budgeting process. The management determines the
profit goals and prepares budgets that will lead them to the realization of these
goals. Profit planning can be done only when the management has the information
about the cost of the product both fixed and variable, and the selling price at which
it will be in a position to sell the products of the company. The concept of marginal
costing, as explained in the preceding pages, is extensively applied by the
management in profit planning.
The profit is affected by the several factors. Some of the important factors
are as follows:
(i) Selling price of the products
(ii) Volume of sales
(iii) Variable costs per unit
(iv) Total fixed costs
(v) Sales makes (or mix) of different products
The management can achieve their target profit goal by varying one or more
of the above variables. This will be clear with the help of the following Illustration.
Illustration 12.9. A firm has `10,00,000 invested in its plant and sets a goal of a
15 per cent annual return on investment. Fixed costs in the factory presently amount
to `4,00,000 per year and variable costs amount to `15 per unit produced. In the
past year the firm produced and sold 50,000 units at `25 each and earned a profit
of `1,00,000. How can management achieve their target profit goal by varying
different variables like fixed costs, variable costs, quantity sold or increasing the
selling price per unit.
Solution:
Profit to be earned is `1,50,000 (i.e., 15 per cent of `10,00,000)
The equation of profit can be put as follows:
Profit = (Quantity × S.P. per unit) – (Quantity × Variable cost per unit) – Fixed costs
(i) Achievement of target profit by varying fixed costs:
Let the fixed costs be X
1,50,000 = (50,000 × `25) – (50,000 × `15) – X
or 1,50,000 = (`12,50,000) – (`7,50,000) – X
X = `12,50,000 – 7,50,000 – 1,50,000 or X = `3,50,000
The present fixed costs are `4,00,000. The management can earn the target profit of `1,50,000 by
reducing the fixed costs by `50,000 (i.e., `4,00,000 – `3,50,000).
Self-Instructional
432 Material
(ii) Achievement of the target profit by varying variable costs: Marginal Costing
Let the variable cost be X per unit.
`1,50,000 = (50,000 × `25) – (50,000 × X) – `4,00,000
or 1,50,000 = `12,50,000 – 50,000 X – `4,00,000
or 50,000 X = `12,50,000 – `4,00,000 – `1,50,000 NOTES
or 50,000 X = 7,00,000 or X = `14
The present variable cost per unit is `15 per unit. The management can earn the target profit of
`1,50,000 by reducing the variable cost by `1 per unit (i.e., `15 – `14)
(iii) Achievement of the target profit by varying quantity sold:
Let the quantity sold be X
`1,50,000 = (X × `25) – (X × `15) – `4,00,000
or 1,50,000 = 25 X – 15 X – `4,00,000
or 10 X = 5,50,000
X = 55,000
The present sales are 50,000 units. The management can earn the target profit of `1,50,000 by
increasing the units sold by 5,000.
(iv) Achievement of the target profit by varying selling price: Let the selling price be X
`1,50,000 = (50,000 × X) – (50,000 × `15) – `4,00,000
or 1,50,000 = 50,000 X – `7,50,000 – `4,00,000
or –50,000 X = –7,50,000 – `4,00,00 – 1,50,000
or – 50,000 X = –13,00,000
X = `26
The present selling price is `25 per unit. The management can earn the target profit of
`1,50,000 by increasing the selling price by `1 per unit.
Illustration 12.10. A company is manufacturing three products A, B and C. The
data regarding costs, sales and profit are as follows:
Product Sales (units) Selling price Variable Contribution
per unit cost per unit per unit
A 2,000 `5 `2 `3
B 1,000 `5 `3 `2
C 1,000 `5 `3 `2
The fixed costs are `5,000. The company wants to change the sales mix
from the existing proportion of 2 : 1 : 1 to 2 : 2 : 1 of A, B and C, respectively.
You are required to calculate the number of units of each product which the
company should sell to maintain the present profit.
Solution:
Present Profit
`
Total Contribution (`6,000 + `2,000 + `2,000) 10,000
Less: Fixed Costs 5,000
Profit 5,000
The above illustrations make this amply clear that the two important factors
which help management in profit planning are cost (both fixed and variable) and
volume of sales (both in quantity and value). This cost-volume-profit relationship,
which is more popularly known as break-even analysis, is being explained in detail
in the following pages.
12.5.1 Cost-Volume-Profit Analysis: An Important Tool of Profit
Planning
Cost-volume-profit (CVP) analysis is an important tool of profit planning. It provides
information about the matters as:
1. The behaviour of cost in relation to volume
2. Volume of production or sales, where the business will break-even
3. Sensitivity of profit due to variations in output
4. Amount of profit for a projected sales volume
5. Quantity of production and sales for a target of profit level
Cost-volume-profit Analysis may, therefore, be defined as a managerial
tool showing the relationship between various ingredients of profit planning, viz.,
cost (both fixed and variable), selling price and volume of activity, etc.
Such an analysis is useful to the cost accountant in the following respects:
(i) It helps him in forecasting the profit fairly accurately.
(ii) It is helpful in setting up flexible budgets, since on the basis of this
relationship, he can ascertain the costs, sales and profits at different
levels of activity.
(iii) It also assists him in performance evaluation for purposes of
management control.
Self-Instructional
434 Material
(iv) It helps in formulating price policy by projecting the effect which Marginal Costing
Fixed Cost
Break-even Point of output =
Contribution per unit
Fixed Costs
Break-even Point of sales = × Selling price
Contribution per unit per unit
Fixed Costs
Or = × Total Sales
Total Con tribution
Fixed Costs
Or =
Variable cost p er u n it
1
Selling p rice p er u n it
Fixed Costs
Or =
P/ V Ratio
At break-even point the desired profit is zero. In case the volume of output
or sales is to be computed for ‘a desired profit’, the amount of ‘desired profit’
should be added to Fixed Costs in the formulae given above. For example:
Fixed Costs + Desired Profit
Units for a desired profit =
Contribution per un it
Fixed Costs + Desired Profit
Sales for a desired profit =
P/ V Ratio
Self-Instructional
436 Material
Break-even point for sales can be also be calculated with the help of any of the following formulae: Marginal Costing
Total Fixed Cost
(i) BEP =
Variable Cost per unit
1
Selling Price per unit
12,000 12,000
= = = `60,000 NOTES
200 1
1
250 5
(i) or (ii) or (iii)
Total Fixed Costs × Selling Price per unit
(ii) BEP =
Contribution per unit
12,000 × 250
= ` 60,000
50
Or
Total Fixed Costs × Total Sales
(iii) BEP =
Total Contribution
12,000 ×1,25,000
= ` 60,000
25,000
Or
Total Fixed Costs
(iv) BEP =
P/V Ratio
12,000
= = `60,000
20%
Contribution 25,000
*P/V Ratio = 100 100 20 per cent
Sales 1, 25,000
Profit at 90% of the capacity has been calculated as follows:
Capacity 500 machines
Output at 90% of capacity 450 machines
Break-even Point of output 240 machines
Since fixed overheads will be recovered in full at the break-even point, the
entire contribution beyond the break-even point will be the profit. The profit on
450 units, therefore, will be:
= `50 × (450 – 240) = `10,500
Cash Break-even Point: It is the point where cash breaks even, i.e., the volume
of sales where cash realizations on account of sales will be just sufficient to meet
immediate cash liabilities. While calculating this point, cash fixed costs (i.e.,
excluding fixed share of depreciation and deferred expenses) and cash contribution
(i.e., after making adjustments for variable share of depreciation, etc.) are
considered. The point helps the management in determining the level of activity
below which there are chances of insolvency on account of the firm’s inability to
meet cash obligations unless alternative arrangements are made.
Illustration 12.12. From the following, calculate the cash break-even point:
Selling Price per unit `50
Variable Cost per unit `40
Depreciation included in above per unit `10
Fixed Cost `2,00,000
Depreciation included in above `40,000
Presume that there is no time lag in payments. Self-Instructional
Material 437
Marginal Costing Solution:
Cash Fixed Costs
Cash Break-even Point (in units) =
Cash Contribution per unit
NOTES `1,60,000
= = 8,000 units
` 20
Cash Break-even Point (Sales in `) = 8,000 × `50 = `4,00,000
Solution:
`
Sales Mix Forecast X : 24,000 × 12.50 = 3,00,000
Y : 1,00,000 × 7.00 = 7,00,000
Z : 50,000 × 10.00 = 5,00,000
15,00,000
Therefore Sales Mix = 3 : 7 : 5
(3/15 × 6) + (7/15 × 2.50) + (5/15 × 4)
Composite P/V Ratio =
(3/15 × 12.50) + (7/15 × 7) + (5/15 × 10)
Or
1,44,000 + 2,50,000 + 2,00,000 594
=
15,00,000 1,500
3,00,000 ×1,500
= = `7,57,575
594
Self-Instructional
438 Material
BEP Sales for the three Products = X: `1,51,515 or 12,121 units Marginal Costing
Y: `3,53,535 or 50,505 units
Z: `2,52,525 or 25,253 units
Cost Break-even Point: It refers to a situation where the costs of operating two
alternative plants is equal. The point enables the firm to identify which plant is NOTES
better to operate at or a given level of output assuming that sale price per unit is
the same. The computation of cost break-even point can be understood with the
help of the following Illustration.
Illustration 12.14. Find the cost break-even points between each pair of plants
whose cost functions are:
` `
Plant A: 6,00,000 + 12X
Plant B: 9,00,000 + 10X
Plant C: 15,00,000 + 8X
(Where X is the number of units produced).
Solution:
Following are the cost break-even points between each pair of plants:
Plants A and B: The amount of fixed cost is `3,00,000 more in case of Plant B as compared to
Plant A. The variable cost per unit is `2 less in case of Plant B as compared to Plant A. Thus 1,50,000
units (`3,00,000/`2) will have to be produced in case of Plant B to recover additional fixed costs of
`3,00,000. At this point, the cost of operating the two Plants (i.e., A and B) will be the same. This can
also be calculated by means of a simultaneous equation:
`6,00,000 + `12 X = `9,00,000 + `10X
or 2X = 3,00,000
or X = 1,50,000
Plants B and C: Plant C has a higher total fixed cost of `6,00,000 and lower `3 per unit variable
cost as compared to Plant B. It means that the two plants will have the same operating costs at a level
of output of 3,00,000 units (`6,00,000/`2). This can also be calculated by means of a simultaneous
equation:
`9,00,000 + `10 X = `15,00,000 + `8X
or 2X = 6,00,000
or X = 3,00,000
Plants A and C: Plants A and C will have the same operating costs at a level of output of 2,25,000
units as calculated below:
`6,00,000 + `12 X = `15,00,000 + `8X
or 4X = 9,00,000
or X = 2,25,000 units
The above workings show that Plant A is the best for an output below
1,50,000 units. Plant B will give the optimum results if the output is between
1,50,000 and 3,00,000 units. Plant C is the best in case of output above 3,00,000
units. In between A and C (if B is ignored), A should be preferred over C up to the
output of 2,25,000 units. Similarly, in between B and C (if A is ignored), B should
be preferred over C up to the output of 3,00,000 units.
12.6.2 Break-Even Chart
The relationship between costs, sales and profits can be shown in the form of a
chart. Such a chart not only depicts the level of activity where there will be neither
Self-Instructional
Material 439
Marginal Costing loss nor profit but also shows the profit or loss at various levels of activity. According
to the Chartered Institute of Management Accountants, London, the break-even
chart means ‘a chart which shows profit or loss at various levels of activity, the
level at which neither profit nor loss is shown being termed the break-even point.
NOTES This may also take the form of a chart on which is plotted the relationship either of
total cost of sales to sales or of fixed costs to contribution.’ Thus, it is a graphical
presentation of cost and revenue data so as to show their interrelationship at different
levels of activity.
Forms of Break-even Chart
A break-even chart can be presented in different forms as given below:
(i) Simple break-even chart: This is also known as traditional or orthodox
break-even chart. This can be prepared by any of the following two methods:
First Method: On the X-axis of the graph is plotted the volume of production or
the quantities of sales and on the Y-axis (vertical line), costs and sales revenues are
represented. The fixed cost line is drawn parallel to the X-axis because with any
volume of production, the fixed costs shall remain the same. The variable cost line
is depicted above the fixed cost line, which shows that the cost is increasing with
the increase in the volume of output. This line can also be regarded as the total
cost line because it starts from the point where variable cost is zero and certain
fixed cost has been incurred. Thereafter, figures of sales are plotted from the origin
and a line is drawn up which goes in the upward direction with the increase of
production/sales. The two—total cost line and sales line—shall intersect each other
at one point, and a perpendicular can be drawn from this point to find out the level
of output where the business shall be at ‘no-profit no-loss’ position, since the total
costs are equal to total sales revenue here. If the business produces less than this
level of output, it shall be running at a loss. The portion of loss is shown by the
lower sales line and upper total cost line. If the business produces more units than
the break-even level, profit shall result and it shall be higher and higher as the
production/sales increases. This is indicated by upper sales line and lower total
cost line.
Illustration 12.15. From the following data, compute the break-even point by
means of a break-even chart:
Selling Price per Unit `2.50
Variable Cost per Unit `2.00
Total Fixed Costs `20,000
Solution:
As explained earlier, break-even point is ‘point of no-profit no-loss’. The point
will, therefore, be there where total costs are equal to total sales. In other words,
if the two data are plotted on the graph paper, at the break-even-point, the two
lines, i.e., the total cost line and the total sales line, will intersect each other. However,
for plotting the data on the graph paper, we need at least two points—one for
Self-Instructional
440 Material
plotting the total cost line and the other for plotting the total sales line. It will, Marginal Costing
Tutorial Note: The students should first compute the break-even point by any mathematical method
as explained in the preceding pages. It will help them in assuming different levels of output and sales
for the purposes of break-even chart. For example, in the case of the above Illustration, the break-even
point can be computed mathematically, as follows:
Total Fixed Costs
BEP of Output =
Contribution per unit
20, 000
= = 40,000 units
0.5
The break-even sales will amount to `1,00,000 (i.e., 40,000 × `2.50).
NOTES
(ii) Contribution break-even chart: The chart helps in ascertaining the amount
of contribution at different levels of activity besides the break-even point.
In case of this chart, first the fixed cost is plotted parallel to the X-axis. The
‘contribution’ line is then drawn from the bottom, or the origin, which goes up with
the increase of output/sales. The sales line is plotted as usual from the ‘O’ point but
since there is no total cost line, the question of intersection of sales line with it to
show the break-even point does not arise. In such a case, the contribution line
crosses the fixed cost line and the point of intersection is treated as break-even
point. At this level, the fixed cost shall be equal to contribution which means that
there shall be no profit and no loss. As the contribution increases to more than the
fixed cost, profit shall arise to the business at different levels of output/sales and as
the contribution steps down from the level of fixed cost, business shall be operated
at a loss at varying levels of production/sales. On the basis of data given in Illustration
12.15, the break-even chart will appear as shown below:
Self-Instructional
442 Material
(iii) Profit chart: The break-even point can also be found out graphically by Marginal Costing
means of a profit chart.
Illustration 12.16. On the basis of figures given in Illustration 12.15, compute
the break-even point by means of a profit chart.
NOTES
Solution:
Output Total Costs Sales Profit/Loss
(Units) ` ` `
10,000 40,000 25,000 – 15,000
20,000 60,000 50,000 – 10,000
30,000 80,000 75,000 – 5,000
40,000 1,00,000 1,00,000 —
50,000 1,20,000 1,25,000 + 5,000
60,000 1,40,000 1,50,000 + 10,000
From the above chart, predict the variable cost, contribution, fixed cost
and profit associated with a sales volume of `250 lakh, and set out your prediction
in the form of a profit statement?
Solution:
Self-Instructional
Material 443
Marginal Costing Statement Showing Costs and Profit at Sales of `250 Lakh
` `
Self-Instructional
444 Material
(v) Analytical break-even chart: Analytical break-even chart is prepared to Marginal Costing
show different elements of cost and appropriations of profits. Its preparation can
be understood with the help of the following Illustration:
Illustration 12.19. Draw up an analytical break-even chart with the following
NOTES
data showing variable cost first above the base line, followed by fixed costs and
profit:
`
Sales 1,00,000
Fixed Costs 20,000
Debenture Interest (not included in fixed cost) 10,000
Proposed Preference Dividend 10,000
Proposed Ordinary Dividend 20,000
Income Tax Payable 20,000
Variable Costs 20,000
Variable Costs divided into:
Direct Material 8,000
Direct Labour 4,000
Factory Overhead 6,000
Selling and Adm. Overheads 2,000
Solution:
Presuming that the figures in the question relate to 100% capacity, the following
table can be prepared to plot the data on the graph paper.
Capacity Direct Direct Variable Fixed Debenture Total Sales
Levels Material Labour Overheads Overheads Interest Cost
` ` ` ` ` ` `
20% 1,600 800 1,600 20,000 10,000 34,000 20,000
40% 3,200 1,600 3,200 20,000 10,000 38,000 40,000
60% 4800 2,400 4,800 20,000 10,000 42,000 60,000
80% 6,400 3,200 6,400 20,000 10,000 46,000 80,000
100% 8,000 4,000 8,000 20,000 10,000 50,000 1,00,000
Self-Instructional
Material 445
Marginal Costing (vi) Cash break-even chart: The chart is prepared to show the volume at which
cash breaks even, i.e., the point at which the cash inflow will be just equal to the
cash required to meet immediate cash liabilities. For the purposes of drawing this
chart, the fixed costs are divided into two categories:
NOTES
(i) fixed costs which do not require immediate cash outlay, e.g., depreciation,
deferred expenses,
(ii) fixed costs which require immediate cash outlay, e.g., rent, salaries, etc.
While drawing the chart the cash fixed costs are plotted first parallel to the
base line, variable costs (presuming all of them to be in terms of cash) are
then plotted over them. The non-cash fixed costs are plotted in the last. The
sales line is plotted as usual. This will be clear from the following Illustration.
Illustration 12.20. From the following data, plot a cash break-even chart:
Output and Sales 10,000 units
Selling Price per unit `15
Fixed Price (including depreciation `1,000) `5,000
Variable Cost per unit (including depreciation of `1 per unit) `6
Solution:
Output Variable Costs Cash Fixed Costs Total Cash Costs Sales
(Units) ` ` ` `
200 1,000 4,000 5,000 3,000
400 2,000 4,000 6,000 6,000
600 3,000 4,000 7,000 9,000
800 4,000 4,000 8,000 12,000
1,000 5,000 4,000 9,000 15,000
(vii) Control break-even chart: Break-even chart can also be used for
management control purposes by making it a part of the budgetary control system.
The control break-even chart compares actual cost with the budgeted cost, actual
sales with the budgeted sales, actual profit with the budgeted profit and actual
Self-Instructional
446 Material
break-even point with the budgeted break-even point. This will be clear with the Marginal Costing
Angle of Incidence
Angle of incidence is formed at the inter-section of total cost line and total sales
line. As a matter of fact, there are two angles of incidence:
Self-Instructional
Material 447
Marginal Costing (i) the angle formed at the right side of the break-even point
(ii) the angle formed at the left side of the break-even point
The angle formed at the right side of the break-even point indicates the
NOTES profit area while that formed at the left side indicates the loss area. The size of the
angle of incidence is indication of the quantum of profit or loss made by the firm at
different output/sales levels. For example, if the angle of incidence is narrow to the
right side of the BEP it indicates that the quantum of profits made by the firm is also
low. Similarly, if it is narrow to the left side of the BEP it indicates that the quantum
of loss made by the firm is also low. In other words, a narrow angle of incidence
shows a slow rate of profit earning while a wider angle of incidence indicates a
swift rate of profit earning capacity of the firm. A narrow angle also indicates that
the variable cost as a proportion to sales is quite high and therefore very little has
been left by way of contribution.
In the following pages, some additional Illustrations have been given for
explaining the technique of drawing break-even charts.
Illustration 12.22. Plot the following data on a graph and determine the break-
even point:
Direct Labour `10 per unit
Direct Material `20 per unit
Variable Overheads 100 per cent of Direct Material
Fixed Overheads `1,20,000
Selling Price `100 per unit
Solution:
In order to determine BEP by a graph, it will be necessary to compute total cost
and sales at varying levels. This may be done as follows:
Output Variable Cost Fixed Cost Total Cost Sales Profit
units ` ` ` ` `
1,000 50,000 1,20,000 1,70,000 1,00,000 – 70,000
2,000 1,00,000 1,20,000 2,20,000 2,00,000 – 20,000
3,000 1,50,000 1,20,000 2,70,000 3,00,000 30,0000
4,000 2,00,000 1,20,000 3,20,000 4,00,000 80,000
Self-Instructional
448 Material
Thus, the break-even point of output is 2,400 units and of sales `2,40,000. Marginal Costing
In case it is also intended to show each element of cost on the graph paper,
the break-even chart will be prepared with the help of the following table:
Output Direct Direct Variable Fixed Total Sales Profit NOTES
units Material Labour Overheads Overheads Cost ` `
1,000 20,000 10,000 20,000 1,20,000 1,70,000 1,00,000 – 70,000
2,000 40,000 20,000 40,000 1,20,000 2,20,000 2,00,000 – 20,000
3,000 60,000 30,000 60,000 1,20,000 2,70,000 3,00,000 30,000
4,000 80,000 40,000 80,000 1,20,000 3,20,000 4,00,000 80,000
Self-Instructional
Material 449
Marginal Costing Margin of safety can also be computed according to the following formula:
Net Profit
Margin of Safety =
P/ V Ratio
Margin of safety can also be expressed as a percentage:
NOTES Margin of Safety
MS% = × 100
Total Sales
Example 4:
`
Total Sales 1,50,000
Variable Costs 75,000
Fixed Costs 50,000
The margin of safety can be computed as follows:
Fixed Costs 50,000
Break-even Sales = = = `1,00,000
P/ V Ratio 50%
Net Profit = Contribution – Fixed Costs
= `75,000 – `50,000
= `25,000
Margin of Safety = `1,50,000 – `1,00,000
= `50,000
Net Profit 25,000
Or = = Rs 50,000
P/ V Ratio 50%
Decision making is the essence of management since it may make or mar the
success of the business as a whole. In general, it means taking the final step in
deliberations before acting. In management terms, it has a specific meaning. It
means the process of choosing among alternatives courses of action, since, if
there is no choice, there is no decision to make. Moreover, since business takes
place in a probabilities-based world, every management decision deals with the
future—whether it be ten seconds ahead (the decision to adjust a dial), or eighty
years ahead (the decision of where to locate the factory). A decision always involves
a prediction. The function of decision maker is, therefore, to select courses of
action for the future. There is no opportunity to alter the past.
Future is risky. Of course, routine decisions do not involve much of risk.
However, most of the top management decisions are not of a routine nature. They
are generally of a crucial and critical nature on account of their requiring huge
investments and involving much uncertainties. But they cannot be avoided. The
executive has to take them. It has been correctly observed. ‘Uncertainty is his
(executive’s) opponent, overcoming it his mission. Whether the outcome is a
consequence of luck or wisdom, the moment of decision is without doubt the most
creative event in the life of an executive.’
Concept of Relevant Costs
It has already been stated that for managerial decision making the decision maker
must make use of relevant costs. The term ‘relevant’ means ‘pertinent to decision
at hand’. Costs are relevant if they guide the executive towards the decision that
harmonises with top management’s objectives. It will be ideal if the costs are not
only relevant or pertinent but also accurate or precise.
Self-Instructional
Material 451
Marginal Costing It may be noted that ‘relevance’ and ‘accuracy’ are not identical concepts.
Costs may be accurate but irrelevant or inaccurate but relevant. Fox example, the
sales manager’s salary may be precisely `60,500 per month, however, this fact
has no relevance in deciding whether to add or drop a production line.
NOTES
The following are the two fundamental characteristics of relevant costs:
(i) They are future costs: Of course, all future costs are not relevant to
alternative choice decisions but all costs are not relevant unless they
are future. This is because past cost are the result of past decisions
and no current or future decisions can change what has already
happened. For example, a company has to decide whether or not to
accept an order for a particular product. In calculating the cost of this
product to see if the order would benefit the company financially, the
company uses the expected cost at the time when it intends to produce
the product. This could be quite different from the latest historical cost
or standard cost. Thus, in forward decision making, data regarding
historical or standard cost is useful only as a basis for estimating future
costs.
(ii) They differ between alternatives: As stated above, all future costs
are not relevant for decision making. Only such future costs are relevant
which may be expected to differ between alternatives. Those costs
which will not change between different alternatives are to be ignored.
For example, a company is considering the substitution of an automatic
process in place of a slow manual process. The material consumption
per unit would be `2 under both the processes but the conversion
cost would be `3 per unit under the new process in place of `5 under
the present process. In this case relevant cost for decision making is
not the material cost which will not change but the conversion cost
which will change. The cost of material should, therefore, be ignored.
Conversion cost should only be considered. The proposal for
automatic process should, therefore, be accepted since it will result in
saving of `2 per unit.
Concept of Differential Costs
The term differential cost means difference in cost between alternatives. It satisfies
both the conditions necessary for relevant costs, i.e., it is a future cost as well as
it changes between alternatives. Mr J M Clark has described the concept of
differential costs as follows:
‘When a decision has to be made involving an increase or decrease of
n units of output, the difference in costs between two policies may be
considered to be the cost really incurred on account of these n units
of business, or of any similar units. This may be called the differential
cost of a given amount of business. It represents the cost that must
be incurred if that business is taken and which need not be incurred if
Self-Instructional that business is not taken.’
452 Material
Since the management’s objective is to maximize the profit (or minimize the Marginal Costing
loss) of the firm, a comparison is made of differentials costs with differential revenue
under the available alternatives, to find out the most favourable alternative which
will give the maximum possible return on the incremental capital employed in the
business. NOTES
During the year 2008–09, the variable costs are expected to increase
by 10%. There will, however, be no change in fixed costs, the selling price and
the units to be produced and sold. The sales potential for each of the product is
unlimited.
(i) You are required to prepare a statement showing the P/V Ratio, break-
even point and margin of safety for 2007–08 and 2008–09 for the company
as a whole.
(ii) The company intends to increase the production of only one of the three
products to reach the full capacity level by utilizing the spare capacity
available. Assuming that all the three products take the same machine time,
advise with reasons, as to which of the three products should be produced
so that the overall profitability is the maximum.
Solution:
(i) Statement Showing P/V Ratio, BEP & Margin of Safety
for the year 2007–08 and 2008–09
Working Notes:
(1) Year 2008–09 A B C Total
(ii) Since Product C is giving the highest contribution per unit in 2008–09, the spare capacity
should be utilized for its production.
Materials 15,000
Wages 11,000
Fixed Overheads 8,000
Variable Overheads 6,000
The foreign market is explored and it is found that this market can consume
20,000 units of the product if offered at a sale price of `3.55 per unit. It is also
discovered that for additional 10,000 units of the product (over initial 10,000 units)
Self-Instructional
456 Material
the fixed overheads will increase by 10%. Is it worth while to try to capture the foreign Marginal Costing
market?
Solution:
Statement Showing the Advisability of Selling Goods in Foreign Market
NOTES
Year 2006 Year 2007
Home Market Home Market Foreign Market Total
10,000 units 10,000 units 20,000 units 30,000 units
` ` ` `
Materials 15,000 15,000 30,000 45,000
Wages 11,000 11,000 22,000 33,000
Overheads:
Fixed 8,000 8,000 1,600 9,600
Variable 6,000 6,000 12,000 18,000
Total Cost 40,000 40,000 65,600 1,05,600
Profit (Loss) 2,500 (2,800) 5,400 2,600
Sales 42,500 37,000 71,000 1,08,200
From the above, it is clear that it is advisable to sell goods in the foreign
market. It will compensate not only for the loss on account of sales in domestic
market but will also result in an overall profit of `2,600.
Illustration 12.27. A machine tool manufacturing company sells its lathes at
`36,500 each made up as follows:
` `
Direct Materials 16,000
Direct Labour 2,000
Variable Overheads 5,000
Fixed Overheads 3,000
Variable Selling Overheads 500
Royalty 1,000
Profit 5,000 32,500
Central Excise Duty 1,000
Sales Tax 3,000
36,500
Self-Instructional
Material 457
Marginal Costing Solution:
Computation of the Marginal Cost and Contribution per Lathe
`
Direct Materials 16,000
NOTES Direct Labour 2,000
Variable Overheads 5,000
Variable Selling Overheads 500
Royalty 1,000
Marginal Cost 24,500
Price Offered (export) 28,500
Gross Contribution as Margin 4,000
(a) The contribution per lathe is `4,000, out of which about `2,500 will go
for sales tax. There will be saving of about `1,500 per lathe in case the
export order is executed. This is on the presumption that the Central
Government may exempt the company from payment of Central Excise
Duty in order to encourage exports and earn foreign exchange. There
will be no increase in fixed costs since there is already surplus capacity.
The company may, therefore, accept the export order.
(b) The company may charge a price of `31,000 [i.e., `36,500—`5,500
(Profit and selling overheads)] as the bare cost, subject to any variation
in the Sales Tax and Central Excise Duty payable by the company on
such sales.
12.7.3 Make or Buy Decisions
A firm may be manufacturing a product by itself. It may receive an offer from an
outsider supplier to supply that product. The decision in such a case will be made
by comparing the price that has to be paid and the saving that can be effected on
cost. The saving will be only in terms of marginal cost of the product since generally
no savings can be effected in fixed costs.
Similarly, a firm may be buying a product from outside, it may be considering
to manufacture that product in the firm itself. The decision in such a case will be
made by comparing the price being paid to outsiders and all additional costs that
will have to be incurred for manufacturing the product. Such additional costs will
comprise not only direct materials and direct labour but also salaries of additional
supervisors engaged, rent for premises if required and interest on additional capital
employed. Besides that the firm must also take into account the fact that the firm
will be losing the opportunity of using surplus capacity for any other purpose in
case it decides to manufacture the product by itself.
In case a firm decides to get a product manufactured from outside, besides
the savings in cost, it must also take into account the following factors:
(i) Whether the outside supplier would be in a position to maintain the
quality of the product.
Self-Instructional
(ii) Whether the supplier would be regular in his supplies.
458 Material
(iii) Whether the supplier is reliable. In other words, he should be financially Marginal Costing
`
Selling Price (per unit) of Product B 100
Less: Variable Costs (per unit) of Product B 60
Contribution per unit 40
Contribution per hour (40/5 hours) 8
Advice: The above analysis shows that the supplier price is less than relevant cost of
production. Hence, it is advisable to buy X— 100 from outside suppliers.
Illustration 12.29. A machine manufacture 10,000 units of a part at a total cost
of `21 of which `18 is variable. This part is readily available in the market at `19
per unit.
If the part is purchased from the market then the machine can either be
utilized to manufacture a component in same quantity contributing `2 per component
or it can be hired out at `21,000.
Recommended which of the alternative is profitable?
Self-Instructional
Material 459
Marginal Costing Solution:
1st Alternative: 10,000 units of the part are manufactured internally
Variable Cost of 10,000 units @ `18 per unit `1,80,000
NOTES 2nd Alternative: 10,000 units of the part are purchased from the market and the
machine is utilized to manufacture 10,000 units of a component contributing `2
per unit
Purchase Cost of 10,000 units @ `19 per unit `1,90,000
Less: Contribution received on the utilization of machine time 10,000 units × `2 20,000
1,70,000
3rd Alternative: 10,000 units of the part are purchased from outside and the
machine time is hired out at `21,000.
Purchase Cost of 10,000 units @ `19 per unit `1,90,000
Less: Rent received on hiring out the machine 21,000
1,69,000
Please note that in the problem, the fixed cost is not relevant for decision
making. Hence it has been ignored.
Recommendation: The above analysis shows that the cost of 10,000 units is
lowest under 3rd Alternative. Hence it is the best and should be adopted.
actual sales with the budgeted sales, actual profit with the budgeted profit
and actual break-even point with the budgeted break-even point.
7. Presuming that fixed costs will remain unaffected, the decision regarding
NOTES
sales/production mix is taken on the basis f the contribution per unit of each
product.
12.9 SUMMARY
Direct costing: It is the technique where only direct costs are considered
while calculating the cost of the product
Differential Costing: It refers to a technique used in the preparation of
ad hoc information in which only cost and income differences between
alternative courses of action are taken into consideration”.
Marginal Cost: It refers to the amount at any given volume of output by
which aggregate costs are changed if the volume of output is increased or
decreased by one unit.
Margin of safety: It refers to the total sales minus the sales at break-even
point
Decision Making: It is a process of choosing among alternative courses
of action.
Relevant Cost: It is the cost pertinent to specific management decision.
Self-Instructional
464 Material
Budgeting and
BUDGETARY CONTROL
NOTES
Structure
13.0 Introduction
13.1 Objectives
13.2 Concept and Need for Budgeting
13.2.1 Meaning of Control
13.2.2 Meaning of Budgetary Control
13.2.3 Budgetary Control as a Management Tool
13.2.4 Limitations of Budgetary Control
13.2.5 Forecasts and Budgets
13.3 Classification of Budgets
13.3.1 Sales Budget and its Preparation
13.3.2 Production Budget and its Preparation
13.3.3 Materials Purchase or Procurement Budget and its Preparation
13.3.4 Cash Budget and its Preparation
13.3.5 The Final or Master Budget
13.4 Mechanism of Budgetary Control System
13.4.1 Budget Procedure
13.5 Answers to Check Your Progress Questions
13.6 Summary
13.7 Key Words
13.8 Self Assessment Questions and Exercises
13.9 Further Readings
13.0 INTRODUCTION
Planning has become the primary function of management these days. Most of the
planning relates to individual situations and individual proposals. However, this
has to be supplemented and reinforced by overall periodic planning followed by
continuous comparison of the actual performance with the planned performance.
Budgets are nothing but the expressions, largely in financial terms, of management’s
plans for operating and financing the enterprise during specific periods of time.
Budgetary control has, therefore, become an essential tool of management for
controlling costs and maximizing profits.
13.1 OBJECTIVES
Self-Instructional
466 Material
13.2.2 Meaning of Budgetary Control Budgeting and
Budgetary Control
The Chartered Institute of Management Accountants (CIMA), London, defines
budgetary control as ‘the establishment of budgets relating to the responsibilities
of executives to the requirements of policy, and the continuous comparison of NOTES
actual with budgeted results, either to secure by individual action the objective of
that policy or to provide a basis for its revision.’According to J A Scott, ‘It is the
system of management control and accounting in which all operations are forecasted
and so far as possible planned ahead, and the actual results compared with the
forecasted and planned ones.’ Thus, budgetary control involves the following:
(a) Establishment of budgets
(b) Continuous comparison of actuals with budgets for achievement of targets
and placing the responsibility for failure to achieve the budget figures
(c) Revision of budgets in the light of changed circumstances
The difference between budgets, budgeting, and budgetary control has been
stated thus: ‘Budgets are the individual objectives of a department, etc., whereas
budgeting may be said to be the act of building budgets. Budgetary control embraces
all and in addition includes the science of planning the budgets themselves and the
utilization of such budgets to effect an overall management tool for the business
planning and control.’
De Paula has given the following beautiful analogy to explain the main idea
behind budgetary control. ‘The position may be likened to the navigation of a ship
across the seas. The log is kept written regarding happenings and the position of
the ship from hour to hour and valuable lessons are to be learnt by the captain
from a study of the factors which caused the misadventure in the past. But to
navigate ship safely over the seven seas the captain requires his navigating officer
to work out the course ahead and constantly to check his ship’s position against
the predetermined one. If the ship is off its course, the navigating officer must
report it immediately so that the captain may take prompt action to regain his
course. Exactly so it is with the industrial ship, the past records represent the log
and the auditor is responsible for verifying so far as he can that those records are
correct and reveal a true and fair view of the financial position of the concern. But
what modern management requires for day-to-day operating purposes is forecasts
showing in detail the anticipated course of business for (say) the coming year.
During the course of years the management requires immediate reports of material
variance from the predetermined course to the other with explanations of the reasons
for variations.’
It should be noted that a budget or a system of budgetary control is not
something rigid or like a strait-jacket. There is enough flexibility to provide initiative
and drive but also caution against undue recklessness. It is, as a matter of fact, one
of the systems through which dynamism is introduced into the organization.
Self-Instructional
Material 467
Budgeting and 13.2.3 Budgetary Control as a Management Tool
Budgetary Control
Budgetary control has become an essential tool of management for controlling
costs and maximizing profits. It may be conceived as one of the supreme examples
NOTES of rationality in management. It is a useful management tool for comparing the
current performance with pre-planned performance with a view to attaining
equilibrium between ends and means, output and effort. It corrects the deviations
from pre-planned path through the media of reservation, research planning, control
and decision making and thus helps in performance of future activities in an orderly
way. It uncovers uneconomies in operations, weaknesses in the organization
structure and minimize wasteful spending. It acts as a friend, philosopher and
guide to the management. Its advantages to management can be summarized as
follows:
1. Brings economy in working: It brings efficiency and economy in the
working of the business enterprise. ‘Even though a monetary reward is not
offered, the budget becomes a game—a goal to achieve or a target to
shoot at—and hence it is more likely to be achieved or hit than if there was
no predetermined goal or target. The budget is an impersonal policeman
that maintains ordered effort and brings about efficiency in results.’
2. Buck-passing avoided: It establishes divisional and departmental
responsibility. It thus prevents alibis and ‘buck-passing’ when the budget
figures are not met.
3. Establishes coordination: It coordinates the various divisions of a business,
namely, the production, marketing, financial and administrative divisions. It
‘forces executives to think, and think as a group.’ This results in smoother
operation of the entire plant.
4. Guards against undue optimism: It guards against undue optimism leading
to over-expansion because the targets are fixed by the executives, after
cool and careful thought.
5. Acts as a safety signal: It acts as a safety signal for the management. It
shows when to proceed cautiously and when manufacturing or merchandising
expansion can be safely undertaken. It serves as an automatic check on the
judgement of the executives as losses are revealed in time which is a caution
to the management to stop wastage.
6. Adoption of uniform policy: Uniform policy without the disadvantage of
a military type of business organization can be pursued by all divisions of
the business by means of centralization of budgetary control.
7. Decrease in production costs: Seasonal variations in production can be
reduced by developing new ‘fill in’ products. This results in decreasing the
cost of production by increasing volume of output.
8. Adoption of standard costing principles: The use of budget figures as
measures of operating performance and financial position makes possible
Self-Instructional
468 Material
the adoption of the standard costing principles in divisions other than the Budgeting and
Budgetary Control
production division.
9. Management by exception: Budgetary control reveals variations of actual
performance from budgeted performance. The variations point to the root
NOTES
of inefficiencies and thus enable the management to consider only the items
that do not go according to plan and leave the others, i.e., to concentrate
on exceptions.
10. Optimum mix: It helps management in obtaining the most profitable
combination of the different factors of production. This results in a more
economical use of capital.
11. Favour with credit agencies: Managements who have developed a well
ordered budget plan and who operate accordingly, receive greater favour
from credit agencies.
12. Optimum capitalization: It is only the technique of predetermining when
and to what extent financing will be necessary avoiding the possibility of
both over and under-capitalization.
13.2.4 Limitations of Budgetary Control
The budgetary control system is not a perfect tool. It has its own limitations which
are as follows:
1. Opposition against the very spirit of budgeting: There will always be
active and passive resistance to budgetary control as it points to the efficiency
or inefficiency of individuals. The opposition is also due to human nature—
the tendency to resist change. Moreover, any system of budgetary control
cannot be successful unless it has the full support of the top management.
Chris Argyris has, in his study of ‘Human Problems with Budget’ has pointed
out the following reasons for a high degree of negative reaction against
budgeting on the part of the front-line managers:
(a) Budgets are evaluation instruments. They tend to set goals against
which the people are measured hence they naturally are complained
about.
(b) Some of the supervisors tend to use budgets as ‘whipping posts’ in
order to release their feelings about many (often totally unrelated)
problems.
(c) Budgets are thought of as pressure devices. As such they produce the
same kind of unfavourable reactions as do other kinds of pressure,
regardless of origin.
2. Budgeting and changing economy: The preparation of a budget which
gives a realistic position of the firm’s affairs under inflationary pressure and
changing government policies is really difficult. Thus, the accurate position
of the business cannot be estimated.
Self-Instructional
Material 469
Budgeting and 3. Time factor: Accuracy in budgeting comes through experience.
Budgetary Control
Management must not expect too much during the development period.
4. Not a substitute for management: Budget is only a management tool. It
cannot substitute management. Besides that no budgetary programme can
NOTES
be successful unless adequate arrangements are made for supervision and
administration.
5. Cooperation required: The success of the budgetary control depends upon
willing cooperation and teamwork. Budget officer must get cooperation
from all department managers. These managers must feel the responsibility
for achieving or bettering the departmental goals laid down in the budget.
In spite of these limitations, it can be safely said that the technique of
budgetary control is a must for each business enterprise. It leaves sufficient time
for the top management for formulation of overall policy and planning. Much success
can be achieved if the top management devotes attention chiefly to unusual or
exceptional items that appear in daily, weekly and monthly statements and reports.
In the words of J R Batliboi, ‘The success of budgetary control must depend on
the adequancy and reliability of records, the past and the present performances,
on the interest of all executives and subordinates in the purpose of such control,
proper departmentalization and sub-division of factory activities, a close classification
and proper division and analysis of the expenditure, and the most suitable system
of cost and financial accounts.’
13.2.5 Forecasts and Budgets
A forecast is the statement of facts likely to occur. According to the Chartered
Institute of Management Accountants, London, forecast is ‘a statement of probable
events.’At planning stage it is necessary to prepare forecasts of probable courses
of action for the business in future. Plans or budgets are prepared on the basis of
these forecasts in order to achieve the objectives of the organization. The forecast
of a function need not necessarily be coordinated. The desired coordination is
obtained before finalization of the budget. A forecast is, therefore, the basis for the
budget.
A budget is a statement of planned events generally expressed in financial
and/or quantitative terms. It is generally evolved from the forecast. A forecast
denotes some degree of looseness while budget denotes a definite ‘target’.
The difference between a ‘forecast’ and a budget can be put as follows:
1. The forecast is a mere estimate of what is likely to happen. It is a
statement of probable events. On the other hand, a budget relates to
planned events. In other words, a budget is the policy or programme
to be followed in the future under prescribed conditions.
2. A forecast represents an event over which no control can be exercised.
On the other hand, a budget connotes a sense of control. For example,
a sales manager on the basis of knowledge of the business conditions
Self-Instructional
470 Material
prevailing in the market, will forecast the specified quantity of the Budgeting and
Budgetary Control
product which he will be in a position to sell in the market. Keeping
this forecast in view and depending upon the production capacity
available at his disposal, he will make out a sales budget. The budget
may, therefore, be set at a level different from what has been indicated NOTES
by the forecast.
3. Forecasting ends with assessment for the probable events, while
budgeting starts after making a forecast. In other words, budgetary
control is preceded by forecasting.
4. Forecasts are made not only for budgeting, but for other purposes
also. For example, where several alternative choices are available,
forecasts are made regarding the likely results which might be there
under different circumstances. A decision is then taken for adopting
the best possible course. For example, economic forecasts may be
made regarding general business conditions. This may have no
relevance with budgeting.
Budgets can be classified into different categories from different points of view.
The following are the most common basis of classification:
1. According to time
2. According to function
3. According to flexibility
4. According to purpose
Classification According to Time
In terms of time, the budget can broadly be classified into three categories:
(a) Long-term Budget: A budget designed for a long period (generally for a
period of 5 to 10 years) is termed as a long-term budget. These budgets
are concerned with planning of the operations of a firm over a considerably
long period of time. They are generally prepared in terms of physical
quantities.
(b) Short-term Budget: These budgets are designed for a period generally
not exceeding 5 years. They are generally prepared in physical as well as in
monetary units.
Self-Instructional
Material 471
Budgeting and (c) Current Budgets: These budgets cover a very short period say a month
Budgetary Control
or a quarter. They are essentially short-term budgets adjusted to current
conditions or prevailing circumstances.
(d) Rolling Budgets: Some companies follow the practice of preparing a
NOTES
rolling or progressive budget. In case of such companies there will always
be a budget for a year in advance. A new budget is prepared after the end
of each month/quarter for a full year ahead. The figures for the month or
quarter which has rolled down are dropped and the figures for the next
month or quarter are added. For example, if a budget has been prepared
for the year 2017, after the expiry of the first quarter ending 31 March
2017, a new budget for the full year ending 31 March 2018 will be prepared
by dropping the figures of the quarter which has rolled down (i.e., quarter
ending 31 March 2017) and adding figures for the new quarter ending
31 March 2018. The figures for the remaining three quarters, ending
31 December 2017, may also be revised, if necessary. This practice will
continue whenever a quarter ends and a new quarter begins.
Classification According to Function
Budgets can be classified on the basis of function they are meant to perform.
These budgets are, therefore, also termed as functional budgets. Their number
depends on the size and the nature of the business. The following are the usual
functional budgets.
(a) Sales Budget: The budget forecasts total sales in terms of quantity, value,
items, periods, areas, etc.
(b) Production Budget: The budget is based on sales budget. It forecasts
quantity of production in terms of items, period, areas, etc.
(c) Cost of Production Budget: The budget forecasts the cost of the
production. Separate budgets are prepared for different elements of costs
such as direct materials budget, direct labour budget, factory overheads
budget, office overheads budget, selling and distribution overheads budget,
etc.
(d) Purchase Budget: The budget forecasts the quantity and value of purchases
required for production. It gives quantity-wise, money-wise and period-
wise information about the materials to be purchased.
(e) Personnel Budget: The budget anticipates the quantity of personnel
required during a period for production activity. This may further be split up
as direct and indirect personnel budgets.
(f) Research Budget: The budget relates to the research work to be done for
improvement in quality of the products or research for new products.
(g) Capital Expenditure Budget: The budget provides a guidance regarding
the amount of capital that may be required for procurement of capital assets
Self-Instructional during the budget period.
472 Material
(h) Cash Budget: This budget is a forecast of the cash position by time period Budgeting and
Budgetary Control
for a specific duration of time. It states the estimated amount of cash receipts
and the estimation of cash payments and the likely balance of cash in hand
at the end of different periods.
NOTES
(i) Master Budget: It is a summary budget incorporating all functional budgets
in a capsule form. It interprets different functional budgets and covers within
its range the preparation of projected income statement and projected balance
sheet.
Classification According to Flexibility
A budget may be fixed or flexible. A fixed budget is based on a fixed volume of
activity. It is ineffective and meaningless, primarily because the actual capacity
utilization may vary from month to month or quarter to quarter. A flexible budget is
prepared for changing levels of activity. The flexible budget considers the fixed
and variable costs separately because of their behaviour. Fixed costs tend to remain
unchanged within the given levels. They change only when there is a change in the
capacity level, while variable costs change in direct proportion of output. The
budget controller can analyse the variance between the actual costs and budgeted
costs, depending upon the actual level of activity attained during a period if flexible
budget approach is adopted.
(i) Fixed Budget: A budget prepared on the basis of a standard or a fixed
level of activity is called a fixed budget. It does not change with the change
in the level of activity.
(ii) Flexible Budget: A budget designed in a manner so as to give the budgeted
cost of any level of activity is termed as a flexible budget.
Classification According to Purpose
On the basis of purpose, budgets can be classified into two categories:
(i) Operating Budget
(ii) Financial Budget
(i) Operating Budget: The budget shows planned operations for the
forthcoming period, including revenues, expenses and related changes in
inventory. It covers in its ambit, sales budget, production budget, cost of
production budget, etc. Thus, it is the principal part of master budget of the
business.
Operating budget usually consists of two parts:
(a) Programme Budget
(b) Responsibility Budget
(a) Programme Budget: It consists of estimated revenues and costs of
the major programmes that the company plans to undertake during
the forthcoming period. Such a budget can be prepared in respect of
Self-Instructional
Material 473
Budgeting and each project or product line giving details of revenue, costs and resultant
Budgetary Control
profit in respect of each one of them. Such budgets are useful in a way
that they provide an overall picture of the various projects or products.
However, they are not suitable for exercising control over individuals
NOTES since various persons may be responsible for individual costs of a
project or product with none of them being responsible for total
operation. It is also termed as a project or a product budget.
(b) Responsibility Budget: It is a budget which identifies the revenues
and costs, with the individual responsible for their incurrence. Such a
budget is an excellent control device, since it identifies with the
individual, only such revenues and costs which are controllable by
him. The data regarding actual results are collected from different
operations and compared with the budgeted figures to find out whether
the individual has achieved what was expected of him.
For example, a factory may be manufacturing three products in its three
production departments, with the help of two service departments. The
factory may prepare a programme budget showing planned costs for each,
including both direct and indirect costs. The costs of service departments
being taken as indirect costs and charged to products A, B and C on some
reasonable basis. Such a budget is useful in ascertaining the adequacy of
profit margin on each product as well as determining whether the production
capacity of the factory is in conformity with its sales potential. However,
such a budget will not be helpful in judging the performance of each individual
manager since all costs shown in a programme budget may not be
controllable by him, e.g., costs of service departments are not controllable
by managers of production departments. Hence it is necessary that budget
for each responsibility centre be prepared separately. Such budget will include
only such costs which come within the sphere of the manager heading that
responsibility centre. This type of budget will localize the difference between
budget the actual operations making possible measurement of individual
performance. Formulation of responsibility budgets is an integral part of
responsibility accounting which has been explained in detail later in the
chapter.
(ii) Financial Budget: Financial budget is concerned with the financial
implications of the operating budget. The following are the important
components of the financial budget:
(a) Cash Budget: It is the most important component of the financial
budget. The main objective of cash budget is to maintain sufficient
cash balance to meet the business needs and using the cash in the
most profitable manner.
(b) Projected Income Statement: This statement helps the business to
forecast results of budgeted operations, analysis of present and past
Self-Instructional financial statements, i.e., income statement and the balance sheet,
474 Material
indicating direction of change and the financial position and overall Budgeting and
Budgetary Control
performance of the business enterprise.
(c) Projected Statement of Changes in Financial Position: This
statement has become quite important these days. It shows clearly
NOTES
the sources and uses of the firm’s financial resources. The statement
can be prepared from the projected income statement and the balance
sheet. The statement helps the firm in framing its policies regarding
payments of dividends, redemption of long-term loans, purchase of
fixed assets, raising money through loans and issue of share capital,
etc.
Some of the important types of budgets covered by the above classifications
have been discussed in the following pages.
13.3.1 Sales Budget and its Preparation
The sales budget, generally, forms the fundamental basis on which all the budgets
are built up. The budget is essentially a forecast of sales to be achieved in a budget
period. The sales manager should be made directly responsible for the preparation
and execution of this budget. He should take into consideration the following factors
while preparing the sales budget:
(a) Past sales figures and trends: The record or previous experience forms
the most reliable guide as to future sales as the past performance is related
to actual business conditions. However, the other factors, such as, seasonal
fluctuations, growth of market, trade cycle, etc., should not be ignored.
(b) Salesmen’s estimates: Salesmen, etc., are in a position to estimate the
potential demand of the customers more accurately because they come in
direct contact with them. However, proper discount should be made for
over optimistic or too conservative estimates of the salesmen, depending
upon their temperament.
(c) Plant capacity: It should be the endeavour of the business to ensure proper
utilization of plant facilities and that the sales budget provides an economic
and balanced production in the factory.
(d) General trade prospects: The general trade prospects considerably affect
the sales. Valuable information can be gathered in this connection from trade
papers and magazines.
(e) Orders on hand: In case of industries where production is quite a lengthy
process, orders on hand also have a considerable influence on the amount
of sales.
(f) Proposed expansion or discontinuance of products: It affects sales and,
therefore, it should also be considered.
(g) Seasonal fluctuations: Past experience will be the best guide in this respect.
However, efforts should be made to minimize the effects of seasonal
Self-Instructional
Material 475
Budgeting and fluctuations by giving special concessions or off-season discounts thus
Budgetary Control
increasing the volume of sales.
(h) Potential market: Market research should be carried out for ascertaining
the potential market for the company’s products. Such an estimate is made
NOTES
on the basis of expected population growth, purchasing power of consumers
and buying habits of the people.
(i) Availability of material and supply: Adequate supply of raw materials
and other supplies must be ensured before drafting the sales programme.
(j) Financial aspect: Expansion of sales usually require increase in capital
outlay also. Therefore, sales budget must be kept within the bounds of
financial capacity.
(k) Other factors:
(i) The nature and degree of competition within the industry;
(ii) Cost of distributing goods;
(iii) Government controls, rules and regulations related to the industry;
(iv) Political situation—national and international—as it may have an
influence upon the market.
The sales manager, after taking into consideration all these factors, will prepare
the Sales budget in terms of quantities and money, distinguishing between products,
periods, and area of sales.
Illustration 13.1. XYZ & Co. manufactures two products, X and Y, and sells
them through two divisions, East and West. For the purpose of submission of
sales budget to the budget committee the following information has been made
available: Budgeted sales for the current year were:
Product East West
X 400 at `9 600 at `9
Y 300 at `21 500 at `21
X 500 at `9 700 at `9
Y 200 at `21 400 at `21
X +10% + 5%
Y +20% +10% NOTES
With the help of an intensive advertisement campaign, the following additional
sales above the estimated sales of divisional managers are possible:
Product East West
X 60 70
Y 40 50
You are required to prepare a budget for sales incorporating the above
estimates. Also shown the budgeted and actual sales of the current year.
Solution:
XYZ & Co. Ltd
Sales Budget
for the year.......
Self-Instructional
Material 477
Budgeting and The production budget may be expressed in quantitative or financial units or
Budgetary Control
both. The objectives of its preparation are:
(i) To answer the following questions:
NOTES (a) What is to be produced?
(b) When it is to be produced?
(c) How it is to be produced?
(d) Where it is to be produced?
(ii) To chalk down and organize the production programme for achieving the
sales target
(iii) To serve as a basis for preparation of production costs budgets, e.g., materials
cost budget, labour cost budget, etc.
(iv) To prepare a cash forecast
There are two problems connected with the production budget:
(i) determining the annual production required, and (ii) pro-rating it throughout the
year. The planning of production programme is essential to have sufficient stock
for sales, to keep inventories within reasonable limits and to manufacture goods
most economically. To achieve it, the following factors should be taken into
consideration:
(i) Inventory policies: Inventory standards should be predetermined so that
neither there is a shortage nor over-stocking of goods.
(ii) Sales requirements: The quantity of goods to be sold would decide to a
great extent how much is to be produced. Therefore, this budget depends
upon the sales budget.
(iii) Production stability: For reduction of costs, stability in employment and
better utilization of plant facilities, the production should be evenly distributed
throughout the year. In case of seasonal industries, since it is not possible to
have stable levels of production or inventory, an effort should be made to
have the optimum balance between the two.
(iv) Plant capacity: How much can be produced depends upon the available
plant capacity. There must be sufficient capacity to produce the annual
requirements and also to meet seasonal nigh demands.
(v) Availability of materials and labour: Adequate and timely supply of raw
materials and labour force should have an important effect on the planning
of production.
(vi) Time taken in production process: The production should commence
well in time, keeping in view how much time it would take in the factory to
convert the raw materials into finished goods.
An illustration has been given here showing the production requirements for
a quarter.
Self-Instructional
478 Material
Illustration 13.2. Prepare a production budget for three months ending 31 March Budgeting and
Budgetary Control
2017, for a factory producing four products, on the basis of the following
information:
Type of Estimated Stock Estimated Sales Desired Closing Stock
product on 1 January 2017 during Jan–March 2017 on 31 March 2017
NOTES
(units) (units) (units)
A 2,000 10,000 3,000
B 3,000 15,000 5,000
C 4,000 13,000 3,000
D 3,000 12,000 2,000
Solution:
Production Budget
for three months to 31 March 2017
Units Units
Product A : Estimated Sales 10,000
Add : Desired Closing Stock 3,000
13,000
Less : Estimated Opening Stock 2,000 11,000
Product B: Estimated Sales 15,000
Add: Desired Closing Stock 5,000
20,000
Less: Estimated Opening Stock 3,000 17,000
Product C: Estimated Sales 13,000
Add: Desired Closing Stock 3,000
16,000
Less: Estimated Opening Stock 4,000 12,000
Product D: Estimated Sales 12,000
Add: Desired Closing Stock 2,000
14,000
Less: Estimated Opening Stock 3,000 11,000
Total units to be produced 51,000
The sales and the production budgets are interdependent and must be
prepared in cooperation with both the sales and the works departments.
Cost of Production Budget
After determining the volume of production, it is necessary to determine the cost
of producing this output. Cost of production includes materials, labour and
overheads and, therefore, separate budgets for each of these items will be prepared.
13.3.3 Materials Purchase or Procurement Budget and its Preparation
Materials may be direct or indirect. The materials budget generally deals only with
the direct materials. Indirect materials are generally included in overhead budget.
The preparation of materials budget includes the following:
(a) the preparation of estimates of raw material requirements.
Self-Instructional
Material 479
Budgeting and (b) the scheduling of purchases in required quantities at the required time.
Budgetary Control
(c) the controlling of raw material inventories.
Material requirements are estimated regarding each class of products by
NOTES multiplying the exact material requirements for each class of product by the number
of units of that class. The total quantity required for the budget period is first
estimated and then is further broken down by component time period (month and
quarters) in the materials budget. The breakdown and length of the period should
be in uniformity with the production budget.
In case of concerns whose raw material requirements can be standardised,
the materials budget can be prepared precisely on this basis. In case it is not
possible, the percentage of raw materials to total cost of products should be
calculated on the basis of the historical data. On the basis of this information, a
rough estimate can be made regarding the raw materials required for the budgeted
output. The figure should further be adjusted taking into account the current price
trends and the normal wastage of materials in the course of production.
The buying department should proceed to find the most profitable means of
procuring the requisite quantity and quality of raw materials. Consideration must
also be given to the amount of stock to be carried forward.
The materials budget can be classified into two categories : (i) Materials
requirement budget, and (ii) Materials procurement or purchase budget. The former
tells about the total quantity of materials required during the budget period; while
the latter tells about the materials to be acquired from the market during the budget
period. Materials to be acquired are estimated after taking into account the closing
inventory and the opening inventory or the materials for which orders have already
been placed.
Illustration 13.3. The sales director of a manufacturing company reports that
next year he expects to sell 50,000 units of a particular product.
The production manager consults the storekeeper and casts his figures as
follows:
Two kinds of raw materials, A and B are required for manufacturing the
product. Each unit of the product requires 2 units of A and 3 units of B. The
estimated opening balances at the commencement of the next year are:
Finished product: 10,000 units.
Raw Materials : A : 12,000 units; B : 15,000 units.
The desirable closing balances at the end of the next are:
Finished Product: 14,000 units, A : 13,000 units, B : 16,000 units.
Draw up a quantitative chart showing materials purchase budget for the next year.
Solution:
The units to be produced are = Sales + Desired Closing Stock – Opening Stock
= 50,000 + 14,000 – 10,000 = 54,000 units
Self-Instructional
480 Material
Materials Purchase or Procurement Budget (Quantitative) Budgeting and
Budgetary Control
Finished Materials
Particulars
Product A B
Units Units Units
Production Budget 54,000 1,08,000 1,62,000
NOTES
Estimated Opening Balance + 10,000 – 12,000 – 15,000
64,000 96,000 1,47,000
Estimated Closing Balance – 14,000 + 13,000 + 16,000
Estimated Sales of Product 50,000
Estimated Purchase of Materials 1,09,000 1,63,000
Illustration 13.4. From the following figures prepare the Raw Materials Purchase
Budget for January 2017:
Materials (Units)
Particulars
A B C D E F
Estimated stock on 1 January 16,000 6,000 24,000 2,000 14,000 28,000
Estimated stock on 31 January 20,000 8,000 28,000 4,000 16,000 32,000
Estimated consumption 1,20,000 44,000 1,32,000 36,000 88,000 1,72,000
Standard price per unit 25 p. 5 p. 15 p. 10 p. 20 p. 30 p.
Solution:
Raw Materials Purchase Budget
for January 2017
Materials
Type Total
A B C D E F
Estimated consumption 1,20,000 44,000 1,32,000 36,000 88,000 1,72,000 5,92,000
(units)
Add : Estimated Stock on
31 Jan. 2017 (Units) 20,000 8,000 28,000 4,000 16,000 32,000 1,08,000
1,40,000 52,000 1,60,000 40,000 1,04,000 2,04,000 7,00,000
Less: Estimated Stock on
1 Jan. 2017 (Units) 16,000 6,000 24,000 2,000 14,000 28,000 90,000
Estimated Purchases (Units) 1,24,000 46,000 1,36,000 38,000 90,000 1,76,000 6,10,000
Rate per unit (`) 0.25 .05 .15 .10 .20 .30
Estimated Purchases (`) 31,000 23,000 20,400 3,800 18,000 52,800 1,28,300
Notes:
(i) Opening balance for June has been written after finding closing balance for May, and for July
after finding the closing balance for June.
(ii) Since the period of credit allowed to customers is one month, the amount of credit sales in
April shall be collected in May and so on.
(iii) Since the period of credit allowed by suppliers is two months, the payment for credit
purchases in March shall be made in May and so on.
(iv) One-half of the manufacturing expenses of April and one-half of those of May shall be paid
in May, i.e., (1/2 of `3,000) + (1/2 of `4,500), i.e., `3,750 and so on.
(v) Office and selling expenses of April shall be paid in May and so on.
(ii) Adjusted Profit and Loss Account Method: In case of this method, the
cash budget is prepared on the basis of opening cash and bank balances, projected
profit and loss account and the balance of the various assets and liabilities. Cash
from operations is taken, as not that profit figure as shown by the profit and loss
account, but the figure of profit as adjusted in the light of non-cash items such as
depreciation, loss on sale of capital assets, preliminary expenses written off from
P&L a/c, etc. Since these items do not affect cash position, though they have been
charged to the profit and loss account, they are added back to the profit or deducted
from loss, as the case may be. Likely issue of new shares, realization from sale of
fixed assets or raising long-term loans are taken as other sources of cash. Similarly
likely redemption of preferences shares (in case of redeemable preference shares),
payment of long-term loans, purchase of fixed assets, payment of dividends, etc.,
Self-Instructional
Material 483
Budgeting and are taken as applications of cash. Moreover increase in current liabilities such as
Budgetary Control
creditors, bills payable will mean less cash payment or decrease in current assets
such as debtors, stock, bills receivable, prepaid expenses, etc., will mean less
investment in these assets, therefore, they will be all taken as sources of cash.
NOTES Decrease in current liabilities or increase in current assets on the same basis, will
mean decrease in cash resources.
The preparation of cash budget according to this method can be understood
with the help of the following illustration:
Illustration 13.6. The following data are available to you. You are required to
prepare a cash budget according to adjusted profit and loss method:
Balance Sheet
as on 31 December 2017
Liabilities ` Assets `
Particulars ` Particulars `
Self-Instructional
484 Material
48,000 48,000 Budgeting and
To Dividends 8,000 By Balance of Profit from last year 10,000 Budgetary Control
To Addition to Reserve 4,000 By Net Profit b/d 19,500
To Balance c/d 17,500
29,500 29,500
NOTES
Closing balances of certain items: Share Capital `1,20,000; 10% Debentures `30,000; Creditors
`40,000; Debtors `60,000 : B/P `12,000.
B/R `4,000; Furniture `15,000;. Plant `50,000 (both these assets are to be purchased by the end
of the year).
Solution:
Cash Budget
` `
Opening Balance as on 1 Jan. 2018 51,000
Add: Net profit for the year 19,500
Depreciation 7,500
Decrease in B/R 1,000
Increase in B/P 2,000
Issue of Share Capital 20,000
Issue of Debentures 30,000
Decrease in Prepaid Commission 1,000
Decrease of Stock 5,000 86,000
1,37,000
Less: Purchase of Plant 50,000
Purchase of Furniture 15,000
Increase of Debtors 20,000
Decrease of Creditors 10,000
Decrease in Outstanding Rent 1,000
Dividends paid 8,000 1,04,000
Closing Balance as on 31 Dec. 2018 33,000
(iii) Balance Sheet Method: In case of this method, at the end of each period, a
projected balance sheet is drawn up, setting out the various assets, and liabilities,
except cash and bank balances. The balancing figures would be the estimated
closing cash/bank balance. Thus, under this method, closing balances other than
cash/bank will have to be found out first, to be put in the budgeted balance sheet.
This can be done by adjusting the anticipated transactions of the year in the opening
balances. This method is not recommended.
Illustration 13.7. With the figures given in Illustration 13.6 prepare the cash budget
using balance sheet method.
Solution:
Budgeted Balance Sheet
as on 31 December 2018
Liabilities Amount (`) Assets Amount (`)
Self-Instructional
486 Material
In case of a trading concern, the quantity to be purchased can also be Budgeting and
Budgetary Control
estimated on the basis of the formula given above. The value of purchases
can be found out by multiplying the quantity to be purchased with the
estimated purchasing cost per unit.
NOTES
3. Cost of production budget is the third step in preparation of the master
budget. The cost of production will be estimated by estimating the cost of
different elements of cost such as cost of direct material, direct labour an d
overheads. Separate budgets for each of these components, may be
prepared.
4. The preparation of the cash budget is the next important step. The budget
will be helpful in estimating the cash inflows from different sources such as
issue of shares, debentures, long-term loans, debtors, etc., and cash outflows
for different purposes such as payment of creditors, purchase of fixed assets,
redemption of long-term loans, etc. It will also give the balance in hand at
the end of particular period.
5. The above steps from 1 to 4 will be helpful in providing information for
preparing the budgeted or projected income statement.
6. On the basis of last year’s balance sheet and the information collected by
taking steps 1 to 5, the budgeted or projected balance sheet for the business
will be prepared. This will be the final step in the preparation of a master
budget. If desired, the important accounting ratios can also be computed
on the basis of information given by the budgeted income statement and the
budgeted balance sheet.
Master Budget
Period: normal capacity... Budgeted Capacity...
` `
Sales (as per sales budget)
Toughended Glass-units @ `... 3,00,000
Bent toughened Glass...unit @ `.. 5,00,000
8,00,000
Less : Cost of Production (as per cost of production budget)
Direct Materials (...units @ `...) 4,80,000
Direct Wages 36,000
Prime Cost 5,16,000
Factory Overheads:
Variable
Stores and Spares (2½% of sales) 20,000
Light and Power 5,000
Self-Instructional
Repairs and Maintenance 8,000 33,000
488 Material
Fixed: Budgeting and
Works Manager’s Salary 6,000 Budgetary Control
Foreman’s Salary 4,800
Depreciation 12,600
Sundries 3,600 27,000
Works Cost 5,76,000 NOTES
Gross Profit 2,24,000
Less: Administration, Selling and Distribution Overheads 14,000
Net Profit 2,10,000
Self-Instructional
Material 489
Budgeting and The steps required for sorting out each of these problems are being explained
Budgetary Control
in the following pages.
2. Organization for Budgeting
NOTES The setting up of a definite plan of organization is the second step to be taken prior
to beginning the real work of installing budgetary control. The responsibility of
each executive must be clearly defined. There should be no uncertainty regarding
the point where the jurisdiction of one executive ends and that of another begins.
3. Creation of Budget Manual
The budget manual is a written document or booklet which specifies the objectives
of the budgeting organization and procedures.
The Chartered Institute of Management Accountants, London, defines it as
‘a document which sets out, inter alia, the responsibilities of the persons engaged
in, the routine of, and the forms and records required for budgetary control.’
Following are some of the important matters covered in a budget manual:
(i) A statement regarding the objectives of the organization and how they can
be achieved through budgetary control.
(ii) A statement regarding the functions and responsibilities of each executive
by designation both regarding preparation and execution of budgets.
(iii) Procedure to be followed for obtaining the necessary approval of budgets.
The authority of granting approval should be stated in explicit terms. Whether
one, two or more signatures are to be required on each document should
also be clearly stated.
(iv) Time-tables for all stages of budgeting.
(v) Reports, statements, forms and other records to be maintained.
(vi) The accounts classification is to be employed. It is necessary that the
framework within which the costs, revenues and other financial amounts
are classified must be identical both in the accounts and the budget
departments.
There are many advantages attaching to the use of budget manual. Since it
is a formal record defining the functions and responsibilities of each executive, the
methods and procedures of budgetary control are well standardized. Moreover,
there is a synchronization of the efforts of all which results in maximization of the
profits of the organization.
4. Determination of Responsibility for Budgeting
1. Budget Controller: Of course, the chief executive is ultimately responsible
for the budget programme but it will be better if the large part of the
supervisory responsibility is delegated to an official designated as budget
controller or budget director. The budget controller or budget director should
Self-Instructional
490 Material
have knowledge of the technical side of the business and should report Budgeting and
Budgetary Control
direct to the President.
2. Budget Committee: The budget controller will be assisted in his work by
the budget committee. The budget committee will consist of heads of the
NOTES
various departments as production, sales, finance, etc., with budget controller
as its chairman. It will be the duty of the budget committee to submit, discuss
and finally approve of the budget figures. Each head of the department will
have his own sub-committee with executive working under him as its
members.
5. Determination of the Budget Period
‘Budget period’ means the period for which a budget is prepared and employed.
The budget period will depend upon (i) the nature of the business, and (ii) the
control techniques to be applied. For example, a seasonal industry will budget for
each season (and off season). An industry requiring long periods to complete
work will budget for 3 or 4 or 5 years. However, it is necessary from the point of
view of control that the budget should not be for a period longer than that what is
necessary.
13.4.1 Budget Procedure
1. Procedural Steps
After the establishment of budget organization and determination of the budget
period, the actual work of budgetary control begins. The procedure followed in
designing and operating a budgetary control system largely depends upon the
nature of the business. However, the usual pattern is as follows:
1. Determination of key factor: Key factor is that factor the extent of whose
influence must first be assessed in order to ensure that functional budgets
(relating to different functions of a business, e.g., sales, production,
purchases and cash) are reasonably capable of fulfilment. This is also termed
as ‘principal budget’ or ‘limiting’ or ‘governing’ factor. It is essential to
consider this factor before preparing the budgets. In some concerns the
key factor might be sales; while in others it might be production, materials,
labour, machinery or capital. This most important factor which governs the
whole process of preparation of budgets should be pre-determined. The
budget relating to that particular factory should be prepared first and the
other budgets should be based upon it. A coordinated plan should then be
finally approved.
The examples of key factors, which can be one or even more than one in a
particular concern, are as under:
First, sales may be the key factor and if it is so, it would be because of the
restricted demand in the market or limited efforts for sales promotion.
Self-Instructional
Material 491
Budgeting and Secondly, management might be another important key factor because of
Budgetary Control
deficiency of capable managers or limited funds at the disposal of the
executives. Thirdly, materials may be the limiting factor, on account of
inadequate availability of supply, fixed quotas, licence restrictions, etc. Labour
NOTES is yet another key factor because there might be dearth of workers in general
or in certain grades. Lastly, plant may be the governing factor. Plant capacity
might be limited due to shortage in supply or lack of capital or space.
We are giving below the general list of key factors in different industries:
Industry Key factor
(i) Motor car Sales demand
(ii) Aluminium Power
(iii) Petroleum Refinery Supply of crude oil
(iv) Electro-optics Skilled technicians
(v) Hydel power generation Monsoon
The key factors should be correctly identified and diagnosed. Budgets will
be meaningless, unless the key factors are considered in depth. However,
the key factors are not of a permanent nature and they can be overcome by
the management in the long run if an effort is made in this direction by selecting
optimum level of production, dealing in more profitable products, introducing
new methods, changing material mix, working overtime or extra shifts,
providing incentives to workers, hiring new machinery, etc.
2. Making of forecasts: Forecast, as explained earlier, means an estimate
about the probabilities for a given period of time. It differs from a budget.
Budget is an operating and financial plan of a business enterprise. It is a sort
of commitment or a target which the management seeks to attain on the
basis of the forecasts made. Forecasts are made regarding sales, production
cost and financial requirements of the business. Physical quantities as well
as monetary values are estimated separately.
3. Consideration of alternative combinations of forecasts: Alternative
combinations of forecasts are considered with a view to obtaining the most
efficient overall plan so as to maximize profits. When the largest combination
of forecasts is selected, the forecasts should be regarded as being finalized.
4. Preparation of Budgets: On finalization of the forecasts, the budgets will
be prepared. Production budget will be prepared on the basis of the sales
budget and also after taking into consideration, the available productive
capacities. Different costs of production budgets will also be prepared on
the basis of the production budgets. Financial budget will be prepared on
the basis of sales forecast and production budget. All these budgets will be
combined and coordinated into one master budget. These budgets may be
revised from time to time taking into account the current developments.
Self-Instructional
492 Material
2. Effective Budgetary Control Budgeting and
Budgetary Control
Besides whatever has been stated above, the following additional points deserve
management’s attention in order to make the system of budgetary control really
effective: NOTES
(i) Consultation with non-financial executives: In order to make each
manager emotionally committed to the budget, the effective participation of
non-financial executives should be solicited by the budget controller in the
formulation of the budgets. Such consultation should be real and not by
way of a mere ritual or formality.
(ii) Total corporate exercise: Budgeting should be a total corporate exercise.
Piecemeal budgeting cannot be effective.
(iii) True delegation of authority and responsibility: There should be a true
delegation of authority and responsibility beginning with top management
itself. Each executive should have maximum opportunity to take decisions
within the scope of his or her authority. This will result in his or her personal
growth, self realization and recognition.
(iv) Motivational approach: People resist pressure and, therefore, budgeting
should not be a pressure device. Motivational approach towards budgeting
should be adopted.
(v) Past experience: Past experience is a useful guide for the future. It is,
therefore, necessary that points revealed by past experience should be taken
note of while formulating plans for the future.
(vi) Minimum limits only: Budgets should be taken as only minimum and not
the maximum level of performance. However, budgets should not be
suffocating. Sufficient operational freedom should be given to the concerned
executives within the overall framework.
(vii) Human factor: The management should not forget that they are dealing
with human beings who have, since ancient times, resented and rebelled
against domination, whether in the form of complete slavery or economic
and political coercion. The management should, therefore, prefer ‘control
through objectives’ to ‘control through domination’. In other words, control
should not be influenced by the personality of the superior or the subordinate.
It should be definite and determinable and verifiable. Moreover, the control
should come from within instead of being imposed from outside.
(viii) Good reporting system: Budgeting cannot be successful unless there is a
proper feedback system. The reporting system should be so devised that it
not only tells about the major variations but also the persons who are
responsible for these variations. For this purpose, periodical statements,
comparing the actual performance with the budgeted performance, should
Self-Instructional
Material 493
Budgeting and be prepared. The causes of variances should be analysed and the
Budgetary Control
management should be kept informed about major variances, working on
the principle of management by exception. Proper remedial measures should
be taken by the management at appropriate level and at appropriate time.
NOTES
Budgetary Control applied under Conditions of Uncertainty
Budgeting is essential for all types of business, whether large or small and in the
public as well as the private sectors. Particularly, in view of constraints like risks,
uncertainties, as well as availability of resources, budgeting is all the more necessary.
In general, it shall be helpful (a) as a tool for management control, (b) as an
instrument of delegation and accountability, (c) as a means of communication, and
(d) as an effective weapon for evaluating the overall performance of an enterprise.
But since the risk and uncertainty as to price and consumer behaviour, etc., are
serious handicaps, the flexible budgeting approach or the technique of preparing
alternative forecasts may be usefully adopted. On account of such factors, the
budget period will naturally vary. A long-term budget, combined with annual budgets
further broken up into quarterly, monthly, weekly or even daily estimates, may be
considered suitable under such conditions. Revision of budgets frequently may
have to be resorted to.
The budgets should not be imposed from above, i.e., the top management.
For successful programming, it is essential that the urge for their implementation
comes from within and for that participation of all concerned is a must. Budgeting
should emerge from the middle management, it should roll upwards and downwards
and then finalized by the top management in the light of suggestions and criticisms
received. In view of the rapidly changing circumstances, it is imperative that the
budgets are reviewed regularly by the budget committee and necessary amendments
incorporated continuously on the basis of altered conditions.
Control Ratios
Three important ratios are commonly used by the management to find out whether
the deviations of actuals from budgeted results are favourable or otherwise. These
ratios are expressed in terms of percentages. If the ratio is 100% or more, the
trend is taken as favourable. The trend is taken as unfavourable if the ratio is less
than 100. These ratios are:
Activity Ratio: It is a measure of the level of activity attained over a period. It is
obtained when the number of standard hours equivalent to the work produced are
expressed as a percentage of the budgeted hours.
Standard Hours for Actual Production
Activity Ratio = × 100
Budgeted Hours
Capacity (or Capacity Utilization) Ratio: This ratio indicates whether, and to
what extent, budgeted hours of activity are actually utilized. It is the relationship
Self-Instructional
494 Material
between the actual number of working hours and the maximum possible number Budgeting and
Budgetary Control
of working hours in a budget period.
Actual Hours Worked
Capacity Ratio = × 100
Budgeted Hours
NOTES
Efficiency Ratio: This ratio indicates the degree of efficiency attained in
production. It is obtained when the standard hours equivalent to the work produced
are expressed as a percentage of the actual hours spent in producing that work.
Sometimes the following two more control ratios are computed for comparing the
budgeted performance with the actual performance. These ratios are as:
1. Calendar Ratio: The ratio expresses the relationship between the available
number of working days in a period with the budgeted number of working
days in the concerned period. The available number of working days are
computed by taking into account some special holidays due to some
unforeseen event. The ratio is expressed as follows:
Available Working Days
Calendar Ratio = × 100
Budgeted Working Days
2. Capacity Usage Ratio: The ratio expresses the relationship between the
budgeted number of working hours and the maximum possible number of
working hours in a budget period. The term budgeted hours represents the
number of actual hours expected to be worked in a period while the term
maximum possible budgeted hours represents the standard hours expected
to be earned in a budget period. The ratio is expressed as follows:
Capacity Usage Ratio = Budgeted Hours
× 100
Maximum Possible Hours in Budget Period
Self-Instructional
Material 495
Budgeting and
Budgetary Control
Check Your Progress
6. What are the factors on which the ‘budget period’ is dependent upon?
NOTES 7. Name the budgets on which the financial budget is prepared.
1. The difference between budgets, budgeting and budgetary control has been
stated thus: ‘‘Budgets are the individual objectives of a department etc.,
whereas budgeting may be said to be the act of building budgets. Budgetary
Control embraces all and in addition includes the science of planning the
budgets themselves and the utilisation of such budgets to effect an overall
management tool for the business planning and control.’’
2. Forecast is known as the basis for the budget.
3. On the basis of purpose, budgets are classified as: operating budget and
financial budget.
4. The methods used to prepare a cash budget are: (i) receipts and payments
method; (ii) the adjusted profit and loss account t method; and (iii) the
balance sheet method.
5. The cost of production budget is the third step in preparation of the master
budget.
6. The ‘budget period’ is dependent upon (i) the nature of the business, and
(ii) control techniques to be applied.
7. The financial budget is prepared on the basis of sales forecast and production
budget.
13.6 SUMMARY
Self-Instructional
496 Material
(c) It is a statement expressed in monetary and/or physical units prepared Budgeting and
Budgetary Control
for the implementation of policy formulated by the management.
The difference between budgets, budgeting and budgetary control has been
stated thus: ‘‘Budgets are the individual objectives of a department etc., NOTES
whereas budgeting may be said to be the act of building budgets. Budgetary
Control embraces all and in addition includes the science of planning the
budgets themselves and the utilisation of such budgets to effect an overall
management tool for the business planning and control.’’
The advantages of budgetary control to the management can be summarized
as follows: brings economy in working, establishes coordination, guards
against undue optimism, adoption of standard costing principles, favour
with credit agencies, decrease in production costs, etc.
The limitations of budgetary control: opposition against the very spirit of
budgeting, time factor, requires cooperation, budgeting and changing
economy, etc.
A forecast is the statement of facts likely to occur. According to the Chartered
Institute of Management Accountants, London, forecast is ‘‘a statement of
probable events’’. At planning stage it is necessary to prepare forecasts of
probable course of action for the business in future.
Budgets can be classified into different categories from different points of
view. The following are most common basis of classification:
(1) According to Time.
(2) According to Function.
(3) According to Flexibility.
(4) According to Purpose
Classification According to Time includes: long-term budgets, short-term
budgets, current budgets, and rolling budgets.
Classification According to Function includes: sales, production, cost of
production, purchase, personnel, research, capital expenditure, cash and
master budgets.
Classification According to Flexibility includes: fixed and flexible budgets.
Classification According to Purpose includes: operating and financial budgets
The Master Budget is “a summary of the budget schedules in capsule form
made for the purpose of presenting in one report the highlights of the budget
forecast”. The Chartered Institute of Management Accountants (CIMA),
London, defines it as “the summary budget, incorporating its component
functional budgets, which is finally approved, adopted and employed”.
Self-Instructional
Material 497
Budgeting and In order to have an effective system of budgetary control, the following
Budgetary Control
steps are to be followed: determination of the objectives, organization for
budgeting, creation of budget manual, determination of responsibility for
budgeting and determination of the budget period.
NOTES
Self-Instructional
498 Material
6. Enumerate the various factors which should considered while preparing the Budgeting and
Budgetary Control
sale budget and the production budget.
7. What are the steps involved in the preparation of a production budget?
8. What is a ‘Budget Manual’? What matters are included in it? NOTES
9. Explain the difference between Fixed Budget and Flexible Budget.
Long Answer Questions
1. Explain the main steps of Budgetary Control with reference to manufacturing-
cum-selling enterprise.
2. What do you mean by Budgetary Control? Explain the objectives of
Budgetary Control with special reference to a large manufacturing concern.
3. Explain what is meant by Flexible Budget and its utility. Prepare a proforma
of Flexible Budge of a manufacturing concern for their imaginary activity
leavels in a suitable form.
4. What do you understand by Budget and Budgetary Control? Given
examples of five budgets that may be prepared and employed by a
manufacturing concern.
5. What is principal budget factor? Given a list of such factor and
explain how you would proceed to prepare budgets in the case of
manufacturing company.
6. Explain the objectives and limitations of budgetary control and the
preliminaries to be completed before introducing a budgetary control system
in a organization.
7. What is budgetary control? Explain briefly the salient features of sales budget,
production budget and cash budget.
8. Write short notes on:
(i) Budgetary Control
(ii) Budget Centre
(iii) Functional Budget
(iv) Master Budget
(v) Zero Based Budgeting
(vi) ResponsibilityAccounting
9. Write short notes on:
(i) Feedback System
(ii) Master Budget
(iii) Flexible Budget
Self-Instructional
Material 499
Budgeting and
Budgetary Control 13.9 FURTHER READINGS
Self-Instructional
500 Material
Capital Budgeting System
14.0 INTRODUCTION
A business organization has to quite often face the problem of capital investment
decisions. Capital investment refers to the investment in projects whose results
would be available only after a year. Investments in these projects are quite heavy
and to be made immediately, but the return will be available only after a period of
time. The following are some of the cases where heavy capital investment may be
necessary:
(i) Replacements: Replacements of fixed assets may become necessary either
on account of their being worn out or becoming outdated on account of
new technology.
(ii) Expansion: A firm may have to expand its production capacity on account
of high demand for its products and inadequate production capacity. This
will need additional capital investment.
(iii) Diversification: A business may like to reduce its risk by operating in
several markets rather than in a single market. In such an event, capital
investment may become necessary for purchase of machinery and facilities
to handle the new products.
(iv) Research and Development: Large sums of money may have to be
expended for research and development in case of those industries where
technology is rapidly changing. In case large sums of money are needed for
equipment, these proposals will normally be included in the capital budget.
(v) Miscellaneous: A firm may have to invest money in projects which do not
directly help in achieving profit-oriented goals. For example, installation
of pollution control equipment may by necessary on account of legal
requirements. Thus, funds will be required for such purposes also.
14.2.1 Concept of Capital Budgeting
The term ‘Capital Budgeting’ refers to long-term planning for proposed capital
outlays and their financing. Thus, it includes both raising of long-term funds as well
Self-Instructional
502 Material
as their utilization. It may thus be defined as ‘the firm’s formal process for the Capital Budgeting System
one system will rule out the acceptance of another. Thus, two or more mutually
exclusive proposals cannot both or all be accepted. Some technique has to be
used for selecting the better or the best one. Once this is done, other alternatives
automatically get eliminated. NOTES
Illustration 14.2. A company intends to replace an old machine with a new machine.
From the following information you are required to determine the net cash required
for such replacement:
Self-Instructional
Material 507
Capital Budgeting System Cost of the old machine ` 50,000
Life of the old machine 5 years
Depreciation according to straightline method
Remaining useful life 2 years
NOTES Cost of the new machine 70,000
Installation charges 10,000
Amount realized on sale of old machine 25,000
Additional working capital required 5,000
Income tax 50 per cent
Capital gains tax 30 per cent
Investment allowance 20 per cent
Solution:
ESTIMATION OF CASH REQUIREMENT FOR REPLACEMENT
Cost of the new machine ` 70,000
Add: Installation charges 10,000
Additional working capital required 5,000
Additional tax liability:
Income tax 5,000 × 50/100 2,500
Capital gains tax —
87,500
Less: Amount realized on sale of old machine 25,000
Investment allowance (70,000 × 20/100) 14,000 39,000
Net cash outflow 48,500
The difference between the two will be clear with the following example.
Example
Benefit as per Benefit as per
Accounting Cash flow NOTES
approach approach
Sales (i) ` 10,000 ` 10,000
Less: Cost of sales (ii) :
Direct material 3,000 3,000
Direct labour 2,000 2,000
Depreciation 1,000 —
Indirect expenses 1,000 1,000
7,000 6,000
Net income/cash flow before tax (i) – (ii) 3,000 4,000
Tax (say at 50 per cent of net income of ` 3,000) 1,500 1,500
Net income/cash after tax 1,500 2,500
The above example shows that the amount of cash flow is `1,000 more
than the amount of accounting profit. The accounting approach shows that only
`1,500 is available after meeting all expenses, while the cash flow approach shows
that `2,500 is available for investment.
The cash flow approach for determination of benefit from a capital investment
project is better as compared to the accounting profit approach on account of the
following reasons:
(i) Determination of economic value
While making capital budgeting decisions, a firm is interested in determining the
economic value of the project which can only be determined by comparing the
cash inflows (benefits) with the cash outflows associated with the project. The
firm can by comparing them to find out for itself whether the future economic
inflows are sufficiently large to warrant the initial investment. The accounting profit
approach allocates the cost of investment over the economic useful life of the asset
in the form of depreciation rather than at the time when the cost is actually incurred.
It, therefore, fails to reflect the original need for cash at the time of investment. It
also does not bring out clearly the actual size of cash inflows and outflows in later
years. On account of these reasons the cash flow approach is more appropriate
for capital budgeting decisions.
(ii) Accounting ambiguities
Accounting profit approach is full of ambiguities on account of different accounting
policies and practices, regarding valuation of inventory, allocation of costs, calculation
of depreciation and amortization of various other expenses. The amount of profit
may therefore vary according to accounting policies and practices adopted while
preparing the accounts. However, there will be only one set of cash flows associated
with a project. Obviously, therefore, the cash flow approach is superior to the
accounting profit approach.
Self-Instructional
Material 509
Capital Budgeting System (iii) Time value of money
Under usual accounting practices revenue is considered to be realized not at the
time when the cash is received, but at the time the sale is made. It means the
amount of profit shown by the books may simply be a paper figure if the sales are
NOTES
not realized. Similarly, expenditure is recognized as being made not when the
payment is made out, but at the time it is incurred. Thus, the time taken in realizing
or making payments is completely ignored. The cash flow approach recognizes
the time value of money by comparing actual cash inflows and cash outflows.
Moreover, in order to have a better picture even the future cash inflows are
discounted and their present worth is found out.
On account of the above reasons, the accounting profit approach, though
quite useful in measuring performance of an enterprise, is less useful as a tool for
managerial decisions.
Conventional and non-conventional cash flows: In case of conventional
cash flows, an initial cash outflow is followed by a series of cash inflows whether
of uniform or of different amounts. Most of the capital budgeting decisions follow
this pattern. For example, a firm may spend `5,000 on capital asset in zero time
period and may receive `1,000 each year for eight years.
In case of unconventional cash flows, initial cash outflow is not followed by
a series of cash inflows. In other words, there may be not one but a series of cash
outflows followed by a series of cash inflows. For example, a firm may purchase
a plant for a sum of `10,000. This cash outflow may be followed by cash inflows
of `3,000 each year for five years. However, after five years the asset may need
overhauling resulting in a cash outflow of `3,000. This may give a new lease of life
to the asset and it may be followed by a series of cash inflows. This practice may
continue in future years also.
4. Ranking of the investment proposals: When a number of projects appear
to be acceptable on the basis of their profitability the projects will be ranked in
order of their profitability in order to determine the most profitable project. Ranking
of capital investment proposals is particularly necessary in the following two
circumstances:
(a) Where capital is rationed, i.e., there is a limit on funds available for investment.
This aspect is being discussed in detail later in the unit.
(b) Where, two or more investment opportunities are mutually exclusive, i.e.,
only one of the opportunities can be undertaken.
Thus, the objective of ranking is to put the capital available to the best
possible use. This will be clear from the following illustration.
Illustration 14.3. A Ltd is considering the following five projects for capital
expenditure. The company can spare a sum of `1,50,000 and expect a minimum
return of 15 per cent before tax on the investment. The details of the projects are
as under:
Self-Instructional
510 Material
Projects Capital expenditure Estimated savings Percentage return Capital Budgeting System
after tax on investment
(before tax)
(i) (ii) (iii) (iv)
A ` 50,000 ` 5,000 20 NOTES
B 75,000 9,000 24
C 1,00,000 8,000 16
D 1,25,000 25,000 40
E 1,50,000 28,000 37
Tax rate may be taken at 50 per cent.
Solution:
On the basis of the information given, project D seems to be the most profitable,
since it is giving the highest percentage return on investment. However, in case this
project is taken up `25,000 will be the surplus amount available with the company
for alternative investment. In case project D is taken up, the full amount of
` 1,50,000 would be used up. The difference between the additional investment
required and the additional income before tax is `25,000 and `6,000 respectively
giving a return of 24 per cent on the balance of `25,000. In case such an opportunity
is not available, the company should take up project E.
5. Risk and uncertainty: Different capital investment proposals have different
degrees of risk and uncertainty. There is a slight difference between risk and
uncertainty. Risk involves situations in which the probabilities of a particular event
occuring are known whereas in uncertainty, these probabilities are not known. Of
course in most cases these two terms are used interchangeably. Risk in capital
investment decisions may be due to general economic conditions, competition,
technological developments, consumer preferences, labour condition, etc. On
account of these reasons the revenues, costs and economic life of a particular
investment are not certain. While evaluating capital investment proposals, proper
adjustment should therefore be made for risk and uncertainty.
14.2.5 Determination of Cash Flows for Investment Analysis
Capital budgeting decisions require computation of both cash outflows for and
cash inflows from a project.
Cash Outflows: They consitute the capital investment required for a project. The
capital investment required, as explained in the preceding pages, is computed on
the following basis:
(i) Cost of plant, equipment, building etc.
(ii) Installation cost of plant, equipment, etc.
(iii) Additional working capital required for the project
(iv) Proceeds from sale of old asset(s). The amount, realized from sale of the
old asset(s), as adjusted by tax effects, will reduce the capital investment.
Self-Instructional
Material 511
Capital Budgeting System Cash Inflows: They represent the cash profit or return generated by the project
year after year. The accounting profit will have to be adjusted for non-cash items for
this purpose.
The cash flows (both inflows and outflows) may take any one of the following
NOTES
parterns over the project life.
(i) Conventional Cash Flows: A situation where initial cash outflow is
followed by a series of cash inflows, whether of uniform or of different
amounts.
(ii) Unconventional Cash Flows: There may be a series of cash outflows
and a series of cash inflows, whether of uniform or of different amounts.
Investment analysis, i.e., evaluating the profitability or otherwise of a capital
budgeting decision is largely based on the cash flows. This is explained in detail in
the following pages.
inflow of `5,000 for ten years, the payback period will be four years calculated as
follows:
Initial Investment
Payback Period = NOTES
Annual Cash Inflow
` 20,000
` 5,000
The annual cash inflow is calculated by taking into account the amount of
net income on account of the asset (or project) before depreciation but after taxation.
The income so earned, if expressed as a percentage of initial investment, is termed
as ‘unadjusted rate to return’. In the above case, it will be calculated as follows:
Annual Return
Unadjusted Rate of Return 100
Initial Investment
` 5,000
100 25 per cent
` 20,000
The economic life of machine No. 1 is two years, while it is three years for the
other two. The scrap values are ` 40,000, ` 25,000 and ` 30,000 respectively.
Sales are expected to be at the rates shown for each year during the full
economic life of the machines. The costs relate to annual expenditure resulting from
each machine.
Tax to be paid is expected at 50 per cent of the net earnings of each year. It
may be assumed that all payables and receivables will be settled promptly, strictly on
a cash basis with no outstanding from one accounting year to another. Interest on
capital has to be paid at 8 per cent per annum.
You are requested to show which machine would be the most profitable
investment on the principle of ‘payback method’.
Solution:
STATEMENT SHOWING THE NET CASH FLOW OF THREE MACHINES
Machine 1 Machine 2 Machine 3
` ` `
Capital Cost 3,00,000 3,00,000 3,00,000
Sales (i) 5,00,000 4,00,000 4,50,000
Cost of Production 1,50,000 1,30,000 1,42,000
Administration Cost 20,000 10,000 15,000
Selling and Distribution Cost 10,000 10,000 10,000
Total Cost (ii) 1,80,000 1,50,000 1,67,000
Profit before depreciation and interest (i) - (ii) - (iii) 3,20,000 2,50,000 2,83,000
Depreciation:
Cost less scrap value
1,30,000 91,667 90,000
Economic life
Interest on borrowings 24,000 24,000 24,000
Depreciation and Interest (iv) 1,54,000 1,15,667 1,14,000
Self-Instructional
514 Material
Profit before tax (iii) - (iv) 1,66,000 1,34,333 1,69,000 Capital Budgeting System
Taxation (50 per cent) 83,000 67,167 84,500
Profit after tax 83,000 67,166 84,500
Add: Depreciation 1,30,000 91,667 90,000
Net Cash Inflow 2,13,000 1,58,833 1,74,500
NOTES
Payback period 1.41 years 1,89 years 1.72 years
Machine No. 1 is most profitable.
Note:
(i) It has been presumed that interest on borrowings throughout the economic life of the asset.
(ii) Factory overheads do not include depreciation.
(iii) No borrowings will be required for working capital.
Merits
The payback method has the following merits:
1. The method is very useful in evaluation of those projects which involve high
uncertainty. Political instability, rapid technological development of cheap
substitutes, etc., are some of the reasons which discourage one to take up
projects having a long gestation period. Payback method is useful in such
cases.
2. The method makes it clear that no profit arises till the payback period is
over. This helps new companies in deciding when they should start paying
dividends.
3. The method is simple to understand and easy to work out.
4. The method reduces the possibility of loss on account of obsolescence as
the method prefers investment in short-term projects.
Demerits
The method has the following demerits.
1. The method ignores the returns generated by a project after its payback
period. Projects having long gestation period will never be taken up if this
method is followed though they may yield high returns for a long period.
Consider the following example.
Example Project A Project B
Initial Investment ` 10,000 ` 10,000
Cash Inflows:
Year 1 4,000 3.000
2 4,000 3,000
3 2.000 3,000
4 —— 3,000
5 —— 3,000
Payback Period 3 years 3.33 years
In the above case Project A has a shorter payback period and therefore it
should be preferred over B. But this may not be rational decision since
project B continues to give return after the payback period which fact has
Self-Instructional
Material 515
Capital Budgeting System been completely ignored. As a matter of fact, on the whole, Project B is
more profitable as compared to Project A
2. The method does not take into account the time value of money. In other
words, it ignores the interest which is an important factor in making sound
NOTES
investment decisions. A rupee tomorrow is worth less than a rupee today.
The following example makes this point clear:
Example. There are two projects A and B. The cost of the project is
` 30,000 in each case. The cash inflows are as under:
Cash Inflows
Year Project ‘A’ Project ‘B’
1 ` 10,000 ` 2.000
2 10,000 4,000
3 10,000 24,000
The payback period is three years in both the cases. However, project A
should be preferred as compared to project B because of speedy recovery of the
initial investment.
Discounted Payback Period Method. The method discussed above is
Traditional Payback Period Method. However in order to overcome the criticism
that this method does not take into account the time value of money, the discounted
payback period method is recommended. In case of this method, the present
value of cash inflows arising at different time intervals at the desired rate of interest
(depending upon the cost of capital) are found out. The present values so calculated
are now taken as the real cash inflows for determination of the payback period.
This technique can better be understood by the students after studying NPV Method
discussed in the following pages.
14.3.2 Discounted Cash Flow (DCF) Method or Time Adjusted
Technique
The discounted cash flow technique is an improvement of the payback period
method. It takes into account both the interest factor as well as the return after the
payback period. The method involves three stages:
(i) Calculation of cash flows, i.e., both inflows and outflows (preferably
after tax) over the full life of the asset.
(ii) Discounting the cash flows so calculated by a discount factor.
(iii) Aggregating discounted cash inflows and comparing the total with the
discounted cash outflows.
Discounted cash flow technique thus recognizes that Re 1 of today (the
cash outflow) is worth more than Re 1 received at a future date (cash inflow).
Discounted cash flow methods for evaluating capital investment proposals are of
three types as explained below:
Self-Instructional
516 Material
(a) The Net Present Value (NPV) Method Capital Budgeting System
This is generally considered to be the best method for evaluating the capital
investment proposals. In case of this method cash inflows and cash outflows
associated with each project are first worked out. The present value of these cash
NOTES
inflows and outflows is then calculated at the rate of return acceptable to the
management. This rate of return is considered as the cut-off rate and is generally
determined on the basis of cost of capital suitably adjusted to allow for the risk
element involved in the project. Cash outflows represent the investment and
commitments of cash in the project at various points of time. The working capital
is taken as a cash outflow in the year the project starts commercial production.
Profit after tax but before depreciation represents cash inflows. The Net Present
Value (NPV) is the difference between the total present value of future cash inflows
and the total present value of future cash outflows.
The equation for calculating NPV in case of conventional cash flows can be
put as follows:
R1 R2 R3 Rn
NPV 1
2
3
1
( I K ) ( I K ) (I K ) ( I K ) n
In case of non-conventional cash inflows(i.e., where there are a series of
cash inflows as well cash outflows) the equation for calculating NPV is as follows:
R1 R2 R3 Rn
NPV
1 2
( I K ) ( I K ) ( I K )3 ( I K ) n
I1 I2 I3 In
I0 n
( I K )1 ( I K ) 2 ( I K )3 ( I K ) n
where, NPV = Net present value, R = Cash inflows at different time periods,
K = Cost of capital or Cut-off rate, I = Cash outflows at different time periods.
Accept or reject criterion
The net present value can be used as an ‘accept or reject’ criterion. In case the
NPV is positive (i.e., present value of cash inflows is more than present value of
cash outflows) the project should be accepted. However, if the NPV is negative
(i.e., present value of cash inflows is less than the present value of cash outflows)
the project should be rejected. Symbolically, the accept/reject criterion can be put
as follows:
where NPV > Zero accept the proposal
NPV < Zero reject the proposal
Or where PV > C accept the proposal
PV < C reject the proposal
Self-Instructional
Material 517
Capital Budgeting System PV stands for Present Value of Cash Inflows and C for Present Value of
Cash Outflows (or outlays).
Illustration 14.5. Calculate the net present value for a small sized project requiring
an initial investment of ` 20,000, and which provides a net cash inflow of ` 6,000
NOTES
each year for six years. Assume the cost of funds to be 8 per cent per annum and
that there is no scrap value.
Solution: The present value of an annuity of Re 1 for six years at 8 per cent per
annum interest is ` 4.623.
Hence, the present value of ` 6,000 comes to:
6,000 × 4.623 = ` 27,738
Less Initial Investment ` 20,000
Net Present Value (NPV) ` 7,738
Illustration 14.6. A choice is to be made between two competing projects which
require an equal investment of ` 50,000 and are expected to generate net cash flows
as under:
Project I Project II
End of year 1 ` 25,000 ` 10,000
End of year 2 15,000 12,000
End of year 3 10,000 18,000
End of year 4 Nil 25,000
End of year 5 12,000 8,000
End of year 6 6,000 4,000
The cost of capital of the company is 10 per cent. The following are the
Present Value Factors @ 10 per cent per annum:
Year P.V. Factors
@ 10 per cent per annum
1 0.909
2 0.826
3 0.751
4 0.683
5 0.621
6 0.564
Which project proposal should be chosen and why? Evaluate the project
proposals under:
(a) Payback Period, and
(b) Discounted Cash Flow methods, pointing out their relative merits and
demerits.
Self-Instructional
518 Material
Solution: Capital Budgeting System
PAYBACK PERIOD METHOD
Project I Project II
Cash inflows Cum. cash Cash Cum. cash
inflows inflows inflows NOTES
End of year 1 ` 25,000 ` 25,000 ` 10,000 ` 10,000
End of year 2 15,000 40,000 12,000 22,000
End of year 3 10,000 50,000 18,000 40,000
End of year 4 Nil 50.000 25,000 65,000
End of year 5 12,000 62,000 8,000 73,000
End of year 6 6,000 68,000 4,000 77,000
Project I has the payback period of three years while project II has a payback
period of 3.4 years (i.e., ` 40,000 in three years and ` 10,000 in the fourth year).
Thus, Project I has to be preferred because it has a shorter payback period.
DISCOUNTED CASH FLOW METHOD
Project I
Project II
Year Cash inflow Discount Present
factor at ` 10 value
per cent per annum `
1 10,000 0.909 9,090
2 12,000 0.826 9,912
3 18,000 0.751 13,518
4 25,000 0.683 17,075
5 8,000 0.621 4.968
6 4,000 0.564 2,256
Total Present Value of Future Cash Inflows 56,819
Initial Investment 50,000
Net Present Value (NPV) 6,819
Self-Instructional
Material 519
Capital Budgeting System Both projects need the same investment of ` 50,000. However, in case of
Project I, there is a surplus of ` 3,461, while in case of Project II, there is a
surplus of ` 6,819. Hence Project II is to be preferred.
NOTES Relative merits and demerits of the two methods: Payback period method
is relatively simple to understand and easy to work out as compared to the
discounted cash flow method. However, it does not take into account the return
after the payback period. Moreover, payback period ignores the time value of
money. Discounted cash flow method does not have these disadvantages. It takes
into account the returns over the effective life of the asset besides considering the
future cash inflows. The method is, therefore, more scientific and dependable.
(b) Excess Present Value Index
This is a refinement of the net present value method. Instead of working out the
net present value, a present value index is found out by comparing the total of
present value of future cash inflows and the total of the present value of future cash
outflows. This can be put in the form of the following formula:
Excess Present Value Index
(Or Benefits Cost (B/C) Ratio)
Present value of future cash inflows
100
Present value of future cash outflows
Excess Present Value Index provides ready comparison between investment
proposals of different magnitudes. For example, Project ‘A’ requiring an investment
of ` 1,00,000 shows excess present value of ` 20,000 while another project ‘B’
requiring an investment of ` 10,000 shows an excess on present value of ` 5,000.
If absolute figures of net present values are compared, Project ‘A’ may seem to
be profitable.
However, if excess present value index method is followed Project ‘B’
would prove to be profitable.
1, 20,000
Present Value Index for Project A 100 120 per cent
1,00,000
15,000
Present Value Index for Project B 100 150 per cent
10,000
Illustration 14.7. On the basis of figures given in the previous illustration, state
which project is profitable according to the Present Value Index Method.
Self-Instructional
520 Material
Solution: Capital Budgeting System
56,819
Project II 100 114 per cent (approx.)
50,000
Since, Project II has a higher Present Value Index hence it is more profitable as
compared to Project I.
(c) Internal Rate of Return (IRR)
Internal Rate of Return is that rate at which the sum of discounted cash inflows equals
the sum of discounted cash outflows. In other words, it is the rate which discounts the
cash flows to zero. It can be stated in the form of a ratio as follows:
Cash inflows
1
Cash outflows
Thus, in case of this method the discount rate is not known but the cash outflows
and cash inflows are known. For example, if a sum of ` 800 invested in a project
becomes ` 1,000 at the end of a year, the rate of return comes to 25 per cent,
calculated as follows:
R
I
I r
where,
I = Cash Outflow, i.e., Initial Investment
R = Cash Inflow
r = Rate of Return Yielded by the Investment (or IRR)
Thus:
800 = 1,000/1 + r
or 800 r + 800 = 1,000
or 800 r = 200
or r = 200/800 = 0.25 or 25%
In case of return is over a number of years, the calculation would take the
following pattern in case of conventional cash flows:
R1 R2 R3 Rn
I 1
2
3
(1 r ) (1 r ) (1 r ) (1 r ) n
Self-Instructional
Material 521
Capital Budgeting System In case of unconventional cash flows, the equation would be as follows:
R1 R2 R3 Rn
.........
1
(1 r ) (1 r )
2
(1 r )3 (1 r )n
NOTES
R1 R2 R3 Rn
I
0 .........
(1 r )1 (1 r ) 2 (1 r )3 (1 r ) n
where,
I = Cash outlay (or outflow) at different time periods.
R = Cash inflows at different time periods.
r = Rate of return yielded by the investment (or IRR).
Since I and R are known factors, r is the only factor to be calculated.
However, calculation will become very difficult over a long period if worked out
according to the above equations. Tabular values are, therefore, used.
Accept/Reject Criterion
Internal rate of return is the maximum rate of interest which an organization can
afford to pay on the capital invested in a project. A project would qualify to be
accepted if IRR exceeds the cut-off rate. While evaluating two or more projects, a
project giving a higher internal rate of return would be preferred. This is because the
higher the rate of return, the more profitable is the investment.
(1) Where cash inflows are uniform: In the case of those projects which
result in uniform cash inflows, the internal rate of return can be calculated by locating
the Factor in Annuity Table II. The factor is calculated as follows:
I
F
C
where,
F = Factor to be located
I = Original investment
C = Cash inflow per year
Illustration 14.8. An equipment requires an initial investment of ` 6,000. The annual
cash flow is estimated at ` 2,000 for five years.
Calculate the internal rate or return.
Solution:
The annual cash flow is uniform at ` 2,000 for five years. Hence, the ‘Factor’ or the
‘Payback’ is 3, calculated by:
I 6,000
F or F=` 3
C 2,000
Self-Instructional
522 Material
This factor of 3 should be located in Table II in the line of five years. The Capital Budgeting System
However, such an effort may not be very useful in the present case since
` 2.99 is very near to 3 and hence the internal rate of returns can be taken as 20 per
cent.
` 2.99 is as a matter of fact the present value of Re 1 received annuity for five
years at 20 per cent interest rate. In case this amount is multiplied by the annual cash
inflow it will be equal to the initial investment as shown below:
` 2,000 × 2.99 = ` 5,980 (or say ` 6,000)
Relationship between payback reciprocal and rate of return
Payback reciprocal is exactly equal to the unadjusted rate of return. Unadjusted rate
means a rate which has not been adjusted by taking into account the time value of
money. For example, in the illustration given above the payback period comes to
three years. Its reciprocal is 1/3 or 0.33 or 33 per cent. The annual return is ` 2,000
on an investment of ` 6,000. It also comes to 33 per cent.
Payback reciprocal also gives a reasonable approximation of the time-
adjusted rate of return as is proved by the above illustration. Of course for calculating
the discounted rate Table II has to be consulted. However, there are two
assumptions for the use of payback reciprocal:
(i) The useful life of the project/asset should be at least twice the payback
reciprocal. In any case the payback reciprocal will always exceed the true
or the discounted rate of return.
(ii) The cash inflows should be uniform over the life of the project/asset.
(2) Where cash inflows are not uniform: When cash inflows are not uniform, the
internal rate of return is calculated by making trial calculations in an attempt to
compute the correct interest rate which equates the present value of cash inflows
with the present value of cash outflows. In the process, cash inflows are to be
discounted by a number of trial rates. The first trial rate may be calculated on the
basis of the same formula which is used for determining the internal rate of return
when cash inflows are uniform, as explained above. However, in this case ‘C’ stands
for ‘annual average cash inflow’, in place of ‘annual cash inflow.’
After applying the first trial rate, the second trial rate is determined when the
total present value of the cash inflows is greater or less than the total present value of
cash outflows. In case the total present value of cash inflows is less than the total
present value of cash outflows, the second trial rate taken will be lower than the first
rate. In case the present total value of cash inflows exceeds the present total value of
Self-Instructional
Material 523
Capital Budgeting System cash outflows, a trial rate higher than first trial rate will be used. This process will
continue till the two flows more or less set off each other. This will be the ‘internal
rates of return’.
Illustration 14.9. A company has to select one of the following two projects:
NOTES
Cost Project A Project B
Cash inflows: ` 11,000 10,000
Year 1 6,000 1,000
Year 2 2,000 1,000
Year 3 1,000 2,000
Year 4 5,000 10,000
Using the Internal Rate of Return Method suggest which project is preferable.
Solution:
The cash inflows are not uniform and hence the internal rate ofreturn will have to be
calculated by the Trial and Error Method. In order to have an approximate idea
about such rate, it will be better to find out the ‘factor’. The factor reflects the same
relationship of investment and ‘cash inflows’ as in case of payback calculations:
Thus,
I
F
C
where, F = Factor to be located
I = Original investment
C = Average cash inflow per year
The ‘factor’ in case of project A would be:
11,000
F 3.14
3,500
The ‘factor’ in case of project B would be:
10,000
F 2.86
3,000
The factor thus calculated will be located in Table II on the line representing
number of years corresponding to estimated useful life of the asset. This would give
the estimated rate of return to be applied for discounting the cash inflows for the
internal rate of return.
In case of Project A, the rate comes to 10 per cent while in case of project B
it comes to 15 per cent.
Self-Instructional
524 Material
Project A: Capital Budgeting System
The present value at 10 per cent comes to ` 11,272. The initial investment is `
11,000. Internal rate of return may be taken approximately at 10 per cent.
In case more exactness is required another trial rate which is slightly higher
than 10 per cent (since at this rate the present value is more than initial investment)
may be taken. Taking a rate of 12 per cent, the following results would emerge.
Year Cash Inflows Discounting Factor at 12 per cent Present Value
1 ` 6,000 0.893 ` 5,358
2 2,000 0.797 1,594
3 1,000 0.712 712
4 5,000 0.636 3,180
Total Present Value 10,844
The internal rate of return is thus more than 10 per cent, but less than 12 per
cent. The exact rate may be calculated as follows:
Difference in calculated
present value and required
net cash outlay
Internal Rate of Return = Difference in rate
Difference in calculated
present values
11,272 11,000
10% 2
11,272 10,844
272
10% 2 11.3 per cent
428
Self-Instructional
Material 525
Capital Budgeting System Project B:
Year Cash Inflows Discount Factor Present Value
at 15 per cent
1 ` 1,000 0.870 ` 870
NOTES 2 1,000 0. 756 756
3 2,000 0. 658 1,316
4 10,000 0.572 5,720
Present Value 8,662
Since present value at 15 per cent comes only to ` 8,662, a lower rate of
discount should be taken. Taking a rate of 10 per cent, the following will be the result:
Year Cash Inflows Discount Factor Present Value
at 10 per cent
1 ` 1,000 0.909 ` 909
2 1,000 0. 826 826
3 2,000 0.7518 1,502
4 10,000 0.683 6,830
Present Value 10,067
The present value at 10 per cent comes to ` 10,067 which is more or less
equal to the initial investment. Hence, the internal rate of return may be taken 10 per
cent.
In order to have more exactness, the internal rate of return can be interpolated
as done in case of project A.
At 10 per cent the present value is + 67
At 15 per cent the present value is – 1,338
67 67
10% 5 10 5
67 1,338 1, 405
= 10 + .24 = 10.24 per cent.
Thus, internal rate of return in case of Project ‘A’ is higher as compared to
Project ‘B’. Hence, Project ‘A’ is preferable.
Merits
The merits of discounted cash flow method are as follows:
(i) Discounted cash flow technique takes into account the time value of money.
Conceptually, it is better than other techniques such as payback or accounting
rate of return.
(ii) The method takes into account directly the amount of expenses and revenues
over the project’s life. In case of other methods simply their averages are
taken.
(iii) The method automatically gives more weight to those money values which
are nearer to the present period than those which are farther from it. While
Self-Instructional
526 Material
in case of other methods, all money units are given the same weight which Capital Budgeting System
seems to be unrealistic.
(iv) The method makes possible comparison of projects requiring different capital
outlays, having different lives and different timings of cash flows at a particular NOTES
moment of time because of discounting of all cash flows.
Demerits
The following are the demerits of discounted cash flow method:
(i) The method is difficult to understand and work out as compared to other
methods of ranking capital investment proposals.
(ii) The method takes into account only the cash inflows on account of a capital
investment decision. As a matter of fact the profitability or otherwise of a
capital investment proposal can be judged only when the net income (and
not the cash inflow) on account of operations is considered.
(iii) The method is based on the presumption that cash inflows can be reinvested
at the discounting rate in the new projects. However, this presumption does
not always hold good because it all depends upon the available investment
opportunities.
Accounting or Average Rate of Return (ARR) Method
According to this method, the capital investment proposals are judged on the
basis of their relative profitability. For this purpose, capital employed and related
income are determined according to commonly accepted accounting principles
and practices over the entire economic life of the project and then the average
yield is calculated. Such a rate is termed as Accounting Rate of Return. It may be
calculated according to any of the following methods:
Annual Average Net Earnings
(i) 100
Original Investment
Self-Instructional
Material 527
Capital Budgeting System
Original investment – Scrap value of the asset
(b)
2
Original investment + Scrap value of the asset
NOTES (c)
2
Original investment – Scrap value Addl. Net Scrap
(d)
2 Working Capital Value
It may be noted that results obtained under each of the above methods will be
quite different from each other. It is, therefore, necessary that while evaluating capital
investment proposals, the same method is followed in each case.
Accept/Reject criterion
Normally, business enterprises fix a minimum rate of return. Any project expected to
give a return below this rate will be straightaway rejected.
In case of several projects, where a choice has to be made, the different
projects may be ranked in the ascending or descending order of their rate of return.
Projects below the minimum rate will be rejected. In case of projects giving rates of
return higher than the minimum rate, obviously projects giving a higher rate of return
will be preferred over those giving a lower rate of return.
Illustration 14.10. Alpha Limited is contemplating the purchase of a new machine
to replace a machine which has been in operation in the factory for the last five years.
Ignoring interest but considering tax at 50 per cent of net earnings, suggest
which of the two alternatives should be preferred. The following are the details:
Old Machine New Machine
Purchase price ` 40,000 ` 60,000
Estimated life of machine 10 years 10 years
Machine running hours per annum 2,000 2,000
Units per hour 24 36
Wages per running hour 3 5.25
Power per annum 2,000 4,500
Consumable stores per annum 6,000 7,500
All other charges per annum 8,000 9,000
Material cost per unit 0.50 0.50
Selling price per unit 1.25 1.25
Information regarding sales and cost of sales will hold good throughout the
economic life of each of the machines. Depreciation has to be charged according to
the straightline method.
Self-Instructional
528 Material
Solution: Capital Budgeting System
PROFITABILITY STATEMENT
Old Machine New Machine
Cost of the Machine (`) 40,000 60,000
Life of Machine (years) 10 10 NOTES
Output (Units) 48,000 72,000
Sales Value (`) 60,000 90,000
Less: Cost of Sales :
Direct material 24,000 36,000
Wages 6,000 10,500
Power 2,000 4,500
Consumable stores 6,000 7,500
Other charges 8,000 9,000
Depreciation 4,000 50,000 6,000 73,500
Profit before tax 10,000 16,500
Tax at 50 per cent 5,000 8,250
Profit after tax 5,000 8,250
Self-Instructional
Material 529
Capital Budgeting System (ii) The method embodies the concept of ‘net earnings’ while evaluating capital
investment projects which is absent in case of all other methods.
Disadvantages
NOTES The method suffers from the following disadvantages:
(i) The method does not take into account the time value of money. Thus, it
has the same fundamental defect as that of the payback method.
(ii) There are different methods for calculating the Accounting Rate of Return
due to diverse concepts of investments as well as earnings. Each method
gives different results. This reduces the reliability of the method.
On account of the above disadvantages, the Accounting Rate of Return
Method is not much in use these days.
It refers to the process in which restriction is put on the capital that can be invested
by the company. It can also be understood as the restriction on the projects that
can be taken up by the company. Ideally, all the profitable projects must be invested
in by companies but capital is not always that vast and the companies instead
undertake the rationing process of select which potential project meets their
budgetary restraints.
There are several advantages of capital rationing including the reduction of
wastage of financial resources, healthy budgets, better management of fewer
projects, better stability, and higher rate of return on investments as the best option
is chosen. However, capital rationing suffers from certain problems as well like
principles of effective capital market is transgressed, smaller projects will be chosen
instead of large scale investments, any mis calculation in the capital restrictions will
result in a loss for the company, intermediate cash flows are not included in the
decision and so may pose as a problem while the project is accepted and operations
underway, etc.
Generally, it is seen that capital rationing is brought into force by companies
when they receive low rate on investment from the current list of investments with
high investment costs. The main rationale for using the process of capital rationing
is to increase the shareholder’s wealth.
The steps involved in the capital rationing process are: (i) to analyse different
projects accounting rate of return and payback methods. (usually maximum
payback period and lowest desired accounting rate of return, (ii) the projects
clearing the first stage is then analysed through the internal rate of return and net
present value method and (iii) finally the projects clearing the second stage are
ranked as per predetermined criteria and funding restraints.
Self-Instructional
530 Material
Capital Budgeting System
14.6 SUMMARY
NOTES
14.7 KEY WORDS
Short-Answer Questions
1. ‘Capital expenditure decisions are by far the most important decisions in
the field of financial management’. Illustrate.
Self-Instructional
532 Material
2. Discuss briefly the Net Present Value Method vs. Internal Rate of Return Capital Budgeting System
Self-Instructional
Material 533